c4f03b25cdb4bb372447f380fd61d9288d40376b
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1604 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1605 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1606
1607 @smallexample
1608 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1609 main
1610 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1611 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1612 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1613 @end smallexample
1614
1615 @noindent
1616 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1617
1618 @table @code
1619 @kindex set max-completions
1620 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1621 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1622 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1623 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1624 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1625 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1626 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1627 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1628 completion slow.
1629 @kindex show max-completions
1630 @item show max-completions
1631 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1632 during completion.
1633 @end table
1634
1635 @cindex quotes in commands
1636 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1637 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1638 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1639 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1640 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1641 @value{GDBN} commands.
1642
1643 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1644 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1645 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1646 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1647 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1648 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1649 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1650 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1651 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1652 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1653 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1654
1655 @smallexample
1656 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1657 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1658 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1659 @end smallexample
1660
1661 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1662 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1663 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1664 place:
1665
1666 @smallexample
1667 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1668 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1669 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1670 @end smallexample
1671
1672 @noindent
1673 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1674 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1675 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1676
1677 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1678 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1679 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1680 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1681
1682 @cindex completion of structure field names
1683 @cindex structure field name completion
1684 @cindex completion of union field names
1685 @cindex union field name completion
1686 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1687 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1688 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1689 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1690 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1691 left-hand-side:
1692
1693 @smallexample
1694 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1695 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1696 to_data to_isatty to_write
1697 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1698 to_flush to_read
1699 @end smallexample
1700
1701 @noindent
1702 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1703 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1704 follows:
1705
1706 @smallexample
1707 struct ui_file
1708 @{
1709 int *magic;
1710 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1711 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1712 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1713 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1714 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1715 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1716 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1717 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1718 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1719 void *to_data;
1720 @}
1721 @end smallexample
1722
1723
1724 @node Help
1725 @section Getting Help
1726 @cindex online documentation
1727 @kindex help
1728
1729 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1730 using the command @code{help}.
1731
1732 @table @code
1733 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1734 @item help
1735 @itemx h
1736 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1737 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help
1741 List of classes of commands:
1742
1743 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1744 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1745 data -- Examining data
1746 files -- Specifying and examining files
1747 internals -- Maintenance commands
1748 obscure -- Obscure features
1749 running -- Running the program
1750 stack -- Examining the stack
1751 status -- Status inquiries
1752 support -- Support facilities
1753 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1754 stopping the program
1755 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1756
1757 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1758 commands in that class.
1759 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1760 documentation.
1761 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1762 (@value{GDBP})
1763 @end smallexample
1764 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1765
1766 @item help @var{class}
1767 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1768 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1769 help display for the class @code{status}:
1770
1771 @smallexample
1772 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1773 Status inquiries.
1774
1775 List of commands:
1776
1777 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1778 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1779 info -- Generic command for showing things
1780 about the program being debugged
1781 show -- Generic command for showing things
1782 about the debugger
1783
1784 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1785 documentation.
1786 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1787 (@value{GDBP})
1788 @end smallexample
1789
1790 @item help @var{command}
1791 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1792 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1793
1794 @kindex apropos
1795 @item apropos @var{args}
1796 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1797 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1798 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 apropos alias
1802 @end smallexample
1803
1804 @noindent
1805 results in:
1806
1807 @smallexample
1808 @c @group
1809 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1810 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1811 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1812 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1813 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1814 @c @end group
1815 @end smallexample
1816
1817 @kindex complete
1818 @item complete @var{args}
1819 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1820 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1821 command you want completed. For example:
1822
1823 @smallexample
1824 complete i
1825 @end smallexample
1826
1827 @noindent results in:
1828
1829 @smallexample
1830 @group
1831 if
1832 ignore
1833 info
1834 inspect
1835 @end group
1836 @end smallexample
1837
1838 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1839 @end table
1840
1841 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1842 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1843 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1844 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1845 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1846 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1847 Index}.
1848
1849 @c @group
1850 @table @code
1851 @kindex info
1852 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1853 @item info
1854 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1855 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1856 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1857 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1858 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1859 @w{@code{help info}}.
1860
1861 @kindex set
1862 @item set
1863 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1864 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1865 @code{set prompt $}.
1866
1867 @kindex show
1868 @item show
1869 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1870 @value{GDBN} itself.
1871 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1872 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1873 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1874 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1875
1876 @kindex info set
1877 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1878 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1879 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1880 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1881 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1882 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1883 @end table
1884 @c @end group
1885
1886 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1887 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1888
1889 @table @code
1890 @kindex show version
1891 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1892 @item show version
1893 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1894 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1895 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1896 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1897 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1898 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1899 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1900 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1901 @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show copying
1904 @kindex info copying
1905 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1906 @item show copying
1907 @itemx info copying
1908 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1909
1910 @kindex show warranty
1911 @kindex info warranty
1912 @item show warranty
1913 @itemx info warranty
1914 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1915 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1916
1917 @kindex show configuration
1918 @item show configuration
1919 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1920 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1921 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1922 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1923 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1924 your report.
1925
1926 @end table
1927
1928 @node Running
1929 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1930
1931 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1932 debugging information when you compile it.
1933
1934 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1935 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1936 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1937 kill a child process.
1938
1939 @menu
1940 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1941 * Starting:: Starting your program
1942 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1943 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1944
1945 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1946 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1947 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1948 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1949
1950 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1951 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1952 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1953 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1954 @end menu
1955
1956 @node Compilation
1957 @section Compiling for Debugging
1958
1959 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1960 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1961 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1962 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1963 and addresses in the executable code.
1964
1965 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1966 the compiler.
1967
1968 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1969 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1970 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1971 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1972 executables containing debugging information.
1973
1974 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1975 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1976 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1977 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1978 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1979
1980 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1981 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1982 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1983
1984 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1985 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1986 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1987 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1988 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1989 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1990
1991 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1992 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1993 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1994
1995 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1996 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1997 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1998 format in @value{GDBN}.
1999
2000 @need 2000
2001 @node Starting
2002 @section Starting your Program
2003 @cindex starting
2004 @cindex running
2005
2006 @table @code
2007 @kindex run
2008 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2009 @item run
2010 @itemx r
2011 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2012 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2013 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2014 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2015 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2016
2017 @end table
2018
2019 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2020 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2021 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2022 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2023 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2024 message like this one:
2025
2026 @smallexample
2027 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2028 Try "help target" or "continue".
2029 @end smallexample
2030
2031 @noindent
2032 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2033 first (@pxref{load}).
2034
2035 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2036 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2037 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2038 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2039 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2040 divided into four categories:
2041
2042 @table @asis
2043 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2044 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2045 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2046 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2047 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2048 the arguments.
2049 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2050 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2051 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2052 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2053 below for details).
2054
2055 @item The @emph{environment.}
2056 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2057 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2058 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2059 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2060
2061 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2062 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2063 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2064 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2065
2066 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2067 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2068 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2069 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2070 set a different device for your program.
2071 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2072
2073 @cindex pipes
2074 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2075 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2076 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2077 wrong program.
2078 @end table
2079
2080 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2081 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2082 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2083 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2084 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2085
2086 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2087 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2088 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2089 your current breakpoints.
2090
2091 @table @code
2092 @kindex start
2093 @item start
2094 @cindex run to main procedure
2095 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2096 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2097 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2098 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2099 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2100 procedure, depending on the language used.
2101
2102 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2103 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2104 the @samp{run} command.
2105
2106 @cindex elaboration phase
2107 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2108 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2109 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2110 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2111 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2112 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2113 will remain to halt execution.
2114
2115 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2116 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2117 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2118 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2119 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2120
2121 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2122 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2123 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2124 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2125 elaboration code before running your program.
2126
2127 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2128 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2129 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2130 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2131 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2132 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2133 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2134 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2135 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2136 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2137 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2138 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2139
2140 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2141 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2142 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2143 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2144
2145 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2146 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2147 environment:
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2151 (@value{GDBP}) run
2152 @end smallexample
2153
2154 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2155 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2156
2157 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2158 @item set startup-with-shell
2159 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2160 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2161 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2162 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2163 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2164 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2165 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2166 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2167 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2168 startup failures such as:
2169
2170 @smallexample
2171 (@value{GDBP}) run
2172 Starting program: ./a.out
2173 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2174 @end smallexample
2175
2176 @noindent
2177 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2178 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2179 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2180 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2181 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2182 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2183
2184 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2185 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2186 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2187 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2188 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2189 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2190
2191 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2192 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2193 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2194 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2195 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2196 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2197
2198 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2199 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2200 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2201
2202 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2203 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2204
2205 @smallexample
2206 (@value{GDBP}) run
2207 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2208 @end smallexample
2209
2210 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2211 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2212
2213 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2214 @code{target native} command. For example,
2215
2216 @smallexample
2217 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2218 (@value{GDBP}) run
2219 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2220 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2221 (@value{GDBP}) run
2222 Starting program: ./a.out
2223 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2224 @end smallexample
2225
2226 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2227 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2228 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2229 disconnect.
2230
2231 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2232 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2233 proc}, @code{info os}.
2234
2235 @kindex set disable-randomization
2236 @item set disable-randomization
2237 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2238 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2239 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2240 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2241 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2242
2243 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2244 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2245
2246 @smallexample
2247 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2248 @end smallexample
2249
2250 @item set disable-randomization off
2251 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2252 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2253 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2254 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2255 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2256 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2257
2258 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2259 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2260 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2261 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2262 a code at its expected addresses.
2263
2264 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2265 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2266 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2267 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2268 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2269 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2270 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2271 a randomly chosen address.
2272
2273 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2274 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2275 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2276 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2277 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2278
2279 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2280 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2281
2282 @item show disable-randomization
2283 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2284 the virtual address space of the started program.
2285
2286 @end table
2287
2288 @node Arguments
2289 @section Your Program's Arguments
2290
2291 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2292 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2293 @code{run} command.
2294 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2295 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2296 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2297 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2298 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2299
2300 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2301 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2302 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2303 the program, not by the shell.
2304
2305 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2306 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @kindex set args
2310 @item set args
2311 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2312 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2313 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2314 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2315 it again without arguments.
2316
2317 @kindex show args
2318 @item show args
2319 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2320 @end table
2321
2322 @node Environment
2323 @section Your Program's Environment
2324
2325 @cindex environment (of your program)
2326 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2327 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2328 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2329 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2330 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2331 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2332 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2333
2334 @table @code
2335 @kindex path
2336 @item path @var{directory}
2337 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2338 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2339 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2340 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2341 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2342 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2343 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2344
2345 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2346 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2347 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2348 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2349 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2350 @var{directory} to the search path.
2351 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2352 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2353
2354 @kindex show paths
2355 @item show paths
2356 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2357 environment variable).
2358
2359 @kindex show environment
2360 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2361 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2362 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2363 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2364 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2365
2366 @kindex set environment
2367 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2368 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2369 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2370 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2371 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2372 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2373 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2374 null value.
2375 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2376 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2377
2378 For example, this command:
2379
2380 @smallexample
2381 set env USER = foo
2382 @end smallexample
2383
2384 @noindent
2385 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2386 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2387 are not actually required.)
2388
2389 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2390 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2391 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2392 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2393 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2394
2395 @kindex unset environment
2396 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2397 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2398 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2399 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2400 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2401 @end table
2402
2403 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2404 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2405 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2406 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2407 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2408 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2409 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2410 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2411 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2412 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2413
2414 @node Working Directory
2415 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2416
2417 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2418 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2419 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2420 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2421 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2422 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2423
2424 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2425 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2426 Specify Files}.
2427
2428 @table @code
2429 @kindex cd
2430 @cindex change working directory
2431 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2432 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2433 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2434
2435 @kindex pwd
2436 @item pwd
2437 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2438 @end table
2439
2440 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2441 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2442 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2443 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2444 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2445 current working directory of the debuggee.
2446
2447 @node Input/Output
2448 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2449
2450 @cindex redirection
2451 @cindex i/o
2452 @cindex terminal
2453 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2454 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2455 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2456 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2457 running your program.
2458
2459 @table @code
2460 @kindex info terminal
2461 @item info terminal
2462 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2463 program is using.
2464 @end table
2465
2466 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2467 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2468
2469 @smallexample
2470 run > outfile
2471 @end smallexample
2472
2473 @noindent
2474 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2475
2476 @kindex tty
2477 @cindex controlling terminal
2478 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2479 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2480 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2481 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2482 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2483
2484 @smallexample
2485 tty /dev/ttyb
2486 @end smallexample
2487
2488 @noindent
2489 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2490 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2491 that as their controlling terminal.
2492
2493 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2494 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2495 terminal.
2496
2497 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2498 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2499 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2500 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2501
2502 @cindex inferior tty
2503 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2504 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2505 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2506 program.
2507
2508 @table @code
2509 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2510 @kindex set inferior-tty
2511 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2512
2513 @item show inferior-tty
2514 @kindex show inferior-tty
2515 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 @node Attach
2519 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2520 @kindex attach
2521 @cindex attach
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @item attach @var{process-id}
2525 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2526 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2527 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2528 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2529 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2530
2531 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2536 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2537 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2538 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2539
2540 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2541 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2542 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2543 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2544 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2545 Specify Files}.
2546
2547 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2548 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2549 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2550 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2551 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2552 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2553 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2554
2555 @table @code
2556 @kindex detach
2557 @item detach
2558 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2559 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2560 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2561 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2562 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2563 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2564 executing the command.
2565 @end table
2566
2567 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2568 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2569 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2570 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2571 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2572 Messages}).
2573
2574 @node Kill Process
2575 @section Killing the Child Process
2576
2577 @table @code
2578 @kindex kill
2579 @item kill
2580 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2581 @end table
2582
2583 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2584 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2585 is running.
2586
2587 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2588 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2589 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2590 outside the debugger.
2591
2592 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2593 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2594 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2595 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2596 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2597 breakpoint settings).
2598
2599 @node Inferiors and Programs
2600 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2601
2602 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2603 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2604 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2605 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2606 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2607 from multiple executables.
2608
2609 @cindex inferior
2610 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2611 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2612 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2613 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2614 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2615 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2616 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2617 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2618 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2619 threads running in it.
2620
2621 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2622 inferiors}}:
2623
2624 @table @code
2625 @kindex info inferiors
2626 @item info inferiors
2627 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2628
2629 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2630
2631 @enumerate
2632 @item
2633 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2634
2635 @item
2636 the target system's inferior identifier
2637
2638 @item
2639 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2640
2641 @end enumerate
2642
2643 @noindent
2644 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2645 indicates the current inferior.
2646
2647 For example,
2648 @end table
2649 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2650
2651 @smallexample
2652 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2653 Num Description Executable
2654 2 process 2307 hello
2655 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2656 @end smallexample
2657
2658 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2659
2660 @table @code
2661 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2662 @item inferior @var{infno}
2663 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2664 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2665 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2666 @end table
2667
2668
2669 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2670 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2671 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2672 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2673 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2674 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2675
2676 @table @code
2677 @kindex add-inferior
2678 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2679 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2680 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2681 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2682 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2683 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2684
2685 @kindex clone-inferior
2686 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2687 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2688 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2689 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2690 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2691
2692 @smallexample
2693 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2694 Num Description Executable
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2697 Added inferior 2.
2698 1 inferiors added.
2699 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2700 Num Description Executable
2701 2 <null> helloworld
2702 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2703 @end smallexample
2704
2705 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2706
2707 @kindex remove-inferiors
2708 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2709 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2710 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2711 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2712
2713 @end table
2714
2715 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2716 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2717 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2718 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2719
2720 @table @code
2721 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2724 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2725 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2726 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727
2728 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2729 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2730 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2731 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2732 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2733 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2737 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2738 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2739 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2740
2741
2742 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2743 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2744
2745 @table @code
2746 @kindex set print inferior-events
2747 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2748 @item set print inferior-events
2749 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2750 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2751 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2752 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2753 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2754 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2755
2756 @kindex show print inferior-events
2757 @item show print inferior-events
2758 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2759 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2760 @end table
2761
2762 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2763 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2764 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2765
2766
2767 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2768 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2769 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2770 info program-spaces}} command.
2771
2772 @table @code
2773 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2774 @item maint info program-spaces
2775 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2776 @value{GDBN}.
2777
2778 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2779
2780 @enumerate
2781 @item
2782 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2783
2784 @item
2785 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2786 the @code{file} command.
2787
2788 @end enumerate
2789
2790 @noindent
2791 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2792 indicates the current program space.
2793
2794 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2795 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2796 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2797
2798 @smallexample
2799 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2800 Id Executable
2801 2 goodbye
2802 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2803 * 1 hello
2804 @end smallexample
2805
2806 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2807 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2808 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2809 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2810 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2811
2812 @smallexample
2813 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2814 Id Executable
2815 * 1 vfork-test
2816 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2817 @end smallexample
2818
2819 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2820 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2821 @end table
2822
2823 @node Threads
2824 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2825
2826 @cindex threads of execution
2827 @cindex multiple threads
2828 @cindex switching threads
2829 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2830 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2831 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2832 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2833 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2834 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2835 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2836
2837 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2838 programs:
2839
2840 @itemize @bullet
2841 @item automatic notification of new threads
2842 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2843 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2844 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2845 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2846 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2847 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2848 messages on thread start and exit.
2849 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2850 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2851 isn't compatible with the program.
2852 @end itemize
2853
2854 @quotation
2855 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2856 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2857 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2858 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2859 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2860 like this:
2861
2862 @smallexample
2863 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2864 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2865 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2866 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2867 @end smallexample
2868 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2869 @c doesn't support threads"?
2870 @end quotation
2871
2872 @cindex focus of debugging
2873 @cindex current thread
2874 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2875 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2876 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2877 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2878 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2879
2880 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2881 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2882 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2883 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2884 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2885 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2886 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2887 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2888 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2889 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2890
2891 @smallexample
2892 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2893 @end smallexample
2894
2895 @noindent
2896 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2897 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2898 further qualifier.
2899
2900 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2901 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2902 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2903 @c program?
2904 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2905 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2906 @c threads ab initio?
2907
2908 @cindex thread number
2909 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2910 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2911 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2912
2913 @table @code
2914 @kindex info threads
2915 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2916 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2917 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2918 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2919 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2920
2921 @enumerate
2922 @item
2923 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2924
2925 @item
2926 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2927
2928 @item
2929 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2930 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2931 program itself.
2932
2933 @item
2934 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2935 @end enumerate
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2939 indicates the current thread.
2940
2941 For example,
2942 @end table
2943 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2944
2945 @smallexample
2946 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2947 Id Target Id Frame
2948 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2949 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2950 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2951 at threadtest.c:68
2952 @end smallexample
2953
2954 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2955 Solaris-specific command:
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @item maint info sol-threads
2959 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2960 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2961 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2962 @end table
2963
2964 @table @code
2965 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2966 @item thread @var{threadno}
2967 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2968 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2969 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2970 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2971 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2972
2973 @smallexample
2974 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2975 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2976 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2977 8 printf ("hello\n");
2978 @end smallexample
2979
2980 @noindent
2981 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2982 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2983 threads.
2984
2985 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2986 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2987 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2988 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2989 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2990 information on convenience variables.
2991
2992 @kindex thread apply
2993 @cindex apply command to several threads
2994 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2995 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2996 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2997 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2998 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2999 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
3000 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
3001 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3002 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3003 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3004
3005
3006 @kindex thread name
3007 @cindex name a thread
3008 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3009 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3010 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3011 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3012
3013 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3014 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3015 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3016 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3017 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3018
3019 @kindex thread find
3020 @cindex search for a thread
3021 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3022 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3023 matches the supplied regular expression.
3024
3025 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3026 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3027 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3028 is the LWP id.
3029
3030 @smallexample
3031 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3032 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3033 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3034 Id Target Id Frame
3035 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3036 @end smallexample
3037
3038 @kindex set print thread-events
3039 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3040 @item set print thread-events
3041 @itemx set print thread-events on
3042 @itemx set print thread-events off
3043 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3044 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3045 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3046 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3047 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3048
3049 @kindex show print thread-events
3050 @item show print thread-events
3051 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3052 have started and exited.
3053 @end table
3054
3055 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3056 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3057 programs with multiple threads.
3058
3059 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3060 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3061
3062 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3063 @table @code
3064 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3065 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3066 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3067 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3068 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3069 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3070 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3071 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3072 macro.
3073
3074 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3075 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3076 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3077 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3078 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3079 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3080
3081 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3082 refers to the default system directories that are
3083 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3084 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3085 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3086
3087 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3088 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3089 was loaded in the inferior process.
3090
3091 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3092 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3093 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3094 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3095 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3096 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3097 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3098
3099 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3100 only on some platforms.
3101
3102 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3103 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3104 Display current libthread_db search path.
3105
3106 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3107 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3108 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3109 @item set debug libthread-db
3110 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3111 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3112 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3113 @end table
3114
3115 @node Forks
3116 @section Debugging Forks
3117
3118 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3119 @cindex multiple processes
3120 @cindex processes, multiple
3121 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3122 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3123 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3124 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3125 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3126 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3127 will cause it to terminate.
3128
3129 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3130 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3131 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3132 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3133 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3134 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3135 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3136 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3137 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3138 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3139
3140 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3141 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3142 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3143 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3144
3145 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3146 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3147
3148 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3149 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3153 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3154 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3155 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3156 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3157
3158 @table @code
3159 @item parent
3160 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3161 unimpeded. This is the default.
3162
3163 @item child
3164 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3165 unimpeded.
3166
3167 @end table
3168
3169 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3170 @item show follow-fork-mode
3171 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3172 @end table
3173
3174 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3175 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3176 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3177
3178 @table @code
3179 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3180 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3181 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3182 retain debugger control over them both.
3183
3184 @table @code
3185 @item on
3186 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3187 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3188 independently. This is the default.
3189
3190 @item off
3191 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3192 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3193 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3194 is held suspended.
3195
3196 @end table
3197
3198 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3199 @item show detach-on-fork
3200 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3201 @end table
3202
3203 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3204 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3205 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3206 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3207 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3208 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3209
3210 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3211 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3212 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3213 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3214 and Programs}.
3215
3216 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3217 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3218 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3219 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3220 the child process's @code{main}.
3221
3222 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3223 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3224
3225 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3226 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3227 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3228 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3229 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3230 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3231 command.
3232
3233 @table @code
3234 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3235 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3236
3237 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3238 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3239
3240 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3241
3242 @table @code
3243 @item new
3244 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3245 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3246 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3247 original inferior.
3248
3249 For example:
3250
3251 @smallexample
3252 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3253 (gdb) info inferior
3254 Id Description Executable
3255 * 1 <null> prog1
3256 (@value{GDBP}) run
3257 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3258 Program exited normally.
3259 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3260 Id Description Executable
3261 * 2 <null> prog2
3262 1 <null> prog1
3263 @end smallexample
3264
3265 @item same
3266 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3267 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3268 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3269 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3270 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3271
3272 For example:
3273
3274 @smallexample
3275 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3276 Id Description Executable
3277 * 1 <null> prog1
3278 (@value{GDBP}) run
3279 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3280 Program exited normally.
3281 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3282 Id Description Executable
3283 * 1 <null> prog2
3284 @end smallexample
3285
3286 @end table
3287 @end table
3288
3289 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3290 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3291 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3292
3293 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3294 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3295
3296 @cindex checkpoint
3297 @cindex restart
3298 @cindex bookmark
3299 @cindex snapshot of a process
3300 @cindex rewind program state
3301
3302 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3303 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3304 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3305 later.
3306
3307 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3308 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3309 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3310 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3311 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3312
3313 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3314 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3315 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3316 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3317 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3318 start again from there.
3319
3320 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3321 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3322
3323 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3324
3325 @table @code
3326 @kindex checkpoint
3327 @item checkpoint
3328 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3329 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3330 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3331
3332 @kindex info checkpoints
3333 @item info checkpoints
3334 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3335 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3336 listed:
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @item Checkpoint ID
3340 @item Process ID
3341 @item Code Address
3342 @item Source line, or label
3343 @end table
3344
3345 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3346 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3347 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3348 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3349 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3350 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3351 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3352
3353 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3354 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3355 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3356 the debugger.
3357
3358 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3359 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3360 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3361
3362 @end table
3363
3364 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3365 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3366 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3367 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3368 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3369 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3370 previously read data can be read again.
3371
3372 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3373 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3374 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3375 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3376 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3377 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3378
3379 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3380 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3381 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3382 different execution path this time.
3383
3384 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3385 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3386 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3387 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3388 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3389 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3390 potentially pose a problem.
3391
3392 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3393
3394 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3395 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3396 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3397 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3398 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3399 next.
3400
3401 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3402 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3403 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3404 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3405 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3406
3407 @node Stopping
3408 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3409
3410 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3411 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3412 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3413
3414 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3415 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3416 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3417 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3418 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3419 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3420 explicitly request this information at any time.
3421
3422 @table @code
3423 @kindex info program
3424 @item info program
3425 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3426 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3427 @end table
3428
3429 @menu
3430 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3431 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3432 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3433 Skipping over functions and files
3434 * Signals:: Signals
3435 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3436 @end menu
3437
3438 @node Breakpoints
3439 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3440
3441 @cindex breakpoints
3442 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3443 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3444 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3445 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3446 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3447 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3448 program.
3449
3450 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3451 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3452 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3453 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3454 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3455 call).
3456
3457 @cindex watchpoints
3458 @cindex data breakpoints
3459 @cindex memory tracing
3460 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3461 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3462 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3463 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3464 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3465 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3466 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3467 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3468 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3469 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3470 same commands.
3471
3472 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3473 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3474 Automatic Display}.
3475
3476 @cindex catchpoints
3477 @cindex breakpoint on events
3478 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3479 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3480 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3481 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3482 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3483 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3484 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3485
3486 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3487 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3488 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3489 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3490 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3491 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3492 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3493 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3494 enable it again.
3495
3496 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3497 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3498 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3499 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3500 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3501 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3502 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3503
3504 @menu
3505 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3506 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3507 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3508 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3509 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3510 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3511 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3512 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3513 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3514 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3515 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3516 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3517 @end menu
3518
3519 @node Set Breaks
3520 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3521
3522 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3523 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3524 @c
3525 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3526
3527 @kindex break
3528 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3529 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3530 @cindex latest breakpoint
3531 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3532 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3533 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3534 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3535 convenience variables.
3536
3537 @table @code
3538 @item break @var{location}
3539 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3540 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3541 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3542 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3543 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3544
3545 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3546 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3547 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3548 that situation.
3549
3550 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3551 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3552 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3553
3554 @item break
3555 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3556 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3557 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3558 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3559 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3560 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3561 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3562 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3563 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3564 inside loops.
3565
3566 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3567 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3568 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3569 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3570 existed when your program stopped.
3571
3572 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3573 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3574 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3575 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3576 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3577 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3578 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3579
3580 @kindex tbreak
3581 @item tbreak @var{args}
3582 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3583 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3584 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3585 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3586
3587 @kindex hbreak
3588 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3589 @item hbreak @var{args}
3590 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3591 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3592 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3593 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3594 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3595 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3596 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3597 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3598 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3599 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3600 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3601 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3602 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3603 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3604 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3605 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3606 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3607 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3608
3609 @kindex thbreak
3610 @item thbreak @var{args}
3611 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3612 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3613 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3614 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3615 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3616 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3617 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3618 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3619
3620 @kindex rbreak
3621 @cindex regular expression
3622 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3623 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3624 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3625 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3626 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3627 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3628 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3629 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3630 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3631
3632 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3633 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3634 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3635 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3636 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3637 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3638
3639 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3640 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3641 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3642 classes.
3643
3644 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3645 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3646 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3647
3648 @smallexample
3649 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3650 @end smallexample
3651
3652 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3653 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3654 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3655 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3656 every function in a given file:
3657
3658 @smallexample
3659 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3660 @end smallexample
3661
3662 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3663 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3664
3665 @kindex info breakpoints
3666 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3667 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3668 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3669 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3670 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3671 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3672 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3673
3674 @table @emph
3675 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3676 @item Type
3677 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3678 @item Disposition
3679 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3680 @item Enabled or Disabled
3681 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3682 that are not enabled.
3683 @item Address
3684 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3685 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3686 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3687 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3688 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3689 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3690 @item What
3691 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3692 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3693 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3694 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3695 @end table
3696
3697 @noindent
3698 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3699 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3700 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3701 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3702 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3703 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3704
3705 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3706 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3707 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3708 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3712 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3713 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3714 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3715 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3716
3717 @noindent
3718 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3719 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3720 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3721 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3722 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3723 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3724
3725 @noindent
3726 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3727 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3728
3729 @end table
3730
3731 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3732 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3733 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3734 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3735
3736 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3737 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3738 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3739 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3740
3741 @itemize @bullet
3742 @item
3743 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3744
3745 @item
3746 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3747 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3748
3749 @item
3750 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3751 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3752
3753 @item
3754 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3755 several places where that function is inlined.
3756 @end itemize
3757
3758 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3759 the relevant locations.
3760
3761 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3762 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3763 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3764 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3765 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3766 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3767 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3768
3769 For example:
3770
3771 @smallexample
3772 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3773 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3774 stop only if i==1
3775 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3776 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3777 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3778 @end smallexample
3779
3780 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3781 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3782 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3783 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3784 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3785 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3786 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3787 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3788 that belong to that breakpoint.
3789
3790 @cindex pending breakpoints
3791 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3792 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3793 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3794 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3795 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3796 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3797 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3798 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3799 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3800 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3801 is not yet resolved.
3802
3803 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3804 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3805 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3806 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3807 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3808 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3809
3810 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3811 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3812 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3813 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3814
3815 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3816 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3817 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3818
3819 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3820 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3821 address specification to an address:
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3824 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3828 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3829
3830 @item set breakpoint pending on
3831 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3832 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3833
3834 @item set breakpoint pending off
3835 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3836 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3837 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3838
3839 @item show breakpoint pending
3840 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3841 @end table
3842
3843 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3844 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3845 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3846
3847 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3848 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3849 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3850 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3851 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3852 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3853 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3854 breakpoints.
3855
3856 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3857
3858 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3859 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3860 @table @code
3861 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3862 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3863 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3864 breakpoint must be used.
3865
3866 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3867 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3868 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3869 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3870 @end table
3871
3872 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3873 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3874 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3875 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3876 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3877 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3878 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3879 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3880 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3881
3882 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3883 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3884 @table @code
3885 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3886 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3887 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3888 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3889
3890 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3891 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3892 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3893 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3894 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3895 @end table
3896
3897 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3898 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3899 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3900
3901 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3902 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3903
3904 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3905
3906 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3907 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3908 @table @code
3909 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3910 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3911 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3912 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3913 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3914
3915 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3916 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3917 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3918 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3919 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3920 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3921 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3922 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3923 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3924 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3925 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3926 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3927 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3928
3929 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3930 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3931 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3932 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3933 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3934 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3935 @end table
3936
3937
3938 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3939 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3940 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3941 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3942 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3943 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3944 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3945 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3946
3947
3948 @node Set Watchpoints
3949 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3950
3951 @cindex setting watchpoints
3952 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3953 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3954 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3955 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3956 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3957
3958 @itemize @bullet
3959 @item
3960 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3961
3962 @item
3963 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3964 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3965 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3966
3967 @item
3968 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3969 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3970 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3971 @end itemize
3972
3973 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3974 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3975 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3976 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3977 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3978 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3979 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3980 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3981 the expression changes.
3982
3983 @cindex software watchpoints
3984 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3985 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3986 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3987 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3988 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3989 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3990 culprit.)
3991
3992 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3993 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3994 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3995
3996 @table @code
3997 @kindex watch
3998 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3999 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4000 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4001 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4002 to watch the value of a single variable:
4003
4004 @smallexample
4005 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4006 @end smallexample
4007
4008 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4009 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4010 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4011 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4012 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4013 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4014
4015 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4016 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4017 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4018 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4019 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4020 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4021 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4022 error.
4023
4024 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4025 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4026 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4027 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4028 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4029 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4030 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4031 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4032 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4033 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4034 Examples:
4035
4036 @smallexample
4037 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4038 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4039 @end smallexample
4040
4041 @kindex rwatch
4042 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4043 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4044 by the program.
4045
4046 @kindex awatch
4047 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4048 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4049 or written into by the program.
4050
4051 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4052 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4053 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4054 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4055 @end table
4056
4057 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4058 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4059 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4060 a never-changing value:
4061
4062 @smallexample
4063 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4064 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4065 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4066 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4067 @end smallexample
4068
4069 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4070 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4071 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4072 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4073 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4074 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4075
4076 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4077 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4078 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4079 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4080 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4081 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4082 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4083 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4084
4085 @table @code
4086 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4087 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4088 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4089
4090 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4091 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4092 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4093 @end table
4094
4095 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4096 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4097 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4098
4099 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 @noindent
4106 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4107
4108 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4109 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4110 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4111 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4112 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4113 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4114 will print a message like this:
4115
4116 @smallexample
4117 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4121 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4122 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4123 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4124 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4125 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4126 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4127 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4128
4129 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4130 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4131 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4132 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4133 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4134 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4135
4136 @smallexample
4137 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4138 @end smallexample
4139
4140 @noindent
4141 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4142
4143 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4144 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4145 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4146 expression with separately allocated resources.
4147
4148 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4149 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4150 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4151
4152 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4153 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4154 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4155 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4156 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4157 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4158 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4159 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4160 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4161
4162 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4163 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4164 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4165 watched expression from every thread.
4166
4167 @quotation
4168 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4169 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4170 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4171 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4172 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4173 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4174 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4175 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4176 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4177 @end quotation
4178
4179 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4180
4181 @node Set Catchpoints
4182 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4183 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4184 @cindex exception handlers
4185 @cindex event handling
4186
4187 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4188 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4189 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4190
4191 @table @code
4192 @kindex catch
4193 @item catch @var{event}
4194 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4195
4196 @table @code
4197 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4198 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4199 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4200 @kindex catch throw
4201 @kindex catch rethrow
4202 @kindex catch catch
4203 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4204 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4205
4206 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4207 regular expression will be caught.
4208
4209 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4210 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4211 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4212 exception being thrown.
4213
4214 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4215 @value{GDBN}:
4216
4217 @itemize @bullet
4218 @item
4219 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4220 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4221 supported.
4222
4223 @item
4224 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4225 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4226 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4227 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4228 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4229 built.
4230
4231 @item
4232 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4233 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4234
4235 @item
4236 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4237 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4238 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4239 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4240
4241 @item
4242 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4243 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4244 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4245 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4246 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4247 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4248 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4249 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4250 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4251
4252 @item
4253 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4254
4255 @item
4256 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4257 @end itemize
4258
4259 @item exception
4260 @kindex catch exception
4261 @cindex Ada exception catching
4262 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4263 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4264 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4265 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4266 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4267
4268 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4269 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4270 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4271 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4272 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4273 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4274 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4275 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4276
4277 @item exception unhandled
4278 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4279 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4280
4281 @item assert
4282 @kindex catch assert
4283 A failed Ada assertion.
4284
4285 @item exec
4286 @kindex catch exec
4287 @cindex break on fork/exec
4288 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4289 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4290
4291 @item syscall
4292 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4293 @kindex catch syscall
4294 @cindex break on a system call.
4295 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4296 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4297 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4298 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4299 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4300 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4301 will be caught.
4302
4303 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4304 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4305 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4306 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4307
4308 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4309 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4310 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4311 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4312
4313 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4314 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4315 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4316 available choices.
4317
4318 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4319 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4320 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4321 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4322 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4323 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4324 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4325 behind the OS upgrades).
4326
4327 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4328 arguments to it:
4329
4330 @smallexample
4331 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4332 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4333 (@value{GDBP}) r
4334 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4335
4336 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4337 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4338 (@value{GDBP}) c
4339 Continuing.
4340
4341 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4342 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4343 (@value{GDBP})
4344 @end smallexample
4345
4346 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4347
4348 @smallexample
4349 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4350 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4351 (@value{GDBP}) r
4352 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4353
4354 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4355 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4356 (@value{GDBP}) c
4357 Continuing.
4358
4359 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4360 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4361 (@value{GDBP})
4362 @end smallexample
4363
4364 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4365 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4366 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4367
4368 @smallexample
4369 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4370 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4371 (@value{GDBP}) r
4372 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4373
4374 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4375 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4376 (@value{GDBP}) c
4377 Continuing.
4378
4379 Program exited normally.
4380 (@value{GDBP})
4381 @end smallexample
4382
4383 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4384 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4385 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4386 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4390 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4391 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4392 (@value{GDBP})
4393 @end smallexample
4394
4395 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4396 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4397 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4398 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4399 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4400 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4401
4402 @smallexample
4403 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4404 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4405 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4406 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4407 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4408 (@value{GDBP})
4409 @end smallexample
4410
4411 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4412
4413 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4414 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4418 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4419 @end smallexample
4420
4421 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4422
4423 @item fork
4424 @kindex catch fork
4425 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4426 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4427
4428 @item vfork
4429 @kindex catch vfork
4430 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4431 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4432
4433 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4434 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4435 @kindex catch load
4436 @kindex catch unload
4437 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4438 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4439 matches one of the affected libraries.
4440
4441 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4442 @kindex catch signal
4443 The delivery of a signal.
4444
4445 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4446 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4447 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4448
4449 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4450 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4451 signal names.
4452
4453 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4454 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4455 will be caught.
4456
4457 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4458 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4459 catchpoint.
4460
4461 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4462 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4463 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4464 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4465 commands.
4466
4467 @end table
4468
4469 @item tcatch @var{event}
4470 @kindex tcatch
4471 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4472 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4473
4474 @end table
4475
4476 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4477
4478
4479 @node Delete Breaks
4480 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4481
4482 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4483 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4484 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4485 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4486 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4487 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4488
4489 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4490 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4491 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4492 their breakpoint numbers.
4493
4494 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4495 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4496 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4497
4498 @table @code
4499 @kindex clear
4500 @item clear
4501 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4502 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4503 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4504 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4505
4506 @item clear @var{location}
4507 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4508 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4509 most useful ones are listed below:
4510
4511 @table @code
4512 @item clear @var{function}
4513 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4514 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4515
4516 @item clear @var{linenum}
4517 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4518 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4519 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4520 @end table
4521
4522 @cindex delete breakpoints
4523 @kindex delete
4524 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4525 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4526 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4527 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4528 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4529 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4530 @end table
4531
4532 @node Disabling
4533 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4534
4535 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4536 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4537 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4538 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4539 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4540
4541 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4542 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4543 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4544 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4545 do not know which numbers to use.
4546
4547 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4548 affects all of its locations.
4549
4550 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4551 different states of enablement:
4552
4553 @itemize @bullet
4554 @item
4555 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4556 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4557 @item
4558 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4559 @item
4560 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4561 disabled.
4562 @item
4563 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4564 N times, then becomes disabled.
4565 @item
4566 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4567 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4568 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4569 @end itemize
4570
4571 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4572 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4573
4574 @table @code
4575 @kindex disable
4576 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4577 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4578 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4579 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4580 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4581 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4582 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4583
4584 @kindex enable
4585 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4586 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4587 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4588
4589 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4590 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4591 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4592
4593 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4594 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4595 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4596 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4597 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4598 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4599 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4600
4601 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4602 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4603 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4604 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4605 @end table
4606
4607 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4608 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4609 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4610 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4611 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4612 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4613 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4614 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4615 Stepping}.)
4616
4617 @node Conditions
4618 @subsection Break Conditions
4619 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4620 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4621
4622 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4623 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4624 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4625 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4626 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4627 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4628 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4629 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4630
4631 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4632 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4633 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4634 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4635 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4636
4637 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4638 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4639 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4640 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4641 one.
4642
4643 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4644 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4645 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4646 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4647 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4648 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4649 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4650 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4651 conditions for the
4652 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4653 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4654
4655 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4656 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4657 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4658 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4659 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4660 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4661
4662 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4663 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4664 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4665 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4666 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4667
4668 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4669 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4670 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4671 with the @code{condition} command.
4672
4673 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4674 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4675 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4676 catchpoint.
4677
4678 @table @code
4679 @kindex condition
4680 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4681 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4682 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4683 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4684 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4685 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4686 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4687 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4688 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4689 prints an error message:
4690
4691 @smallexample
4692 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 @value{GDBN} does
4697 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4698 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4699 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4700
4701 @item condition @var{bnum}
4702 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4703 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4704 @end table
4705
4706 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4707 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4708 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4709 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4710 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4711 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4712 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4713 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4714 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4715 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4716 your program reaches it.
4717
4718 @table @code
4719 @kindex ignore
4720 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4721 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4722 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4723 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4724 takes no action.
4725
4726 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4727 a count of zero.
4728
4729 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4730 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4731 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4732 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4733
4734 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4735 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4736 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4737
4738 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4739 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4740 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4741 Variables}.
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4745
4746
4747 @node Break Commands
4748 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4749
4750 @cindex breakpoint commands
4751 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4752 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4753 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4754 enable other breakpoints.
4755
4756 @table @code
4757 @kindex commands
4758 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4759 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4760 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4761 @itemx end
4762 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4763 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4764 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4765
4766 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4767 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4768
4769 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4770 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4771 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4772 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4773 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4774 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4775 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4776 Expressions}).
4777 @end table
4778
4779 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4780 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4781
4782 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4783 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4784 that resumes execution.
4785
4786 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4787 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4788 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4789 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4790 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4791
4792 @kindex silent
4793 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4794 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4795 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4796 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4797 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4798 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4799
4800 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4801 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4802 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4803
4804 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4805 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4806
4807 @smallexample
4808 break foo if x>0
4809 commands
4810 silent
4811 printf "x is %d\n",x
4812 cont
4813 end
4814 @end smallexample
4815
4816 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4817 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4818 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4819 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4820 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4821 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4822 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4823
4824 @smallexample
4825 break 403
4826 commands
4827 silent
4828 set x = y + 4
4829 cont
4830 end
4831 @end smallexample
4832
4833 @node Dynamic Printf
4834 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4835
4836 @cindex dynamic printf
4837 @cindex dprintf
4838 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4839 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4840 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4841 having to recompile it.
4842
4843 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4844 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4845 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4846 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4847 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4848 redirects to files and so forth.
4849
4850 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4851 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4852 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4853 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4854 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4855 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4856 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4857
4858 @table @code
4859 @kindex dprintf
4860 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4861 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4862 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4863 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4864
4865 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4866 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4867 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4868 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4869 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4870 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4871
4872 @item gdb
4873 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4874 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4875
4876 @item call
4877 @kindex dprintf-style call
4878 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4879 @code{printf}).
4880
4881 @item agent
4882 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4883 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4884 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4885 support running commands on the target.
4886
4887 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4888 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4889 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4890 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4891 command.
4892
4893 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4894 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4895 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4896 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4897 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4898 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4899
4900 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4901 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4902 you could do the following:
4903
4904 @example
4905 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4906 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4907 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4908 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4909 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4910 (gdb) info break
4911 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4912 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4913 continue
4914 (gdb)
4915 @end example
4916
4917 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4918 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4919 the variable settings.
4920
4921 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4922 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4923 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4924 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4925 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4926 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4927
4928 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4929 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4930 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4931
4932 @end table
4933
4934 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4935 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4936 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4937 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4938 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4939 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4940
4941 @node Save Breakpoints
4942 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4943
4944 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4945 breakpoints}} command.
4946
4947 @table @code
4948 @kindex save breakpoints
4949 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4950 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4951 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4952 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4953 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4954 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4955 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4956 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4957 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4958 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4959 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4960 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4961 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4962 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4963 that can no longer be recreated.
4964 @end table
4965
4966 @node Static Probe Points
4967 @subsection Static Probe Points
4968
4969 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4970 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4971 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4972 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4973 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4974 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4975 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4976
4977 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4978 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4979 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4980 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4981 in your applications.
4982
4983 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4984 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4985 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4986 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4987 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4988 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4989 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4990 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4991
4992 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4993 probes}, with optional arguments:
4994
4995 @table @code
4996 @kindex info probes
4997 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4998 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4999 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5000 probes from all providers are listed.
5001
5002 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5003 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5004 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5005
5006 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5007 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5008 given, all object files are considered.
5009
5010 @item info probes all
5011 List the available static probes, from all types.
5012 @end table
5013
5014 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5015 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5016 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5017 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5018 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5019 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
5020 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
5021 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5022 at the current probe point.
5023
5024 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5025 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5026 an error message.
5027
5028
5029 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5030 @node Error in Breakpoints
5031 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5032
5033 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5034 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5035
5036 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5037 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5038 @smallexample
5039 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5040 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5041 @end smallexample
5042
5043 @noindent
5044 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5045 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5046 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5047
5048 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5049 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5050
5051 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5052 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5053 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5054
5055 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5056 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5057 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5058 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5059
5060 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5061 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5062 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5063 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5064 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5065 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5066 first in the bundle.
5067
5068 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5069 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5070 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5071 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5072 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5073 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5074 is hit.
5075
5076 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5077 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5078
5079 @smallexample
5080 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5081 @end smallexample
5082
5083 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5084 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5085 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5086 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5087 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5088 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5089 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5090 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5091
5092 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5093 adjusted breakpoints:
5094
5095 @smallexample
5096 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5097 to 0x00010410.
5098 @end smallexample
5099
5100 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5101 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5102 frequently than expected.
5103
5104 @node Continuing and Stepping
5105 @section Continuing and Stepping
5106
5107 @cindex stepping
5108 @cindex continuing
5109 @cindex resuming execution
5110 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5111 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5112 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5113 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5114 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5115 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5116 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5117 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5118 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5119 handlers}).)
5120
5121 @table @code
5122 @kindex continue
5123 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5124 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5125 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5126 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5127 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5128 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5129 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5130 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5131 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5132 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5133
5134 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5135 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5136 @code{continue} is ignored.
5137
5138 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5139 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5140 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5141 @code{continue}.
5142 @end table
5143
5144 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5145 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5146 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5147 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5148
5149 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5150 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5151 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5152 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5153 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5154 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5155
5156 @table @code
5157 @kindex step
5158 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5159 @item step
5160 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5161 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5162 abbreviated @code{s}.
5163
5164 @quotation
5165 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5166 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5167 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5168 @c distinction here.
5169 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5170 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5171 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5172 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5173 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5174 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5175 below.
5176 @end quotation
5177
5178 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5179 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5180 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5181 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5182 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5183 called within the line.
5184
5185 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5186 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5187 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5188 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5189 was any debugging information about the routine.
5190
5191 @item step @var{count}
5192 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5193 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5194 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5195
5196 @kindex next
5197 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5198 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5199 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5200 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5201 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5202 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5203 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5204 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5205
5206 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5207
5208
5209 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5210 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5211 @c
5212 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5213 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5214 @c function are executed without stopping.
5215
5216 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5217 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5218 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5219
5220 @kindex set step-mode
5221 @item set step-mode
5222 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5223 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5224 @itemx set step-mode on
5225 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5226 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5227 information rather than stepping over it.
5228
5229 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5230 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5231 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5232
5233 @item set step-mode off
5234 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5235 debug information. This is the default.
5236
5237 @item show step-mode
5238 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5239 source line debug information.
5240
5241 @kindex finish
5242 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5243 @item finish
5244 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5245 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5246 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5247
5248 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5249 ,Returning from a Function}).
5250
5251 @kindex until
5252 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5253 @cindex run until specified location
5254 @item until
5255 @itemx u
5256 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5257 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5258 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5259 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5260 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5261 than the address of the jump.
5262
5263 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5264 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5265 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5266 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5267 through the next iteration.
5268
5269 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5270 stack frame.
5271
5272 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5273 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5274 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5275 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5276 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5277
5278 @smallexample
5279 (@value{GDBP}) f
5280 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5281 206 expand_input();
5282 (@value{GDBP}) until
5283 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5284 @end smallexample
5285
5286 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5287 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5288 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5289 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5290 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5291 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5292 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5293
5294 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5295 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5296 argument.
5297
5298 @item until @var{location}
5299 @itemx u @var{location}
5300 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5301 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5302 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5303 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5304 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5305 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5306 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5307 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5308 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5309 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5310 invocations have returned.
5311
5312 @smallexample
5313 94 int factorial (int value)
5314 95 @{
5315 96 if (value > 1) @{
5316 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5317 98 @}
5318 99 return (value);
5319 100 @}
5320 @end smallexample
5321
5322
5323 @kindex advance @var{location}
5324 @item advance @var{location}
5325 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5326 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5327 @ref{Specify Location}.
5328 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5329 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5330 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5331 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5332
5333
5334 @kindex stepi
5335 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5336 @item stepi
5337 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5338 @itemx si
5339 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5340
5341 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5342 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5343 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5344 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5345
5346 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5347
5348 @need 750
5349 @kindex nexti
5350 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5351 @item nexti
5352 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5353 @itemx ni
5354 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5355 proceed until the function returns.
5356
5357 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5358
5359 @end table
5360
5361 @anchor{range stepping}
5362 @cindex range stepping
5363 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5364 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5365 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5366 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5367 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5368 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5369 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5370 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5371 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5372 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5373 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5374 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5375 if necessary:
5376
5377 @table @code
5378 @kindex set range-stepping
5379 @kindex show range-stepping
5380 @item set range-stepping
5381 @itemx show range-stepping
5382 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5383
5384 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5385 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5386 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5387 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5388 default is @code{on}.
5389
5390 @end table
5391
5392 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5393 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5394 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5395
5396 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5397 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5398 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5399
5400 For example, consider the following C function:
5401
5402 @smallexample
5403 101 int func()
5404 102 @{
5405 103 foo(boring());
5406 104 bar(boring());
5407 105 @}
5408 @end smallexample
5409
5410 @noindent
5411 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5412 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5413 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5414 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5415
5416 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5417 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5418 is called from many places.
5419
5420 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5421 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5422 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5423 @code{foo}.
5424
5425 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5426 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5427
5428 @table @code
5429 @kindex skip function
5430 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5431 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5432 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5433 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5434 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5435
5436 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5437 will be skipped.
5438
5439 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5440 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5441
5442 @kindex skip file
5443 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5444 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5445 will be skipped over when stepping.
5446
5447 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5448 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5449 @end table
5450
5451 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5452 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5453
5454 @table @code
5455 @kindex info skip
5456 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5457 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5458 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5459 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5460
5461 @table @emph
5462 @item Identifier
5463 A number identifying this skip.
5464 @item Type
5465 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5466 @item Enabled or Disabled
5467 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5468 @item Address
5469 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5470 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5471 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5472 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5473 address here.
5474 @item What
5475 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5476 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5477 where it is defined.
5478 @end table
5479
5480 @kindex skip delete
5481 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5482 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5483 skips.
5484
5485 @kindex skip enable
5486 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5487 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5488 skips.
5489
5490 @kindex skip disable
5491 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5492 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5493 skips.
5494
5495 @end table
5496
5497 @node Signals
5498 @section Signals
5499 @cindex signals
5500
5501 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5502 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5503 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5504 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5505 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5506 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5507 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5508 requested an alarm).
5509
5510 @cindex fatal signals
5511 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5512 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5513 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5514 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5515 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5516 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5517
5518 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5519 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5520 signal.
5521
5522 @cindex handling signals
5523 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5524 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5525 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5526 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5527 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5528
5529 @table @code
5530 @kindex info signals
5531 @kindex info handle
5532 @item info signals
5533 @itemx info handle
5534 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5535 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5536 the defined types of signals.
5537
5538 @item info signals @var{sig}
5539 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5540
5541 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5542
5543 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5544 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5545 for details about this command.
5546
5547 @kindex handle
5548 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5549 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5550 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5551 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5552 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5553 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5554 say what change to make.
5555 @end table
5556
5557 @c @group
5558 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5559 Their full names are:
5560
5561 @table @code
5562 @item nostop
5563 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5564 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5565
5566 @item stop
5567 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5568 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5569
5570 @item print
5571 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5572
5573 @item noprint
5574 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5575 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5576
5577 @item pass
5578 @itemx noignore
5579 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5580 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5581 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5582
5583 @item nopass
5584 @itemx ignore
5585 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5586 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5587 @end table
5588 @c @end group
5589
5590 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5591 program until you
5592 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5593 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5594 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5595 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5596 program sees that signal when you continue.
5597
5598 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5599 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5600 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5601 erroneous signals.
5602
5603 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5604 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5605 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5606 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5607 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5608 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5609 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5610 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5611 Program a Signal}.
5612
5613 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5614 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5615
5616 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5617 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5618 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5619 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5620 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5621 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5622 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5623 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5624 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5625 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5626 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5627 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5628 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5629
5630 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5631
5632 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5633 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5634 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5635 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5636
5637 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5638 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5639 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5640 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5641
5642 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5643 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5644
5645 @smallexample
5646 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5647 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5648 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5649 (@value{GDBP}) c
5650 Continuing.
5651
5652 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5653 main () sigusr1.c:28
5654 28 p = 0;
5655 (@value{GDBP}) si
5656 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5657 9 @{
5658 @end smallexample
5659
5660 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5661 program to receive the signal first:
5662
5663 @smallexample
5664 (@value{GDBP}) n
5665 28 p = 0;
5666 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5667 (@value{GDBP}) si
5668 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5669 9 @{
5670 (@value{GDBP})
5671 @end smallexample
5672
5673 @cindex extra signal information
5674 @anchor{extra signal information}
5675
5676 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5677 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5678 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5679 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5680 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5681 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5682 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5683 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5684 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5685 system header.
5686
5687 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5688 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5689
5690 @smallexample
5691 @group
5692 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5693 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5694 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5695 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5696 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5697 type = struct @{
5698 int si_signo;
5699 int si_errno;
5700 int si_code;
5701 union @{
5702 int _pad[28];
5703 struct @{...@} _kill;
5704 struct @{...@} _timer;
5705 struct @{...@} _rt;
5706 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5707 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5708 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5709 @} _sifields;
5710 @}
5711 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5712 type = struct @{
5713 void *si_addr;
5714 @}
5715 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5716 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5717 @end group
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5721
5722 @node Thread Stops
5723 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5724
5725 @cindex stopped threads
5726 @cindex threads, stopped
5727
5728 @cindex continuing threads
5729 @cindex threads, continuing
5730
5731 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5732 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5733 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5734 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5735 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5736 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5737 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5738 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5739 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5740
5741 @menu
5742 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5743 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5744 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5745 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5746 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5747 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5748 @end menu
5749
5750 @node All-Stop Mode
5751 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5752
5753 @cindex all-stop mode
5754
5755 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5756 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5757 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5758 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5759 underfoot.
5760
5761 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5762 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5763 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5764
5765 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5766 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5767 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5768 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5769 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5770 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5771 stops.
5772
5773 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5774 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5775 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5776 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5777
5778 @cindex automatic thread selection
5779 @cindex switching threads automatically
5780 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5781 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5782 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5783 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5784 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5785 thread.
5786
5787 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5788 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5789
5790 @table @code
5791 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5792 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5793 @cindex lock scheduler
5794 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5795 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5796 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5797 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5798 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5799 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5800 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5801 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5802 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5803 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5804 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5805 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5806
5807 @item show scheduler-locking
5808 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5809 @end table
5810
5811 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5812 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5813 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5814 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5815 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5816 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5817 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5818 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5819 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5820 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5821 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5822 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5823 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5824 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5825
5826 @table @code
5827 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5828 @item set schedule-multiple
5829 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5830 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5831 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5832 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5833 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5834 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5835
5836 @item show schedule-multiple
5837 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5838 multiple processes.
5839 @end table
5840
5841 @node Non-Stop Mode
5842 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5843
5844 @cindex non-stop mode
5845
5846 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5847 @c with more details.
5848
5849 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5850 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5851 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5852 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5853 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5854 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5855
5856 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5857 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5858 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5859 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5860 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5861 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5862 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5863 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5864 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5865 independently and simultaneously.
5866
5867 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5868 or attach to your program:
5869
5870 @smallexample
5871 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5872 set pagination off
5873
5874 # Finally, turn it on!
5875 set non-stop on
5876 @end smallexample
5877
5878 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5879
5880 @table @code
5881 @kindex set non-stop
5882 @item set non-stop on
5883 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5884 @item set non-stop off
5885 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5886 @kindex show non-stop
5887 @item show non-stop
5888 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5889 @end table
5890
5891 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5892 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5893 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5894 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5895 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5896 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5897 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5898 default.
5899
5900 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5901 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5902 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5903
5904 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5905 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5906 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5907 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5908 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5909
5910 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5911 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5912 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5913 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5914 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5915
5916 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5917
5918 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5919 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5920 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5921 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5922 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5923 previously current thread.
5924
5925 @node Background Execution
5926 @subsection Background Execution
5927
5928 @cindex foreground execution
5929 @cindex background execution
5930 @cindex asynchronous execution
5931 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5932
5933 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5934 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5935 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5936 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5937 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5938 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5939
5940 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5941 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5942
5943 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5944 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5945 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5946 are:
5947
5948 @table @code
5949 @kindex run&
5950 @item run
5951 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5952
5953 @item attach
5954 @kindex attach&
5955 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5956
5957 @item step
5958 @kindex step&
5959 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5960
5961 @item stepi
5962 @kindex stepi&
5963 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5964
5965 @item next
5966 @kindex next&
5967 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5968
5969 @item nexti
5970 @kindex nexti&
5971 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5972
5973 @item continue
5974 @kindex continue&
5975 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5976
5977 @item finish
5978 @kindex finish&
5979 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5980
5981 @item until
5982 @kindex until&
5983 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5984
5985 @end table
5986
5987 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5988 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5989 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5990 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5991 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5992 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5993
5994 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5995 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5996
5997 @table @code
5998 @kindex interrupt
5999 @item interrupt
6000 @itemx interrupt -a
6001
6002 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6003 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6004 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6005 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6006 @end table
6007
6008 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6009 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6010
6011 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6012 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6013 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6014
6015 @table @code
6016 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6017 @cindex thread breakpoints
6018 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6019 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6020 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6021 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6022 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6023 specify some source line.
6024
6025 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6026 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6027 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6028 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6029 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6030
6031 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6032 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6033 program.
6034
6035 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6036 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6037 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6038
6039 @smallexample
6040 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6041 @end smallexample
6042
6043 @end table
6044
6045 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6046 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6047 thread list. For example:
6048
6049 @smallexample
6050 (@value{GDBP}) c
6051 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6052 @end smallexample
6053
6054 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6055 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6056 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6057 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6058 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6059 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6060 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6061 command.
6062
6063 @node Interrupted System Calls
6064 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6065
6066 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6067 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6068 @cindex premature return from system calls
6069 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6070 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6071 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6072 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6073 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6074 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6075 stop execution.
6076
6077 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6078 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6079 style anyways.
6080
6081 For example, do not write code like this:
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 sleep (10);
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6088 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6089
6090 Instead, write this:
6091
6092 @smallexample
6093 int unslept = 10;
6094 while (unslept > 0)
6095 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6096 @end smallexample
6097
6098 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6099 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6100 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6101 @value{GDBN}.
6102
6103 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6104 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6105 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6106 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6107
6108 @node Observer Mode
6109 @subsection Observer Mode
6110
6111 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6112 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6113 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6114 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6115 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6116
6117 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6118 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6119 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6120 mode.
6121
6122 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6123 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6124 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6125 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6126 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6127
6128 @table @code
6129
6130 @kindex observer
6131 @item set observer on
6132 @itemx set observer off
6133 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6134 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6135 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6136 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6137
6138 @item show observer
6139 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6140
6141 @kindex may-write-registers
6142 @item set may-write-registers on
6143 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6144 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6145 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6146 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6147
6148 @item show may-write-registers
6149 Show the current permission to write registers.
6150
6151 @kindex may-write-memory
6152 @item set may-write-memory on
6153 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6154 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6155 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6156 defaults to @code{on}.
6157
6158 @item show may-write-memory
6159 Show the current permission to write memory.
6160
6161 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6162 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6163 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6164 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6165 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6166 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6167
6168 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6169 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6170
6171 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6172 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6173 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6174 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6175 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6176 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6177 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6178
6179 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6180 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6181
6182 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6183 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6184 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6185 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6186 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6187 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6188 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6189
6190 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6191 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6192
6193 @kindex may-interrupt
6194 @item set may-interrupt on
6195 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6196 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6197 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6198 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6199 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6200
6201 @item show may-interrupt
6202 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6203
6204 @end table
6205
6206 @node Reverse Execution
6207 @chapter Running programs backward
6208 @cindex reverse execution
6209 @cindex running programs backward
6210
6211 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6212 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6213 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6214 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6215
6216 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6217 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6218 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6219 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6220 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6221 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6222
6223 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6224 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6225 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6226 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6227 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6228 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6229 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6230 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6231 prior values@footnote{
6232 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6233 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6234 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6235
6236 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6237 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6238 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6239 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6240 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6241 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6242 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6243 }.
6244
6245 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6246 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6247
6248 @table @code
6249 @kindex reverse-continue
6250 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6251 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6252 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6253 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6254 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6255 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6256 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6257
6258 @kindex reverse-step
6259 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6260 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6261 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6262 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6263
6264 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6265 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6266 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6267 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6268 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6269 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6270
6271 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6272 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6273
6274 @kindex reverse-stepi
6275 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6276 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6277 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6278 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6279 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6280 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6281 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6282
6283 @kindex reverse-next
6284 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6285 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6286 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6287 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6288 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6289 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6290 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6291 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6292 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6293 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6294
6295 @kindex reverse-nexti
6296 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6297 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6298 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6299 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6300 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6301 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6302 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6303 frame) is reached.
6304
6305 @kindex reverse-finish
6306 @item reverse-finish
6307 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6308 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6309 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6310 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6311
6312 @kindex set exec-direction
6313 @item set exec-direction
6314 Set the direction of target execution.
6315 @item set exec-direction reverse
6316 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6317 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6318 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6319 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6320 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6321 @item set exec-direction forward
6322 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6323 This is the default.
6324 @end table
6325
6326
6327 @node Process Record and Replay
6328 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6329 @cindex process record and replay
6330 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6331
6332 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6333 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6334 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6335
6336 @cindex replay mode
6337 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6338 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6339 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6340 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6341 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6342 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6343 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6344 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6345 execution log.
6346
6347 @cindex record mode
6348 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6349 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6350 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6351 for future replay.
6352
6353 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6354 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6355 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6356 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6357 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6358 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6359
6360 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6361 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6362 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6363 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6364
6365 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6366 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6367
6368 @table @code
6369 @kindex target record
6370 @kindex target record-full
6371 @kindex target record-btrace
6372 @kindex record
6373 @kindex record full
6374 @kindex record btrace
6375 @kindex record btrace bts
6376 @kindex record bts
6377 @kindex rec
6378 @kindex rec full
6379 @kindex rec btrace
6380 @kindex rec btrace bts
6381 @kindex rec bts
6382 @item record @var{method}
6383 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6384 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6385 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6386 recording methods are available:
6387
6388 @table @code
6389 @item full
6390 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6391 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6392 execution.
6393
6394 @item btrace @var{format}
6395 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6396 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6397 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6398 reverse execution.
6399
6400 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6401 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6402 formats are available:
6403
6404 @table @code
6405 @item bts
6406 @cindex branch trace store
6407 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6408 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6409 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6410 @end table
6411
6412 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6413 @end table
6414
6415 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6416 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6417 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6418 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6419
6420 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6421 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6422
6423 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6424 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6425 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6426 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6427 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6428
6429 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6430 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6431 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6432 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6433 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6434 does not support these two modes.
6435
6436 @kindex record stop
6437 @kindex rec s
6438 @item record stop
6439 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6440 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6441 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6442
6443 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6444 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6445 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6446 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6447 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6448
6449 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6450 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6451 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6452 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6453 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6454
6455 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6456 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6457
6458 @kindex record goto
6459 @item record goto
6460 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6461 ways to specify the location to go to:
6462
6463 @table @code
6464 @item record goto begin
6465 @itemx record goto start
6466 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6467
6468 @item record goto end
6469 Go to the end of the execution log.
6470
6471 @item record goto @var{n}
6472 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6473 @end table
6474
6475 @kindex record save
6476 @item record save @var{filename}
6477 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6478 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6479 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6480
6481 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6482
6483 @kindex record restore
6484 @item record restore @var{filename}
6485 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6486 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6487
6488 @kindex set record full
6489 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6490 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6491 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6492 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6493
6494 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6495 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6496 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6497 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6498 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6499 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6500 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6501 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6502
6503 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6504 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6505 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6506
6507 @kindex show record full
6508 @item show record full insn-number-max
6509 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6510 recording method.
6511
6512 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6513 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6514 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6515 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6516 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6517 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6518 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6519 oldest one to be deleted.
6520
6521 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6522 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6523
6524 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6525 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6526
6527 @item set record full memory-query
6528 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6529 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6530 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6531 case.
6532
6533 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6534 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6535 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6536 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6537 results.
6538
6539 @item show record full memory-query
6540 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6541
6542 @kindex set record btrace
6543 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6544 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6545 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6546 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6547 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6548 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6549 You can use the following command for that:
6550
6551 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6552 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6553 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6554 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6555 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6556 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6557 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6558 position.
6559
6560 @kindex show record btrace
6561 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6562 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6563
6564 @kindex set record btrace bts
6565 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6566 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6567 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6568 format. Default is 64KB.
6569
6570 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6571 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6572 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6573 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6574 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6575 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6576 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6577
6578 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6579 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6580
6581 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6582 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6583
6584 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6585 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6586 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6587
6588 @kindex info record
6589 @item info record
6590 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6591 method:
6592
6593 @table @code
6594 @item full
6595 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6596 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6597
6598 @itemize @bullet
6599 @item
6600 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6601 @item
6602 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6603 @item
6604 Highest recorded instruction number.
6605 @item
6606 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6607 @item
6608 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6609 @item
6610 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6611 @end itemize
6612
6613 @item btrace
6614 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6615
6616 @itemize @bullet
6617 @item
6618 Recording format.
6619 @item
6620 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6621 @item
6622 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6623 instructions.
6624 @item
6625 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6626 @end itemize
6627
6628 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6629 @itemize @bullet
6630 @item
6631 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6632 @end itemize
6633 @end table
6634
6635 @kindex record delete
6636 @kindex rec del
6637 @item record delete
6638 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6639 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6640 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6641 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6642
6643 @kindex record instruction-history
6644 @kindex rec instruction-history
6645 @item record instruction-history
6646 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6647 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6648 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6649 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6650 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6651
6652 @table @code
6653 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6654 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6655 @var{insn}.
6656
6657 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6658 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6659 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6660 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6661 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6662 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6663
6664 @item record instruction-history
6665 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6666
6667 @item record instruction-history -
6668 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6669
6670 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6671 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6672 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6673 number @var{end} is included.
6674 @end table
6675
6676 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6677
6678 @kindex set record
6679 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6680 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6681 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6682 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6683 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6684
6685 @kindex show record
6686 @item show record instruction-history-size
6687 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6688 instruction-history} command.
6689
6690 @kindex record function-call-history
6691 @kindex rec function-call-history
6692 @item record function-call-history
6693 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6694 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6695 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6696 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6697 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6698 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6699 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6700 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6701 given together.
6702
6703 @smallexample
6704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6705 1 void foo (void)
6706 2 @{
6707 3 @}
6708 4
6709 5 void bar (void)
6710 6 @{
6711 7 ...
6712 8 foo ();
6713 9 ...
6714 10 @}
6715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6716 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6717 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6718 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6719 @end smallexample
6720
6721 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6722 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6723 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6724 to print:
6725
6726 @table @code
6727 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6728 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6729
6730 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6731 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6732 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6733 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6734 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6735
6736 @item record function-call-history
6737 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6738
6739 @item record function-call-history -
6740 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6741
6742 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6743 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6744 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6745 @end table
6746
6747 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6748
6749 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6750 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6751 Define how many lines to print in the
6752 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6753 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6754
6755 @item show record function-call-history-size
6756 Show how many lines to print in the
6757 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6758 @end table
6759
6760
6761 @node Stack
6762 @chapter Examining the Stack
6763
6764 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6765 stopped and how it got there.
6766
6767 @cindex call stack
6768 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6769 is generated.
6770 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6771 the arguments of the call,
6772 and the local variables of the function being called.
6773 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6774 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6775 stack}.
6776
6777 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6778 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6779
6780 @cindex selected frame
6781 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6782 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6783 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6784 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6785 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6786 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6787
6788 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6789 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6790 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6791
6792 @menu
6793 * Frames:: Stack frames
6794 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6795 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6796 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6797 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6798
6799 @end menu
6800
6801 @node Frames
6802 @section Stack Frames
6803
6804 @cindex frame, definition
6805 @cindex stack frame
6806 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6807 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6808 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6809 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6810 which the function is executing.
6811
6812 @cindex initial frame
6813 @cindex outermost frame
6814 @cindex innermost frame
6815 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6816 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6817 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6818 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6819 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6820 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6821 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6822 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6823
6824 @cindex frame pointer
6825 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6826 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6827 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6828 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6829 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6830 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6831
6832 @cindex frame number
6833 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6834 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6835 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6836 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6837 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6838
6839 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6840 @c underflow problems.
6841 @cindex frameless execution
6842 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6843 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6844 @smallexample
6845 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6846 @end smallexample
6847 generates functions without a frame.)
6848 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6849 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6850 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6851 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6852 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6853 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6854 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6855
6856 @table @code
6857 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6858 @cindex current stack frame
6859 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6860 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6861 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6862 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6863 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6864
6865 @kindex select-frame
6866 @cindex selecting frame silently
6867 @item select-frame
6868 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6869 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6870 @code{frame}.
6871 @end table
6872
6873 @node Backtrace
6874 @section Backtraces
6875
6876 @cindex traceback
6877 @cindex call stack traces
6878 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6879 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6880 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6881 stack.
6882
6883 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6884 @table @code
6885 @kindex backtrace
6886 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6887 @item backtrace
6888 @itemx bt
6889 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6890 frames in the stack.
6891
6892 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6893 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6894
6895 @item backtrace @var{n}
6896 @itemx bt @var{n}
6897 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6898
6899 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6900 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6901 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6902
6903 @item backtrace full
6904 @itemx bt full
6905 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6906 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6907 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6908 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6909
6910 @item backtrace no-filters
6911 @itemx bt no-filters
6912 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6913 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6914 @itemx bt no-filters full
6915 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6916 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6917 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6918 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6919 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6920 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6921 support.
6922 @end table
6923
6924 @kindex where
6925 @kindex info stack
6926 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6927 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6928
6929 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6930 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6931 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6932 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6933 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6934 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6935 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6936 multi-threaded program.
6937
6938 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6939 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6940 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6941 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6942 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6943 line number.
6944
6945 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6946 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6947
6948 @smallexample
6949 @group
6950 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6951 at builtin.c:993
6952 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6953 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6954 at macro.c:71
6955 (More stack frames follow...)
6956 @end group
6957 @end smallexample
6958
6959 @noindent
6960 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6961 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6962 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6963
6964 @noindent
6965 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6966 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6967 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6968 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6969 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6970
6971 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6972 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6973 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6974 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6975 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6976 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6977 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6978 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6979 such a backtrace might look like:
6980
6981 @smallexample
6982 @group
6983 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6984 at builtin.c:993
6985 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6986 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6987 at macro.c:71
6988 (More stack frames follow...)
6989 @end group
6990 @end smallexample
6991
6992 @noindent
6993 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6994 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6995
6996 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6997 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6998 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6999
7000 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7001 @cindex program entry point
7002 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7003 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7004 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7005 @code{main}@footnote{
7006 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7007 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7008 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7009 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7010 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7011 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7012
7013 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7014 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7015
7016 @table @code
7017 @item set backtrace past-main
7018 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7019 @kindex set backtrace
7020 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7021
7022 @item set backtrace past-main off
7023 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7024 default.
7025
7026 @item show backtrace past-main
7027 @kindex show backtrace
7028 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7029
7030 @item set backtrace past-entry
7031 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7032 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7033 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7034 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7035
7036 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7037 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7038 application. This is the default.
7039
7040 @item show backtrace past-entry
7041 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7042
7043 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7044 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7045 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7046 @cindex backtrace limit
7047 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7048 or zero means unlimited levels.
7049
7050 @item show backtrace limit
7051 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7052 @end table
7053
7054 You can control how file names are displayed.
7055
7056 @table @code
7057 @item set filename-display
7058 @itemx set filename-display relative
7059 @cindex filename-display
7060 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7061
7062 @item set filename-display basename
7063 Display only basename of a filename.
7064
7065 @item set filename-display absolute
7066 Display an absolute filename.
7067
7068 @item show filename-display
7069 Show the current way to display filenames.
7070 @end table
7071
7072 @node Frame Filter Management
7073 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7074 @cindex managing frame filters
7075
7076 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7077 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7078
7079 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7080 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7081
7082 @table @code
7083 @kindex info frame-filter
7084 @item info frame-filter
7085 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7086 their name, priority and enabled status.
7087
7088 @kindex disable frame-filter
7089 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7090 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7091 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7092 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7093 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7094 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7095 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7096 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7097 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7098 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7099 may be enabled again later.
7100
7101 @kindex enable frame-filter
7102 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7103 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7104 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7105 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7106 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7107 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7108 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7109 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7110 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7111
7112 Example:
7113
7114 @smallexample
7115 (gdb) info frame-filter
7116
7117 global frame-filters:
7118 Priority Enabled Name
7119 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7120 100 Yes Reverse
7121
7122 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7123 Priority Enabled Name
7124 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7125
7126 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7127 Priority Enabled Name
7128 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7129
7130 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7131 (gdb) info frame-filter
7132
7133 global frame-filters:
7134 Priority Enabled Name
7135 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7136 100 Yes Reverse
7137
7138 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7139 Priority Enabled Name
7140 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7141
7142 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7143 Priority Enabled Name
7144 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7145
7146 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7147 (gdb) info frame-filter
7148
7149 global frame-filters:
7150 Priority Enabled Name
7151 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7152 100 Yes Reverse
7153
7154 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7155 Priority Enabled Name
7156 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7157
7158 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7159 Priority Enabled Name
7160 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7161 @end smallexample
7162
7163 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7164 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7165 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7166 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7167 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7168 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7169 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7170
7171 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7172 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7173 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7174 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7175 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7176 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7177 dictionary resides.
7178
7179 Example:
7180
7181 @smallexample
7182 (gdb) info frame-filter
7183
7184 global frame-filters:
7185 Priority Enabled Name
7186 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7187 100 Yes Reverse
7188
7189 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7190 Priority Enabled Name
7191 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7192
7193 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7194 Priority Enabled Name
7195 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7196
7197 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7198 (gdb) info frame-filter
7199
7200 global frame-filters:
7201 Priority Enabled Name
7202 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7203 50 Yes Reverse
7204
7205 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7206 Priority Enabled Name
7207 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7208
7209 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7210 Priority Enabled Name
7211 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7212 @end smallexample
7213 @end table
7214
7215 @node Selection
7216 @section Selecting a Frame
7217
7218 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7219 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7220 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7221 of the stack frame just selected.
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7225 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7226 @item frame @var{n}
7227 @itemx f @var{n}
7228 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7229 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7230 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7231 @code{main}.
7232
7233 @item frame @var{addr}
7234 @itemx f @var{addr}
7235 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7236 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7237 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7238 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7239 switches between them.
7240
7241 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7242 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7243
7244 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7245 pointer and a program counter.
7246
7247 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7248 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7249
7250 @kindex up
7251 @item up @var{n}
7252 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7253 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7254 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7255
7256 @kindex down
7257 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7258 @item down @var{n}
7259 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7260 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7261 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7262 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7263 @end table
7264
7265 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7266 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7267 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7268 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7269
7270 @need 1000
7271 For example:
7272
7273 @smallexample
7274 @group
7275 (@value{GDBP}) up
7276 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7277 at env.c:10
7278 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7279 @end group
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7283 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7284 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7285 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7286 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7287 for details.
7288
7289 @table @code
7290 @kindex down-silently
7291 @kindex up-silently
7292 @item up-silently @var{n}
7293 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7294 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7295 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7296 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7297 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7298 distracting.
7299 @end table
7300
7301 @node Frame Info
7302 @section Information About a Frame
7303
7304 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7305 stack frame.
7306
7307 @table @code
7308 @item frame
7309 @itemx f
7310 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7311 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7312 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7313 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7314 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7315
7316 @kindex info frame
7317 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7318 @item info frame
7319 @itemx info f
7320 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7321 including:
7322
7323 @itemize @bullet
7324 @item
7325 the address of the frame
7326 @item
7327 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7328 @item
7329 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7330 @item
7331 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7332 @item
7333 the address of the frame's arguments
7334 @item
7335 the address of the frame's local variables
7336 @item
7337 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7338 @item
7339 which registers were saved in the frame
7340 @end itemize
7341
7342 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7343 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7344 the usual conventions.
7345
7346 @item info frame @var{addr}
7347 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7348 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7349 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7350 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7351 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7352 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7353
7354 @kindex info args
7355 @item info args
7356 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7357
7358 @item info locals
7359 @kindex info locals
7360 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7361 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7362 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7363
7364 @end table
7365
7366
7367 @node Source
7368 @chapter Examining Source Files
7369
7370 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7371 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7372 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7373 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7374 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7375 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7376 source files by explicit command.
7377
7378 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7379 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7380 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7381
7382 @menu
7383 * List:: Printing source lines
7384 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7385 * Edit:: Editing source files
7386 * Search:: Searching source files
7387 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7388 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7389 @end menu
7390
7391 @node List
7392 @section Printing Source Lines
7393
7394 @kindex list
7395 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7396 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7397 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7398 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7399 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7400
7401 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7402
7403 @table @code
7404 @item list @var{linenum}
7405 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7406 current source file.
7407
7408 @item list @var{function}
7409 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7410 @var{function}.
7411
7412 @item list
7413 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7414 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7415 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7416 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7417 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7418
7419 @item list -
7420 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7421 @end table
7422
7423 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7424 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7425 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7426
7427 @table @code
7428 @kindex set listsize
7429 @item set listsize @var{count}
7430 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7431 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7432 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7433 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7434
7435 @kindex show listsize
7436 @item show listsize
7437 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7438 @end table
7439
7440 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7441 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7442 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7443 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7444 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7445
7446 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7447 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7448 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7449 to specify some source line.
7450
7451 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7452
7453 @table @code
7454 @item list @var{linespec}
7455 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7456
7457 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7458 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7459 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7460 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7461 the same source file as the first linespec.
7462
7463 @item list ,@var{last}
7464 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7465
7466 @item list @var{first},
7467 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7468
7469 @item list +
7470 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7471
7472 @item list -
7473 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7474
7475 @item list
7476 As described in the preceding table.
7477 @end table
7478
7479 @node Specify Location
7480 @section Specifying a Location
7481 @cindex specifying location
7482 @cindex linespec
7483
7484 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7485 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7486 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7487 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7488
7489 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7490 @value{GDBN} understands:
7491
7492 @table @code
7493 @item @var{linenum}
7494 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7495
7496 @item -@var{offset}
7497 @itemx +@var{offset}
7498 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7499 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7500 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7501 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7502 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7503 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7504 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7505 linespec.
7506
7507 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7508 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7509 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7510 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7511 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7512 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7513 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7514
7515 @item @var{function}
7516 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7517 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7518
7519 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7520 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7521
7522 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7523 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7524 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7525 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7526 functions in different source files.
7527
7528 @item @var{label}
7529 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7530 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7531 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7532 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7533 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7534
7535 @item *@var{address}
7536 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7537 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7538 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7539 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7540 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7541 source files.
7542
7543 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7544 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7545 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7546 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7547 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7548 of @var{address}:
7549
7550 @table @code
7551 @item @var{expression}
7552 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7553
7554 @item @var{funcaddr}
7555 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7556 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7557 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7558 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7559 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7560 (although the Pascal form also works).
7561
7562 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7563 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7564
7565 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7566 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7567 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7568 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7569 functions with identical names in different source files.
7570 @end table
7571
7572 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7573 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7574 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7575 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7576 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7577 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7578
7579 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7580 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7581 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7582 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7583 each one of those probes.
7584
7585 @end table
7586
7587
7588 @node Edit
7589 @section Editing Source Files
7590 @cindex editing source files
7591
7592 @kindex edit
7593 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7594 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7595 The editing program of your choice
7596 is invoked with the current line set to
7597 the active line in the program.
7598 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7599 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7600
7601 @table @code
7602 @item edit @var{location}
7603 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7604 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7605 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7606 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7607 command most commonly used:
7608
7609 @table @code
7610 @item edit @var{number}
7611 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7612
7613 @item edit @var{function}
7614 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7615 @end table
7616
7617 @end table
7618
7619 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7620 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7621 @footnote{
7622 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7623 following command-line syntax:
7624 @smallexample
7625 ex +@var{number} file
7626 @end smallexample
7627 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7628 the file where to start editing.}.
7629 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7630 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7631 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7632 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7633 @smallexample
7634 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7635 export EDITOR
7636 gdb @dots{}
7637 @end smallexample
7638 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7639 @smallexample
7640 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7641 gdb @dots{}
7642 @end smallexample
7643
7644 @node Search
7645 @section Searching Source Files
7646 @cindex searching source files
7647
7648 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7649 regular expression.
7650
7651 @table @code
7652 @kindex search
7653 @kindex forward-search
7654 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7655 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7656 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7657 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7658 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7659 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7660 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7661 @code{fo}.
7662
7663 @kindex reverse-search
7664 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7665 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7666 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7667 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7668 this command as @code{rev}.
7669 @end table
7670
7671 @node Source Path
7672 @section Specifying Source Directories
7673
7674 @cindex source path
7675 @cindex directories for source files
7676 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7677 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7678 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7679 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7680 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7681 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7682 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7683
7684 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7685 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7686 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7687 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7688 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7689 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7690 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7691 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7692 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7693 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7694 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7695
7696 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7697 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7698 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7699 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7700 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7701 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7702
7703 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7704 source files.
7705
7706 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7707 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7708 each line is in the file.
7709
7710 @kindex directory
7711 @kindex dir
7712 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7713 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7714 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7715
7716 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7717 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7718
7719 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7720 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7721 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7722 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7723 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7724 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7725 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7726 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7727 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7728 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7729 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7730 name to look up the sources.
7731
7732 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7733 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7734 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7735 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7736 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7737 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7738 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7739 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7740
7741 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7742 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7743 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7744 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7745 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7746 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7747 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7748
7749 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7750 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7751 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7752 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7753 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7754 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7755 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7756 command.
7757
7758 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7759 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7760 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7761 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7762 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7763 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7764 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7765
7766 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7767 @cindex default source path substitution
7768 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7769 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7770 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7771 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7772 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7773 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7774 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7775 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7776 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7777 together.
7778
7779 @table @code
7780 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7781 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7782 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7783 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7784 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7785 part of absolute file names) or
7786 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7787 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7788
7789 @kindex cdir
7790 @kindex cwd
7791 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7792 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7793 @cindex compilation directory
7794 @cindex current directory
7795 @cindex working directory
7796 @cindex directory, current
7797 @cindex directory, compilation
7798 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7799 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7800 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7801 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7802 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7803 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7804
7805 @item directory
7806 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7807
7808 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7809 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7810
7811 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7812 @kindex set directories
7813 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7814 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7815
7816 @item show directories
7817 @kindex show directories
7818 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7819
7820 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7821 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7822 @kindex set substitute-path
7823 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7824 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7825 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7826
7827 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7828 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7829
7830 @smallexample
7831 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7832 @end smallexample
7833
7834 @noindent
7835 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7836 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7837 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7838
7839 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7840 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7841 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7842 the substitution.
7843
7844 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7845
7846 @smallexample
7847 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7848 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7849 @end smallexample
7850
7851 @noindent
7852 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7853 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7854 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7855 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7856
7857
7858 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7859 @kindex unset substitute-path
7860 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7861 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7862 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7863
7864 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7865
7866 @item show substitute-path [path]
7867 @kindex show substitute-path
7868 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7869 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7870
7871 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7872 rules.
7873
7874 @end table
7875
7876 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7877 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7878 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7879
7880 @enumerate
7881 @item
7882 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7883
7884 @item
7885 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7886 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7887 directories in one command.
7888 @end enumerate
7889
7890 @node Machine Code
7891 @section Source and Machine Code
7892 @cindex source line and its code address
7893
7894 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7895 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7896 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7897 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7898 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7899 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7900 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7901 well as hex.
7902
7903 @table @code
7904 @kindex info line
7905 @item info line @var{linespec}
7906 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7907 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7908 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7909 @end table
7910
7911 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7912 the object code for the first line of function
7913 @code{m4_changequote}:
7914
7915 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7916 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7917 @smallexample
7918 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7919 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7920 @end smallexample
7921
7922 @noindent
7923 @cindex code address and its source line
7924 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7925 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7926 @smallexample
7927 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7928 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7929 @end smallexample
7930
7931 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7932 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7933 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7934 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7935 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7936 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7937 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7938 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7939 Variables}).
7940
7941 @table @code
7942 @kindex disassemble
7943 @cindex assembly instructions
7944 @cindex instructions, assembly
7945 @cindex machine instructions
7946 @cindex listing machine instructions
7947 @item disassemble
7948 @itemx disassemble /m
7949 @itemx disassemble /r
7950 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7951 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7952 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7953 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7954 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7955 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7956 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7957 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7958 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7959 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7960
7961 @table @code
7962 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7963 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7964 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7965 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7966 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7967 @end table
7968
7969 @noindent
7970 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7971 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7972
7973 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7974 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7975
7976 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7977 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7978 @end table
7979
7980 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7981 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7982
7983 @smallexample
7984 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7985 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7986 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7987 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7988 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7989 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7990 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7991 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7992 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7993 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7994 End of assembler dump.
7995 @end smallexample
7996
7997 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7998 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7999
8000 @smallexample
8001 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8002 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8003 5 @{
8004 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8005 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8006 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8007 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8008 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8009
8010 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8011 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8012 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8013
8014 7 return 0;
8015 8 @}
8016 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8017 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8018 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8019
8020 End of assembler dump.
8021 @end smallexample
8022
8023 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8024
8025 @smallexample
8026 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8027 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8028 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8029 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8030 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8031 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8032 End of assembler dump.
8033 @end smallexample
8034
8035 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8036 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8037 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8038 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8039
8040 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8041 mnemonics or other syntax.
8042
8043 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8044 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8045 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8046 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8047 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8048
8049 @table @code
8050 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8051 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8052 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8053 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8054 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8055 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8056
8057 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8058 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8059 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8060 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8061
8062 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8063 @item show disassembly-flavor
8064 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8065 @end table
8066
8067 @table @code
8068 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8069 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8070 @item set disassemble-next-line
8071 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8072 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8073 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8074 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8075 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8076 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8077 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8078 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8079 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8080 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8081 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8082 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8083 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8084 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8085 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8086 instruction.
8087 @end table
8088
8089
8090 @node Data
8091 @chapter Examining Data
8092
8093 @cindex printing data
8094 @cindex examining data
8095 @kindex print
8096 @kindex inspect
8097 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8098 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8099 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8100 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8101 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8102 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8103
8104 @table @code
8105 @item print @var{expr}
8106 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8107 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8108 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8109 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8110 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8111 Formats}.
8112
8113 @item print
8114 @itemx print /@var{f}
8115 @cindex reprint the last value
8116 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8117 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8118 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8119 @end table
8120
8121 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8122 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8123 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8124
8125 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8126 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8127 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8128 Table}.
8129
8130 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8131 @kindex explore
8132 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8133 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8134 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8135 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8136 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8137 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8138 embedded in the higher level data types.
8139
8140 @table @code
8141 @item explore @var{arg}
8142 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8143 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8144 @end table
8145
8146 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8147 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8148 C program as
8149
8150 @smallexample
8151 struct SimpleStruct
8152 @{
8153 int i;
8154 double d;
8155 @};
8156
8157 struct ComplexStruct
8158 @{
8159 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8160 int arr[10];
8161 @};
8162 @end smallexample
8163
8164 @noindent
8165 followed by variable declarations as
8166
8167 @smallexample
8168 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8169 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8170 @end smallexample
8171
8172 @noindent
8173 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8174 @code{explore} command as follows.
8175
8176 @smallexample
8177 (gdb) explore cs
8178 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8179 the following fields:
8180
8181 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8182 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8183
8184 Enter the field number of choice:
8185 @end smallexample
8186
8187 @noindent
8188 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8189 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8190 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8191 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8192 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8193 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8194 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8195 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8196
8197 @smallexample
8198 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8199 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8200 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8201 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8202
8203 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8204 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8205
8206 Press enter to return to parent value:
8207 @end smallexample
8208
8209 @noindent
8210 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8211 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8212 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8213 to explore.
8214
8215 @smallexample
8216 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8217 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8218
8219 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8220
8221 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8222
8223 Press enter to return to parent value:
8224 @end smallexample
8225
8226 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8227 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8228 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8229 level data structure).
8230
8231 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8232 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8233 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8234 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8235 same example as above, your can explore the type
8236 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8237 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8238
8239 @smallexample
8240 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8241 @end smallexample
8242
8243 @noindent
8244 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8245 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8246 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8247 example.
8248
8249 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8250 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8251 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8252 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8253 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8254
8255 @table @code
8256 @item explore value @var{expr}
8257 @cindex explore value
8258 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8259 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8260 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8261 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8262 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8263
8264 @item explore type @var{arg}
8265 @cindex explore type
8266 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8267 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8268 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8269 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8270 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8271 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8272 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8273 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8274 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8275 @end table
8276
8277 @menu
8278 * Expressions:: Expressions
8279 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8280 * Variables:: Program variables
8281 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8282 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8283 * Memory:: Examining memory
8284 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8285 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8286 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8287 * Value History:: Value history
8288 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8289 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8290 * Registers:: Registers
8291 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8292 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8293 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8294 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8295 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8296 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8297 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8298 character set than GDB does
8299 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8300 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8301 @end menu
8302
8303 @node Expressions
8304 @section Expressions
8305
8306 @cindex expressions
8307 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8308 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8309 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8310 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8311 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8312 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8313 @ref{Compilation}.
8314
8315 @cindex arrays in expressions
8316 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8317 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8318 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8319 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8320 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8321 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8322
8323 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8324 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8325 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8326 languages.
8327
8328 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8329 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8330
8331 @cindex casts, in expressions
8332 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8333 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8334 at that address in memory.
8335 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8336
8337 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8338 to programming languages:
8339
8340 @table @code
8341 @item @@
8342 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8343 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8344
8345 @item ::
8346 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8347 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8348
8349 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8350 @cindex type casting memory
8351 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8352 @cindex casts, to view memory
8353 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8354 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8355 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8356 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8357 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8358 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8359 @end table
8360
8361 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8362 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8363 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8364
8365 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8366 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8367 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8368 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8369 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8370 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8371 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8372
8373 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8374 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8375 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8376 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8377 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8378 as well.
8379
8380 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8381 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8382 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8383 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8384 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8385 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8386 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8387 choices.
8388
8389 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8390 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8391 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8392
8393 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8394 @smallexample
8395 @group
8396 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8397 [0] cancel
8398 [1] all
8399 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8400 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8401 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8402 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8403 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8404 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8405 > 2 4 6
8406 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8407 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8408 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8409 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8410 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8411 breakpoints.
8412 (@value{GDBP})
8413 @end group
8414 @end smallexample
8415
8416 @table @code
8417 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8418 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8419 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8420
8421 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8422 is ambiguous.
8423
8424 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8425 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8426 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8427 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8428 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8429 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8430 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8431 in the use of the menu.
8432
8433 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8434 when an ambiguity is detected.
8435
8436 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8437 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8438
8439 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8440 @item show multiple-symbols
8441 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8442 @end table
8443
8444 @node Variables
8445 @section Program Variables
8446
8447 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8448 in your program.
8449
8450 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8451 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8452
8453 @itemize @bullet
8454 @item
8455 global (or file-static)
8456 @end itemize
8457
8458 @noindent or
8459
8460 @itemize @bullet
8461 @item
8462 visible according to the scope rules of the
8463 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8464 @end itemize
8465
8466 @noindent This means that in the function
8467
8468 @smallexample
8469 foo (a)
8470 int a;
8471 @{
8472 bar (a);
8473 @{
8474 int b = test ();
8475 bar (b);
8476 @}
8477 @}
8478 @end smallexample
8479
8480 @noindent
8481 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8482 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8483 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8484 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8485
8486 @cindex variable name conflict
8487 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8488 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8489 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8490 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8491 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8492 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8493 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8494
8495 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8496 @ifnotinfo
8497 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8498 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8499 @end ifnotinfo
8500 @smallexample
8501 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8502 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8503 @end smallexample
8504
8505 @noindent
8506 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8507 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8508 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8509 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8510
8511 @smallexample
8512 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8513 @end smallexample
8514
8515 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8516 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8517 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8518 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8519 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8520
8521 @smallexample
8522 void
8523 foo (int a)
8524 @{
8525 if (a < 10)
8526 bar (a);
8527 else
8528 process (a); /* Stop here */
8529 @}
8530
8531 int
8532 bar (int a)
8533 @{
8534 foo (a + 5);
8535 @}
8536 @end smallexample
8537
8538 @noindent
8539 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8540 here is what you might see
8541 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8542
8543 @smallexample
8544 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8545 $1 = 10
8546 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8547 $2 = 5
8548 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8549 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8550 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8551 $3 = 5
8552 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8553 $4 = 0
8554 @end smallexample
8555
8556 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8557 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8558 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8559 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8560 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8561
8562 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8563 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8564 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8565 @code{some_global}.
8566
8567 @smallexample
8568 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8569 $1 = 23
8570 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8571 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8572 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8573 $2 = 27
8574 @end smallexample
8575
8576 @cindex wrong values
8577 @cindex variable values, wrong
8578 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8579 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8580 @quotation
8581 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8582 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8583 scope, and just before exit.
8584 @end quotation
8585 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8586 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8587 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8588 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8589 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8590 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8591 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8592 variable definitions may be gone.
8593
8594 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8595 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8596 when compiling.
8597
8598 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8599 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8600 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8601 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8602 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8603 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8604 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8605
8606 @smallexample
8607 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8608 @end smallexample
8609
8610 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8611 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8612 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8613 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8614 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8615
8616 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8617 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8618 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8619 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8620
8621 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8622 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8623 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8624 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8625 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8626
8627 @smallexample
8628 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8629 29 i++;
8630 (gdb) next
8631 30 e (i);
8632 (gdb) print i
8633 $1 = 31
8634 (gdb) print i@@entry
8635 $2 = 30
8636 @end smallexample
8637
8638 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8639 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8640 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8641 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8642 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8643 For program code
8644
8645 @smallexample
8646 char var0[] = "A";
8647 signed char var1[] = "A";
8648 @end smallexample
8649
8650 You get during debugging
8651 @smallexample
8652 (gdb) print var0
8653 $1 = "A"
8654 (gdb) print var1
8655 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8656 @end smallexample
8657
8658 @node Arrays
8659 @section Artificial Arrays
8660
8661 @cindex artificial array
8662 @cindex arrays
8663 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8664 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8665 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8666 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8667 program.
8668
8669 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8670 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8671 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8672 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8673 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8674 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8675 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8676 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8677 example. If a program says
8678
8679 @smallexample
8680 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 p *array@@len
8688 @end smallexample
8689
8690 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8691 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8692 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8693 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8694 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8695
8696 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8697 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8698 The value need not be in memory:
8699 @smallexample
8700 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8701 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8702 @end smallexample
8703
8704 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8705 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8706 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8707 @smallexample
8708 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8709 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8710 @end smallexample
8711
8712 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8713 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8714 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8715 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8716 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8717 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8718 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8719 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8720 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8721 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8722
8723 @smallexample
8724 set $i = 0
8725 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8726 @key{RET}
8727 @key{RET}
8728 @dots{}
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 @node Output Formats
8732 @section Output Formats
8733
8734 @cindex formatted output
8735 @cindex output formats
8736 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8737 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8738 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8739 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8740 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8741
8742 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8743 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8744 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8745 letters supported are:
8746
8747 @table @code
8748 @item x
8749 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8750 hexadecimal.
8751
8752 @item d
8753 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8754
8755 @item u
8756 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8757
8758 @item o
8759 Print as integer in octal.
8760
8761 @item t
8762 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8763 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8764 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8765 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8766
8767 @item a
8768 @cindex unknown address, locating
8769 @cindex locate address
8770 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8771 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8772 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8773
8774 @smallexample
8775 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8776 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8777 @end smallexample
8778
8779 @noindent
8780 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8781 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8782
8783 @item c
8784 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8785 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8786 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8787 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8788
8789 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8790 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8791 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8792 data.
8793
8794 @item f
8795 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8796 using typical floating point syntax.
8797
8798 @item s
8799 @cindex printing strings
8800 @cindex printing byte arrays
8801 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8802 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8803 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8804 natural types.
8805
8806 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8807 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8808 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8809 array.
8810
8811 @item z
8812 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8813 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8814 to the size of the integer type.
8815
8816 @item r
8817 @cindex raw printing
8818 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8819 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8820 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8821 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8822 pretty-printer which might exist.
8823 @end table
8824
8825 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8826
8827 @smallexample
8828 p/x $pc
8829 @end smallexample
8830
8831 @noindent
8832 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8833 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8834
8835 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8836 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8837 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8838
8839 @node Memory
8840 @section Examining Memory
8841
8842 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8843 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8844
8845 @cindex examining memory
8846 @table @code
8847 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8848 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8849 @itemx x @var{addr}
8850 @itemx x
8851 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8852 @end table
8853
8854 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8855 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8856 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8857 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8858 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8859
8860 @table @r
8861 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8862 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8863 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8864 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8865 @c 4.1.2.
8866
8867 @item @var{f}, the display format
8868 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8869 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8870 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8871 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8872 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8873
8874 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8875 The unit size is any of
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @item b
8879 Bytes.
8880 @item h
8881 Halfwords (two bytes).
8882 @item w
8883 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8884 @item g
8885 Giant words (eight bytes).
8886 @end table
8887
8888 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8889 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8890 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8891 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8892 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8893 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8894 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8895 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8896 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8897 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8898 be altered.
8899
8900 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8901 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8902 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8903 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8904 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8905 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8906 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8907 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8908 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8909 a value from memory).
8910 @end table
8911
8912 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8913 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8914 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8915 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8916 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8917
8918 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8919 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8920 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8921 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8922 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8923
8924 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8925 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8926 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8927 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8928 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8929 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8930 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8931 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8932 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8933
8934 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8935 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8936 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8937 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8938 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8939 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8940 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8941
8942 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8943 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8944
8945 @smallexample
8946 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8947 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8948 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8949 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8950 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8951 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8952 @end smallexample
8953
8954 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8955 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8956 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8957 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8958 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8959 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8960 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8961 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8962 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8963
8964 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8965 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8966 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8967
8968 @cindex remote memory comparison
8969 @cindex target memory comparison
8970 @cindex verify remote memory image
8971 @cindex verify target memory image
8972 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8973 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8974 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8975 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8976 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8977 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8978
8979 @table @code
8980 @kindex compare-sections
8981 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8982 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8983 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8984 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8985 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8986 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8987
8988 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8989 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8990 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8991 @end table
8992
8993 @node Auto Display
8994 @section Automatic Display
8995 @cindex automatic display
8996 @cindex display of expressions
8997
8998 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8999 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9000 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9001 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9002 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9003 The automatic display looks like this:
9004
9005 @smallexample
9006 2: foo = 38
9007 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9008 @end smallexample
9009
9010 @noindent
9011 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9012 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9013 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9014 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9015 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9016 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9017
9018 @table @code
9019 @kindex display
9020 @item display @var{expr}
9021 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9022 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9023
9024 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9025
9026 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9027 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9028 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9029 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9030 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9031
9032 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9033 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9034 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9035 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9036 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9037 @end table
9038
9039 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9040 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9041 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9042
9043 @table @code
9044 @kindex delete display
9045 @kindex undisplay
9046 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9047 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9048 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9049 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9050 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9051 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9052 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9053
9054 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9055 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9056
9057 @kindex disable display
9058 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9059 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9060 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9061 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9062 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9063 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9064 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9065 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9066
9067 @kindex enable display
9068 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9069 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9070 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9071 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9072 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9073 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9074 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9075
9076 @item display
9077 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9078 done when your program stops.
9079
9080 @kindex info display
9081 @item info display
9082 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9083 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9084 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9085 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9086 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9087 @end table
9088
9089 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9090 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9091 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9092 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9093 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9094 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9095 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9096 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9097 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9098 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9099 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9100
9101 @node Print Settings
9102 @section Print Settings
9103
9104 @cindex format options
9105 @cindex print settings
9106 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9107 and symbols are printed.
9108
9109 @noindent
9110 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9111
9112 @table @code
9113 @kindex set print
9114 @item set print address
9115 @itemx set print address on
9116 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9117 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9118 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9119 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9120 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9121 @code{set print address on}:
9122
9123 @smallexample
9124 @group
9125 (@value{GDBP}) f
9126 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9127 at input.c:530
9128 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9129 @end group
9130 @end smallexample
9131
9132 @item set print address off
9133 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9134 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9135
9136 @smallexample
9137 @group
9138 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9139 (@value{GDBP}) f
9140 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9141 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9142 @end group
9143 @end smallexample
9144
9145 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9146 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9147 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9148 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9149
9150 @kindex show print
9151 @item show print address
9152 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9153 @end table
9154
9155 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9156 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9157 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9158 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9159 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9160 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9161 it prints a symbolic address:
9162
9163 @table @code
9164 @item set print symbol-filename on
9165 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9166 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9167 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9168 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9169
9170 @item set print symbol-filename off
9171 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9172 default.
9173
9174 @item show print symbol-filename
9175 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9176 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9177 @end table
9178
9179 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9180 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9181 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9182
9183 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9184 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9185
9186 @table @code
9187 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9188 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9189 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9190 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9191 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9192 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9193 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9194 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9195
9196 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9197 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9198 symbolic address.
9199 @end table
9200
9201 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9202 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9203 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9204 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9205 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9206 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9207 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9208 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9209
9210 @smallexample
9211 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9212 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9213 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9214 @end smallexample
9215
9216 @quotation
9217 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9218 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9219 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9220 @end quotation
9221
9222 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9223 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9224
9225 @table @code
9226 @item set print symbol on
9227 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9228 one exists.
9229
9230 @item set print symbol off
9231 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9232 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9233 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9234
9235 @item show print symbol
9236 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9237 address.
9238 @end table
9239
9240 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9241
9242 @table @code
9243 @item set print array
9244 @itemx set print array on
9245 @cindex pretty print arrays
9246 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9247 but uses more space. The default is off.
9248
9249 @item set print array off
9250 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9251
9252 @item show print array
9253 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9254 arrays.
9255
9256 @cindex print array indexes
9257 @item set print array-indexes
9258 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9259 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9260 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9261 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9262
9263 @item set print array-indexes off
9264 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9265
9266 @item show print array-indexes
9267 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9268 arrays.
9269
9270 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9271 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9272 @cindex number of array elements to print
9273 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9274 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9275 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9276 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9277 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9278 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9279 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9280 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9281
9282 @item show print elements
9283 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9284 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9285
9286 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9287 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9288 @cindex printing frame argument values
9289 @cindex print all frame argument values
9290 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9291 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9292 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9293 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9294 values are:
9295
9296 @table @code
9297 @item all
9298 The values of all arguments are printed.
9299
9300 @item scalars
9301 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9302 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9303 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9304 only scalar arguments are shown:
9305
9306 @smallexample
9307 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9308 at frame-args.c:23
9309 @end smallexample
9310
9311 @item none
9312 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9313 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9314
9315 @smallexample
9316 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9317 at frame-args.c:23
9318 @end smallexample
9319 @end table
9320
9321 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9322 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9323 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9324 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9325 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9326 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9327 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9328 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9329 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9330 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9331
9332 @item show print frame-arguments
9333 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9334
9335 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9336 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9337
9338 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9339 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9340 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9341 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9342 This is the default.
9343
9344 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9345 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9346
9347 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9348 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9349 @kindex set print entry-values
9350 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9351 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9352 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9353 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9354 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9355
9356 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9357 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9358 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9359 @code{no} setting.
9360
9361 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9362 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9363 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9364 this information.
9365
9366 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9367
9368 @table @code
9369 @item no
9370 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9371 point.
9372 @smallexample
9373 #0 equal (val=5)
9374 #0 different (val=6)
9375 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9376 #0 born (val=10)
9377 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9378 @end smallexample
9379
9380 @item only
9381 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9382 values are never printed.
9383 @smallexample
9384 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9385 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9386 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9387 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9388 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9389 @end smallexample
9390
9391 @item preferred
9392 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9393 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9394 value for such parameter.
9395 @smallexample
9396 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9397 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9398 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9399 #0 born (val=10)
9400 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9401 @end smallexample
9402
9403 @item if-needed
9404 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9405 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9406 parameter.
9407 @smallexample
9408 #0 equal (val=5)
9409 #0 different (val=6)
9410 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9411 #0 born (val=10)
9412 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9413 @end smallexample
9414
9415 @item both
9416 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9417 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9418 optimizations.
9419 @smallexample
9420 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9421 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9422 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9423 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9424 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 @item compact
9428 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9429 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9430 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9431 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9432 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9433 @smallexample
9434 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9435 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9436 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9437 #0 born (val=10)
9438 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9439 @end smallexample
9440
9441 @item default
9442 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9443 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9444 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9445 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9446 @smallexample
9447 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9448 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9449 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9450 #0 born (val=10)
9451 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9452 @end smallexample
9453 @end table
9454
9455 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9456 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9457
9458 @item show print entry-values
9459 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9460 entry.
9461
9462 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9463 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9464 @cindex repeated array elements
9465 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9466 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9467 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9468 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9469 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9470 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9471 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9472 is 10.
9473
9474 @item show print repeats
9475 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9476 elements.
9477
9478 @item set print null-stop
9479 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9480 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9481 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9482 contain only short strings.
9483 The default is off.
9484
9485 @item show print null-stop
9486 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9487 @sc{null} character.
9488
9489 @item set print pretty on
9490 @cindex print structures in indented form
9491 @cindex indentation in structure display
9492 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9493 per line, like this:
9494
9495 @smallexample
9496 @group
9497 $1 = @{
9498 next = 0x0,
9499 flags = @{
9500 sweet = 1,
9501 sour = 1
9502 @},
9503 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9504 @}
9505 @end group
9506 @end smallexample
9507
9508 @item set print pretty off
9509 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9510
9511 @smallexample
9512 @group
9513 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9514 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9515 @end group
9516 @end smallexample
9517
9518 @noindent
9519 This is the default format.
9520
9521 @item show print pretty
9522 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9523
9524 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9525 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9526 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9527 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9528 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9529 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9530 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9531 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9532
9533 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9534 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9535 international character sets, and is the default.
9536
9537 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9538 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9539
9540 @item set print union on
9541 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9542 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9543 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9544
9545 @item set print union off
9546 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9547 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9548 instead.
9549
9550 @item show print union
9551 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9552 structures and other unions.
9553
9554 For example, given the declarations
9555
9556 @smallexample
9557 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9558 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9559 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9560 Bug_forms;
9561
9562 struct thing @{
9563 Species it;
9564 union @{
9565 Tree_forms tree;
9566 Bug_forms bug;
9567 @} form;
9568 @};
9569
9570 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9571 @end smallexample
9572
9573 @noindent
9574 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9575
9576 @smallexample
9577 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 @noindent
9581 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9582
9583 @smallexample
9584 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9585 @end smallexample
9586
9587 @noindent
9588 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9589 and in Pascal.
9590 @end table
9591
9592 @need 1000
9593 @noindent
9594 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9595
9596 @table @code
9597 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9598 @item set print demangle
9599 @itemx set print demangle on
9600 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9601 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9602 linkage. The default is on.
9603
9604 @item show print demangle
9605 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9606
9607 @item set print asm-demangle
9608 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9609 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9610 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9611 The default is off.
9612
9613 @item show print asm-demangle
9614 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9615 or demangled form.
9616
9617 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9618 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9619 @kindex set demangle-style
9620 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9621 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9622 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9623
9624 @table @code
9625 @item auto
9626 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9627 This is the default.
9628
9629 @item gnu
9630 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9631
9632 @item hp
9633 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9634
9635 @item lucid
9636 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9637
9638 @item arm
9639 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9640 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9641 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9642 require further enhancement to permit that.
9643
9644 @end table
9645 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9646
9647 @item show demangle-style
9648 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9649
9650 @item set print object
9651 @itemx set print object on
9652 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9653 @cindex display derived types
9654 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9655 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9656 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9657 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9658 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9659 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9660 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9661
9662 @item set print object off
9663 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9664 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9665
9666 @item show print object
9667 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9668
9669 @item set print static-members
9670 @itemx set print static-members on
9671 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9672 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9673
9674 @item set print static-members off
9675 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9676
9677 @item show print static-members
9678 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9679
9680 @item set print pascal_static-members
9681 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9682 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9683 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9684 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9685
9686 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9687 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9688
9689 @item show print pascal_static-members
9690 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9691
9692 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9693 @item set print vtbl
9694 @itemx set print vtbl on
9695 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9696 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9697 @cindex VTBL display
9698 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9699 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9700 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9701
9702 @item set print vtbl off
9703 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9704
9705 @item show print vtbl
9706 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9707 @end table
9708
9709 @node Pretty Printing
9710 @section Pretty Printing
9711
9712 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9713 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9714 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9715
9716 @menu
9717 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9718 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9719 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9720 @end menu
9721
9722 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9723 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9724
9725 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9726 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9727 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9728
9729 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9730 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9731 pretty-printers with their names.
9732 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9733 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9734 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9735 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9736
9737 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9738 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9739 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9740 do anything special.
9741
9742 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9743
9744 @itemize @bullet
9745 @item
9746 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9747 all inferiors.
9748
9749 @item
9750 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9751 when debugging that program.
9752 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9753
9754 @item
9755 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9756 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9757 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9758 @end itemize
9759
9760 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9761 pretty-printers are selected,
9762
9763 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9764 for new types.
9765
9766 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9767 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9768
9769 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9770
9771 @smallexample
9772 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9773 $1 = @{
9774 static npos = 4294967295,
9775 _M_dataplus = @{
9776 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9777 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9778 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9779 @},
9780 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9781 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9782 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9783 @}
9784 @}
9785 @end smallexample
9786
9787 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9788
9789 @smallexample
9790 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9791 $2 = "abcd"
9792 @end smallexample
9793
9794 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9795 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9796 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9797
9798 @table @code
9799 @kindex info pretty-printer
9800 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9801 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9802 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9803
9804 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9805 whose pretty-printers to list.
9806 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9807 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9808 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9809 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9810 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9811
9812 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9813 to list.
9814
9815 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9816 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9817 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9818 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9819
9820 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9821 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9822 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9823 @end table
9824
9825 Example:
9826
9827 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9828 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9829 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9830 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9831
9832 @smallexample
9833 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9834 library1.so:
9835 foo
9836 library2.so:
9837 bar
9838 bar1
9839 bar2
9840 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9841 library2.so:
9842 bar
9843 bar1
9844 bar2
9845 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9846 1 printer disabled
9847 2 of 3 printers enabled
9848 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9849 library1.so:
9850 foo [disabled]
9851 library2.so:
9852 bar
9853 bar1
9854 bar2
9855 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9856 1 printer disabled
9857 1 of 3 printers enabled
9858 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9859 library1.so:
9860 foo [disabled]
9861 library2.so:
9862 bar
9863 bar1 [disabled]
9864 bar2
9865 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9866 1 printer disabled
9867 0 of 3 printers enabled
9868 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9869 library1.so:
9870 foo [disabled]
9871 library2.so:
9872 bar [disabled]
9873 bar1 [disabled]
9874 bar2
9875 @end smallexample
9876
9877 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9878 as can each individual subprinter.
9879
9880 @node Value History
9881 @section Value History
9882
9883 @cindex value history
9884 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9885 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9886 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9887 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9888 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9889 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9890 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9891 symbol table.
9892
9893 @cindex @code{$}
9894 @cindex @code{$$}
9895 @cindex history number
9896 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9897 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9898 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9899 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9900 history number.
9901
9902 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9903 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9904 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9905 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9906 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9907 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9908 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9909
9910 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9911 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9912
9913 @smallexample
9914 p *$
9915 @end smallexample
9916
9917 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9918 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9919
9920 @smallexample
9921 p *$.next
9922 @end smallexample
9923
9924 @noindent
9925 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9926 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9927
9928 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9929 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9930
9931 @smallexample
9932 print x
9933 set x=5
9934 @end smallexample
9935
9936 @noindent
9937 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9938 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9939
9940 @table @code
9941 @kindex show values
9942 @item show values
9943 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9944 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9945 values} does not change the history.
9946
9947 @item show values @var{n}
9948 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9949
9950 @item show values +
9951 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9952 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9953 @end table
9954
9955 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9956 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9957
9958 @node Convenience Vars
9959 @section Convenience Variables
9960
9961 @cindex convenience variables
9962 @cindex user-defined variables
9963 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9964 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9965 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9966 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9967 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9968
9969 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9970 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9971 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9972 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9973 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9974
9975 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9976 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9977 For example:
9978
9979 @smallexample
9980 set $foo = *object_ptr
9981 @end smallexample
9982
9983 @noindent
9984 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9985 @code{object_ptr}.
9986
9987 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9988 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9989 value with another assignment at any time.
9990
9991 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9992 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9993 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9994 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @kindex show convenience
9998 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9999 @item show convenience
10000 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10001 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10002 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10003
10004 @kindex init-if-undefined
10005 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10006 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10007 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10008 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10009 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10010 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10011 override default values used in a command script.
10012
10013 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10014 any side-effects do not occur.
10015 @end table
10016
10017 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10018 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10019 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10020
10021 @smallexample
10022 set $i = 0
10023 print bar[$i++]->contents
10024 @end smallexample
10025
10026 @noindent
10027 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10028
10029 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10030 values likely to be useful.
10031
10032 @table @code
10033 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10034 @item $_
10035 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10036 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10037 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10038 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10039 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10040 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10041 to the type of @code{$__}.
10042
10043 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10044 @item $__
10045 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10046 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10047 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10048
10049 @item $_exitcode
10050 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10051 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10052 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10053 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10054
10055 @item $_exitsignal
10056 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10057 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10058 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10059 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10060
10061 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10062 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10063 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10064 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10065 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10066
10067 @smallexample
10068 #include <signal.h>
10069
10070 int
10071 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10072 @{
10073 raise (SIGALRM);
10074 return 0;
10075 @}
10076 @end smallexample
10077
10078 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10079 or signalled would be:
10080
10081 @smallexample
10082 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10083 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10084 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10085 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10086 >echo The program has exited\n
10087 >else
10088 >echo The program has signalled\n
10089 >end
10090 >end
10091 (@value{GDBP}) run
10092 Starting program:
10093
10094 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10095 The program no longer exists.
10096 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10097 The program has signalled
10098 @end smallexample
10099
10100 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10101 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10102 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10103 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10104
10105 @smallexample
10106 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10107 The program has exited
10108 @end smallexample
10109
10110 @item $_exception
10111 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10112 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10113
10114 @item $_probe_argc
10115 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10116 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10117
10118 @item $_sdata
10119 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10120 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10121 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10122 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10123 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10124
10125 @item $_siginfo
10126 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10127 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10128 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10129 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10130 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10131
10132 @item $_tlb
10133 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10134 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10135 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10136 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10137 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10138 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10139
10140 @end table
10141
10142 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10143 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10144 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10145
10146 @node Convenience Funs
10147 @section Convenience Functions
10148
10149 @cindex convenience functions
10150 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10151 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10152 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10153 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10154 @value{GDBN}.
10155
10156 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10157 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10158
10159 @table @code
10160
10161 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10162 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10163 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10164 returns zero.
10165
10166 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10167 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10168 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10169 it is @code{void}:
10170
10171 @smallexample
10172 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10173 $1 = void
10174 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10175 $2 = 1
10176 (@value{GDBP}) run
10177 Starting program: ./a.out
10178 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10179 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10180 $3 = 0
10181 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10182 $4 = 0
10183 @end smallexample
10184
10185 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10186 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10187 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10188 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10189 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10190 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10191 anymore.
10192
10193 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10194 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10195
10196 @smallexample
10197 void
10198 foo (void)
10199 @{
10200 @}
10201 @end smallexample
10202
10203 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10204
10205 @smallexample
10206 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10207 $1 = void
10208 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10209 $2 = 1
10210 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10211 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10212 $3 = void
10213 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10214 $4 = 1
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 @end table
10218
10219 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10220 @code{Python} support.
10221
10222 @table @code
10223
10224 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10225 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10226 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10227 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10228 Otherwise it returns zero.
10229
10230 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10231 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10232 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10233 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10234 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10235 regular expression support.
10236
10237 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10238 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10239 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10240 Otherwise it returns zero.
10241
10242 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10243 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10244 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10245
10246 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10247 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10248 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10249 Otherwise it returns zero.
10250
10251 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10252 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10253 The default is 1.
10254
10255 Example:
10256
10257 @smallexample
10258 (gdb) backtrace
10259 #0 bottom_func ()
10260 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10261 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10262 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10263 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10264 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10265 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10266 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10267 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10268 $1 = 1
10269 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10270 $1 = 1
10271 @end smallexample
10272
10273 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10274 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10275 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10276 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10277
10278 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10279 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10280 The default is 1.
10281
10282 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10283 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10284 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10285 Otherwise it returns zero.
10286
10287 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10288 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10289 The default is 1.
10290
10291 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10292 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10293 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10294 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10295
10296 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10297 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10298 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10299 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10300
10301 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10302 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10303 The default is 1.
10304
10305 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10306 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10307 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10308 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10309
10310 @end table
10311
10312 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10313 convenience functions.
10314
10315 @table @code
10316 @item help function
10317 @kindex help function
10318 @cindex show all convenience functions
10319 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10320 @end table
10321
10322 @node Registers
10323 @section Registers
10324
10325 @cindex registers
10326 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10327 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10328 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10329 your machine.
10330
10331 @table @code
10332 @kindex info registers
10333 @item info registers
10334 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10335 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10336
10337 @kindex info all-registers
10338 @cindex floating point registers
10339 @item info all-registers
10340 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10341 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10342
10343 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10344 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10345 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10346 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10347 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10348 @end table
10349
10350 @anchor{standard registers}
10351 @cindex stack pointer register
10352 @cindex program counter register
10353 @cindex process status register
10354 @cindex frame pointer register
10355 @cindex standard registers
10356 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10357 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10358 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10359 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10360 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10361 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10362 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10363 you could print the program counter in hex with
10364
10365 @smallexample
10366 p/x $pc
10367 @end smallexample
10368
10369 @noindent
10370 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10371
10372 @smallexample
10373 x/i $pc
10374 @end smallexample
10375
10376 @noindent
10377 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10378 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10379 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10380 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10381 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10382 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10383 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10384
10385 @smallexample
10386 set $sp += 4
10387 @end smallexample
10388
10389 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10390 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10391 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10392 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10393 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10394 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10395 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10396
10397 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10398 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10399 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10400 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10401 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10402 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10403 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10404
10405 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10406 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10407 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10408 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10409 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10410 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10411 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10412 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10413 prints the data in both formats.
10414
10415 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10416 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10417 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10418 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10419 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10420 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10421 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10422
10423 @smallexample
10424 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10425 $1 = @{
10426 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10427 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10428 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10429 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10430 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10431 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10432 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10433 @}
10434 @end smallexample
10435
10436 @noindent
10437 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10438 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10439 value to a @code{struct} member:
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10443 @end smallexample
10444
10445 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10446 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10447 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10448 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10449 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10450 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10451
10452 @cindex caller-saved registers
10453 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10454 @cindex volatile registers
10455 @cindex <not saved> values
10456 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10457 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10458 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10459 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10460 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10461 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10462 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10463 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10464 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10465 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10466 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10467 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10468 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10469 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10470 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10471 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10472 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10473 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10474 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10475 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10476 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10477 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10478 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10479
10480 @node Floating Point Hardware
10481 @section Floating Point Hardware
10482 @cindex floating point
10483
10484 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10485 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10486
10487 @table @code
10488 @kindex info float
10489 @item info float
10490 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10491 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10492 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10493 the ARM and x86 machines.
10494 @end table
10495
10496 @node Vector Unit
10497 @section Vector Unit
10498 @cindex vector unit
10499
10500 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10501 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10502
10503 @table @code
10504 @kindex info vector
10505 @item info vector
10506 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10507 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10508 @end table
10509
10510 @node OS Information
10511 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10512 @cindex OS information
10513
10514 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10515 you debug your program.
10516
10517 @cindex auxiliary vector
10518 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10519 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10520 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10521 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10522 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10523 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10524 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10525 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10526 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10527 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10528 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10529 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10530
10531 @table @code
10532 @kindex info auxv
10533 @item info auxv
10534 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10535 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10536 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10537 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10538 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10539 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10540 an unrecognized tag.
10541 @end table
10542
10543 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10544 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10545 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10546 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10547 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10548 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10549 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10550
10551 @table @code
10552 @kindex info os
10553 @item info os @var{infotype}
10554
10555 Display OS information of the requested type.
10556
10557 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10558
10559 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10560 @table @code
10561 @kindex info os processes
10562 @item processes
10563 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10564 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10565 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10566 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10567 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10568 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10569
10570 @kindex info os procgroups
10571 @item procgroups
10572 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10573 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10574 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10575 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10576 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10577 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10578 and the process group leader is listed first.
10579
10580 @kindex info os threads
10581 @item threads
10582 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10583 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10584 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10585 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10586 process is not listed.
10587
10588 @kindex info os files
10589 @item files
10590 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10591 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10592 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10593 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10594
10595 @kindex info os sockets
10596 @item sockets
10597 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10598 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10599 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10600 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10601 connection.
10602
10603 @kindex info os shm
10604 @item shm
10605 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10606 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10607 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10608 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10609 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10610 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10611 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10612
10613 @kindex info os semaphores
10614 @item semaphores
10615 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10616 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10617 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10618 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10619 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10620
10621 @kindex info os msg
10622 @item msg
10623 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10624 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10625 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10626 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10627 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10628 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10629 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10630 the message queue was last changed.
10631
10632 @kindex info os modules
10633 @item modules
10634 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10635 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10636 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10637 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10638 in memory.
10639 @end table
10640
10641 @item info os
10642 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10643 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10644 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10645 types, this command will report an error.
10646 @end table
10647
10648 @node Memory Region Attributes
10649 @section Memory Region Attributes
10650 @cindex memory region attributes
10651
10652 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10653 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10654 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10655 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10656 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10657 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10658 user can override the fetched regions.
10659
10660 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10661 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10662 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10663 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10664 all memory.
10665
10666 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10667 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10668
10669 @table @code
10670 @kindex mem
10671 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10672 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10673 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10674 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10675 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10676 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10677
10678 @item mem auto
10679 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10680 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10681
10682 @kindex delete mem
10683 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10684 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10685 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10686
10687 @kindex disable mem
10688 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10689 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10690 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10691 It may be enabled again later.
10692
10693 @kindex enable mem
10694 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10695 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10696
10697 @kindex info mem
10698 @item info mem
10699 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10700 for each region:
10701
10702 @table @emph
10703 @item Memory Region Number
10704 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10705 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10706 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10707
10708 @item Lo Address
10709 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10710
10711 @item Hi Address
10712 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10713
10714 @item Attributes
10715 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10716 @end table
10717 @end table
10718
10719
10720 @subsection Attributes
10721
10722 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10723 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10724 write accesses to a memory region.
10725
10726 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10727 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10728 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10729
10730 @table @code
10731 @item ro
10732 Memory is read only.
10733 @item wo
10734 Memory is write only.
10735 @item rw
10736 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10737 @end table
10738
10739 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10740 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10741 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10742 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10743 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10744
10745 @table @code
10746 @item 8
10747 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10748 @item 16
10749 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10750 @item 32
10751 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10752 @item 64
10753 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10754 @end table
10755
10756 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10757 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10758 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10759 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10760 @c
10761 @c @table @code
10762 @c @item hwbreak
10763 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10764 @c @item swbreak (default)
10765 @c @end table
10766
10767 @subsubsection Data Cache
10768 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10769 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10770 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10771 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10772 registers.
10773
10774 @table @code
10775 @item cache
10776 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10777 @item nocache
10778 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10779 @end table
10780
10781 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10782 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10783 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10784 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10785 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10786
10787 @table @code
10788 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10789 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10790 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10791 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10792 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10793 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10794 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10795 The default value is @code{on}.
10796 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10797 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10798 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10799 @end table
10800
10801
10802 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10803 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10804 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10805 @c
10806 @c @table @code
10807 @c @item verify
10808 @c @item noverify (default)
10809 @c @end table
10810
10811 @node Dump/Restore Files
10812 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10813 @cindex dump/restore files
10814 @cindex append data to a file
10815 @cindex dump data to a file
10816 @cindex restore data from a file
10817
10818 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10819 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10820 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10821 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10822 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10823 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10824 files.
10825
10826 @table @code
10827
10828 @kindex dump
10829 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10830 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10831 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10832 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10833
10834 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10835 @table @code
10836 @item binary
10837 Raw binary form.
10838 @item ihex
10839 Intel hex format.
10840 @item srec
10841 Motorola S-record format.
10842 @item tekhex
10843 Tektronix Hex format.
10844 @end table
10845
10846 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10847 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10848 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10849 form.
10850
10851 @kindex append
10852 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10853 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10854 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10855 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10856 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10857
10858 @kindex restore
10859 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10860 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10861 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10862 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10863 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10864
10865 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10866 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10867 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10868 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10869 from that location.
10870
10871 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10872 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10873 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10874 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10875
10876 @end table
10877
10878 @node Core File Generation
10879 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10880 @cindex dump core from inferior
10881
10882 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10883 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10884 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10885 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10886 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10887 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10888 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10889
10890 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10891 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10892 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @kindex gcore
10896 @kindex generate-core-file
10897 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10898 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10899 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10900 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10901 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10902 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10903
10904 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10905 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10906 @end table
10907
10908 @node Character Sets
10909 @section Character Sets
10910 @cindex character sets
10911 @cindex charset
10912 @cindex translating between character sets
10913 @cindex host character set
10914 @cindex target character set
10915
10916 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10917 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10918 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10919 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10920 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10921 @dfn{target character set}.
10922
10923 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10924 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10925 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10926 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10927 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10928 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10929 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10930 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10931 character and string literals in expressions.
10932
10933 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10934 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10935 target-charset} command, described below.
10936
10937 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10938 support:
10939
10940 @table @code
10941 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10942 @kindex set target-charset
10943 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10944 list of supported target character sets, type
10945 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10946
10947 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10948 @kindex set host-charset
10949 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10950
10951 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10952 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10953 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10954 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10955 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10956
10957 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10958 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10959 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10960
10961 @item set charset @var{charset}
10962 @kindex set charset
10963 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10964 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10965 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10966 for both host and target.
10967
10968 @item show charset
10969 @kindex show charset
10970 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10971
10972 @item show host-charset
10973 @kindex show host-charset
10974 Show the name of the current host character set.
10975
10976 @item show target-charset
10977 @kindex show target-charset
10978 Show the name of the current target character set.
10979
10980 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10981 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10982 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10983 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10984 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10985 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10986
10987 @item show target-wide-charset
10988 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10989 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10990 @end table
10991
10992 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10993 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10994 @file{charset-test.c}:
10995
10996 @smallexample
10997 #include <stdio.h>
10998
10999 char ascii_hello[]
11000 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11001 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11002 char ibm1047_hello[]
11003 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11004 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11005
11006 main ()
11007 @{
11008 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11009 @}
11010 @end smallexample
11011
11012 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11013 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11014 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11015
11016 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11017
11018 @smallexample
11019 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11020 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11021 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11022 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11023 @dots{}
11024 (@value{GDBP})
11025 @end smallexample
11026
11027 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11028 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11029 strings:
11030
11031 @smallexample
11032 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11033 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11034 (@value{GDBP})
11035 @end smallexample
11036
11037 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11038 initial character set:
11039 @smallexample
11040 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11041 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11042 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11043 (@value{GDBP})
11044 @end smallexample
11045
11046 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11047 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11048 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11049 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11050 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11051
11052 @smallexample
11053 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11054 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11055 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11056 $2 = 72 'H'
11057 (@value{GDBP})
11058 @end smallexample
11059
11060 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11061 literals you use in expressions:
11062
11063 @smallexample
11064 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11065 $3 = 43 '+'
11066 (@value{GDBP})
11067 @end smallexample
11068
11069 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11070 character.
11071
11072 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11073 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11074 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11075
11076 @smallexample
11077 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11078 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11079 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11080 $5 = 200 '\310'
11081 (@value{GDBP})
11082 @end smallexample
11083
11084 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11085 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11086
11087 @smallexample
11088 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11089 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11090 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11091 @end smallexample
11092
11093 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11094 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11095 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11096 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11097 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11098
11099 @smallexample
11100 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11101 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11102 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11103 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11104 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11105 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11106 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11107 $7 = 72 '\110'
11108 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11109 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11110 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11111 $9 = 200 'H'
11112 (@value{GDBP})
11113 @end smallexample
11114
11115 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11116 string literals you use in expressions:
11117
11118 @smallexample
11119 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11120 $10 = 78 '+'
11121 (@value{GDBP})
11122 @end smallexample
11123
11124 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11125 character.
11126
11127 @node Caching Target Data
11128 @section Caching Data of Targets
11129 @cindex caching data of targets
11130
11131 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11132 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11133 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11134 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11135 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11136 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11137 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11138 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11139 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11140 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11141 is executing.
11142 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11143 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11144 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11145 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11146 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11147 in the code segment.
11148 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11149 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11150
11151 @table @code
11152 @kindex set remotecache
11153 @item set remotecache on
11154 @itemx set remotecache off
11155 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11156 with old scripts.
11157
11158 @kindex show remotecache
11159 @item show remotecache
11160 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11161
11162 @kindex set stack-cache
11163 @item set stack-cache on
11164 @itemx set stack-cache off
11165 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11166 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11167
11168 @kindex show stack-cache
11169 @item show stack-cache
11170 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11171
11172 @kindex set code-cache
11173 @item set code-cache on
11174 @itemx set code-cache off
11175 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11176 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11177 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11178
11179 @kindex show code-cache
11180 @item show code-cache
11181 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11182 accesses.
11183
11184 @kindex info dcache
11185 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11186 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11187 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11188 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11189 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11190 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11191
11192 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11193 printed in hex.
11194
11195 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11196 @cindex dcache size
11197 @kindex set dcache size
11198 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11199
11200 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11201 @cindex dcache line-size
11202 @kindex set dcache line-size
11203 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11204 Must be a power of 2.
11205
11206 @item show dcache size
11207 @kindex show dcache size
11208 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11209
11210 @item show dcache line-size
11211 @kindex show dcache line-size
11212 Show default size of dcache lines.
11213
11214 @end table
11215
11216 @node Searching Memory
11217 @section Search Memory
11218 @cindex searching memory
11219
11220 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11221 @code{find} command.
11222
11223 @table @code
11224 @kindex find
11225 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11226 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11227 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11228 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11229 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11230 @end table
11231
11232 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11233 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11234
11235 @table @r
11236 @item @var{s}, search query size
11237 The size of each search query value.
11238
11239 @table @code
11240 @item b
11241 bytes
11242 @item h
11243 halfwords (two bytes)
11244 @item w
11245 words (four bytes)
11246 @item g
11247 giant words (eight bytes)
11248 @end table
11249
11250 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11251 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11252 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11253
11254 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11255 value's type in the current language.
11256 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11257 pattern as a mixture of types.
11258 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11259 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11260 which is typically four bytes.
11261
11262 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11263 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11264 @end table
11265
11266 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11267 (@code{"}).
11268 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11269 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11270
11271 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11272 number of matches found.
11273
11274 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11275 @samp{$_}.
11276 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11277
11278 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11279
11280 @smallexample
11281 void
11282 hello ()
11283 @{
11284 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11285 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11286 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11287 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11288 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11289 @}
11290 @end smallexample
11291
11292 @noindent
11293 you get during debugging:
11294
11295 @smallexample
11296 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11297 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11298 1 pattern found
11299 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11300 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11301 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11302 2 patterns found
11303 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11304 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11305 1 pattern found
11306 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11307 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11308 1 pattern found
11309 (gdb) print $numfound
11310 $1 = 1
11311 (gdb) print $_
11312 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11313 @end smallexample
11314
11315 @node Optimized Code
11316 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11317 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11318 @cindex debugging optimized code
11319
11320 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11321 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11322 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11323 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11324 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11325 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11326 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11327
11328 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11329 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11330 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11331 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11332
11333 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11334 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11335 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11336 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11337 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11338 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11339
11340 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11341 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11342 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11343 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11344 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11345
11346 @menu
11347 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11348 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11349 @end menu
11350
11351 @node Inline Functions
11352 @section Inline Functions
11353 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11354
11355 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11356 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11357 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11358 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11359 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11360 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11361 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11362 @code{info frame} command.
11363
11364 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11365 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11366 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11367 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11368 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11369 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11370 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11371 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11372 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11373 local variables in the caller.
11374
11375 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11376 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11377 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11378 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11379 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11380 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11381 instructions are executed.
11382
11383 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11384 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11385 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11386 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11387
11388 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11389 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11390
11391 @itemize @bullet
11392 @item
11393 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11394 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11395 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11396 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11397 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11398 or inside the inlined function instead.
11399
11400 @item
11401 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11402 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11403 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11404 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11405
11406 @end itemize
11407
11408 @node Tail Call Frames
11409 @section Tail Call Frames
11410 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11411
11412 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11413 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11414 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11415 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11416 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11417
11418 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11419 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11420 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11421 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11422 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11423 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11424 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11425
11426 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11427 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11428 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11429 this information.
11430
11431 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11432 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11433
11434 @smallexample
11435 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11436 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11437 (gdb) info frame
11438 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11439 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11440 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11441 source language c++.
11442 Arglist at unknown address.
11443 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11444 @end smallexample
11445
11446 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11447 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11448 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11449 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11450 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11451 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11452
11453 @table @code
11454 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11455 @item set debug entry-values
11456 @kindex set debug entry-values
11457 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11458 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11459 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11460 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11461 result.
11462
11463 @item show debug entry-values
11464 @kindex show debug entry-values
11465 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11466 values at function entry and tail calls.
11467 @end table
11468
11469 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11470 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11471 reference by variable @code{x}):
11472
11473 @smallexample
11474 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11475 void (*x) (void) = c;
11476 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11477 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11478 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11479
11480 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11481 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11482 a () at t.c:3
11483 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11484 (gdb) bt
11485 #0 a () at t.c:3
11486 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11487 @end smallexample
11488
11489 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11490
11491 @smallexample
11492 int i;
11493 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11494 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11495 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11496 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11497 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11498 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11499 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11500 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11501
11502 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11503 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11504 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11505 (gdb) bt
11506 #0 f () at t.c:2
11507 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11508 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11509 @end smallexample
11510
11511 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11512 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11513
11514 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11515 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11516 @set ARROW @click{}
11517 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11518 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11519 @end ifset
11520 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11521 @set ARROW ->
11522 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11523 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11524 @end ifclear
11525
11526 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11527 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11528 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11529
11530 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11531 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11532 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11533 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11534 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11535 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11536
11537 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11538 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11539 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11540 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11541 omitted.
11542
11543 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11544 entry may fail:
11545
11546 @smallexample
11547 int v;
11548 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11549 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11550 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11551 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11552 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11553 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11554
11555 (gdb) bt
11556 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11557 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11558 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11559 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11560 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11561 @end smallexample
11562
11563 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11564 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11565 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11566 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11567 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11568
11569 @node Macros
11570 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11571
11572 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11573 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11574 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11575 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11576 where it was defined.
11577
11578 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11579 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11580 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11581 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11582
11583 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11584 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11585 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11586 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11587 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11588 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11589 see @ref{List}.
11590
11591 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11592 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11593 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11594
11595 @table @code
11596
11597 @kindex macro expand
11598 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11599 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11600 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11601 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11602 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11603 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11604 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11605 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11606 it can be any string of tokens.
11607
11608 @kindex macro exp1
11609 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11610 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11611 @cindex expand macro once
11612 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11613 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11614 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11615 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11616 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11617 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11618 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11619 can be any string of tokens.
11620
11621 @kindex info macro
11622 @cindex macro definition, showing
11623 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11624 @cindex macros, from debug info
11625 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11626 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11627 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11628 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11629 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11630 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11631
11632 @kindex info macros
11633 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11634 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11635 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11636 command-line where those definitions were established.
11637
11638 @kindex macro define
11639 @cindex user-defined macros
11640 @cindex defining macros interactively
11641 @cindex macros, user-defined
11642 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11643 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11644 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11645 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11646 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11647 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11648 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11649 @var{arglist}.
11650
11651 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11652 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11653 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11654 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11655 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11656
11657 @kindex macro undef
11658 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11659 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11660 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11661 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11662 in the program being debugged.
11663
11664 @kindex macro list
11665 @item macro list
11666 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11667 @end table
11668
11669 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11670 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11671 show our source files:
11672
11673 @smallexample
11674 $ cat sample.c
11675 #include <stdio.h>
11676 #include "sample.h"
11677
11678 #define M 42
11679 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11680
11681 main ()
11682 @{
11683 #define N 28
11684 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11685 #undef N
11686 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11687 #define N 1729
11688 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11689 @}
11690 $ cat sample.h
11691 #define Q <
11692 $
11693 @end smallexample
11694
11695 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11696 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11697 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11698 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11699 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11700 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11701 information.
11702
11703 @smallexample
11704 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11705 $
11706 @end smallexample
11707
11708 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11709
11710 @smallexample
11711 $ gdb -nw sample
11712 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11713 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11714 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11715 (@value{GDBP})
11716 @end smallexample
11717
11718 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11719 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11720 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11721
11722 @smallexample
11723 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11724 3
11725 4 #define M 42
11726 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11727 6
11728 7 main ()
11729 8 @{
11730 9 #define N 28
11731 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11732 11 #undef N
11733 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11734 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11735 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11736 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11737 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11738 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11739 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11740 #define Q <
11741 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11742 expands to: (42 + 1)
11743 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11744 expands to: once (M + 1)
11745 (@value{GDBP})
11746 @end smallexample
11747
11748 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11749 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11750 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11751 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11752
11753 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11754 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11755
11756 @smallexample
11757 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11758 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11759 (@value{GDBP}) run
11760 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11761
11762 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11763 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11764 (@value{GDBP})
11765 @end smallexample
11766
11767 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11768
11769 @smallexample
11770 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11771 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11772 #define N 28
11773 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11774 expands to: 28 < 42
11775 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11776 $1 = 1
11777 (@value{GDBP})
11778 @end smallexample
11779
11780 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11781 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11782 thereof) in force at each point:
11783
11784 @smallexample
11785 (@value{GDBP}) next
11786 Hello, world!
11787 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11788 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11789 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11790 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11791 (@value{GDBP}) next
11792 We're so creative.
11793 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11794 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11795 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11796 #define N 1729
11797 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11798 expands to: 1729 < 42
11799 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11800 $2 = 0
11801 (@value{GDBP})
11802 @end smallexample
11803
11804 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11805 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11806 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11807 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11808
11809 @smallexample
11810 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11811 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11812 -D__STDC__=1
11813 (@value{GDBP})
11814 @end smallexample
11815
11816
11817 @node Tracepoints
11818 @chapter Tracepoints
11819 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11820 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11821
11822 @cindex tracepoints
11823 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11824 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11825 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11826 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11827 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11828 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11829 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11830
11831 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11832 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11833 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11834 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11835 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11836 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11837 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11838 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11839 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11840 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11841 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11842
11843 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11844 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11845 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11846 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11847 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11848 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11849 Packets}.
11850
11851 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11852 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11853 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11854
11855 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11856
11857 @menu
11858 * Set Tracepoints::
11859 * Analyze Collected Data::
11860 * Tracepoint Variables::
11861 * Trace Files::
11862 @end menu
11863
11864 @node Set Tracepoints
11865 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11866
11867 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11868 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11869 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11870 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11871 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11872 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11873 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11874
11875 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11876 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11877 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11878 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11879 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11880 tracepoint was hit.
11881
11882 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11883 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11884 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11885 either.
11886
11887 @cindex fast tracepoints
11888 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11889 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11890 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11891
11892 @cindex static tracepoints
11893 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11894 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11895 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11896 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11897 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11898 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11899 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11900 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11901 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11902 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11903 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11904 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11905 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11906 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11907 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11908 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11909 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11910 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11911 static tracepoint marker.
11912
11913 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11914 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11915
11916 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11917 conditions and actions.
11918
11919 @menu
11920 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11921 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11922 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11923 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11924 * Trace State Variables::
11925 * Tracepoint Actions::
11926 * Listing Tracepoints::
11927 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11928 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11929 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11930 @end menu
11931
11932 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11933 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11934
11935 @table @code
11936 @cindex set tracepoint
11937 @kindex trace
11938 @item trace @var{location}
11939 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11940 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11941 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11942 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11943 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11944 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11945 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11946 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11947 in tracing}).
11948 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11949 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11950 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11951 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11952 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11953 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11954 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11955 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11956 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11957 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11958 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11959 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11960
11961 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11962
11963 @smallexample
11964 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11965
11966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11967
11968 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11969
11970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11971
11972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11973 @end smallexample
11974
11975 @noindent
11976 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11977
11978 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11979 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11980 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11981 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11982 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11983 information on tracepoint conditions.
11984
11985 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11986 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11987 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11988 @kindex ftrace
11989 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11990 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11991 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11992 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11993 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11994 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11995 message.
11996
11997 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11998 @code{trace}.
11999
12000 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12001 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12002 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12003 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12004 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12005 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12006 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12007 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12008
12009 @example
12010 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12011 @end example
12012
12013 @noindent
12014 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12015 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12016
12017 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12018 @cindex set static tracepoint
12019 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12020 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12021 @kindex strace
12022 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12023 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12024 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12025 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12026 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12027
12028 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12029 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12030 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12031 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12032 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12033 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12034 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12035 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12036 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12037 tracing engine:
12038
12039 @smallexample
12040 main ()
12041 @{
12042 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12043 @}
12044 @end smallexample
12045
12046 @noindent
12047 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12048 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12049
12050 @smallexample
12051 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12052 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12053 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12054 Data: "str %s"
12055 [etc...]
12056 @end smallexample
12057
12058 @noindent
12059 so you may probe the marker above with:
12060
12061 @smallexample
12062 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12063 @end smallexample
12064
12065 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12066 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12067 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12068 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12069 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12070 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12071 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12072 the @samp{Data:} field.
12073
12074 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12075 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12076 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12077
12078 @vindex $tpnum
12079 @cindex last tracepoint number
12080 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12081 @cindex tracepoint number
12082 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12083 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12084
12085 @kindex delete tracepoint
12086 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12087 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12088 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12089 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12090 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12091
12092 Examples:
12093
12094 @smallexample
12095 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12096
12097 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12098 @end smallexample
12099
12100 @noindent
12101 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12102 @end table
12103
12104 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12105 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12106
12107 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12108
12109 @table @code
12110 @kindex disable tracepoint
12111 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12112 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12113 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12114 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12115 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12116 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12117 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12118 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12119 next trace experiment.
12120
12121 @kindex enable tracepoint
12122 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12123 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12124 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12125 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12126 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12127 next time a trace experiment is run.
12128 @end table
12129
12130 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12131 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12132
12133 @table @code
12134 @kindex passcount
12135 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12136 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12137 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12138 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12139 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12140 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12141 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12142 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12143 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12144 user.
12145
12146 Examples:
12147
12148 @smallexample
12149 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12150 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12151
12152 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12153 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12154 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12155 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12156 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12160 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12161 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12162 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12163 @end smallexample
12164 @end table
12165
12166 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12167 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12168 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12169 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12170
12171 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12172 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12173 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12174 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12175 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12176 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12177 is true.
12178
12179 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12180 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12181 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12182 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12183 just as with breakpoints.
12184
12185 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12186 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12187 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12188 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12189 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12190 accesses, and so forth.
12191
12192 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12193 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12194 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12195 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12196 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12197 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12198 search through.
12199
12200 @smallexample
12201 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12202 @end smallexample
12203
12204 @node Trace State Variables
12205 @subsection Trace State Variables
12206 @cindex trace state variables
12207
12208 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12209 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12210 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12211 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12212 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12213 integers.
12214
12215 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12216 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12217 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12218 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12219
12220 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12221 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12222 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12223 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12224 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12225 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12226 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12227 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12228 variable with the same name.
12229
12230 @table @code
12231
12232 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12233 @kindex tvariable
12234 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12235 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12236 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12237 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12238 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12239 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12240 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12241 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12242 value. The default initial value is 0.
12243
12244 @item info tvariables
12245 @kindex info tvariables
12246 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12247 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12248 currently running.
12249
12250 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12251 @kindex delete tvariable
12252 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12253 are specified.
12254
12255 @end table
12256
12257 @node Tracepoint Actions
12258 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12259
12260 @table @code
12261 @kindex actions
12262 @cindex tracepoint actions
12263 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12264 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12265 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12266 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12267 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12268 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12269 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12270 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12271 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12272 @code{while-stepping}.
12273
12274 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12275 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12276 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12277
12278 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12279 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12280 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12281
12282 @smallexample
12283 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12284
12285 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12286
12287 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12288 @end smallexample
12289
12290 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12291 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12292 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12293 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12294 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12295 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12296 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12297 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12298
12299 @smallexample
12300 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12302 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12303 > collect bar,baz
12304 > collect $regs
12305 > while-stepping 12
12306 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12307 > end
12308 end
12309 @end smallexample
12310
12311 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12312 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12313 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12314 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12315 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12316 special arguments are supported:
12317
12318 @table @code
12319 @item $regs
12320 Collect all registers.
12321
12322 @item $args
12323 Collect all function arguments.
12324
12325 @item $locals
12326 Collect all local variables.
12327
12328 @item $_ret
12329 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12330 of a backtrace.
12331
12332 @item $_probe_argc
12333 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12334 tracepoint is located.
12335 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12336
12337 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12338 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12339 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12340 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12341
12342 @item $_sdata
12343 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12344 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12345 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12346 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12347 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12348 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12349 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12350 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12351 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12352
12353 @smallexample
12354 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12355 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12356 @end smallexample
12357
12358 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12359 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12360 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12361 @value{GDBN}.
12362 @end table
12363
12364 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12365 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12366 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12367
12368 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12369 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12370 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12371 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12372 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12373 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12374 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12375 @samp{mystr}.
12376
12377 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12378 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12379
12380 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12381 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12382 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12383 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12384 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12385 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12386 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12387 action were used.
12388
12389 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12390 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12391 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12392 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12393 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12394 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12395
12396 @smallexample
12397 > while-stepping 12
12398 > collect $regs, myglobal
12399 > end
12400 >
12401 @end smallexample
12402
12403 @noindent
12404 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12405 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12406 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12407 @code{stepping}.
12408
12409 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12410 @kindex set default-collect
12411 @cindex default collection action
12412 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12413 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12414 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12415 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12416 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12417 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12418
12419 @item show default-collect
12420 @kindex show default-collect
12421 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12422 tracepoint hit.
12423
12424 @end table
12425
12426 @node Listing Tracepoints
12427 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12428
12429 @table @code
12430 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12431 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12432 @cindex information about tracepoints
12433 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12434 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12435 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12436 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12437 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12438 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12439
12440 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12441 tracing:
12442
12443 @itemize @bullet
12444 @item
12445 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12446
12447 @item
12448 the state about installed on target of each location
12449 @end itemize
12450
12451 @smallexample
12452 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12453 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12454 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12455 while-stepping 20
12456 collect globfoo, $regs
12457 end
12458 collect globfoo2
12459 end
12460 pass count 1200
12461 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12462 collect $eip
12463 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12464 installed on target
12465 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12466 installed on target
12467 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12468 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12469 not installed on target
12470 (@value{GDBP})
12471 @end smallexample
12472
12473 @noindent
12474 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12475 @end table
12476
12477 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12478 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12479
12480 @table @code
12481 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12482 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12483 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12484 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12485 program.
12486
12487 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12488
12489 @table @emph
12490 @item Count
12491 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12492 stable identifier.
12493 @item ID
12494 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12495 @item Enabled or Disabled
12496 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12497 that are not enabled.
12498 @item Address
12499 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12500 @item What
12501 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12502 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12503 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12504 will be left blank.
12505 @end table
12506
12507 @noindent
12508 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12509
12510 @table @emph
12511 @item Data
12512 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12513 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12514 marker call.
12515 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12516 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12517 @end table
12518
12519 @smallexample
12520 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12521 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12522 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12523 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12524 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12525 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12526 Data: str %s
12527 (@value{GDBP})
12528 @end smallexample
12529 @end table
12530
12531 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12532 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12533
12534 @table @code
12535 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12536 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12537 @cindex collected data discarded
12538 @item tstart
12539 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12540 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12541 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12542 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12543 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12544 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12545 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12546 information, and so forth.
12547
12548 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12549 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12550 @item tstop
12551 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12552 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12553 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12554 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12555 needs to be stopped quickly.
12556
12557 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12558 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12559 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12560
12561 @kindex tstatus
12562 @cindex status of trace data collection
12563 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12564 @item tstatus
12565 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12566 collection.
12567 @end table
12568
12569 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12573 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12574 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12575 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12576 > while-stepping 11
12577 > collect $regs
12578 > end
12579 > end
12580 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12581 [time passes @dots{}]
12582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12583 @end smallexample
12584
12585 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12586 @cindex disconnected tracing
12587 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12588 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12589 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12590 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12591 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12592 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12593 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12594 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12595
12596 @table @code
12597 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12598 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12599 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12600 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12601 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12602 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12603 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12604 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12605
12606 @item show disconnected-tracing
12607 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12608 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12609
12610 @end table
12611
12612 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12613 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12614 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12615 it will continue after reconnection.
12616
12617 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12618 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12619 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12620 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12621 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12622 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12623 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12624 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12625 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12626 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12627
12628 @cindex circular trace buffer
12629 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12630 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12631 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12632 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12633 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12634 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12635 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12636 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12637 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12638 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12639 the next run.
12640
12641 @table @code
12642 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12643 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12644 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12645 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12646 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12647 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12648 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12649
12650 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12651 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12652 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12653 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12654 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12655 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12656
12657 @end table
12658
12659 @table @code
12660 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12661 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12662 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12663 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12664 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12665 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12666 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12667 likes. This is also the default.
12668
12669 @item show trace-buffer-size
12670 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12671 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12672 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12673 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12674 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12675 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12676 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12677 @end table
12678
12679 @table @code
12680 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12681 @kindex set trace-user
12682
12683 @item show trace-user
12684 @kindex show trace-user
12685
12686 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12687 @kindex set trace-notes
12688 Set the trace run's notes.
12689
12690 @item show trace-notes
12691 @kindex show trace-notes
12692 Show the trace run's notes.
12693
12694 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12695 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12696 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12697 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12698 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12699
12700 @item show trace-stop-notes
12701 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12702 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12703
12704 @end table
12705
12706 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12707 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12708
12709 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12710 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12711 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12712 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12713 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12714 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12715 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12716 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12717 mentioned here.
12718
12719 @itemize @bullet
12720
12721 @item
12722 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12723 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12724 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12725 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12726 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12727 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12728 cannot be collected either.
12729
12730 @item
12731 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12732 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12733 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12734 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12735 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12736 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12737 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12738 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12739 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12740 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12741
12742 @item
12743 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12744 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12745 in a misleading way.
12746
12747 @item
12748 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12749 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12750 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12751 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12752 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12753 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12754 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12755 by @code{ptr}.
12756
12757 @item
12758 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12759 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12760 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12761 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12762 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12763 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12764 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12765 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12766 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12767 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12768 invalid address.
12769
12770 @item
12771 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12772 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12773 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12774 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12775 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12776 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12777 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12778 it to zero.
12779
12780 @end itemize
12781
12782 @node Analyze Collected Data
12783 @section Using the Collected Data
12784
12785 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12786 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12787 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12788 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12789 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12790 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12791 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12792 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12793 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12794 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12795 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12796 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12797 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12798 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12799 the buffer will fail.
12800
12801 @menu
12802 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12803 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12804 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12805 @end menu
12806
12807 @node tfind
12808 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12809
12810 @kindex tfind
12811 @cindex select trace snapshot
12812 @cindex find trace snapshot
12813 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12814 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12815 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12816 snapshot is selected.
12817
12818 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12819
12820 @table @code
12821 @item tfind start
12822 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12823 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12824
12825 @item tfind none
12826 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12827
12828 @item tfind end
12829 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12830
12831 @item tfind
12832 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12833
12834 @item tfind -
12835 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12836 retracing earlier steps.
12837
12838 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12839 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12840 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12841 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12842 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12843
12844 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12845 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12846 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12847 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12848 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12849
12850 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12851 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12852 addresses (exclusive).
12853
12854 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12855 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12856 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12857
12858 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12859 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12860 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12861 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12862 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12863 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12864 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12865 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12866 @end table
12867
12868 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12869 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12870 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12871 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12872 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12873 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12874 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12875 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12876 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12877 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12878 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12879 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12880 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12881 tracepoint as the current one.
12882
12883 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12884 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12885 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12886 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12887 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12888
12889 @smallexample
12890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12892 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12893 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12894 > tfind
12895 > end
12896
12897 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12898 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12899 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12900 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12901 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12902 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12903 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12904 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12905 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12906 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12907 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12908 @end smallexample
12909
12910 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12911 the buffer:
12912
12913 @smallexample
12914 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12915 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12916 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12917 > tfind line
12918 > end
12919
12920 Frame 0, X = 1
12921 Frame 7, X = 2
12922 Frame 13, X = 255
12923 @end smallexample
12924
12925 @node tdump
12926 @subsection @code{tdump}
12927 @kindex tdump
12928 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12929 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12930
12931 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12932 the current trace snapshot.
12933
12934 @smallexample
12935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12936 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12937 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12938 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12939 > end
12940
12941 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12942
12943 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12944 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12945 at gdb_test.c:444
12946 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12947
12948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12949 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12950 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12951 d1 0x18 24
12952 d2 0x80 128
12953 d3 0x33 51
12954 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12955 d5 0x22 34
12956 d6 0xe0 224
12957 d7 0x380035 3670069
12958 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12959 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12960 a2 0x100 256
12961 a3 0x322000 3284992
12962 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12963 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12964 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12965 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12966 ps 0x0 0
12967 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12968 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12969 fpstatus 0x0 0
12970 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12971 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12972 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12973 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12974 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12975 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12976 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12977 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12978 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12979
12980 (@value{GDBP})
12981 @end smallexample
12982
12983 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12984 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12985 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12986 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12987
12988 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12989 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12990 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12991 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12992 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12993 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12994 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12995 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12996 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12997 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12998
12999 @node save tracepoints
13000 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13001 @kindex save tracepoints
13002 @kindex save-tracepoints
13003 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13004
13005 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13006 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13007 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13008 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13009 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13010 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13011
13012 @node Tracepoint Variables
13013 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13014 @cindex tracepoint variables
13015 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13016
13017 @table @code
13018 @vindex $trace_frame
13019 @item (int) $trace_frame
13020 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13021 snapshot is selected.
13022
13023 @vindex $tracepoint
13024 @item (int) $tracepoint
13025 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13026
13027 @vindex $trace_line
13028 @item (int) $trace_line
13029 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13030
13031 @vindex $trace_file
13032 @item (char []) $trace_file
13033 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13034
13035 @vindex $trace_func
13036 @item (char []) $trace_func
13037 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13038 @end table
13039
13040 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13041 use @code{output} instead.
13042
13043 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13044 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13045 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13046 which are managed by the target.
13047
13048 @smallexample
13049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13050
13051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13052 > output $trace_file
13053 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13054 > tfind
13055 > end
13056 @end smallexample
13057
13058 @node Trace Files
13059 @section Using Trace Files
13060 @cindex trace files
13061
13062 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13063 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13064 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13065 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13066 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13067
13068 @table @code
13069
13070 @kindex tsave
13071 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13072 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13073 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13074 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13075 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13076 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13077 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13078 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13079 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13080 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13081 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13082 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13083 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13084 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13085 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13086
13087 @kindex target tfile
13088 @kindex tfile
13089 @kindex target ctf
13090 @kindex ctf
13091 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13092 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13093 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13094 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13095 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13096 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13097 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13098 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13099 the host.
13100
13101 @smallexample
13102 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13103 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13104 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13105 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13106 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13107 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13108 i = 0
13109 a = 0
13110 b = 1 '\001'
13111 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13112 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13113 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13114 $1 = 1
13115 @end smallexample
13116
13117 @end table
13118
13119 @node Overlays
13120 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13121 @cindex overlays
13122
13123 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13124 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13125 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13126 use overlays.
13127
13128 @menu
13129 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13130 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13131 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13132 mapped by asking the inferior.
13133 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13134 @end menu
13135
13136 @node How Overlays Work
13137 @section How Overlays Work
13138 @cindex mapped overlays
13139 @cindex unmapped overlays
13140 @cindex load address, overlay's
13141 @cindex mapped address
13142 @cindex overlay area
13143
13144 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13145 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13146 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13147 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13148 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13149
13150 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13151 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13152 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13153 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13154 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13155 largest overlay as well.
13156
13157 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13158 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13159 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13160 there.
13161
13162 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13163 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13164 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13165
13166 @smallexample
13167 @group
13168 Data Instruction Larger
13169 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13170 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13171 | | | | | |
13172 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13173 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13174 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13175 | and heap | | | | | |
13176 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13177 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13178 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13179 | | | | | |
13180 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13181 address | | | | | |
13182 | overlay | <-' | | |
13183 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13184 | | <---. | | load address
13185 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13186 | | | |
13187 +-----------+ | |
13188 +-----------+
13189 | |
13190 +-----------+
13191
13192 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13193 @end group
13194 @end smallexample
13195
13196 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13197 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13198 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13199 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13200 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13201 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13202 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13203 program and the overlay area.
13204
13205 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13206 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13207 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13208 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13209 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13210 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13211 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13212
13213 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13214 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13215 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13216
13217 @itemize @bullet
13218
13219 @item
13220 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13221 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13222 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13223 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13224
13225 @item
13226 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13227 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13228 your program's performance.
13229
13230 @item
13231 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13232 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13233 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13234 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13235 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13236 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13237 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13238
13239 @item
13240 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13241 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13242 instruction and data spaces.
13243
13244 @end itemize
13245
13246 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13247 improved in many ways:
13248
13249 @itemize @bullet
13250
13251 @item
13252 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13253 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13254 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13255 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13256 area in the usual way.
13257
13258 @item
13259 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13260 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13261
13262 @item
13263 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13264 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13265 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13266 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13267 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13268 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13269 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13270
13271 @end itemize
13272
13273
13274 @node Overlay Commands
13275 @section Overlay Commands
13276
13277 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13278 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13279 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13280 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13281 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13282 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13283
13284 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13285 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13286
13287 @table @code
13288 @item overlay off
13289 @kindex overlay
13290 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13291 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13292 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13293 overlay support is disabled.
13294
13295 @item overlay manual
13296 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13297 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13298 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13299 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13300 commands described below.
13301
13302 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13303 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13304 @cindex map an overlay
13305 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13306 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13307 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13308 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13309 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13310 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13311
13312 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13313 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13314 @cindex unmap an overlay
13315 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13316 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13317 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13318 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13319
13320 @item overlay auto
13321 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13322 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13323 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13324 Overlay Debugging}.
13325
13326 @item overlay load-target
13327 @itemx overlay load
13328 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13329 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13330 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13331 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13332 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13333 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13334
13335 @item overlay list-overlays
13336 @itemx overlay list
13337 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13338 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13339 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13340
13341 @end table
13342
13343 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13344 of the function the address falls in:
13345
13346 @smallexample
13347 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13348 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13349 @end smallexample
13350 @noindent
13351 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13352 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13353 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13354 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13355
13356 @smallexample
13357 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13358 No sections are mapped.
13359 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13360 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13361 @end smallexample
13362 @noindent
13363 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13364 name normally:
13365
13366 @smallexample
13367 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13368 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13369 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13370 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13371 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13372 @end smallexample
13373
13374 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13375 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13376 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13377 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13378 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13379
13380 @itemize @bullet
13381 @item
13382 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13383 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13384 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13385 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13386 @item
13387 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13388 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13389 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13390 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13391 breakpoints properly.
13392 @end itemize
13393
13394
13395 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13396 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13397 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13398
13399 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13400 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13401 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13402 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13403 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13404 current state of the overlays.
13405
13406 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13407 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13408
13409 @table @asis
13410
13411 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13412 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13413
13414 @smallexample
13415 struct
13416 @{
13417 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13418 unsigned long vma;
13419
13420 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13421 unsigned long size;
13422
13423 /* The overlay's load address. */
13424 unsigned long lma;
13425
13426 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13427 zero otherwise. */
13428 unsigned long mapped;
13429 @}
13430 @end smallexample
13431
13432 @item @code{_novlys}:
13433 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13434 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13435
13436 @end table
13437
13438 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13439 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13440 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13441 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13442 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13443 currently mapped.
13444
13445 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13446 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13447 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13448 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13449 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13450 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13451 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13452 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13453 are not being executed.
13454
13455 @node Overlay Sample Program
13456 @section Overlay Sample Program
13457 @cindex overlay example program
13458
13459 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13460 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13461 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13462 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13463 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13464 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13465 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13466
13467 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13468 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13469 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13470 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13471
13472 @table @file
13473 @item overlays.c
13474 The main program file.
13475 @item ovlymgr.c
13476 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13477 @item foo.c
13478 @itemx bar.c
13479 @itemx baz.c
13480 @itemx grbx.c
13481 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13482 @item d10v.ld
13483 @itemx m32r.ld
13484 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13485 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13486 @end table
13487
13488 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13489 cross-compiler like this:
13490
13491 @smallexample
13492 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13493 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13494 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13495 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13496 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13497 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13498 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13499 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13500 @end smallexample
13501
13502 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13503 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13504 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13505
13506
13507 @node Languages
13508 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13509 @cindex languages
13510
13511 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13512 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13513 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13514 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13515 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13516 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13517
13518 @cindex working language
13519 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13520 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13521 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13522 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13523 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13524 language}.
13525
13526 @menu
13527 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13528 * Show:: Displaying the language
13529 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13530 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13531 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13532 @end menu
13533
13534 @node Setting
13535 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13536
13537 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13538 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13539 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13540 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13541 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13542 are printed, etc.
13543
13544 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13545 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13546 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13547 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13548 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13549 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13550 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13551 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13552 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13553 Displaying the Language}.
13554
13555 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13556 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13557 another language. In that case, make the
13558 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13559 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13560 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13561
13562 @menu
13563 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13564 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13565 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13566 @end menu
13567
13568 @node Filenames
13569 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13570
13571 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13572 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13573
13574 @table @file
13575 @item .ada
13576 @itemx .ads
13577 @itemx .adb
13578 @itemx .a
13579 Ada source file.
13580
13581 @item .c
13582 C source file
13583
13584 @item .C
13585 @itemx .cc
13586 @itemx .cp
13587 @itemx .cpp
13588 @itemx .cxx
13589 @itemx .c++
13590 C@t{++} source file
13591
13592 @item .d
13593 D source file
13594
13595 @item .m
13596 Objective-C source file
13597
13598 @item .f
13599 @itemx .F
13600 Fortran source file
13601
13602 @item .mod
13603 Modula-2 source file
13604
13605 @item .s
13606 @itemx .S
13607 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13608 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13609 @end table
13610
13611 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13612 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13613
13614 @node Manually
13615 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13616
13617 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13618 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13619 your program.
13620
13621 @kindex set language
13622 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13623 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13624 a language, such as
13625 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13626 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13627
13628 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13629 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13630 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13631 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13632 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13633 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13634 command such as:
13635
13636 @smallexample
13637 print a = b + c
13638 @end smallexample
13639
13640 @noindent
13641 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13642 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13643 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13644 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13645
13646 @node Automatically
13647 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13648
13649 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13650 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13651 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13652 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13653 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13654 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13655 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13656 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13657 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13658
13659 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13660 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13661 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13662 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13663 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13664
13665 @node Show
13666 @section Displaying the Language
13667
13668 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13669 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13670
13671 @table @code
13672 @item show language
13673 @anchor{show language}
13674 @kindex show language
13675 Display the current working language. This is the
13676 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13677 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13678
13679 @item info frame
13680 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13681 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13682 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13683 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13684 information listed here.
13685
13686 @item info source
13687 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13688 Display the source language of this source file.
13689 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13690 information listed here.
13691 @end table
13692
13693 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13694 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13695 with a language explicitly:
13696
13697 @table @code
13698 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13699 @kindex set extension-language
13700 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13701 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13702
13703 @item info extensions
13704 @kindex info extensions
13705 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13706 @end table
13707
13708 @node Checks
13709 @section Type and Range Checking
13710
13711 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13712 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13713 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13714 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13715 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13716 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13717 errors when your program is running.
13718
13719 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13720 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13721 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13722 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13723
13724 @menu
13725 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13726 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13727 @end menu
13728
13729 @cindex type checking
13730 @cindex checks, type
13731 @node Type Checking
13732 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13733
13734 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13735 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13736 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13737 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13738
13739 @smallexample
13740 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13741
13742 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13743 $1 = 2
13744 @exdent but
13745 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13746 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13747 @end smallexample
13748
13749 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13750 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13751
13752 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13753 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13754 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13755 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13756 expressions like the second example above.
13757
13758 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13759 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13760 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13761 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13762 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13763 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13764
13765 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13766
13767 @kindex set check type
13768 @kindex show check type
13769 @table @code
13770 @item set check type on
13771 @itemx set check type off
13772 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13773 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13774 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13775
13776 @item show check type
13777 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13778 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13779 @end table
13780
13781 @cindex range checking
13782 @cindex checks, range
13783 @node Range Checking
13784 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13785
13786 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13787 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13788 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13789 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13790 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13791
13792 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13793 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13794 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13795 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13796
13797 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13798 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13799 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13800 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13801 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13802 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13803
13804 @smallexample
13805 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13806 @end smallexample
13807
13808 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13809 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13810 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13811
13812 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13813
13814 @kindex set check range
13815 @kindex show check range
13816 @table @code
13817 @item set check range auto
13818 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13819 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13820 each language.
13821
13822 @item set check range on
13823 @itemx set check range off
13824 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13825 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13826 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13827 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13828
13829 @item set check range warn
13830 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13831 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13832 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13833 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13834 systems).
13835
13836 @item show range
13837 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13838 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13839 @end table
13840
13841 @node Supported Languages
13842 @section Supported Languages
13843
13844 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13845 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13846 @c This is false ...
13847 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13848 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13849 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13850 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13851 language.
13852
13853 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13854 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13855 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13856 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13857 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13858 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13859 language reference or tutorial.
13860
13861 @menu
13862 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13863 * D:: D
13864 * Go:: Go
13865 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13866 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13867 * Fortran:: Fortran
13868 * Pascal:: Pascal
13869 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13870 * Ada:: Ada
13871 @end menu
13872
13873 @node C
13874 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13875
13876 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13877 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13878
13879 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13880 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13881 together.
13882
13883 @cindex C@t{++}
13884 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13885 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13886 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13887 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13888 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13889 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13890 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13891
13892 @menu
13893 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13894 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13895 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13896 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13897 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13898 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13899 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13900 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13901 @end menu
13902
13903 @node C Operators
13904 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13905
13906 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13907
13908 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13909 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13910 often defined on groups of types.
13911
13912 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13913
13914 @itemize @bullet
13915
13916 @item
13917 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13918 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13919
13920 @item
13921 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13922 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13923
13924 @item
13925 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13926
13927 @item
13928 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13929
13930 @end itemize
13931
13932 @noindent
13933 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13934 in order of increasing precedence:
13935
13936 @table @code
13937 @item ,
13938 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13939 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13940 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13941
13942 @item =
13943 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13944 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13945
13946 @item @var{op}=
13947 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13948 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13949 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13950 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13951 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13952
13953 @item ?:
13954 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13955 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13956 should be of an integral type.
13957
13958 @item ||
13959 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13960
13961 @item &&
13962 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13963
13964 @item |
13965 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13966
13967 @item ^
13968 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13969
13970 @item &
13971 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13972
13973 @item ==@r{, }!=
13974 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13975 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13976
13977 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13978 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13979 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13980 and non-zero for true.
13981
13982 @item <<@r{, }>>
13983 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13984
13985 @item @@
13986 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13987
13988 @item +@r{, }-
13989 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13990 pointer types.
13991
13992 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13993 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13994 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13995 integral types.
13996
13997 @item ++@r{, }--
13998 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13999 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14000 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14001 operation takes place.
14002
14003 @item *
14004 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14005 @code{++}.
14006
14007 @item &
14008 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14009
14010 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14011 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14012 to examine the address
14013 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14014 stored.
14015
14016 @item -
14017 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14018 precedence as @code{++}.
14019
14020 @item !
14021 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14022 @code{++}.
14023
14024 @item ~
14025 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14026 @code{++}.
14027
14028
14029 @item .@r{, }->
14030 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14031 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14032 pointer based on the stored type information.
14033 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14034
14035 @item .*@r{, }->*
14036 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14037
14038 @item []
14039 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14040 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14041
14042 @item ()
14043 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14044
14045 @item ::
14046 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14047 and @code{class} types.
14048
14049 @item ::
14050 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14051 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14052 above.
14053 @end table
14054
14055 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14056 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14057 predefined meaning.
14058
14059 @node C Constants
14060 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14061
14062 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14063
14064 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14065 following ways:
14066
14067 @itemize @bullet
14068 @item
14069 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14070 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14071 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14072 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14073 @code{long} value.
14074
14075 @item
14076 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14077 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14078 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14079 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14080 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14081 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14082 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14083 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14084 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14085 constant.
14086
14087 @item
14088 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14089 integral equivalents.
14090
14091 @item
14092 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14093 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14094 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14095 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14096 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14097 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14098 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14099 @samp{\n} for newline.
14100
14101 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14102 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14103 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14104 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14105
14106 @item
14107 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14108 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14109 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14110 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14111 characters.
14112
14113 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14114 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14115 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14116
14117 @item
14118 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14119 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14120
14121 @item
14122 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14123 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14124 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14125 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14126 @end itemize
14127
14128 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14129 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14130
14131 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14132 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14133
14134 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14135 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14136 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14137 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14138 @quotation
14139 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14140 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14141 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14142 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14143 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14144 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14145 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14146 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14147 @end quotation
14148
14149 @enumerate
14150
14151 @cindex member functions
14152 @item
14153 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14154
14155 @smallexample
14156 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14157 @end smallexample
14158
14159 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14160 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14161 @item
14162 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14163 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14164 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14165 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14166 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14167
14168 @cindex call overloaded functions
14169 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14170 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14171 @item
14172 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14173 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14174 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14175 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14176 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14177 default arguments.
14178
14179 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14180 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14181 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14182 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14183 number of function arguments.
14184
14185 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14186 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14187 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14188
14189 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14190 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14191 @smallexample
14192 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14193 @end smallexample
14194
14195 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14196 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14197
14198 @cindex reference declarations
14199 @item
14200 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14201 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14202 dereferenced.
14203
14204 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14205 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14206 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14207 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14208 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14209
14210 @item
14211 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14212 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14213 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14214 necessary, for example in an expression like
14215 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14216 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14217 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14218
14219 @item
14220 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14221 specification.
14222 @end enumerate
14223
14224 @node C Defaults
14225 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14226
14227 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14228
14229 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14230 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14231 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14232 selects the working language.
14233
14234 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14235 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14236 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14237 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14238 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14239 for further details.
14240
14241 @node C Checks
14242 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14243
14244 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14245
14246 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14247 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14248 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14249 constants to pointers.
14250
14251 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14252 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14253 that is not itself an array.
14254
14255 @node Debugging C
14256 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14257
14258 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14259 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14260 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14261 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14262
14263 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14264 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14265 ,Expressions}.
14266
14267 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14268 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14269
14270 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14271
14272 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14273 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14274
14275 @table @code
14276 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14277 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14278 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14279 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14280 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14281 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14282
14283 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14284 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14285 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14286 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14287 classes.
14288 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14289
14290 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14291 @item catch throw
14292 @itemx catch rethrow
14293 @itemx catch catch
14294 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14295 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14296
14297 @cindex inheritance
14298 @item ptype @var{typename}
14299 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14300 @var{typename}.
14301 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14302
14303 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14304 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14305 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14306 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14307 multiple inheritance is in use.
14308
14309 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14310 @item demangle @var{name}
14311 Demangle @var{name}.
14312 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14313
14314 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14315 @item set print demangle
14316 @itemx show print demangle
14317 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14318 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14319 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14320 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14321 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14322
14323 @item set print object
14324 @itemx show print object
14325 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14326 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14327
14328 @item set print vtbl
14329 @itemx show print vtbl
14330 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14331 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14332 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14333 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14334
14335 @kindex set overload-resolution
14336 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14337 @item set overload-resolution on
14338 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14339 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14340 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14341 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14342 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14343 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14344
14345 @item set overload-resolution off
14346 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14347 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14348 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14349 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14350 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14351 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14352 argument types.
14353
14354 @kindex show overload-resolution
14355 @item show overload-resolution
14356 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14357
14358 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14359 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14360 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14361 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14362 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14363 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14364 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14365 @end table
14366
14367 @node Decimal Floating Point
14368 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14369 @cindex decimal floating point format
14370
14371 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14372 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14373 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14374 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14375
14376 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14377 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14378 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14379 configured target.
14380
14381 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14382 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14383 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14384
14385 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14386 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14387 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14388
14389 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14390 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14391 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14392
14393 @node D
14394 @subsection D
14395
14396 @cindex D
14397 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14398 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14399 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14400
14401 @node Go
14402 @subsection Go
14403
14404 @cindex Go (programming language)
14405 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14406 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14407
14408 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14409
14410 @table @code
14411 @cindex current Go package
14412 @item The current Go package
14413 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14414 specifying global variables and functions.
14415
14416 For example, given the program:
14417
14418 @example
14419 package main
14420 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14421 func main () @{
14422 // ...
14423 @}
14424 @end example
14425
14426 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14427
14428 @example
14429 (gdb) p myglob
14430 (gdb) p main.myglob
14431 @end example
14432
14433 @cindex builtin Go types
14434 @item Builtin Go types
14435 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14436 as a string.
14437
14438 @cindex builtin Go functions
14439 @item Builtin Go functions
14440 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14441 function and handles it internally.
14442
14443 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14444 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14445 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14446 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14447 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14448 @end table
14449
14450 @node Objective-C
14451 @subsection Objective-C
14452
14453 @cindex Objective-C
14454 This section provides information about some commands and command
14455 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14456 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14457 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14458
14459 @menu
14460 * Method Names in Commands::
14461 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14462 @end menu
14463
14464 @node Method Names in Commands
14465 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14466
14467 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14468 names as line specifications:
14469
14470 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14471 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14472 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14473 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14474 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14475 @itemize
14476 @item @code{clear}
14477 @item @code{break}
14478 @item @code{info line}
14479 @item @code{jump}
14480 @item @code{list}
14481 @end itemize
14482
14483 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14484
14485 @smallexample
14486 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14487 @end smallexample
14488
14489 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14490 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14491 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14492 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14493 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14494 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14495 debugged, enter:
14496
14497 @smallexample
14498 break -[Fruit create]
14499 @end smallexample
14500
14501 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14502 enter:
14503
14504 @smallexample
14505 list +[NSText initialize]
14506 @end smallexample
14507
14508 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14509 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14510 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14511 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14512
14513 @smallexample
14514 break create
14515 @end smallexample
14516
14517 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14518 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14519 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14520 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14521 none apply.
14522
14523 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14524 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14525
14526 @smallexample
14527 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14528 @end smallexample
14529
14530 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14531 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14532 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14533 @kindex print-object
14534 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14535
14536 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14537
14538 @smallexample
14539 print -[@var{object} hash]
14540 @end smallexample
14541
14542 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14543 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14544 @noindent
14545 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14546 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14547 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14548 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14549 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14550 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14551
14552 @node OpenCL C
14553 @subsection OpenCL C
14554
14555 @cindex OpenCL C
14556 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14557
14558 @menu
14559 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14560 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14561 * OpenCL C Operators::
14562 @end menu
14563
14564 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14565 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14566
14567 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14568 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14569 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14570 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14571 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14572
14573 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14574 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14575
14576 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14577 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14578 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14579 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14580
14581 @node OpenCL C Operators
14582 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14583
14584 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14585 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14586 vector data types.
14587
14588 @node Fortran
14589 @subsection Fortran
14590 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14591
14592 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14593 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14594
14595 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14596 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14597 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14598 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14599 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14600 underscore.
14601
14602 @menu
14603 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14604 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14605 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14606 @end menu
14607
14608 @node Fortran Operators
14609 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14610
14611 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14612
14613 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14614 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14615 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14616
14617 @table @code
14618 @item **
14619 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14620 of the second one.
14621
14622 @item :
14623 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14624 represent a section of array.
14625
14626 @item %
14627 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14628 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14629 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14630 union type.
14631 @end table
14632
14633 @node Fortran Defaults
14634 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14635
14636 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14637
14638 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14639 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14640 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14641 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14642
14643 @node Special Fortran Commands
14644 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14645
14646 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14647
14648 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14649 such as displaying common blocks.
14650
14651 @table @code
14652 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14653 @kindex info common
14654 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14655 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14656 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14657 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14658 printed.
14659 @end table
14660
14661 @node Pascal
14662 @subsection Pascal
14663
14664 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14665 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14666 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14667 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14668 syntax.
14669
14670 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14671 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14672 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14673
14674 @node Modula-2
14675 @subsection Modula-2
14676
14677 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14678
14679 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14680 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14681 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14682 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14683 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14684 table.
14685
14686 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14687 @menu
14688 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14689 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14690 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14691 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14692 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14693 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14694 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14695 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14696 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14697 @end menu
14698
14699 @node M2 Operators
14700 @subsubsection Operators
14701 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14702
14703 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14704 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14705 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14706 following definitions hold:
14707
14708 @itemize @bullet
14709
14710 @item
14711 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14712 their subranges.
14713
14714 @item
14715 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14716
14717 @item
14718 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14719
14720 @item
14721 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14722 @var{type}}.
14723
14724 @item
14725 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14726
14727 @item
14728 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14729
14730 @item
14731 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14732 @end itemize
14733
14734 @noindent
14735 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14736 increasing precedence:
14737
14738 @table @code
14739 @item ,
14740 Function argument or array index separator.
14741
14742 @item :=
14743 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14744 @var{value}.
14745
14746 @item <@r{, }>
14747 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14748 types.
14749
14750 @item <=@r{, }>=
14751 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14752 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14753 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14754
14755 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14756 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14757 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14758 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14759 comment character.
14760
14761 @item IN
14762 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14763 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14764
14765 @item OR
14766 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14767
14768 @item AND@r{, }&
14769 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14770
14771 @item @@
14772 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14773
14774 @item +@r{, }-
14775 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14776 and difference on set types.
14777
14778 @item *
14779 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14780 on set types.
14781
14782 @item /
14783 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14784 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14785
14786 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14787 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14788 precedence as @code{*}.
14789
14790 @item -
14791 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14792
14793 @item ^
14794 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14795
14796 @item NOT
14797 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14798 @code{^}.
14799
14800 @item .
14801 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14802 precedence as @code{^}.
14803
14804 @item []
14805 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14806
14807 @item ()
14808 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14809 as @code{^}.
14810
14811 @item ::@r{, }.
14812 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14813 @end table
14814
14815 @quotation
14816 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14817 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14818 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14819 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14820 @end quotation
14821
14822
14823 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14824 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14825 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14826
14827 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14828 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14829
14830 @table @var
14831
14832 @item a
14833 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14834
14835 @item c
14836 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14837
14838 @item i
14839 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14840
14841 @item m
14842 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14843 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14844 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14845
14846 @item n
14847 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14848
14849 @item r
14850 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14851
14852 @item t
14853 represents a type.
14854
14855 @item v
14856 represents a variable.
14857
14858 @item x
14859 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14860 explanation of the function for details.
14861 @end table
14862
14863 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14864
14865 @table @code
14866 @item ABS(@var{n})
14867 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14868
14869 @item CAP(@var{c})
14870 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14871 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14872
14873 @item CHR(@var{i})
14874 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14875
14876 @item DEC(@var{v})
14877 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14878
14879 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14880 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14881 new value.
14882
14883 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14884 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14885 set.
14886
14887 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14888 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14889
14890 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14891 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14892
14893 @item INC(@var{v})
14894 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14895
14896 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14897 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14898 new value.
14899
14900 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14901 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14902 there. Returns the new set.
14903
14904 @item MAX(@var{t})
14905 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14906
14907 @item MIN(@var{t})
14908 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14909
14910 @item ODD(@var{i})
14911 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14912
14913 @item ORD(@var{x})
14914 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14915 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14916 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14917 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14918
14919 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14920 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14921 variable or a type.
14922
14923 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14924 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14925
14926 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14927 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14928 variable or a type.
14929
14930 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14931 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14932 @end table
14933
14934 @quotation
14935 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14936 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14937 an error.
14938 @end quotation
14939
14940 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14941 @node M2 Constants
14942 @subsubsection Constants
14943
14944 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14945 ways:
14946
14947 @itemize @bullet
14948
14949 @item
14950 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14951 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14952 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14953 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14954
14955 @item
14956 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14957 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14958 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14959 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14960 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14961 digits.
14962
14963 @item
14964 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14965 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14966 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14967 followed by a @samp{C}.
14968
14969 @item
14970 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14971 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14972 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14973 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14974 sequences.
14975
14976 @item
14977 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14978
14979 @item
14980 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14981 @code{FALSE}.
14982
14983 @item
14984 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14985
14986 @item
14987 Set constants are not yet supported.
14988 @end itemize
14989
14990 @node M2 Types
14991 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14992 @cindex Modula-2 types
14993
14994 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14995 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14996 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14997 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14998 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14999 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15000
15001 The first example contains the following section of code:
15002
15003 @smallexample
15004 VAR
15005 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15006 r: [20..40] ;
15007 @end smallexample
15008
15009 @noindent
15010 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15011 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15012
15013 @smallexample
15014 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15015 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15016 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15017 SET OF CHAR
15018 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15019 21
15020 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15021 [20..40]
15022 @end smallexample
15023
15024 @noindent
15025 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15026
15027 @smallexample
15028 VAR
15029 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15030 @end smallexample
15031
15032 @noindent
15033 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15034
15035 @smallexample
15036 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15037 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15038 @end smallexample
15039
15040 @noindent
15041 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15042 expressions using the debugger.
15043
15044 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15045 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15046
15047 @smallexample
15048 VAR
15049 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15050 @end smallexample
15051
15052 @smallexample
15053 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15054 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15055 @end smallexample
15056
15057 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15058 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15059 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15060 above.
15061
15062 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15063
15064 @smallexample
15065 TYPE
15066 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15067 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15068 VAR
15069 s: t ;
15070 BEGIN
15071 s := blue ;
15072 @end smallexample
15073
15074 @noindent
15075 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15076 and value of a variable.
15077
15078 @smallexample
15079 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15080 $1 = blue
15081 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15082 type = [blue..yellow]
15083 @end smallexample
15084
15085 @noindent
15086 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15087 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15088 their @code{C} counterparts.
15089
15090 @smallexample
15091 VAR
15092 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15093 BEGIN
15094 s[1] := 1 ;
15095 @end smallexample
15096
15097 @smallexample
15098 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15099 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15101 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15102 @end smallexample
15103
15104 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15105 pointer types as shown in this example:
15106
15107 @smallexample
15108 VAR
15109 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15110 BEGIN
15111 NEW(s) ;
15112 s^[1] := 1 ;
15113 @end smallexample
15114
15115 @noindent
15116 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15117
15118 @smallexample
15119 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15120 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15121 @end smallexample
15122
15123 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15124 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15125 types:
15126
15127 @smallexample
15128 TYPE
15129 foo = RECORD
15130 f1: CARDINAL ;
15131 f2: CHAR ;
15132 f3: myarray ;
15133 END ;
15134
15135 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15136 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15137 VAR
15138 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15139 @end smallexample
15140
15141 @noindent
15142 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15143 below.
15144
15145 @smallexample
15146 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15147 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15148 f1 : CARDINAL;
15149 f2 : CHAR;
15150 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15151 END
15152 @end smallexample
15153
15154 @node M2 Defaults
15155 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15156 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15157
15158 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15159 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15160 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15161 selected the working language.
15162
15163 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15164 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15165 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15166 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15167
15168 @node Deviations
15169 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15170 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15171
15172 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15173 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15174
15175 @itemize @bullet
15176 @item
15177 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15178 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15179 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15180 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15181 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15182 returned a pointer.)
15183
15184 @item
15185 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15186 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15187 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15188 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15189
15190 @item
15191 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15192 argument.
15193
15194 @item
15195 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15196 @end itemize
15197
15198 @node M2 Checks
15199 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15200 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15201
15202 @quotation
15203 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15204 range checking.
15205 @end quotation
15206 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15207
15208 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15209
15210 @itemize @bullet
15211 @item
15212 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15213 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15214
15215 @item
15216 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15217 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15218 @end itemize
15219
15220 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15221 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15222
15223 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15224 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15225
15226 @node M2 Scope
15227 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15228 @cindex scope
15229 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15230 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15231 @ifinfo
15232 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15233 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15234 @end ifinfo
15235 @ifnotinfo
15236 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15237 @end ifnotinfo
15238
15239 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15240 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15241 similar syntax:
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244
15245 @var{module} . @var{id}
15246 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15247 @end smallexample
15248
15249 @noindent
15250 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15251 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15252 identifier within your program, except another module.
15253
15254 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15255 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15256 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15257 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15258
15259 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15260 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15261 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15262 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15263 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15264 @var{module}.
15265
15266 @node GDB/M2
15267 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15268
15269 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15270 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15271 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15272 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15273 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15274 analogue in Modula-2.
15275
15276 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15277 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15278 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15279 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15280 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15281 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15282
15283 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15284 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15285 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15286
15287 @node Ada
15288 @subsection Ada
15289 @cindex Ada
15290
15291 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15292 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15293 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15294 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15295 to be difficult.
15296
15297
15298 @cindex expressions in Ada
15299 @menu
15300 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15301 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15302 in @value{GDBN}.
15303 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15304 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15305 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15306 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15307 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15308 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15309 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15310 Profile
15311 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15312 @end menu
15313
15314 @node Ada Mode Intro
15315 @subsubsection Introduction
15316 @cindex Ada mode, general
15317
15318 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15319 syntax, with some extensions.
15320 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15321
15322 @itemize @bullet
15323 @item
15324 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15325 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15326 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15327 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15328
15329 @item
15330 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15331 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15332
15333 @item
15334 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15335 @end itemize
15336
15337 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15338 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15339 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15340 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15341 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15342
15343 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15344 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15345 was translated from an Ada source file.
15346
15347 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15348 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15349 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15350 middle (to allow based literals).
15351
15352 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15353 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15354 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15355 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15356 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15357 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15358
15359 @node Omissions from Ada
15360 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15361 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15362
15363 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15364
15365 @itemize @bullet
15366 @item
15367 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15368
15369 @itemize @minus
15370 @item
15371 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15372 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15373
15374 @item
15375 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15376
15377 @item
15378 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15379
15380 @item
15381 @t{'Tag}.
15382
15383 @item
15384 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15385 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15386
15387 @item
15388 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15389 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15390
15391 @item
15392 @t{'Address}.
15393 @end itemize
15394
15395 @item
15396 The names in
15397 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15398 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15399 not currently available.
15400
15401 @item
15402 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15403 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15404 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15405 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15406 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15407 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15408 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15409 indeterminate values.
15410
15411 @item
15412 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15413 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15414 are not implemented.
15415
15416 @item
15417 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15418 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15419 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15420 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15421 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15422
15423 @smallexample
15424 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15425 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15426 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15427 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15428 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15429 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15430 @end smallexample
15431
15432 Changing a
15433 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15434 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15435 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15436 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15437 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15438 declared to have a type such as:
15439
15440 @smallexample
15441 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15442 Id : Integer;
15443 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15444 end record;
15445 @end smallexample
15446
15447 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15448 assignments:
15449
15450 @smallexample
15451 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15452 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15453 @end smallexample
15454
15455 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15456 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15457 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15458 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15459 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15460 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15461 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15462 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15463
15464 @item
15465 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15466
15467 @item
15468 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15469 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15470 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15471 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15472 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15473 the proper resolution.
15474
15475 @item
15476 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15477
15478 @item
15479 Entry calls are not implemented.
15480
15481 @item
15482 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15483 formats are not supported.
15484
15485 @item
15486 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15487
15488 @item
15489 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15490 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15491 context.
15492 Should your program
15493 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15494 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15495 @end itemize
15496
15497 @node Additions to Ada
15498 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15499 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15500
15501 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15502 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15503
15504 @itemize @bullet
15505 @item
15506 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15507 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15508 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15509 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15510 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15511 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15512 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15513 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15514
15515 @item
15516 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15517 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15518 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15519
15520 @item
15521 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15522 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15523
15524 @item
15525 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15526 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15527 @end itemize
15528
15529 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15530 additions specific to Ada:
15531
15532 @itemize @bullet
15533 @item
15534 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15535 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15536
15537 @smallexample
15538 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15539 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15540 @end smallexample
15541
15542 @item
15543 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15544 the value of its right-hand operand.
15545 This allows, for example,
15546 complex conditional breaks:
15547
15548 @smallexample
15549 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15550 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15551 @end smallexample
15552
15553 @item
15554 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15555 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15556 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15557 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15558 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15559 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15560 in strings. For example,
15561 @smallexample
15562 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15563 @end smallexample
15564 @noindent
15565 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15566 after each period.
15567
15568 @item
15569 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15570 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15571 to write
15572
15573 @smallexample
15574 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15575 @end smallexample
15576
15577 @item
15578 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15579 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15580 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15581 of 3 might print as
15582
15583 @smallexample
15584 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15585 @end smallexample
15586
15587 @noindent
15588 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15589 clause.
15590
15591 @item
15592 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15593 multi-character subsequence of
15594 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15595 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15596 in place of @t{a'length}.
15597
15598 @item
15599 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15600 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15601 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15602 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15603 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15604 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15605 For example,
15606 @smallexample
15607 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15608 @end smallexample
15609
15610 @item
15611 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15612 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15613 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15614 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15615 object.
15616
15617 @end itemize
15618
15619 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15620 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15621
15622 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15623 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15624 before reaching the main procedure.
15625 As defined in the Ada Reference
15626 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15627 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15628 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15629 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15630
15631 @node Ada Exceptions
15632 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15633
15634 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15635
15636 @table @code
15637 @kindex info exceptions
15638 @item info exceptions
15639 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15640 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15641 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15642 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15643 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15644 @end table
15645
15646 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15647 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15648 argument.
15649
15650 @smallexample
15651 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15652 All defined Ada exceptions:
15653 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15654 program_error: 0x613d20
15655 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15656 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15657 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15658 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15659 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15660 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15661 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15662 @end smallexample
15663
15664 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15665 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15666
15667 @node Ada Tasks
15668 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15669 @cindex Ada, tasking
15670
15671 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15672 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15673
15674 @table @code
15675 @kindex info tasks
15676 @item info tasks
15677 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15678
15679
15680 @smallexample
15681 @iftex
15682 @leftskip=0.5cm
15683 @end iftex
15684 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15685 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15686 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15687 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15688 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15689 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15690
15691 @end smallexample
15692
15693 @noindent
15694 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15695 task currently being inspected.
15696
15697 @table @asis
15698 @item ID
15699 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15700
15701 @item TID
15702 The Ada task ID.
15703
15704 @item P-ID
15705 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15706
15707 @item Pri
15708 The base priority of the task.
15709
15710 @item State
15711 Current state of the task.
15712
15713 @table @code
15714 @item Unactivated
15715 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15716 executing.
15717
15718 @item Runnable
15719 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15720 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15721
15722 @item Terminated
15723 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15724 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15725 terminated themselves.
15726
15727 @item Child Activation Wait
15728 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15729
15730 @item Accept Statement
15731 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15732
15733 @item Waiting on entry call
15734 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15735
15736 @item Async Select Wait
15737 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15738 select statement.
15739
15740 @item Delay Sleep
15741 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15742 alternative open.
15743
15744 @item Child Termination Wait
15745 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15746 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15747 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15748
15749 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15750 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15751 finish terminating.
15752
15753 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15754 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15755 @end table
15756
15757 @item Name
15758 Name of the task in the program.
15759
15760 @end table
15761
15762 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15763 @item info task @var{taskno}
15764 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15765 the following example:
15766 @smallexample
15767 @iftex
15768 @leftskip=0.5cm
15769 @end iftex
15770 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15771 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15772 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15773 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15774 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15775 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15776 Name: task_1
15777 Thread: 0x807f378
15778 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15779 Base Priority: 15
15780 State: Runnable
15781 @end smallexample
15782
15783 @item task
15784 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15785 @cindex current Ada task ID
15786 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15787
15788 @smallexample
15789 @iftex
15790 @leftskip=0.5cm
15791 @end iftex
15792 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15793 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15794 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15795 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15796 (@value{GDBP}) task
15797 [Current task is 2]
15798 @end smallexample
15799
15800 @item task @var{taskno}
15801 @cindex Ada task switching
15802 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15803 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15804 from the current task to the given task.
15805
15806 @smallexample
15807 @iftex
15808 @leftskip=0.5cm
15809 @end iftex
15810 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15811 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15812 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15813 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15814 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15815 [Switching to task 1]
15816 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15817 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15818 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15819 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15820 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15821 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15822 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15823 @end smallexample
15824
15825 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15826 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15827 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15828 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15829 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15830 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15831 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15832 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15833 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15834
15835 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15836 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15837 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15838 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15839 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15840
15841 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15842 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15843 program.
15844
15845 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15846 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15847 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15848
15849 For example,
15850
15851 @smallexample
15852 @iftex
15853 @leftskip=0.5cm
15854 @end iftex
15855 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15856 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15857 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15858 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15859 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15860 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15861 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15862 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15863 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15864 Continuing.
15865 task # 1 running
15866 task # 2 running
15867
15868 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15869 15 flush;
15870 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15871 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15872 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15873 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15874 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15875 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15876 @end smallexample
15877 @end table
15878
15879 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15880 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15881 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15882
15883 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15884 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15885 the platform being used.
15886 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15887 switching is not supported.
15888
15889 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15890 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15891 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15892 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15893 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15894 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15895
15896 @node Ravenscar Profile
15897 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15898 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15899
15900 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15901 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15902 requirements.
15903
15904 @table @code
15905 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15906 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15907 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15908 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15909 Profile. This is the default.
15910
15911 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15912 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15913 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15914 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15915 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15916 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15917 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15918
15919 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15920 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15921 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15922 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15923
15924 @end table
15925
15926 @node Ada Glitches
15927 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15928 @cindex Ada, problems
15929
15930 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15931 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15932 @value{GDBN},
15933 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15934 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15935
15936 @itemize @bullet
15937 @item
15938 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15939 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15940
15941 @item
15942 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15943 argument lists are treated as positional).
15944
15945 @item
15946 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15947
15948 @item
15949 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15950 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15951 the host machine.
15952
15953 @item
15954 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15955 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15956 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15957 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15958 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15959 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15960 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15961 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15962 you can usually resolve the confusion
15963 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15964 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15965 @end itemize
15966
15967 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15968 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15969 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15970 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15971 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15972 enabled.
15973
15974 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15975 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15976 @table @code
15977
15978 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15979 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15980 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15981 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15982 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15983 This is the default.
15984
15985 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15986 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15987 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15988 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15989 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15990 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15991 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15992
15993 @end table
15994
15995 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15996 @cindex GNAT encoding
15997 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15998 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15999 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16000 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16001 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16002 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16003
16004 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16005 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16006 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16007 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16008 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16009 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16010 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16011 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16012
16013 @table @code
16014
16015 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16016 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16017 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16018 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16019
16020 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16021 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16022 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16023
16024 @end table
16025
16026 @node Unsupported Languages
16027 @section Unsupported Languages
16028
16029 @cindex unsupported languages
16030 @cindex minimal language
16031 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16032 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16033 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16034 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16035 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16036 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16037
16038 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16039 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16040 language.
16041
16042 @node Symbols
16043 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16044
16045 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16046 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16047 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16048 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16049 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16050 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16051 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16052
16053 @cindex symbol names
16054 @cindex names of symbols
16055 @cindex quoting names
16056 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16057 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16058 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16059 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16060 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16061 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16062 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16063 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16064
16065 @smallexample
16066 p 'foo.c'::x
16067 @end smallexample
16068
16069 @noindent
16070 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16071
16072 @table @code
16073 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16074 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16075 @kindex set case-sensitive
16076 @item set case-sensitive on
16077 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16078 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16079 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16080 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16081 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16082 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16083 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16084 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16085 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16086 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16087 case-insensitive matches.
16088
16089 @kindex show case-sensitive
16090 @item show case-sensitive
16091 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16092 lookups.
16093
16094 @kindex set print type methods
16095 @item set print type methods
16096 @itemx set print type methods on
16097 @itemx set print type methods off
16098 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16099 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16100 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16101 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16102 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16103 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16104
16105 @kindex show print type methods
16106 @item show print type methods
16107 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16108 classes.
16109
16110 @kindex set print type typedefs
16111 @item set print type typedefs
16112 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16113 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16114
16115 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16116 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16117 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16118 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16119 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16120 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16121 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16122 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16123 types.
16124
16125 @kindex show print type typedefs
16126 @item show print type typedefs
16127 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16128 printing classes.
16129
16130 @kindex info address
16131 @cindex address of a symbol
16132 @item info address @var{symbol}
16133 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16134 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16135 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16136 is always stored.
16137
16138 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16139 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16140 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16141
16142 @kindex info symbol
16143 @cindex symbol from address
16144 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16145 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16146 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16147 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16148 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16149
16150 @smallexample
16151 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16152 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16153 @end smallexample
16154
16155 @noindent
16156 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16157 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16158
16159 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16160 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16161
16162 @smallexample
16163 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16164 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16165 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16166 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16167 @end smallexample
16168
16169 @kindex demangle
16170 @cindex demangle
16171 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16172 Demangle @var{name}.
16173 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16174 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16175
16176 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16177 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16178
16179 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16180 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16181
16182 @kindex whatis
16183 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16184 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16185 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16186 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16187
16188 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16189 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16190 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16191
16192 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16193 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16194 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16195 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16196 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16197 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16198 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16199 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16200 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16201
16202 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16203 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16204 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16205 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16206 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16207 unroll it.
16208
16209 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16210 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16211 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16212
16213 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16214 Available flags are:
16215
16216 @table @code
16217 @item r
16218 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16219 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16220 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16221
16222 @item m
16223 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16224
16225 @item M
16226 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16227 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16228
16229 @item t
16230 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16231 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16232 names are substituted when printing other types.
16233
16234 @item T
16235 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16236 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16237 @end table
16238
16239 @kindex ptype
16240 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16241 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16242 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16243 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16244
16245 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16246 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16247 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16248 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16249 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16250 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16251 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16252 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16253
16254 For example, for this variable declaration:
16255
16256 @smallexample
16257 typedef double real_t;
16258 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16259 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16260 complex_t var;
16261 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16262 @end smallexample
16263
16264 @noindent
16265 the two commands give this output:
16266
16267 @smallexample
16268 @group
16269 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16270 type = complex_t
16271 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16272 type = struct complex @{
16273 real_t real;
16274 double imag;
16275 @}
16276 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16277 type = struct complex
16278 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16279 type = struct complex
16280 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16281 type = struct complex @{
16282 real_t real;
16283 double imag;
16284 @}
16285 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16286 type = real_t *
16287 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16288 type = double *
16289 @end group
16290 @end smallexample
16291
16292 @noindent
16293 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16294 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16295
16296 @cindex incomplete type
16297 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16298 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16299 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16300 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16301 given these declarations:
16302
16303 @smallexample
16304 struct foo;
16305 struct foo *fooptr;
16306 @end smallexample
16307
16308 @noindent
16309 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16313 $1 = <incomplete type>
16314 @end smallexample
16315
16316 @noindent
16317 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16318 completely specified.
16319
16320 @kindex info types
16321 @item info types @var{regexp}
16322 @itemx info types
16323 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16324 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16325 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16326 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16327 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16328 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16329 name is @code{value}.
16330
16331 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16332 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16333 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16334
16335 @kindex info type-printers
16336 @item info type-printers
16337 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16338 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16339 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16340 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16341 type printers.
16342
16343 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16344
16345 @kindex enable type-printer
16346 @kindex disable type-printer
16347 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16348 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16349 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16350
16351 @kindex info scope
16352 @cindex local variables
16353 @item info scope @var{location}
16354 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16355 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16356 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16357 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16358 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16359
16360 @smallexample
16361 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16362 Scope for command_line_handler:
16363 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16364 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16365 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16366 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16367 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16368 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16369 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16370 @end smallexample
16371
16372 @noindent
16373 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16374 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16375 collect}.
16376
16377 @kindex info source
16378 @item info source
16379 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16380 the function containing the current point of execution:
16381 @itemize @bullet
16382 @item
16383 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16384 @item
16385 the directory it was compiled in,
16386 @item
16387 its length, in lines,
16388 @item
16389 which programming language it is written in,
16390 @item
16391 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16392 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16393 @item
16394 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16395 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16396 @item
16397 whether the debugging information includes information about
16398 preprocessor macros.
16399 @end itemize
16400
16401
16402 @kindex info sources
16403 @item info sources
16404 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16405 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16406 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16407
16408 @kindex info functions
16409 @item info functions
16410 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16411
16412 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16413 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16414 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16415 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16416 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16417 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16418 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16419 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16420
16421 @kindex info variables
16422 @item info variables
16423 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16424 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16425
16426 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16427 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16428 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16429 @var{regexp}.
16430
16431 @kindex info classes
16432 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16433 @item info classes
16434 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16435 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16436 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16437 expression.
16438
16439 @kindex info selectors
16440 @item info selectors
16441 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16442 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16443 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16444 expression.
16445
16446 @ignore
16447 This was never implemented.
16448 @kindex info methods
16449 @item info methods
16450 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16451 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16452 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16453 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16454 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16455 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16456 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16457 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16458 @end ignore
16459
16460 @cindex opaque data types
16461 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16462 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16463 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16464 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16465 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16466 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16467 another source file. The default is on.
16468
16469 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16470 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16471
16472 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16473 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16474 is printed as follows:
16475 @smallexample
16476 @{<no data fields>@}
16477 @end smallexample
16478
16479 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16480 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16481 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16482
16483 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16484 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16485 @item set print symbol-loading
16486 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16487 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16488 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16489 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16490 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16491 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16492 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16493 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16494 can be annoying.
16495 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16496 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16497 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16498 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16499
16500 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16501 @item show print symbol-loading
16502 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16503 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16504
16505 @kindex maint print symbols
16506 @cindex symbol dump
16507 @kindex maint print psymbols
16508 @cindex partial symbol dump
16509 @kindex maint print msymbols
16510 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16511 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16512 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16513 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16514 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16515 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16516 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16517 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16518 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16519 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16520 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16521 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16522 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16523 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16524 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16525 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16526 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16527 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16528
16529 @kindex maint info symtabs
16530 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16531 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16532 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16533 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16534 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16535 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16536 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16537
16538 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16539 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16540 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16541 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16542 structure in more detail. For example:
16543
16544 @smallexample
16545 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16546 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16547 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16548 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16549 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16550 readin no
16551 fullname (null)
16552 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16553 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16554 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16555 dependencies (none)
16556 @}
16557 @}
16558 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16559 (@value{GDBP})
16560 @end smallexample
16561 @noindent
16562 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16563 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16564 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16565 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16566 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16567
16568 @smallexample
16569 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16570 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16571 line 1574.
16572 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16573 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16574 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16575 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16576 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16577 dirname (null)
16578 fullname (null)
16579 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16580 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16581 debugformat DWARF 2
16582 @}
16583 @}
16584 (@value{GDBP})
16585 @end smallexample
16586
16587 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16588 @cindex symbol cache size
16589 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16590 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16591 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16592 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16593 with different sizes.
16594
16595 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16596 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16597 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16598
16599 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16600 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16601 @item maint print symbol-cache
16602 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16603 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16604
16605 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16606 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16607 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16608 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16609 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16610
16611 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16612 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16613 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16614 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16615 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16616 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16617
16618 @end table
16619
16620 @node Altering
16621 @chapter Altering Execution
16622
16623 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16624 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16625 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16626 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16627 program.
16628
16629 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16630 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16631 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16632
16633 @menu
16634 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16635 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16636 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16637 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16638 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16639 * Patching:: Patching your program
16640 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16641 @end menu
16642
16643 @node Assignment
16644 @section Assignment to Variables
16645
16646 @cindex assignment
16647 @cindex setting variables
16648 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16649 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16650
16651 @smallexample
16652 print x=4
16653 @end smallexample
16654
16655 @noindent
16656 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16657 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16658 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16659 information on operators in supported languages.
16660
16661 @kindex set variable
16662 @cindex variables, setting
16663 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16664 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16665 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16666 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16667 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16668
16669 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16670 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16671 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16672 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16673 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16674 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16675 command @code{set width}:
16676
16677 @smallexample
16678 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16679 type = double
16680 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16681 $4 = 13
16682 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16683 Invalid syntax in expression.
16684 @end smallexample
16685
16686 @noindent
16687 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16688 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16689
16690 @smallexample
16691 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16692 @end smallexample
16693
16694 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16695 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16696 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16697 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16698 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16699 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16700
16701 @smallexample
16702 @group
16703 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16704 type = double
16705 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16706 $1 = 1
16707 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16708 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16709 $2 = 1
16710 (@value{GDBP}) r
16711 The program being debugged has been started already.
16712 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16713 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16714 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16715 Invalid bfd target.
16716 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16717 The current BFD target is "=4".
16718 @end group
16719 @end smallexample
16720
16721 @noindent
16722 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16723 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16724 @code{g}, use
16725
16726 @smallexample
16727 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16728 @end smallexample
16729
16730 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16731 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16732 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16733 same length or shorter.
16734 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16735 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16736
16737 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16738 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16739 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16740 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16741 and representation in memory), and
16742
16743 @smallexample
16744 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16745 @end smallexample
16746
16747 @noindent
16748 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16749
16750 @node Jumping
16751 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16752
16753 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16754 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16755 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16756
16757 @table @code
16758 @kindex jump
16759 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16760 @item jump @var{linespec}
16761 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16762 @itemx jump @var{location}
16763 @itemx j @var{location}
16764 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16765 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16766 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16767 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16768 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16769 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16770
16771 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16772 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16773 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16774 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16775 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16776 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16777 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16778 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16779 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16780 @end table
16781
16782 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16783 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16784 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16785 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16786 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16787 example,
16788
16789 @smallexample
16790 set $pc = 0x485
16791 @end smallexample
16792
16793 @noindent
16794 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16795 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16796 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16797
16798 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16799 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16800 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16801 detail.
16802
16803 @c @group
16804 @node Signaling
16805 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16806 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16807
16808 @table @code
16809 @kindex signal
16810 @item signal @var{signal}
16811 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16812 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16813 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16814 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16815
16816 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16817 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16818 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16819 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16820 signal.
16821
16822 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16823 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16824 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16825 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16826 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16827 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16828 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16829 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16830
16831 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16832 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16833 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16834 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16835 passes the signal directly to your program.
16836
16837 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16838 after executing the command.
16839
16840 @kindex queue-signal
16841 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16842 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16843 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16844 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16845 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16846 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16847 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16848 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16849 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16850
16851 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16852 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16853 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16854 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16855 @code{continue} command.
16856
16857 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16858 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16859 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16860 (@pxref{Signals}).
16861 @end table
16862 @c @end group
16863
16864 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16865 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16866
16867 @node Returning
16868 @section Returning from a Function
16869
16870 @table @code
16871 @cindex returning from a function
16872 @kindex return
16873 @item return
16874 @itemx return @var{expression}
16875 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16876 command. If you give an
16877 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16878 value.
16879 @end table
16880
16881 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16882 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16883 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16884 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16885
16886 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16887 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16888 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16889 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16890 of functions.
16891
16892 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16893 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16894 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16895 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16896 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16897
16898 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16899 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16900 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16901 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16902 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16903 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16904 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16905 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16906 assignment into the right register(s).
16907
16908 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16909 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16910 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16911 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16912 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16913 into a @code{long long int}:
16914
16915 @smallexample
16916 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16917 29 return 31;
16918 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16919 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16920 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16921 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16922 (@value{GDBP})
16923 @end smallexample
16924
16925 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16926 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16927 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16928 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16929 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16930 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16931 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16932 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16933
16934 @smallexample
16935 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16936 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16937 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16938 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16939 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16940 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16941 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16942 (@value{GDBP})
16943 @end smallexample
16944
16945 @node Calling
16946 @section Calling Program Functions
16947
16948 @table @code
16949 @cindex calling functions
16950 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16951 @item print @var{expr}
16952 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16953 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16954 debugged.
16955
16956 @kindex call
16957 @item call @var{expr}
16958 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16959 returned values.
16960
16961 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16962 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16963 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16964 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16965 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16966 value history.
16967 @end table
16968
16969 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16970 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16971 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16972 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16973
16974 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16975 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16976 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16977 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16978 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16979 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16980 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16981 in that case is controlled by the
16982 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16983
16984 @table @code
16985 @item set unwindonsignal
16986 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16987 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16988 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16989 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16990 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16991 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16992 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16993 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16994 received.
16995
16996 @item show unwindonsignal
16997 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16998 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16999 @value{GDBN}.
17000
17001 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17002 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17003 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17004 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17005 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17006 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17007 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17008 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17009 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17010 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17011
17012 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17013 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17014 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17015 @value{GDBN}.
17016
17017 @end table
17018
17019 @cindex weak alias functions
17020 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17021 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17022 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17023 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17024 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17025 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17026 function instead.
17027
17028 @node Patching
17029 @section Patching Programs
17030
17031 @cindex patching binaries
17032 @cindex writing into executables
17033 @cindex writing into corefiles
17034
17035 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17036 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17037 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17038 patching your program's binary.
17039
17040 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17041 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17042 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17043 repairs.
17044
17045 @table @code
17046 @kindex set write
17047 @item set write on
17048 @itemx set write off
17049 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17050 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17051 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17052
17053 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17054 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17055 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17056
17057 @item show write
17058 @kindex show write
17059 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17060 as well as reading.
17061 @end table
17062
17063 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17064 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17065 @cindex injecting code
17066 @cindex writing into executables
17067 @cindex compiling code
17068
17069 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17070 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17071 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17072 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17073
17074 @table @code
17075 @kindex compile code
17076 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17077 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17078 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17079 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17080 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17081 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17082 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17083 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17084 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17085 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17086 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17087 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17088
17089 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17090 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17091 E.g.:
17092
17093 @smallexample
17094 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17095 @end smallexample
17096
17097 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17098 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17099 from actual source code. E.g.:
17100
17101 @smallexample
17102 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17103 @end smallexample
17104
17105 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17106 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17107 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17108 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17109 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17110 editor.
17111
17112 @smallexample
17113 compile code
17114 >printf ("hello\n");
17115 >printf ("world\n");
17116 >end
17117 @end smallexample
17118
17119 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17120 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17121 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17122 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17123 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17124 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17125 inferior symbols otherwise.
17126
17127 @kindex compile file
17128 @item compile file @var{filename}
17129 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17130 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17131
17132 @smallexample
17133 compile file /home/user/example.c
17134 @end smallexample
17135 @end table
17136
17137 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17138
17139 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17140 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17141 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17142
17143 @table @asis
17144 @item C code examples and caveats
17145 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17146 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17147 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17148 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17149 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17150
17151 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17152 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17153 much like any other normal debugging session.
17154
17155 @smallexample
17156 void function1 (void)
17157 @{
17158 int i = 42;
17159 printf ("function 1\n");
17160 @}
17161
17162 void function2 (void)
17163 @{
17164 int j = 12;
17165 function1 ();
17166 @}
17167
17168 int main(void)
17169 @{
17170 int k = 6;
17171 int *p;
17172 function2 ();
17173 return 0;
17174 @}
17175 @end smallexample
17176
17177 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17178 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17179 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17180
17181 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17182 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17183 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17184 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17185 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17186
17187 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17188 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17189 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17190 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17191 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17192 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17193 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17194 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17195 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17196 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17197
17198 @smallexample
17199 compile code k = 3;
17200 @end smallexample
17201
17202 @noindent
17203 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17204 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17205 @code{compile} command changes it.
17206
17207 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17208 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17209 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17210 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17211 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17212
17213 @smallexample
17214 compile code j = 3;
17215 @end smallexample
17216
17217 @noindent
17218 will result in a compilation error message.
17219
17220 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17221 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17222 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17223
17224 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17225 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17226 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17227 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17228
17229 @smallexample
17230 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17231 @end smallexample
17232
17233 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17234 command has completed:
17235
17236 @smallexample
17237 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17238 @end smallexample
17239
17240 @noindent
17241 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17242 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17243 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17244 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17245 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17246
17247 @smallexample
17248 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17249 @end smallexample
17250
17251 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17252 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17253 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17254 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17255 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17256 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17257 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17258 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17259
17260 @smallexample
17261 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17262 @end smallexample
17263
17264 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17265 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17266 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17267 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17268 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17269 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17270 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17271
17272 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17273 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17274 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17275 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17276 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17277 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17278
17279 @smallexample
17280 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17281 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17282 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17283 Compilation failed.
17284 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17285 42
17286 @end smallexample
17287
17288 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17289 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17290 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17291 will print to the console.
17292 @end table
17293
17294 @node GDB Files
17295 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17296
17297 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17298 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17299 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17300 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17301
17302 @menu
17303 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17304 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17305 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17306 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17307 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17308 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17309 @end menu
17310
17311 @node Files
17312 @section Commands to Specify Files
17313
17314 @cindex symbol table
17315 @cindex core dump file
17316
17317 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17318 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17319 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17320 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17321
17322 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17323 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17324 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17325 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17326 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17327 new files are useful.
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @cindex executable file
17331 @kindex file
17332 @item file @var{filename}
17333 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17334 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17335 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17336 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17337 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17338 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17339 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17340 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17341
17342 @cindex unlinked object files
17343 @cindex patching object files
17344 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17345 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17346 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17347 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17348 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17349 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17350 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17351 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17352
17353 @item file
17354 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17355 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17356
17357 @kindex exec-file
17358 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17359 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17360 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17361 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17362 discard information on the executable file.
17363
17364 @kindex symbol-file
17365 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17366 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17367 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17368 table and program to run from the same file.
17369
17370 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17371 program's symbol table.
17372
17373 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17374 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17375 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17376 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17377 @value{GDBN}.
17378
17379 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17380 executing it once.
17381
17382 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17383 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17384 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17385 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17386 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17387 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17388 optimized code.
17389
17390 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17391 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17392 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17393 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17394 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17395
17396 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17397 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17398 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17399 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17400 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17401 Warnings and Messages}.)
17402
17403 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17404 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17405 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17406 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17407 in stabs format.
17408
17409 @kindex readnow
17410 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17411 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17412 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17413 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17414 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17415 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17416 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17417 entire symbol table available.
17418
17419 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17420 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17421 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17422 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17423 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17424 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17425 @c files.
17426
17427 @kindex core-file
17428 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17429 @itemx core
17430 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17431 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17432 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17433 executable file itself for other parts.
17434
17435 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17436 to be used.
17437
17438 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17439 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17440 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17441 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17442 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17443
17444 @kindex add-symbol-file
17445 @cindex dynamic linking
17446 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17447 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17448 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17449 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17450 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17451 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17452 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17453 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17454 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17455 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17456 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17457 @var{address} as an expression.
17458
17459 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17460 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17461 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17462 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17463
17464 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17465
17466 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17467 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17468 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17469 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17470 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17471 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17472 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17473 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17474 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17475
17476 @itemize @bullet
17477 @item
17478 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17479 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17480 @item
17481 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17482 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17483 @item
17484 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17485 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17486 @end itemize
17487
17488 @noindent
17489 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17490 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17491 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17492 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17493 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17494 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17495 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17496 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17497 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17498 way.
17499
17500 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17501
17502 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17503 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17504 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17505 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17506 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17507 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17508
17509 @smallexample
17510 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17511 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17512 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17513 (y or n) y
17514 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17515 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17516 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17517 (gdb)
17518 @end smallexample
17519
17520
17521 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17522
17523 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17524 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17525 @cindex load symbols from memory
17526 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17527 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17528 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17529 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17530 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17531 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17532 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17533 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17534 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17535
17536 @kindex section
17537 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17538 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17539 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17540 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17541 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17542 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17543 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17544 their addresses.
17545
17546 @kindex info files
17547 @kindex info target
17548 @item info files
17549 @itemx info target
17550 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17551 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17552 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17553 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17554 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17555 current ones.
17556
17557 @kindex maint info sections
17558 @item maint info sections
17559 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17560 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17561 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17562 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17563 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17564 may be arbitrarily combined):
17565
17566 @table @code
17567 @item ALLOBJ
17568 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17569 @item @var{sections}
17570 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17571 @item @var{section-flags}
17572 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17573 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17574 @table @code
17575 @item ALLOC
17576 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17577 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17578 @item LOAD
17579 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17580 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17581 @item RELOC
17582 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17583 @item READONLY
17584 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17585 @item CODE
17586 Section contains executable code only.
17587 @item DATA
17588 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17589 @item ROM
17590 Section will reside in ROM.
17591 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17592 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17593 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17594 Section is not empty.
17595 @item NEVER_LOAD
17596 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17597 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17598 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17599 COFF shared library information.
17600 @item IS_COMMON
17601 Section contains common symbols.
17602 @end table
17603 @end table
17604 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17605 @cindex read-only sections
17606 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17607 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17608 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17609 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17610 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17611 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17612 enhancement to debugging performance.
17613
17614 The default is off.
17615
17616 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17617 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17618 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17619 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17620
17621 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17622 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17623 @end table
17624
17625 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17626 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17627 name and remembers it that way.
17628
17629 @cindex shared libraries
17630 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17631 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17632 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17633
17634 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17635 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17636
17637 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17638 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17639 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17640 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17641 debugging a core file).
17642
17643 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17644 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17645
17646 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17647 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17648 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17649
17650 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17651 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17652 particularly large or there are many of them.
17653
17654 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17655 commands:
17656
17657 @table @code
17658 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17659 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17660 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17661 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17662 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17663 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17664 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17665 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17666
17667 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17668 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17669 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17670 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17671 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17672 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17673 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17674 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17675 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17676
17677 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17678 @item show auto-solib-add
17679 Display the current autoloading mode.
17680 @end table
17681
17682 @cindex load shared library
17683 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17684 command:
17685
17686 @table @code
17687 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17688 @kindex info share
17689 @item info share @var{regex}
17690 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17691 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17692 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17693 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17694
17695 @kindex sharedlibrary
17696 @kindex share
17697 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17698 @itemx share @var{regex}
17699 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17700 Unix regular expression.
17701 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17702 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17703 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17704 loaded.
17705
17706 @item nosharedlibrary
17707 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17708 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17709 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17710 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17711 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17712 discarded.
17713 @end table
17714
17715 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17716 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17717 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17718 Catchpoints}).
17719
17720 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17721 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17722 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17723 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17724
17725 @table @code
17726 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17727 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17728 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17729 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17730 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17731 shared library.
17732
17733 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17734 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17735 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17736 library events happen.
17737 @end table
17738
17739 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17740 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17741 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17742 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17743 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17744 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17745 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17746 not.
17747
17748 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17749 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17750 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17751 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17752 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17753
17754 @table @code
17755 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17756 @cindex system root, alternate
17757 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17758 @kindex set sysroot
17759 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17760 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17761 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17762 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17763 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17764 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17765 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17766 under @var{path}.
17767
17768 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17769 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17770 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17771 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17772 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17773 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17774 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17775 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17776 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17777
17778 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17779 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17780 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17781 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17782 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17783
17784 @smallexample
17785 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17786 @end smallexample
17787
17788 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17789 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17790 system:
17791
17792 @smallexample
17793 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17794 @end smallexample
17795
17796 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17797 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17798 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17799 colons:
17800
17801 @smallexample
17802 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17803 @end smallexample
17804
17805 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17806 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17807 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17808 @samp{z}):
17809
17810 @smallexample
17811 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17812 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17813 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17814 @end smallexample
17815
17816 @noindent
17817 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17818 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17819 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17820
17821 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17822 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17823
17824 @smallexample
17825 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17826 @end smallexample
17827
17828 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17829 if you don't want or need to.
17830
17831 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17832 sysroot}.
17833
17834 @cindex default system root
17835 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17836 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17837 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17838 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17839 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17840 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17841 location.
17842
17843 @kindex show sysroot
17844 @item show sysroot
17845 Display the current shared library prefix.
17846
17847 @kindex set solib-search-path
17848 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17849 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17850 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17851 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17852 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17853 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17854 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17855 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17856 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17857 of shared library symbols.
17858
17859 @kindex show solib-search-path
17860 @item show solib-search-path
17861 Display the current shared library search path.
17862
17863 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17864 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17865 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17866 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17867 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17868
17869 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17870 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17871 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17872 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17873 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17874 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17875 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17876 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17877 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17878 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17879 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17880 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17881 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17882 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17883 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17884 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17885 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17886 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17887 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17888 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17889 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17890 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17891
17892 @table @code
17893 @item unix
17894 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17895 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17896 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17897 the forward slash.
17898
17899 @item dos-based
17900 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17901 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17902 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17903 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17904 considered directory separators.
17905
17906 @item auto
17907 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17908 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17909 This is the default.
17910 @end table
17911 @end table
17912
17913 @cindex file name canonicalization
17914 @cindex base name differences
17915 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17916 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17917 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17918 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17919 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17920 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17921 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17922 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17923 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17924 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17925 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17926 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17927 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17928 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17929 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17930
17931 @table @code
17932 @item set basenames-may-differ
17933 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17934 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17935
17936 @item show basenames-may-differ
17937 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17938 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17939 @end table
17940
17941 @node Separate Debug Files
17942 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17943 @cindex separate debugging information files
17944 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17945 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17946 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17947 @cindex global debugging information directories
17948 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17949 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17950
17951 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17952 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17953 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17954 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17955 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17956 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17957 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17958
17959 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17960 file:
17961
17962 @itemize @bullet
17963 @item
17964 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17965 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17966 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17967 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17968 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17969 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17970 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17971 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17972
17973 @item
17974 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17975 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17976 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17977 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17978 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17979 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17980 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17981 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17982 below.
17983 @end itemize
17984
17985 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17986 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17987
17988 @itemize @bullet
17989 @item
17990 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17991 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17992 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17993 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17994 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17995
17996 @item
17997 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17998 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17999 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18000 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18001 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18002 hex characters, not 10.)
18003 @end itemize
18004
18005 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18006 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18007 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18008 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18009 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18010 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18011
18012 @itemize @minus
18013 @item
18014 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18015 @item
18016 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18017 @item
18018 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18019 @item
18020 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18021 @end itemize
18022
18023 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18024 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18025 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18026 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18027 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18028
18029 @table @code
18030
18031 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18032 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18033 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18034 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18035 concatenating them by a path separator.
18036
18037 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18038 @item show debug-file-directory
18039 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18040 information files.
18041
18042 @end table
18043
18044 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18045 @cindex debug link sections
18046 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18047 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18048
18049 @itemize
18050 @item
18051 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18052 a zero byte,
18053 @item
18054 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18055 boundary within the section, and
18056 @item
18057 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18058 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18059 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18060 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18061 @end itemize
18062
18063 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18064 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18065 described above.
18066
18067 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18068 @cindex build ID sections
18069 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18070 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18071 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18072 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18073 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18074 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18075 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18076 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18077 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18078
18079 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18080 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18081 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18082 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18083 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18084 in an ordinary executable.
18085
18086 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18087 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18088 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18089 following commands:
18090
18091 @smallexample
18092 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18093 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18094 @end smallexample
18095
18096 @noindent
18097 These commands remove the debugging
18098 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18099 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18100 two files:
18101
18102 @itemize @bullet
18103 @item
18104 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18105 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18106
18107 @smallexample
18108 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18109 @end smallexample
18110
18111 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18112 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18113 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18114 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18115
18116 @item
18117 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18118 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18119 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18120 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18121 @end itemize
18122
18123 @noindent
18124
18125 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18126 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18127 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18128
18129 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18130 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18131 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18132 @c different ways!
18133 @ifhtml
18134 @display
18135 @html
18136 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18137 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18138 @end html
18139 @end display
18140 @end ifhtml
18141 @ifnothtml
18142 @display
18143 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18144 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18145 @end display
18146 @end ifnothtml
18147
18148 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18149 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18150 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18151 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18152 CRC.
18153
18154 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18155 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18156 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18157 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18158 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18159
18160 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18161 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18162 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18163 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18164 @code{0xffffffff}.
18165
18166 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18167 @smallexample
18168 unsigned long
18169 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18170 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18171 @{
18172 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18173 @{
18174 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18175 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18176 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18177 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18178 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18179 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18180 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18181 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18182 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18183 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18184 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18185 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18186 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18187 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18188 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18189 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18190 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18191 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18192 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18193 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18194 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18195 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18196 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18197 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18198 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18199 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18200 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18201 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18202 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18203 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18204 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18205 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18206 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18207 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18208 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18209 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18210 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18211 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18212 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18213 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18214 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18215 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18216 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18217 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18218 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18219 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18220 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18221 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18222 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18223 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18224 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18225 0x2d02ef8d
18226 @};
18227 unsigned char *end;
18228
18229 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18230 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18231 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18232 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18233 @}
18234 @end smallexample
18235
18236 @noindent
18237 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18238
18239 @node MiniDebugInfo
18240 @section Debugging information in a special section
18241 @cindex separate debug sections
18242 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18243
18244 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18245 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18246 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18247 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18248
18249 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18250 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18251 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18252 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18253 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18254 debugging information might be included in the section.
18255
18256 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18257 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18258 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18259
18260 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18261 standard utilities:
18262
18263 @smallexample
18264 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18265 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18266 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18267 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18268
18269 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18270 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18271 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18272 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18273 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18274 | sort > funcsyms
18275
18276 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18277 # table.
18278 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18279
18280 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18281 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18282
18283 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18284 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18285 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18286 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18287
18288 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18289 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18290
18291 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18292 # original binary.
18293 xz mini_debuginfo
18294 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18295 @end smallexample
18296
18297 @node Index Files
18298 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18299 @cindex index files
18300 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18301
18302 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18303 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18304 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18305 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18306 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18307 startup.
18308
18309 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18310 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18311 using @command{objcopy}.
18312
18313 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18314
18315 @table @code
18316 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18317 @kindex save gdb-index
18318 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18319 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18320 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18321 @var{directory}.
18322 @end table
18323
18324 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18325 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18326
18327 @smallexample
18328 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18329 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18330 @end smallexample
18331
18332 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18333 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18334 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18335 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18336 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18337 The default is @code{off}.
18338 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18339 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18340
18341 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18342 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18343
18344 @smallexample
18345 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18346 @end smallexample
18347
18348 Instead you must do, for example,
18349
18350 @smallexample
18351 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18352 @end smallexample
18353
18354 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18355 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18356 currently work for programs using Ada.
18357
18358 @node Symbol Errors
18359 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18360
18361 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18362 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18363 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18364 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18365 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18366 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18367 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18368 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18369 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18370 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18371 Messages}).
18372
18373 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18374
18375 @table @code
18376 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18377
18378 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18379 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18380 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18381 in its outer scope blocks.
18382
18383 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18384 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18385 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18386 function.
18387
18388 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18389
18390 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18391 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18392 do so.
18393
18394 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18395 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18396 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18397 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18398 Messages}.)
18399
18400 @item bad block start address patched
18401
18402 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18403 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18404 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18405
18406 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18407 starting on the previous source line.
18408
18409 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18410
18411 @cindex foo
18412 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18413 larger than the size of the string table.
18414
18415 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18416 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18417 with this name.
18418
18419 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18420
18421 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18422 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18423 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18424
18425 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18426 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18427 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18428 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18429 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18430 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18431
18432 @item stub type has NULL name
18433
18434 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18435
18436 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18437 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18438 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18439 it.
18440
18441 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18442
18443 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18444
18445 @end table
18446
18447 @node Data Files
18448 @section GDB Data Files
18449
18450 @cindex prefix for data files
18451 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18452 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18453
18454 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18455 is currently using.
18456
18457 @table @code
18458 @kindex set data-directory
18459 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18460 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18461 to @var{directory}.
18462
18463 @kindex show data-directory
18464 @item show data-directory
18465 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18466 @end table
18467
18468 @cindex default data directory
18469 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18470 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18471 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18472 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18473 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18474 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18475 location.
18476
18477 The data directory may also be specified with the
18478 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18479 @xref{Mode Options}.
18480
18481 @node Targets
18482 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18483
18484 @cindex debugging target
18485 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18486
18487 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18488 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18489 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18490 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18491 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18492 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18493 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18494 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18495
18496 @cindex target architecture
18497 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18498 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18499 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18500 command.
18501
18502 @table @code
18503 @kindex set architecture
18504 @kindex show architecture
18505 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18506 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18507 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18508 supported architectures.
18509
18510 @item show architecture
18511 Show the current target architecture.
18512
18513 @item set processor
18514 @itemx processor
18515 @kindex set processor
18516 @kindex show processor
18517 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18518 and @code{show architecture}.
18519 @end table
18520
18521 @menu
18522 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18523 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18524 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18525 @end menu
18526
18527 @node Active Targets
18528 @section Active Targets
18529
18530 @cindex stacking targets
18531 @cindex active targets
18532 @cindex multiple targets
18533
18534 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18535 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18536 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18537 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18538 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18539 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18540 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18541 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18542 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18543
18544 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18545 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18546 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18547 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18548
18549 @node Target Commands
18550 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18551
18552 @table @code
18553 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18554 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18555 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18556 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18557 protocol of the target machine.
18558
18559 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18560 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18561 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18562
18563 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18564 after executing the command.
18565
18566 @kindex help target
18567 @item help target
18568 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18569 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18570 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18571
18572 @item help target @var{name}
18573 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18574 select it.
18575
18576 @kindex set gnutarget
18577 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18578 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18579 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18580 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18581 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18582 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18583
18584 @quotation
18585 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18586 you must know the actual BFD name.
18587 @end quotation
18588
18589 @noindent
18590 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18591
18592 @kindex show gnutarget
18593 @item show gnutarget
18594 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18595 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18596 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18597 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18598 @end table
18599
18600 @cindex common targets
18601 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18602 configuration):
18603
18604 @table @code
18605 @kindex target
18606 @item target exec @var{program}
18607 @cindex executable file target
18608 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18609 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18610
18611 @item target core @var{filename}
18612 @cindex core dump file target
18613 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18614 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18615
18616 @item target remote @var{medium}
18617 @cindex remote target
18618 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18619 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18620 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18621
18622 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18623 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18624
18625 @smallexample
18626 target remote /dev/ttya
18627 @end smallexample
18628
18629 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18630 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18631 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18632 clobbered by the download.
18633
18634 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18635 @cindex built-in simulator target
18636 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18637 In general,
18638 @smallexample
18639 target sim
18640 load
18641 run
18642 @end smallexample
18643 @noindent
18644 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18645 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18646 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18647 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18648 Processors}.
18649
18650 @item target native
18651 @cindex native target
18652 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18653 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18654 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18655 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18656
18657 @end table
18658
18659 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18660 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18661
18662 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18663 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18664 various aspects of this process.
18665
18666 @table @code
18667
18668 @item set hash
18669 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18670 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18671 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18672 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18673 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18674 monitor.
18675
18676 @item show hash
18677 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18678 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18679
18680 @item set debug monitor
18681 @kindex set debug monitor
18682 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18683 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18684 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18685
18686 @item show debug monitor
18687 @kindex show debug monitor
18688 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18689 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18690 @end table
18691
18692 @table @code
18693
18694 @kindex load @var{filename}
18695 @item load @var{filename}
18696 @anchor{load}
18697 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18698 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18699 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18700 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18701 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18702 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18703
18704 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18705 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18706 target is @dots{}}''
18707
18708 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18709 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18710 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18711 specifies a fixed address.
18712 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18713
18714 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18715 load programs into flash memory.
18716
18717 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18718 @end table
18719
18720 @node Byte Order
18721 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18722
18723 @cindex choosing target byte order
18724 @cindex target byte order
18725
18726 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18727 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18728 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18729 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18730 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18731 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18732
18733 @table @code
18734 @kindex set endian
18735 @item set endian big
18736 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18737
18738 @item set endian little
18739 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18740
18741 @item set endian auto
18742 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18743 executable.
18744
18745 @item show endian
18746 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18747
18748 @end table
18749
18750 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18751 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18752 target system.
18753
18754
18755 @node Remote Debugging
18756 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18757 @cindex remote debugging
18758
18759 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18760 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18761 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18762 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18763 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18764
18765 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18766 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18767 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18768 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18769 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18770 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18771
18772 Other remote targets may be available in your
18773 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18774
18775 @menu
18776 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18777 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18778 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18779 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18780 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18781 @end menu
18782
18783 @node Connecting
18784 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18785
18786 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18787 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18788 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18789 program as the first argument.
18790
18791 @cindex @code{target remote}
18792 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18793 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18794 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18795 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18796 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18797 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18798
18799 @table @code
18800
18801 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18802 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18803 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18804 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18805
18806 @smallexample
18807 target remote /dev/ttyb
18808 @end smallexample
18809
18810 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18811 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18812 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18813 @code{target} command.
18814
18815 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18816 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18817 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18818 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18819 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18820 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18821 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18822 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18823 target.
18824
18825 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18826 @code{manyfarms}:
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 target remote manyfarms:2828
18830 @end smallexample
18831
18832 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18833 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18834 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18835 port 1234 on your local machine:
18836
18837 @smallexample
18838 target remote :1234
18839 @end smallexample
18840 @noindent
18841
18842 Note that the colon is still required here.
18843
18844 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18845 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18846 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18847 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18854 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18855 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18856 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18857
18858 @item target remote | @var{command}
18859 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18860 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18861 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18862 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18863 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18864 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18865 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18866 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18867
18868 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18869 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18870 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18871
18872 @end table
18873
18874 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18875 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18876 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18877 need to use @kbd{run}.
18878
18879 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18880 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18881 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18882 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18883 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18884 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18885 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18886
18887 @smallexample
18888 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18889 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18890 @end smallexample
18891
18892 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18893 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18894 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18895 goes back to waiting.
18896
18897 @table @code
18898 @kindex detach (remote)
18899 @item detach
18900 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18901 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18902 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18903 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18904 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18905
18906 @kindex disconnect
18907 @item disconnect
18908 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18909 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18910 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18911 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18912 another target.
18913
18914 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18915 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18916 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18917 @kindex monitor
18918 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18919 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18920 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18921 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18922 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18923 and implement.
18924 @end table
18925
18926 @node File Transfer
18927 @section Sending files to a remote system
18928 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18929 @cindex file transfer
18930 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18931
18932 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18933 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18934 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18935 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18936 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18937 the only way to upload or download files.
18938
18939 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18940
18941 @table @code
18942 @kindex remote put
18943 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18944 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18945 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18946
18947 @kindex remote get
18948 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18949 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18950 on the host system.
18951
18952 @kindex remote delete
18953 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18954 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18955
18956 @end table
18957
18958 @node Server
18959 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18960
18961 @kindex gdbserver
18962 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18963 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18964 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18965 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18966
18967 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18968 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18969 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18970 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18971 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18972 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18973 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18974 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18975 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18976 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18977 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18978 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18979 choice for debugging.
18980
18981 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18982 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18983 protocol.
18984
18985 @quotation
18986 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18987 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18988 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18989 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18990 @code{gdbserver}.
18991 @end quotation
18992
18993 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18994 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18995 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18996
18997 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18998 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18999 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19000 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19001 system does all the symbol handling.
19002
19003 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19004 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19005 syntax is:
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19009 @end smallexample
19010
19011 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19012 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19013 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19014 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19015 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19016 @file{/dev/com1}:
19017
19018 @smallexample
19019 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19020 @end smallexample
19021
19022 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19023 with it.
19024
19025 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19026
19027 @smallexample
19028 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19029 @end smallexample
19030
19031 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19032 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19033 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19034 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19035 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19036 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19037 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19038 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19039 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19040 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19041 @code{target remote} command.
19042
19043 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19044 with ssh:
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19051 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19052 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19053 You could elide it if you want to.
19054
19055 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19056 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19057 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19058 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19059
19060 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19061 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19062 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19063
19064 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19065 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19066
19067 @smallexample
19068 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19069 @end smallexample
19070
19071 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19072 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19073
19074 @pindex pidof
19075 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19076 @code{pidof} utility:
19077
19078 @smallexample
19079 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19080 @end smallexample
19081
19082 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19083 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19084 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19085
19086 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19087 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19088 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19089
19090 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19091 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19092 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19093 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19094
19095 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19096 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19097 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19098 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19099 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19100 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19101 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19102 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19103 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19104
19105 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19106 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19107 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19108 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19109 the program you want to debug.
19110
19111 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19112 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19113 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19114 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19115 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19116 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19117
19118 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19119
19120 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19121
19122 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19123 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19124 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19125 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19126 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19127 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19128 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19129 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19130
19131 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19132 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19133 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19134
19135 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19136 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19137 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19138 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19139 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19140 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19141 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19142 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19143 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19144 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19145 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19146 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19147
19148 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19149 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19150
19151 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19152 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19153 status information about the debugging process.
19154 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19155 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19156 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19157 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19158
19159 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19160 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19161 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19162 Possible options are:
19163
19164 @table @code
19165 @item none
19166 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19167 @item all
19168 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19169 @item timestamps
19170 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19171 @end table
19172
19173 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19174 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19175
19176 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19177 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19178 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19179 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19180 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19181
19182 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19183 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19184 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19185 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19186
19187 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19188 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19189 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19190 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19191
19192 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19193 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19194 environment:
19195
19196 @smallexample
19197 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19201
19202 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19203
19204 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19205 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19206 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19207 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19208
19209 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19210 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19211 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19212 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19213 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19214 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19215 programs.
19216
19217 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19218 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19219 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19220 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19221 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19222 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19223 already on the target.
19224
19225 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19226 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19227 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19228
19229 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19230 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19231 Here are the available commands.
19232
19233 @table @code
19234 @item monitor help
19235 List the available monitor commands.
19236
19237 @item monitor set debug 0
19238 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19239 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19240
19241 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19242 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19243 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19244 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19245
19246 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19247 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19248 Possible options are:
19249
19250 @table @code
19251 @item none
19252 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19253 @item all
19254 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19255 @item timestamps
19256 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19257 @end table
19258
19259 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19260 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19261
19262 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19263 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19264 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19265 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19266 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19267 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19268
19269 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19270 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19271
19272 @item monitor exit
19273 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19274 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19275 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19276 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19277 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19278
19279 @end table
19280
19281 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19282 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19283
19284 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19285 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19286
19287 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19288 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19289 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19290 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19291 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19292 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19293 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19294 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19295 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19296 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19297 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19298 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19299
19300 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19301
19302 @table @code
19303 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19304
19305 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19306 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19307 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19308
19309 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19310
19311 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19312 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19313 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19314 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19315 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19316 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19317
19318 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19319
19320 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19321 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19322 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19323 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19324 command for that. For example:
19325
19326 @smallexample
19327 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19328 @end smallexample
19329
19330 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19331 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19332 @end table
19333
19334 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19335 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19336 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19337 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19338 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19339 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19340 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19341 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19342 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19343 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19344
19345 @smallexample
19346 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19347 @end smallexample
19348
19349 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19350
19351 @smallexample
19352 $ gdb myprogram
19353 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19354 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19355 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19356 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19357 @end smallexample
19358
19359 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19360 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19361 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19362 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19363 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19364 tracing.
19365
19366 @node Remote Configuration
19367 @section Remote Configuration
19368
19369 @kindex set remote
19370 @kindex show remote
19371 This section documents the configuration options available when
19372 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19373 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19374 system-call-allowed}.
19375
19376 @table @code
19377 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19378 @cindex address size for remote targets
19379 @cindex bits in remote address
19380 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19381 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19382 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19383 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19384
19385 @item show remoteaddresssize
19386 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19387
19388 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19389 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19390 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19391 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19392 remote targets.
19393
19394 @item show serial baud
19395 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19396
19397 @item set remotebreak
19398 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19399 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19400 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19401 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19402 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19403 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19404 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19405 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19406
19407 @item show remotebreak
19408 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19409 interrupt the remote program.
19410
19411 @item set remoteflow on
19412 @itemx set remoteflow off
19413 @kindex set remoteflow
19414 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19415 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19416
19417 @item show remoteflow
19418 @kindex show remoteflow
19419 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19420
19421 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19422 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19423 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19424 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19425 @code{ascii}.
19426
19427 @item show remotelogbase
19428 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19429 protocol.
19430
19431 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19432 @cindex record serial communications on file
19433 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19434 default is not to record at all.
19435
19436 @item show remotelogfile.
19437 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19438 serial communications.
19439
19440 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19441 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19442 @cindex remote timeout
19443 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19444 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19445
19446 @item show remotetimeout
19447 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19448 responses.
19449
19450 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19451 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19452 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19453 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19454 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19455 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19456 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19457 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19458
19459 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19460 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19461 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19462 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19463 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19464 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19465 as unlimited.
19466
19467 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19468 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19469 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19470
19471 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19472 @itemx show remote exec-file
19473 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19474 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19475 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19476 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19477 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19478 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19479
19480 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19481 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19482 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19483 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19484 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19485 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19486 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19487 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19488 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19489 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19490
19491 @item show interrupt-sequence
19492 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19493 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19494 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19495 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19496
19497 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19498 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19499 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19500 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19501 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19502 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19503
19504 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19505 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19506 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19507
19508 @kindex set tcp
19509 @kindex show tcp
19510 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19511 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19512 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19513 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19514 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19515 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19516 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19517 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19518 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19519
19520 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19521 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19522
19523 @item show tcp auto-retry
19524 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19525
19526 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19527 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19528 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19529 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19530 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19531 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19532 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19533 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19534 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19535 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19536 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19537
19538 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19539 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19540 @end table
19541
19542 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19543 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19544 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19545 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19546 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19547 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19548 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19549 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19550 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19551
19552 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19553 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19554 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19555 @value{GDBN} developers.
19556
19557 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19558 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19559 are:
19560
19561 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19562 @item Command Name
19563 @tab Remote Packet
19564 @tab Related Features
19565
19566 @item @code{fetch-register}
19567 @tab @code{p}
19568 @tab @code{info registers}
19569
19570 @item @code{set-register}
19571 @tab @code{P}
19572 @tab @code{set}
19573
19574 @item @code{binary-download}
19575 @tab @code{X}
19576 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19577
19578 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19579 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19580 @tab @code{info auxv}
19581
19582 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19583 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19584 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19585
19586 @item @code{attach}
19587 @tab @code{vAttach}
19588 @tab @code{attach}
19589
19590 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19591 @tab @code{vCont}
19592 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19593
19594 @item @code{run}
19595 @tab @code{vRun}
19596 @tab @code{run}
19597
19598 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19599 @tab @code{Z0}
19600 @tab @code{break}
19601
19602 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19603 @tab @code{Z1}
19604 @tab @code{hbreak}
19605
19606 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19607 @tab @code{Z2}
19608 @tab @code{watch}
19609
19610 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19611 @tab @code{Z3}
19612 @tab @code{rwatch}
19613
19614 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19615 @tab @code{Z4}
19616 @tab @code{awatch}
19617
19618 @item @code{target-features}
19619 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19620 @tab @code{set architecture}
19621
19622 @item @code{library-info}
19623 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19624 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19625
19626 @item @code{memory-map}
19627 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19628 @tab @code{info mem}
19629
19630 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19631 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19632 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19633
19634 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19635 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19636 @tab @code{info spu}
19637
19638 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19639 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19640 @tab @code{info spu}
19641
19642 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19643 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19644 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19645
19646 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19647 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19648 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19649
19650 @item @code{threads}
19651 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19652 @tab @code{info threads}
19653
19654 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19655 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19656 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19657
19658 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19659 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19660 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19661
19662 @item @code{search-memory}
19663 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19664 @tab @code{find}
19665
19666 @item @code{supported-packets}
19667 @tab @code{qSupported}
19668 @tab Remote communications parameters
19669
19670 @item @code{pass-signals}
19671 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19672 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19673
19674 @item @code{program-signals}
19675 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19676 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19677
19678 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19679 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19680 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19681
19682 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19683 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19684 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19685
19686 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19687 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19688 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19689
19690 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19691 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19692 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19693
19694 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19695 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19696 @tab @code{remote delete}
19697
19698 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19699 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19700 @tab Host I/O
19701
19702 @item @code{noack-packet}
19703 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19704 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19705
19706 @item @code{osdata}
19707 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19708 @tab @code{info os}
19709
19710 @item @code{query-attached}
19711 @tab @code{qAttached}
19712 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19713
19714 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19715 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19716 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19717
19718 @item @code{trace-status}
19719 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19720 @tab @code{tstatus}
19721
19722 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19723 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19724 @tab Traceframe info
19725
19726 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19727 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19728 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19729
19730 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19731 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19732 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19733
19734 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19735 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19736 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19737 @end multitable
19738
19739 @node Remote Stub
19740 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19741
19742 @cindex debugging stub, example
19743 @cindex remote stub, example
19744 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19745 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19746 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19747 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19748 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19749 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19750 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19751 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19752
19753 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19754 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19755 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19756 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19757 program, you need:
19758
19759 @enumerate
19760 @item
19761 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19762 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19763 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19764
19765 @item
19766 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19767 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19768
19769 @item
19770 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19771 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19772 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19773 documentation.
19774 @end enumerate
19775
19776 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19777 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19778 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19779
19780 @table @emph
19781 @item On the host,
19782 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19783 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19784 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19785
19786 @item On the target,
19787 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19788 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19789 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19790
19791 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19792 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19793 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19794 @end table
19795
19796 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19797 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19798 @sc{sparc} boards.
19799
19800 @cindex remote serial stub list
19801 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19802
19803 @table @code
19804
19805 @item i386-stub.c
19806 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19807 @cindex Intel
19808 @cindex i386
19809 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19810
19811 @item m68k-stub.c
19812 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19813 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19814 @cindex m680x0
19815 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19816
19817 @item sh-stub.c
19818 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19819 @cindex Renesas
19820 @cindex SH
19821 For Renesas SH architectures.
19822
19823 @item sparc-stub.c
19824 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19825 @cindex Sparc
19826 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19827
19828 @item sparcl-stub.c
19829 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19830 @cindex Fujitsu
19831 @cindex SparcLite
19832 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19833
19834 @end table
19835
19836 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19837 recently added stubs.
19838
19839 @menu
19840 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19841 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19842 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19843 @end menu
19844
19845 @node Stub Contents
19846 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19847
19848 @cindex remote serial stub
19849 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19850 subroutines:
19851
19852 @table @code
19853 @item set_debug_traps
19854 @findex set_debug_traps
19855 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19856 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19857 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19858 program's startup code.
19859
19860 @item handle_exception
19861 @findex handle_exception
19862 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19863 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19864 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19865 run when a trap is triggered.
19866
19867 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19868 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19869 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19870 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19871 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19872 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19873 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19874 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19875 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19876 machine.
19877
19878 @item breakpoint
19879 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19880 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19881 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19882 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19883 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19884 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19885 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19886 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19887 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19888 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19889 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19890
19891 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19892 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19893 start of your debugging session.
19894 @end table
19895
19896 @node Bootstrapping
19897 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19898
19899 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19900 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19901 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19902 debugging target machine.
19903
19904 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19905 serial port.
19906
19907 @table @code
19908 @item int getDebugChar()
19909 @findex getDebugChar
19910 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19911 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19912 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19913
19914 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19915 @findex putDebugChar
19916 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19917 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19918 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19919 @end table
19920
19921 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19922 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19923 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19924 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19925 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19926 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19927 remote system to stop.
19928
19929 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19930 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19931 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19932 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19933
19934 Other routines you need to supply are:
19935
19936 @table @code
19937 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19938 @findex exceptionHandler
19939 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19940 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19941 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19942 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19943 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19944 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19945 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19946 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19947 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19948 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19949 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19950 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19951 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19952
19953 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19954 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19955 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19956 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19957 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19958
19959 @item void flush_i_cache()
19960 @findex flush_i_cache
19961 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19962 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19963 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19964
19965 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19966 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19967 @end table
19968
19969 @noindent
19970 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19971
19972 @table @code
19973 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19974 @findex memset
19975 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19976 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19977 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19978 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19979 @end table
19980
19981 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19982 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19983 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19984 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19985
19986
19987 @node Debug Session
19988 @subsection Putting it All Together
19989
19990 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19991 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19992 steps.
19993
19994 @enumerate
19995 @item
19996 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19997 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19998 @display
19999 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20000 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20001 @end display
20002
20003 @item
20004 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20005 procedure is called:
20006
20007 @smallexample
20008 set_debug_traps();
20009 breakpoint();
20010 @end smallexample
20011
20012 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20013 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20014 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20015 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20016 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20017 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20018 progress.
20019
20020 @item
20021 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20022 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20023
20024 @smallexample
20025 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 @noindent
20029 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20030 function in your program, that function is called when
20031 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20032 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20033 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20034
20035 @item
20036 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20037 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20038
20039 @item
20040 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20041 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20042
20043 @item
20044 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20045 @c document that. FIXME.
20046 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20047 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20048
20049 @item
20050 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20051 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20052
20053 @end enumerate
20054
20055 @node Configurations
20056 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20057
20058 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20059 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20060 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20061
20062 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20063 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20064 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20065 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20066 are quite different from each other.
20067
20068 @menu
20069 * Native::
20070 * Embedded OS::
20071 * Embedded Processors::
20072 * Architectures::
20073 @end menu
20074
20075 @node Native
20076 @section Native
20077
20078 This section describes details specific to particular native
20079 configurations.
20080
20081 @menu
20082 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20083 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20084 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20085 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20086 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20087 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20088 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20089 @end menu
20090
20091 @node HP-UX
20092 @subsection HP-UX
20093
20094 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20095 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20096 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20097
20098
20099 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20100 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20101
20102 @cindex libkvm
20103 @cindex kernel memory image
20104 @cindex kernel crash dump
20105
20106 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20107 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20108 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20109 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20110 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20111 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20112 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20113 @code{kvm} target:
20114
20115 @smallexample
20116 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20117 @end smallexample
20118
20119 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20120 argument:
20121
20122 @smallexample
20123 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20124 @end smallexample
20125
20126 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20127 available:
20128
20129 @table @code
20130 @kindex kvm
20131 @item kvm pcb
20132 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20133
20134 @item kvm proc
20135 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20136 modern FreeBSD systems.
20137 @end table
20138
20139 @node SVR4 Process Information
20140 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20141 @cindex /proc
20142 @cindex examine process image
20143 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20144
20145 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20146 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20147 process using file-system subroutines.
20148
20149 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20150 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20151 information about the process running your program, or about any
20152 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20153 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20154
20155 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20156 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20157
20158 @table @code
20159 @kindex info proc
20160 @cindex process ID
20161 @item info proc
20162 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20163 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20164 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20165 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20166 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20167 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20168 executable file's absolute file name.
20169
20170 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20171 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20172 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20173 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20174 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20175 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20176
20177 @item info proc cmdline
20178 @cindex info proc cmdline
20179 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20180 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20181
20182 @item info proc cwd
20183 @cindex info proc cwd
20184 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20185 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20186
20187 @item info proc exe
20188 @cindex info proc exe
20189 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20190 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20191
20192 @item info proc mappings
20193 @cindex memory address space mappings
20194 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20195 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20196 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20197 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20198 memory access rights to that range.
20199
20200 @item info proc stat
20201 @itemx info proc status
20202 @cindex process detailed status information
20203 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20204 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20205 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20206 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20207 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20208 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20209 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20210
20211 @item info proc all
20212 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20213 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20214
20215 @ignore
20216 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20217 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20218 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20219 @kindex info proc times
20220 @item info proc times
20221 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20222 its children.
20223
20224 @kindex info proc id
20225 @item info proc id
20226 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20227 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20228 @end ignore
20229
20230 @item set procfs-trace
20231 @kindex set procfs-trace
20232 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20233 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20234
20235 @item show procfs-trace
20236 @kindex show procfs-trace
20237 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20238
20239 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20240 @kindex set procfs-file
20241 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20242 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20243 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20244 standard output.
20245
20246 @item show procfs-file
20247 @kindex show procfs-file
20248 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20249
20250 @item proc-trace-entry
20251 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20252 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20253 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20254 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20255 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20256 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20257 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20258 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20259 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20260
20261 @item info pidlist
20262 @kindex info pidlist
20263 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20264 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20265 processes and all the threads within each process.
20266
20267 @item info meminfo
20268 @kindex info meminfo
20269 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20270 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20271 @end table
20272
20273 @node DJGPP Native
20274 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20275 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20276 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20277 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20278
20279 @cindex DPMI
20280 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20281 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20282 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20283 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20284
20285 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20286 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20287 subsection describes those commands.
20288
20289 @table @code
20290 @kindex info dos
20291 @item info dos
20292 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20293 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20294
20295 @kindex sysinfo
20296 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20297 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20298 @item info dos sysinfo
20299 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20300 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20301 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20302
20303 @cindex GDT
20304 @cindex LDT
20305 @cindex IDT
20306 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20307 @cindex descriptor tables display
20308 @item info dos gdt
20309 @itemx info dos ldt
20310 @itemx info dos idt
20311 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20312 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20313 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20314 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20315 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20316 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20317 rights.
20318
20319 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20320 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20321 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20322 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20323 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20324
20325 @cindex garbled pointers
20326 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20327 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20328 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20329 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20330 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20331 debugged program's data segment:
20332
20333 @smallexample
20334 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20335 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20336 @end smallexample
20337
20338 @noindent
20339 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20340 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20341
20342 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20343 @item info dos pde
20344 @itemx info dos pte
20345 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20346 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20347 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20348 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20349 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20350 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20351 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20352 that is currently in use.
20353
20354 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20355 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20356 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20357 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20358 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20359 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20360 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20361
20362 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20363 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20364 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20365 controller.
20366
20367 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20368
20369 @cindex physical address from linear address
20370 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20371 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20372 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20373 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20374 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20375 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20376 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20377
20378 @smallexample
20379 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20380 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20381 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20382 @end smallexample
20383
20384 @noindent
20385 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20386 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20387 attributes of that page.
20388
20389 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20390 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20391 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20392 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20393 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20394 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20395
20396 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20397 transfer buffer:
20398
20399 @smallexample
20400 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20401 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20402 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20403 @end smallexample
20404
20405 @noindent
20406 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20407 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20408 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20409 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20410 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20411
20412 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20413 @end table
20414
20415 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20416 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20417 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20418 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20419
20420 @table @code
20421 @kindex set com1base
20422 @kindex set com1irq
20423 @kindex set com2base
20424 @kindex set com2irq
20425 @kindex set com3base
20426 @kindex set com3irq
20427 @kindex set com4base
20428 @kindex set com4irq
20429 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20430 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20431 port.
20432
20433 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20434 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20435 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20436
20437 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20438 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20439 other 3 COM ports.
20440
20441 @kindex show com1base
20442 @kindex show com1irq
20443 @kindex show com2base
20444 @kindex show com2irq
20445 @kindex show com3base
20446 @kindex show com3irq
20447 @kindex show com4base
20448 @kindex show com4irq
20449 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20450 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20451 lines used by the COM ports.
20452
20453 @item info serial
20454 @kindex info serial
20455 @cindex DOS serial port status
20456 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20457 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20458 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20459 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20460 @end table
20461
20462
20463 @node Cygwin Native
20464 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20465 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20466 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20467 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20468
20469 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20470 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20471
20472 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20473 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20474 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20475 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20476 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20477 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20478 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20479 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20480
20481 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20482 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20483 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20484
20485 @table @code
20486 @kindex info w32
20487 @item info w32
20488 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20489 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20490
20491 @item info w32 selector
20492 This command displays information returned by
20493 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20494 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20495 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20496 Without argument, this command displays information
20497 about the six segment registers.
20498
20499 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20500 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20501 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20502 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20503
20504 @kindex info dll
20505 @item info dll
20506 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20507
20508 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20509 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20510 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20511 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20512 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20513 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20514 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20515 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20516 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20517 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20518 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20519
20520 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20521 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20522 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20523 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20524
20525 @kindex set new-console
20526 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20527 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20528 be started in a new console on next start.
20529 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20530 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20531
20532 @kindex show new-console
20533 @item show new-console
20534 Displays whether a new console is used
20535 when the debuggee is started.
20536
20537 @kindex set new-group
20538 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20539 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20540 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20541 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20542 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20543
20544 @kindex show new-group
20545 @item show new-group
20546 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20547
20548 @kindex set debugevents
20549 @item set debugevents
20550 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20551 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20552 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20553 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20554 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20555
20556 @kindex set debugexec
20557 @item set debugexec
20558 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20559 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20560
20561 @kindex set debugexceptions
20562 @item set debugexceptions
20563 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20564 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20565
20566 @kindex set debugmemory
20567 @item set debugmemory
20568 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20569 and writes by the debugger.
20570
20571 @kindex set shell
20572 @item set shell
20573 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20574 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20575
20576 @kindex show shell
20577 @item show shell
20578 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20579
20580 @end table
20581
20582 @menu
20583 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20584 @end menu
20585
20586 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20587 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20588 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20589 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20590
20591 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20592 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20593 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20594 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20595 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20596 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20597 ``minimal symbols''.
20598
20599 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20600 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20601 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20602 program run once to completion.
20603
20604 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20605
20606 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20607 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20608 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20609 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20610 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20611 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20612 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20613 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20614 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20615
20616 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20617 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20618 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20619 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20620 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20621 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20622
20623 @smallexample
20624 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20625 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20626
20627 Non-debugging symbols:
20628 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20629 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20630 @end smallexample
20631
20632 @smallexample
20633 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20634 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20635
20636 Non-debugging symbols:
20637 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20638 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20639 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20640 [etc...]
20641 @end smallexample
20642
20643 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20644
20645 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20646 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20647 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20648 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20649 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20650 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20651 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20652
20653 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20654 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20655 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20656 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20657 problem:
20658
20659 @smallexample
20660 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20661 $1 = 268572168
20662 @end smallexample
20663
20664 @smallexample
20665 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20666 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20667 @end smallexample
20668
20669 And two possible solutions:
20670
20671 @smallexample
20672 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20673 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20674 @end smallexample
20675
20676 @smallexample
20677 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20678 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20679 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20680 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20681 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20682 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20683 @end smallexample
20684
20685 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20686 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20687 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20688 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20689 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20690
20691 @smallexample
20692 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20693 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20694 @end smallexample
20695
20696 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20697 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20698 safe.
20699
20700 @node Hurd Native
20701 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20702 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20703
20704 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20705 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20706
20707 @table @code
20708 @item set signals
20709 @itemx set sigs
20710 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20711 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20712 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20713 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20714 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20715 @code{signals}.
20716
20717 @item show signals
20718 @itemx show sigs
20719 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20720 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20721 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20722
20723 @item set signal-thread
20724 @itemx set sigthread
20725 @kindex set signal-thread
20726 @kindex set sigthread
20727 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20728 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20729 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20730 signal-thread}.
20731
20732 @item show signal-thread
20733 @itemx show sigthread
20734 @kindex show signal-thread
20735 @kindex show sigthread
20736 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20737 delivered a signal.
20738
20739 @item set stopped
20740 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20741 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20742 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20743 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20744
20745 @item show stopped
20746 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20747 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20748 stopped.
20749
20750 @item set exceptions
20751 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20752 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20753 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20754 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20755 trapping on.
20756
20757 @item show exceptions
20758 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20759 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20760
20761 @item set task pause
20762 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20763 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20764 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20765 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20766 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20767 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20768 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20769 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20770 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20771
20772 @item show task pause
20773 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20774 Show the current state of task suspension.
20775
20776 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20777 @cindex task suspend count
20778 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20779 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20780 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20781
20782 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20783 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20784
20785 @item set task exception-port
20786 @itemx set task excp
20787 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20788 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20789 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20790 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20791
20792 @item set noninvasive
20793 @cindex noninvasive task options
20794 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20795 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20796 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20797 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20798
20799 @item info send-rights
20800 @itemx info receive-rights
20801 @itemx info port-rights
20802 @itemx info port-sets
20803 @itemx info dead-names
20804 @itemx info ports
20805 @itemx info psets
20806 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20807 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20808 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20809 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20810 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20811 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20812 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20813 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20814 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20815
20816 @item set thread pause
20817 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20818 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20819 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20820 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20821 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20822 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20823 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20824 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20825 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20826 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20827 only the current thread.
20828
20829 @item show thread pause
20830 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20831 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20832
20833 @item set thread run
20834 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20835
20836 @item show thread run
20837 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20838
20839 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20840 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20841 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20842 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20843 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20844 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20845 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20846
20847 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20848 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20849 detaching.
20850
20851 @item set thread exception-port
20852 @itemx set thread excp
20853 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20854 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20855 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20856
20857 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20858 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20859 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20860 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20861
20862 @item set thread default
20863 @itemx show thread default
20864 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20865 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20866 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20867 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20868 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20869 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20870 the non-default commands.
20871 @end table
20872
20873 @node Darwin
20874 @subsection Darwin
20875 @cindex Darwin
20876
20877 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20878
20879 @table @code
20880 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20881 @kindex set debug darwin
20882 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20883 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20884
20885 @item show debug darwin
20886 @kindex show debug darwin
20887 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20888
20889 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20890 @kindex set debug mach-o
20891 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20892 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20893 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20894 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20895 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20896 usage.
20897
20898 @item show debug mach-o
20899 @kindex show debug mach-o
20900 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20901
20902 @item set mach-exceptions on
20903 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20904 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20905 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20906 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20907 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20908 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20909
20910 @item show mach-exceptions
20911 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20912 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20913 @end table
20914
20915
20916 @node Embedded OS
20917 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20918
20919 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20920 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20921 architectures.
20922
20923 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20924 various real-time operating systems.
20925
20926 @node Embedded Processors
20927 @section Embedded Processors
20928
20929 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20930 configurations.
20931
20932 @cindex send command to simulator
20933 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20934 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20935
20936 @table @code
20937 @item sim @var{command}
20938 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20939 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20940 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20941 acceptable commands.
20942 @end table
20943
20944
20945 @menu
20946 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20947 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20948 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20949 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20950 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20951 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20952 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20953 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20954 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20955 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20956 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20957 * CRIS:: CRIS
20958 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20959 @end menu
20960
20961 @node ARM
20962 @subsection ARM
20963 @cindex ARM RDI
20964
20965 @table @code
20966 @kindex target rdi
20967 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20968 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20969 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20970 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20971
20972 @kindex target rdp
20973 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20974 ARM Demon monitor.
20975
20976 @end table
20977
20978 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20979
20980 @table @code
20981 @item set arm disassembler
20982 @kindex set arm
20983 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20984 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20985
20986 @item show arm disassembler
20987 @kindex show arm
20988 Show the current disassembly style.
20989
20990 @item set arm apcs32
20991 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20992 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20993
20994 @item show arm apcs32
20995 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20996
20997 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20998 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20999 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21000
21001 @table @code
21002 @item auto
21003 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21004 @item softfpa
21005 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21006 processors.
21007 @item fpa
21008 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21009 @item softvfp
21010 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21011 @item vfp
21012 VFP co-processor.
21013 @end table
21014
21015 @item show arm fpu
21016 Show the current type of the FPU.
21017
21018 @item set arm abi
21019 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21020
21021 @item show arm abi
21022 Show the currently used ABI.
21023
21024 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21025 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21026 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21027 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21028 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21029 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21030 register).
21031
21032 @item show arm fallback-mode
21033 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21034
21035 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21036 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21037 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21038 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21039 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21040
21041 @item show arm force-mode
21042 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21043
21044 @item set debug arm
21045 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21046 target support subsystem.
21047
21048 @item show debug arm
21049 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21050 @end table
21051
21052 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21053 using the RDI interface:
21054
21055 @table @code
21056 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21057 @kindex rdilogfile
21058 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21059 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21060 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21061 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21062 @file{rdi.log}.
21063
21064 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21065 @kindex rdilogenable
21066 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21067 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21068 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21069 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21070 are logged to a file.
21071
21072 @item set rdiromatzero
21073 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21074 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21075 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21076 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21077 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21078 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21079
21080 @item show rdiromatzero
21081 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21082 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21083
21084 @item set rdiheartbeat
21085 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21086 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21087 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21088 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21089 well as the Angel monitor.
21090
21091 @item show rdiheartbeat
21092 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21093 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21094 @end table
21095
21096 @table @code
21097 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21098 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21099
21100 @table @code
21101 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21102 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21103 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21104 The default value is @code{all}.
21105
21106 @table @code
21107 @item none
21108 @item demon
21109 @item angel
21110 @item redboot
21111 @item all
21112 @end table
21113 @end table
21114 @end table
21115
21116 @node M32R/D
21117 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21118
21119 @table @code
21120 @kindex target m32r
21121 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21122 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21123
21124 @kindex target m32rsdi
21125 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21126 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21127 @end table
21128
21129 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21130
21131 @table @code
21132 @item set download-path @var{path}
21133 @kindex set download-path
21134 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21135 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21136
21137 @item show download-path
21138 @kindex show download-path
21139 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21140
21141 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21142 @kindex set board-address
21143 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21144 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21145
21146 @item show board-address
21147 @kindex show board-address
21148 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21149
21150 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21151 @kindex set server-address
21152 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21153 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21154 host machine.
21155
21156 @item show server-address
21157 @kindex show server-address
21158 Display the IP address of the download server.
21159
21160 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21161 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21162 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21163 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21164 executable file is uploaded.
21165
21166 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21167 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21168 Test the @code{upload} command.
21169 @end table
21170
21171 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21172
21173 @table @code
21174 @item sdireset
21175 @kindex sdireset
21176 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21177 This command resets the SDI connection.
21178
21179 @item sdistatus
21180 @kindex sdistatus
21181 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21182
21183 @item debug_chaos
21184 @kindex debug_chaos
21185 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21186 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21187
21188 @item use_debug_dma
21189 @kindex use_debug_dma
21190 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21191
21192 @item use_mon_code
21193 @kindex use_mon_code
21194 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21195
21196 @item use_ib_break
21197 @kindex use_ib_break
21198 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21199
21200 @item use_dbt_break
21201 @kindex use_dbt_break
21202 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21203 @end table
21204
21205 @node M68K
21206 @subsection M68k
21207
21208 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21209 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21210
21211 @table @code
21212
21213 @kindex target dbug
21214 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21215 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21216
21217 @end table
21218
21219 @node MicroBlaze
21220 @subsection MicroBlaze
21221 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21222 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21223
21224 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21225 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21226 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21227 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21228 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21229 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21230 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21231 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21232 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21233 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21234 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21235
21236 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21237
21238 @table @code
21239 @item target remote :1234
21240 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21241 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21242
21243 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21244 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21245 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21246
21247 @item load
21248 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21249
21250 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21251 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21252
21253 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21254 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21255 @end table
21256
21257 @node MIPS Embedded
21258 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21259
21260 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21261 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21262 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21263 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21264
21265 @need 1000
21266 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21267
21268 @table @code
21269 @item target mips @var{port}
21270 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21271 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21272 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21273 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21274 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21275 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21276 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21277
21278 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21279 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21280 debugger:
21281
21282 @smallexample
21283 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21284 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21285 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21286 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21287 (@value{GDBP}) run
21288 @end smallexample
21289
21290 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21291 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21292 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21293 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21294 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21295
21296 @item target pmon @var{port}
21297 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21298 PMON ROM monitor.
21299
21300 @item target ddb @var{port}
21301 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21302 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21303
21304 @item target lsi @var{port}
21305 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21306 LSI variant of PMON.
21307
21308 @kindex target r3900
21309 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21310 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21311
21312 @kindex target array
21313 @item target array @var{dev}
21314 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21315
21316 @end table
21317
21318
21319 @noindent
21320 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21321
21322 @table @code
21323 @item set mipsfpu double
21324 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21325 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21326 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21327 @itemx show mipsfpu
21328 @kindex set mipsfpu
21329 @kindex show mipsfpu
21330 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21331 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21332 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21333 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21334 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21335 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21336 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21337 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21338 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21339 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21340 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21341 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21342 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21343
21344 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21345 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21346 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21347
21348 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21349 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21350
21351 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21352 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21353 @itemx show timeout
21354 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21355 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21356 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21357 @kindex set timeout
21358 @kindex show timeout
21359 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21360 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21361 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21362 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21363 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21364 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21365 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21366 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21367 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21368 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21369
21370 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21371 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21372 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21373 to run before stopping.
21374
21375 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21376 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21377 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21378 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21379 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21380 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21381
21382 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21383 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21384 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21385 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21386
21387 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21388 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21389 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21390 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21391 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21392 @table @asis
21393 @item pmon target
21394 @samp{PMON}
21395 @item ddb target
21396 @samp{NEC010}
21397 @item lsi target
21398 @samp{PMON>}
21399 @end table
21400
21401 @item show monitor-prompt
21402 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21403 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21404 remote monitor.
21405
21406 @item set monitor-warnings
21407 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21408 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21409 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21410 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21411 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21412
21413 @item show monitor-warnings
21414 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21415 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21416
21417 @item pmon @var{command}
21418 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21419 @cindex send PMON command
21420 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21421 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21422 @end table
21423
21424 @node PowerPC Embedded
21425 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21426
21427 @cindex DVC register
21428 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21429 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21430
21431 @smallexample
21432 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21433 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21434 @end smallexample
21435
21436 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21437 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21438 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21439 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21440 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21441 or newer.
21442
21443 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21444 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21445 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21446 watching variables of scalar types.
21447
21448 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21449 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21450
21451 @smallexample
21452 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21453 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21454 @end smallexample
21455
21456 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21457 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21458
21459 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21460 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21461 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21462 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21463 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21464 use the @code{break-range} command.
21465
21466 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21467
21468 @table @code
21469 @kindex break-range
21470 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21471 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21472 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21473 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21474 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21475 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21476 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21477 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21478 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21479
21480 @kindex set powerpc
21481 @item set powerpc soft-float
21482 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21483 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21484 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21485 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21486
21487 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21488 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21489 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21490 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21491 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21492 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21493 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21494 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21495
21496 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21497 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21498 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21499 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21500 address of its first byte.
21501
21502 @kindex target dink32
21503 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21504 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21505
21506 @kindex target ppcbug
21507 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21508 @kindex target ppcbug1
21509 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21510 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21511
21512 @kindex target sds
21513 @item target sds @var{dev}
21514 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21515 @end table
21516
21517 @cindex SDS protocol
21518 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21519 by @value{GDBN}:
21520
21521 @table @code
21522 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21523 @kindex set sdstimeout
21524 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21525 default is 2 seconds.
21526
21527 @item show sdstimeout
21528 @kindex show sdstimeout
21529 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21530
21531 @item sds @var{command}
21532 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21533 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21534 @end table
21535
21536
21537 @node PA
21538 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21539
21540 @table @code
21541
21542 @kindex target op50n
21543 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21544 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21545
21546 @kindex target w89k
21547 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21548 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21549
21550 @end table
21551
21552 @node Sparclet
21553 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21554
21555 @cindex Sparclet
21556
21557 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21558 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21559 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21560 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21561 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21562
21563 @table @code
21564 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21565 @kindex remotetimeout
21566 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21567 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21568 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21569 @end table
21570
21571 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21572 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21573 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21574 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21575 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21576
21577 @smallexample
21578 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21579 @end smallexample
21580
21581 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21582
21583 @smallexample
21584 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21585 @end smallexample
21586
21587 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21588 Once you have set
21589 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21590 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21591 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21592
21593 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21594
21595 @smallexample
21596 (gdbslet)
21597 @end smallexample
21598
21599 @menu
21600 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21601 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21602 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21603 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21604 @end menu
21605
21606 @node Sparclet File
21607 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21608
21609 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21610
21611 @smallexample
21612 (gdbslet) file prog
21613 @end smallexample
21614
21615 @need 1000
21616 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21617 @value{GDBN} locates
21618 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21619 path.
21620 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21621 files will be searched as well.
21622 @value{GDBN} locates
21623 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21624 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21625 If it fails
21626 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21627
21628 @smallexample
21629 prog: No such file or directory.
21630 @end smallexample
21631
21632 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21633 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21634 @code{target} command again.
21635
21636 @node Sparclet Connection
21637 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21638
21639 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21640 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21641
21642 @smallexample
21643 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21644 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21645 main () at ../prog.c:3
21646 @end smallexample
21647
21648 @need 750
21649 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21650
21651 @smallexample
21652 Connected to ttya.
21653 @end smallexample
21654
21655 @node Sparclet Download
21656 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21657
21658 @cindex download to Sparclet
21659 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21660 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21661 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21662 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21663 command.
21664 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21665 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21666 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21667 of each of the file's sections.
21668 For instance, if the program
21669 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21670 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21671
21672 @smallexample
21673 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21674 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21675 @end smallexample
21676
21677 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21678 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21679 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21680
21681 @node Sparclet Execution
21682 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21683
21684 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21685 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21686 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21687 manual for the list of commands.
21688
21689 @smallexample
21690 (gdbslet) b main
21691 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21692 (gdbslet) run
21693 Starting program: prog
21694 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21695 3 char *symarg = 0;
21696 (gdbslet) step
21697 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21698 (gdbslet)
21699 @end smallexample
21700
21701 @node Sparclite
21702 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21703
21704 @table @code
21705
21706 @kindex target sparclite
21707 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21708 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21709 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21710 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21711 remote protocol.
21712
21713 @end table
21714
21715 @node Z8000
21716 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21717
21718 @cindex Z8000
21719 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21720 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21721
21722 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21723 a Z8000 simulator.
21724
21725 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21726 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21727 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21728 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21729
21730 @table @code
21731 @item target sim @var{args}
21732 @kindex sim
21733 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21734 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21735 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21736 @end table
21737
21738 @noindent
21739 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21740 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21741 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21742 to run your program, and so on.
21743
21744 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21745 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21746 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21747
21748 @table @code
21749
21750 @item cycles
21751 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21752
21753 @item insts
21754 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21755
21756 @item time
21757 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21758
21759 @end table
21760
21761 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21762 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21763 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21764 simulated clock ticks.
21765
21766 @node AVR
21767 @subsection Atmel AVR
21768 @cindex AVR
21769
21770 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21771 following AVR-specific commands:
21772
21773 @table @code
21774 @item info io_registers
21775 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21776 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21777 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21778 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21779 @end table
21780
21781 @node CRIS
21782 @subsection CRIS
21783 @cindex CRIS
21784
21785 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21786 following CRIS-specific commands:
21787
21788 @table @code
21789 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21790 @cindex CRIS version
21791 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21792 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21793 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21794
21795 @item show cris-version
21796 Show the current CRIS version.
21797
21798 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21799 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21800 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21801 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21802 @code{R59}.
21803
21804 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21805 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21806
21807 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21808 @cindex CRIS mode
21809 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21810 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21811 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21812
21813 @item show cris-mode
21814 Show the current CRIS mode.
21815 @end table
21816
21817 @node Super-H
21818 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21819 @cindex Super-H
21820
21821 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21822 commands:
21823
21824 @table @code
21825 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21826 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21827 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21828 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21829 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21830 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21831 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21832 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21833 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21834 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21835 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21836 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21837
21838 @item show sh calling-convention
21839 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21840 Show the current calling convention setting.
21841
21842 @end table
21843
21844
21845 @node Architectures
21846 @section Architectures
21847
21848 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21849 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21850
21851 @menu
21852 * AArch64::
21853 * i386::
21854 * Alpha::
21855 * MIPS::
21856 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21857 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21858 * PowerPC::
21859 * Nios II::
21860 @end menu
21861
21862 @node AArch64
21863 @subsection AArch64
21864 @cindex AArch64 support
21865
21866 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21867 following special commands:
21868
21869 @table @code
21870 @item set debug aarch64
21871 @kindex set debug aarch64
21872 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21873 messages are to be displayed.
21874
21875 @item show debug aarch64
21876 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21877
21878 @end table
21879
21880 @node i386
21881 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21882
21883 @table @code
21884 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21885 @kindex set struct-convention
21886 @cindex struct return convention
21887 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21888 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21889 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21890 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21891 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21892 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21893 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21894 be returned in a register.
21895
21896 @item show struct-convention
21897 @kindex show struct-convention
21898 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21899 from functions.
21900 @end table
21901
21902 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21903 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21904
21905 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21906 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21907 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21908 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21909 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21910 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21911 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21912
21913 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21914 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21915 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21916 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21917 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21918 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21919
21920 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21921 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21922 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21923
21924 @smallexample
21925 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21926 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21927 @end smallexample
21928
21929 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21930 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21931 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21932 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21933 the pointer.
21934
21935 @node Alpha
21936 @subsection Alpha
21937
21938 See the following section.
21939
21940 @node MIPS
21941 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21942
21943 @cindex stack on Alpha
21944 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21945 @cindex Alpha stack
21946 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21947 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21948 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21949 find the beginning of a function.
21950
21951 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21952 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21953 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21954 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21955 commands:
21956
21957 @table @code
21958 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21959 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21960 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21961 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21962 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21963 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21964 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21965 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21966
21967 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21968 Display the current limit.
21969 @end table
21970
21971 @noindent
21972 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21973 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21974
21975 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21976 programs:
21977
21978 @table @code
21979 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21980 @kindex set mips abi
21981 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21982 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21983 values of @var{arg} are:
21984
21985 @table @samp
21986 @item auto
21987 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21988 default).
21989 @item o32
21990 @item o64
21991 @item n32
21992 @item n64
21993 @item eabi32
21994 @item eabi64
21995 @end table
21996
21997 @item show mips abi
21998 @kindex show mips abi
21999 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22000
22001 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22002 @kindex set mips compression
22003 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22004 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22005 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22006 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22007 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22008 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22009 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22010 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22011 provided by the executable.
22012
22013 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22014 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22015 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22016 identified as such.
22017
22018 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22019 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22020 implicitly from an executable.
22021
22022 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22023 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22024 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22025 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22026 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22027
22028 @item show mips compression
22029 @kindex show mips compression
22030 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22031 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22032
22033 @item set mipsfpu
22034 @itemx show mipsfpu
22035 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22036
22037 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22038 @kindex set mips mask-address
22039 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22040 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22041 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22042 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22043 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22044
22045 @item show mips mask-address
22046 @kindex show mips mask-address
22047 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22048 not.
22049
22050 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22051 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22052 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22053 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22054 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22055 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22056
22057 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22058 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22059 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22060
22061 @item set debug mips
22062 @kindex set debug mips
22063 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22064 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22065
22066 @item show debug mips
22067 @kindex show debug mips
22068 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22069 @end table
22070
22071
22072 @node HPPA
22073 @subsection HPPA
22074 @cindex HPPA support
22075
22076 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22077 following special commands:
22078
22079 @table @code
22080 @item set debug hppa
22081 @kindex set debug hppa
22082 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22083 messages are to be displayed.
22084
22085 @item show debug hppa
22086 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22087
22088 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22089 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22090 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22091 given @var{address}.
22092
22093 @end table
22094
22095
22096 @node SPU
22097 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22098 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22099 @cindex SPU
22100
22101 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22102 it provides the following special commands:
22103
22104 @table @code
22105 @item info spu event
22106 @kindex info spu
22107 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22108 and pending event status.
22109
22110 @item info spu signal
22111 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22112 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22113 notification channels.
22114
22115 @item info spu mailbox
22116 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22117 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22118 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22119
22120 @item info spu dma
22121 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22122 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22123 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22124
22125 @item info spu proxydma
22126 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22127 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22128 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22129
22130 @end table
22131
22132 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22133 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22134 special commands:
22135
22136 @table @code
22137 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22138 @kindex set spu
22139 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22140 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22141 function. The default is @code{off}.
22142
22143 @item show spu stop-on-load
22144 @kindex show spu
22145 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22146
22147 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22148 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22149 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22150 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22151 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22152 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22153
22154 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22155 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22156
22157 @end table
22158
22159 @node PowerPC
22160 @subsection PowerPC
22161 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22162
22163 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22164 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22165 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22166 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22167 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22168
22169 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22170 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22171 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22172
22173 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22174 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22175
22176 @node Nios II
22177 @subsection Nios II
22178 @cindex Nios II architecture
22179
22180 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22181 it provides the following special commands:
22182
22183 @table @code
22184
22185 @item set debug nios2
22186 @kindex set debug nios2
22187 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22188 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22189
22190 @item show debug nios2
22191 @kindex show debug nios2
22192 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22193 @end table
22194
22195 @node Controlling GDB
22196 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22197
22198 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22199 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22200 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22201 described here.
22202
22203 @menu
22204 * Prompt:: Prompt
22205 * Editing:: Command editing
22206 * Command History:: Command history
22207 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22208 * Numbers:: Numbers
22209 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22210 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22211 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22212 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22213 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22214 @end menu
22215
22216 @node Prompt
22217 @section Prompt
22218
22219 @cindex prompt
22220
22221 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22222 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22223 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22224 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22225 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22226 which one you are talking to.
22227
22228 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22229 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22230 or a prompt that does not.
22231
22232 @table @code
22233 @kindex set prompt
22234 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22235 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22236
22237 @kindex show prompt
22238 @item show prompt
22239 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22240 @end table
22241
22242 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22243 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22244 are:
22245
22246 @table @code
22247 @kindex set extended-prompt
22248 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22249 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22250 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22251 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22252 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22253 is displayed.
22254
22255 For example:
22256
22257 @smallexample
22258 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22259 @end smallexample
22260
22261 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22262 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22263
22264 @kindex show extended-prompt
22265 @item show extended-prompt
22266 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22267 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22268 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22269 @end table
22270
22271 @node Editing
22272 @section Command Editing
22273 @cindex readline
22274 @cindex command line editing
22275
22276 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22277 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22278 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22279 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22280 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22281 debugging sessions.
22282
22283 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22284 command @code{set}.
22285
22286 @table @code
22287 @kindex set editing
22288 @cindex editing
22289 @item set editing
22290 @itemx set editing on
22291 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22292
22293 @item set editing off
22294 Disable command line editing.
22295
22296 @kindex show editing
22297 @item show editing
22298 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22299 @end table
22300
22301 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22302 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22303 @end ifset
22304 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22305 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22306 @end ifclear
22307 for more details about the Readline
22308 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22309 encouraged to read that chapter.
22310
22311 @node Command History
22312 @section Command History
22313 @cindex command history
22314
22315 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22316 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22317 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22318 history facility.
22319
22320 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22321 package, to provide the history facility.
22322 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22323 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22324 @end ifset
22325 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22326 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22327 @end ifclear
22328 for the detailed description of the History library.
22329
22330 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22331 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22332 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22333 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22334 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22335 pressed on a line by itself.
22336
22337 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22338 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22339 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22340 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22341
22342 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22343 history.
22344
22345 @table @code
22346 @cindex history substitution
22347 @cindex history file
22348 @kindex set history filename
22349 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22350 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22351 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22352 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22353 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22354 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22355 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22356 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22357 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22358 is not set.
22359
22360 @cindex save command history
22361 @kindex set history save
22362 @item set history save
22363 @itemx set history save on
22364 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22365 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22366
22367 @item set history save off
22368 Stop recording command history in a file.
22369
22370 @cindex history size
22371 @kindex set history size
22372 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22373 @item set history size @var{size}
22374 @itemx set history size unlimited
22375 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22376 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22377 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22378 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22379 history list is unlimited.
22380 @end table
22381
22382 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22383 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22384 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22385 @end ifset
22386 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22387 @xref{Event Designators},
22388 @end ifclear
22389 for more details.
22390
22391 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22392 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22393 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22394 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22395 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22396 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22397 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22398 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22399
22400 The commands to control history expansion are:
22401
22402 @table @code
22403 @item set history expansion on
22404 @itemx set history expansion
22405 @kindex set history expansion
22406 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22407
22408 @item set history expansion off
22409 Disable history expansion.
22410
22411 @c @group
22412 @kindex show history
22413 @item show history
22414 @itemx show history filename
22415 @itemx show history save
22416 @itemx show history size
22417 @itemx show history expansion
22418 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22419 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22420 @c @end group
22421 @end table
22422
22423 @table @code
22424 @kindex show commands
22425 @cindex show last commands
22426 @cindex display command history
22427 @item show commands
22428 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22429
22430 @item show commands @var{n}
22431 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22432
22433 @item show commands +
22434 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22435 @end table
22436
22437 @node Screen Size
22438 @section Screen Size
22439 @cindex size of screen
22440 @cindex screen size
22441 @cindex pagination
22442 @cindex page size
22443 @cindex pauses in output
22444
22445 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22446 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22447 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22448 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22449 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22450 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22451 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22452 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22453
22454 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22455 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22456 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22457 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22458 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22459 width} commands:
22460
22461 @table @code
22462 @kindex set height
22463 @kindex set width
22464 @kindex show width
22465 @kindex show height
22466 @item set height @var{lpp}
22467 @itemx set height unlimited
22468 @itemx show height
22469 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22470 @itemx set width unlimited
22471 @itemx show width
22472 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22473 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22474 commands display the current settings.
22475
22476 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22477 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22478 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22479 buffer.
22480
22481 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22482 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22483
22484 @item set pagination on
22485 @itemx set pagination off
22486 @kindex set pagination
22487 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22488 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22489 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22490 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22491
22492 @item show pagination
22493 @kindex show pagination
22494 Show the current pagination mode.
22495 @end table
22496
22497 @node Numbers
22498 @section Numbers
22499 @cindex number representation
22500 @cindex entering numbers
22501
22502 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22503 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22504 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22505 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22506 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22507 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22508 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22509 both input and output with the commands described below.
22510
22511 @table @code
22512 @kindex set input-radix
22513 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22514 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22515 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22516 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22517 example, any of
22518
22519 @smallexample
22520 set input-radix 012
22521 set input-radix 10.
22522 set input-radix 0xa
22523 @end smallexample
22524
22525 @noindent
22526 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22527 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22528 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22529 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22530 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22531 change the radix.
22532
22533 @kindex set output-radix
22534 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22535 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22536 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22537 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22538
22539 @kindex show input-radix
22540 @item show input-radix
22541 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22542
22543 @kindex show output-radix
22544 @item show output-radix
22545 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22546
22547 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22548 @itemx show radix
22549 @kindex set radix
22550 @kindex show radix
22551 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22552 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22553 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22554 default value of 10.
22555
22556 @end table
22557
22558 @node ABI
22559 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22560
22561 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22562 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22563 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22564 current ABI.
22565
22566 @cindex OS ABI
22567 @kindex set osabi
22568 @kindex show osabi
22569 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22570
22571 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22572 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22573 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22574 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22575 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22576 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22577 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22578 platform provides.
22579
22580 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22581 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22582 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22583 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22584
22585 @table @code
22586 @item show osabi
22587 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22588
22589 @item set osabi
22590 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22591
22592 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22593 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22594 @end table
22595
22596 @cindex float promotion
22597
22598 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22599 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22600 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22601 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22602 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22603 @code{double} and then passed.
22604
22605 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22606 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22607 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22608
22609 @table @code
22610 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22611 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22612 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22613 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22614 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22615
22616 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22617 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22618 functions.
22619
22620 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22621 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22622 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22623 @end table
22624
22625 @kindex set cp-abi
22626 @kindex show cp-abi
22627 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22628 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22629 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22630 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22631 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22632 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22633 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22634 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22635 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22636 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22637 ``auto''.
22638
22639 @table @code
22640 @item show cp-abi
22641 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22642
22643 @item set cp-abi
22644 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22645
22646 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22647 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22648 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22649 @end table
22650
22651 @node Auto-loading
22652 @section Automatically loading associated files
22653 @cindex auto-loading
22654
22655 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22656 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22657 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22658 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22659 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22660 sources).
22661
22662 @menu
22663 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22664 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22665
22666 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22667 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22668 @end menu
22669
22670 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22671 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22672 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22673
22674 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22675 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22676 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22677
22678 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22679 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22680
22681 @table @code
22682 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22683 @kindex set auto-load off
22684 @item set auto-load off
22685 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22686 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22687 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22688 @smallexample
22689 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22690 @end smallexample
22691
22692 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22693 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22694 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22695 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22696 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22697 @code{set auto-load no}.
22698
22699 @anchor{show auto-load}
22700 @kindex show auto-load
22701 @item show auto-load
22702 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22703 or disabled.
22704
22705 @smallexample
22706 (gdb) show auto-load
22707 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22708 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22709 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22710 is on.
22711 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22712 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22713 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22714 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22715 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22716 @end smallexample
22717
22718 @anchor{info auto-load}
22719 @kindex info auto-load
22720 @item info auto-load
22721 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22722 not.
22723
22724 @smallexample
22725 (gdb) info auto-load
22726 gdb-scripts:
22727 Loaded Script
22728 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22729 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22730 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22731 loaded.
22732 python-scripts:
22733 Loaded Script
22734 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22735 @end smallexample
22736 @end table
22737
22738 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22739
22740 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22741 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22742 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22743 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22744 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22745 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22746 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22747 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22748 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22749 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22750 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22751 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22752 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22753 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22754 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22755 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22756 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22757 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22758 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22759 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22760 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22761 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22762 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22763 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22764 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22765 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22766 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22767 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22768 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22769 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22770 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22771 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22772 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22773 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22774 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22775 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22776 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22777 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22778 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22779 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22780 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22781 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22782 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22783 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22784 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22785 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22786 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22787 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22788 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22789 @end multitable
22790
22791 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22792 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22793 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22794
22795 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22796 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22797 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22798
22799 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22800 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22801
22802 @table @code
22803 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22804 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22805 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22806 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22807 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22808
22809 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22810 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22811 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22812 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22813 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22814
22815 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22816 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22817 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22818 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22819 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22820 @end table
22821
22822 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22823 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22824 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22825
22826 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22827
22828 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22829 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22830
22831 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22832 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22833 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22834 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22835 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22836 library.
22837
22838 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22839 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22840
22841 @table @code
22842 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22843 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22844 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22845 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22846
22847 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22848 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22849 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22850 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22851 enabled or disabled.
22852
22853 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22854 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22855 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22856 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22857 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22858 @end table
22859
22860 @node Auto-loading safe path
22861 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22862 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22863
22864 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22865 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22866 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22867 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22868 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22869
22870 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22871 get loaded:
22872
22873 @smallexample
22874 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22875 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22876 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22877 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22878 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22879 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22880 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22881 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22882 @end smallexample
22883
22884 @noindent
22885 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22886 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22887
22888 @smallexample
22889 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22890 @end smallexample
22891
22892 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22893
22894 @table @code
22895 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22896 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22897 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22898 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22899 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22900 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22901 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22902 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22903 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22904 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22905
22906 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22907 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22908 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22909
22910 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22911 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22912 @item show auto-load safe-path
22913 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22914 scripts.
22915
22916 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22917 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22918 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22919 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
22920 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
22921 by the host platform path separator in use.
22922 @end table
22923
22924 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22925 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22926 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22927 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22928 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22929
22930 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22931 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22932 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22933 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22934 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22935 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22936 init file in the current directory
22937 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22938
22939 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22940 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22941
22942 @table @asis
22943 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22944 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22945 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22946 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22947
22948 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22949 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22950 @value{GDBN} session.
22951
22952 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22953 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22954 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22955 from trusted sources.
22956
22957 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22958 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22959 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22960 trusted sources.
22961 @end table
22962
22963 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22964 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22965
22966 @table @asis
22967 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22968 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22969
22970 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22971 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22972 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22973 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22974 @end table
22975
22976 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22977 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22978 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22979 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22980 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22981 recommended to be entered.
22982
22983 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22984 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22985 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22986
22987 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22988 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22989 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22990 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22991 be printed.
22992
22993 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22994 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22995 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22996
22997 @smallexample
22998 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22999 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23000 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23001 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23002 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23003 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23004 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23005 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23006 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23007 @end smallexample
23008
23009 @table @code
23010 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23011 @kindex set debug auto-load
23012 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23013 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23014
23015 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23016 @kindex show debug auto-load
23017 @item show debug auto-load
23018 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23019 on or off.
23020 @end table
23021
23022 @node Messages/Warnings
23023 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23024
23025 @cindex verbose operation
23026 @cindex optional warnings
23027 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23028 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23029 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23030 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23031
23032 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23033 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23034 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23035
23036 @table @code
23037 @kindex set verbose
23038 @item set verbose on
23039 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23040
23041 @item set verbose off
23042 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23043
23044 @kindex show verbose
23045 @item show verbose
23046 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23047 @end table
23048
23049 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23050 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23051 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23052 Symbol Files}).
23053
23054 @table @code
23055
23056 @kindex set complaints
23057 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23058 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23059 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23060 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23061 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23062
23063 @kindex show complaints
23064 @item show complaints
23065 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23066
23067 @end table
23068
23069 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23070 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23071 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23072 you try to run a program which is already running:
23073
23074 @smallexample
23075 (@value{GDBP}) run
23076 The program being debugged has been started already.
23077 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23078 @end smallexample
23079
23080 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23081 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23082
23083 @table @code
23084
23085 @kindex set confirm
23086 @cindex flinching
23087 @cindex confirmation
23088 @cindex stupid questions
23089 @item set confirm off
23090 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23091 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23092 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23093
23094 @item set confirm on
23095 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23096
23097 @kindex show confirm
23098 @item show confirm
23099 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23100
23101 @end table
23102
23103 @cindex command tracing
23104 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23105 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23106 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23107 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23108
23109 @table @code
23110 @kindex set trace-commands
23111 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23112 @item set trace-commands on
23113 Enable command tracing.
23114 @item set trace-commands off
23115 Disable command tracing.
23116 @item show trace-commands
23117 Display the current state of command tracing.
23118 @end table
23119
23120 @node Debugging Output
23121 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23122 @cindex optional debugging messages
23123
23124 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23125 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23126 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23127 section documents those commands.
23128
23129 @table @code
23130 @kindex set exec-done-display
23131 @item set exec-done-display
23132 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23133 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23134 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23135 @kindex show exec-done-display
23136 @item show exec-done-display
23137 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23138 notification.
23139 @kindex set debug
23140 @cindex ARM AArch64
23141 @item set debug aarch64
23142 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23143 The default is off.
23144 @kindex show debug
23145 @item show debug aarch64
23146 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23147 ARM AArch64.
23148 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23149 @cindex architecture debugging info
23150 @item set debug arch
23151 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23152 @item show debug arch
23153 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23154 @item set debug aix-solib
23155 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23156 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23157 support module. The default is off.
23158 @item show debug aix-thread
23159 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23160 @item set debug aix-thread
23161 @cindex AIX threads
23162 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23163 module.
23164 @item show debug aix-thread
23165 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23166 @item set debug check-physname
23167 @cindex physname
23168 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23169 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23170 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23171 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23172 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23173 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23174 @item show debug check-physname
23175 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23176 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23177 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23178 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23179 exported symbols. The default is off.
23180 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23181 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23182 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23183 @item set debug dwarf2-die
23184 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
23185 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
23186 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23187 A value of zero turns off the display.
23188 @item show debug dwarf2-die
23189 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
23190 @item set debug dwarf2-read
23191 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
23192 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23193 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23194 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23195 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23196 @item show debug dwarf2-read
23197 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
23198 @item set debug displaced
23199 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23200 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23201 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23202 @item show debug displaced
23203 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23204 related to displaced stepping.
23205 @item set debug event
23206 @cindex event debugging info
23207 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23208 default is off.
23209 @item show debug event
23210 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23211 info.
23212 @item set debug expression
23213 @cindex expression debugging info
23214 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23215 expression parsing. The default is off.
23216 @item show debug expression
23217 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23218 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23219 @item set debug frame
23220 @cindex frame debugging info
23221 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23222 default is off.
23223 @item show debug frame
23224 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23225 info.
23226 @item set debug gnu-nat
23227 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23228 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23229 @item show debug gnu-nat
23230 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23231 @item set debug infrun
23232 @cindex inferior debugging info
23233 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23234 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23235 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23236 @item show debug infrun
23237 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23238 @item set debug jit
23239 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23240 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23241 @item show debug jit
23242 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23243 @item set debug lin-lwp
23244 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23245 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23246 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23247 @item show debug lin-lwp
23248 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23249 @item set debug mach-o
23250 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23251 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23252 processing. The default is off.
23253 @item show debug mach-o
23254 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23255 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23256 @item set debug notification
23257 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23258 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23259 The default is off.
23260 @item show debug notification
23261 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23262 @item set debug observer
23263 @cindex observer debugging info
23264 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23265 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23266 @item show debug observer
23267 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23268 @item set debug overload
23269 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23270 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23271 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23272 is off.
23273 @item show debug overload
23274 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23275 debugging info.
23276 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23277 @cindex debug expression parser
23278 @item set debug parser
23279 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23280 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23281 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23282 details. The default is off.
23283 @item show debug parser
23284 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23285 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23286 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23287 @cindex debug remote protocol
23288 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23289 @cindex display remote packets
23290 @item set debug remote
23291 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23292 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23293 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23294 @item show debug remote
23295 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23296 @item set debug serial
23297 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23298 default is off.
23299 @item show debug serial
23300 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23301 info.
23302 @item set debug solib-frv
23303 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23304 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23305 @item show debug solib-frv
23306 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23307 messages.
23308 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23309 @cindex symbol lookup
23310 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23311 The default is 0 (off).
23312 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23313 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23314 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23315 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23316 @item set debug symfile
23317 @cindex symbol file functions
23318 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23319 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23320 @item show debug symfile
23321 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23322 @item set debug symtab-create
23323 @cindex symbol table creation
23324 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23325 The default is 0 (off).
23326 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23327 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23328 @item show debug symtab-create
23329 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23330 @item set debug target
23331 @cindex target debugging info
23332 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23333 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23334 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23335 value of large memory transfers.
23336 @item show debug target
23337 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23338 info.
23339 @item set debug timestamp
23340 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23341 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23342 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23343 message.
23344 @item show debug timestamp
23345 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23346 debugging info.
23347 @item set debug varobj
23348 @cindex variable object debugging info
23349 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23350 info. The default is off.
23351 @item show debug varobj
23352 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23353 debugging info.
23354 @item set debug xml
23355 @cindex XML parser debugging
23356 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23357 @item show debug xml
23358 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23359 @end table
23360
23361 @node Other Misc Settings
23362 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23363 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23364
23365 @table @code
23366 @kindex set interactive-mode
23367 @item set interactive-mode
23368 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23369 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23370 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23371 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23372 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23373 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23374 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23375 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23376
23377 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23378 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23379 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23380 inside a cygwin window.
23381
23382 @kindex show interactive-mode
23383 @item show interactive-mode
23384 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23385 @end table
23386
23387 @node Extending GDB
23388 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23389 @cindex extending GDB
23390
23391 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23392 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23393 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23394 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23395 being debugged.
23396
23397 @menu
23398 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23399 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23400 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23401 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23402 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23403 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23404 @end menu
23405
23406 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23407 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23408 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23409 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23410 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23411 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23412
23413 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23414 setting:
23415
23416 @table @code
23417 @kindex set script-extension
23418 @kindex show script-extension
23419 @item set script-extension off
23420 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23421
23422 @item set script-extension soft
23423 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23424 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23425 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23426 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23427
23428 @item set script-extension strict
23429 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23430 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23431 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23432
23433 @item show script-extension
23434 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23435
23436 @end table
23437
23438 @node Sequences
23439 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23440
23441 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23442 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23443 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23444 files.
23445
23446 @menu
23447 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23448 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23449 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23450 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23451 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23452 @end menu
23453
23454 @node Define
23455 @subsection User-defined Commands
23456
23457 @cindex user-defined command
23458 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23459 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23460 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23461 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23462 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23463 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23464
23465 @smallexample
23466 define adder
23467 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23468 end
23469 @end smallexample
23470
23471 @noindent
23472 To execute the command use:
23473
23474 @smallexample
23475 adder 1 2 3
23476 @end smallexample
23477
23478 @noindent
23479 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23480 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23481 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23482 functions calls.
23483
23484 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23485 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23486 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23487 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23488
23489 @smallexample
23490 define adder
23491 if $argc == 2
23492 print $arg0 + $arg1
23493 end
23494 if $argc == 3
23495 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23496 end
23497 end
23498 @end smallexample
23499
23500 @table @code
23501
23502 @kindex define
23503 @item define @var{commandname}
23504 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23505 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23506 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23507 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23508 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23509 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23510
23511 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23512 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23513 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23514
23515 @kindex document
23516 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23517 @item document @var{commandname}
23518 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23519 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23520 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23521 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23522 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23523 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23524
23525 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23526 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23527 does not change the documentation.
23528
23529 @kindex dont-repeat
23530 @cindex don't repeat command
23531 @item dont-repeat
23532 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23533 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23534 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23535
23536 @kindex help user-defined
23537 @item help user-defined
23538 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23539 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23540 included (if any).
23541
23542 @kindex show user
23543 @item show user
23544 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23545 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23546 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23547 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23548 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23549
23550 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23551 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23552 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23553 @item show max-user-call-depth
23554 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23555 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23556 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23557 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23558 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23559 @end table
23560
23561 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23562 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23563
23564 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23565 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23566 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23567
23568 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23569 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23570 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23571 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23572
23573 @node Hooks
23574 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23575 @cindex command hooks
23576 @cindex hooks, for commands
23577 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23578
23579 @kindex hook
23580 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23581 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23582 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23583 before that command.
23584
23585 @cindex hooks, post-command
23586 @kindex hookpost
23587 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23588 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23589 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23590 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23591 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23592
23593 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23594 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23595
23596 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23597 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23598
23599 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23600 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23601 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23602 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23603 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23604
23605 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23606 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23607 you could define:
23608
23609 @smallexample
23610 define hook-stop
23611 handle SIGALRM nopass
23612 end
23613
23614 define hook-run
23615 handle SIGALRM pass
23616 end
23617
23618 define hook-continue
23619 handle SIGALRM pass
23620 end
23621 @end smallexample
23622
23623 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23624 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23625 you could define:
23626
23627 @smallexample
23628 define hook-echo
23629 echo <<<---
23630 end
23631
23632 define hookpost-echo
23633 echo --->>>\n
23634 end
23635
23636 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23637 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23638 (@value{GDBP})
23639
23640 @end smallexample
23641
23642 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23643 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23644 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23645 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23646 @c or not?
23647 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23648 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23649 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23650
23651 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23652 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23653 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23654
23655 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23656 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23657
23658 @node Command Files
23659 @subsection Command Files
23660
23661 @cindex command files
23662 @cindex scripting commands
23663 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23664 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23665 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23666 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23667 terminal.
23668
23669 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23670 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23671 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23672 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23673 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23674
23675 @table @code
23676 @kindex source
23677 @cindex execute commands from a file
23678 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23679 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23680 @end table
23681
23682 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23683 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23684 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23685 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23686 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23687
23688 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23689 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23690 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23691 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23692 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23693 is not relevant to scripts.
23694
23695 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23696 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23697 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23698 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23699 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23700 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23701 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23702 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23703 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23704 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23705 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23706 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23707 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23708 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23709
23710 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23711 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23712 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23713
23714 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23715 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23716 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23717 when called from command files.
23718
23719 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23720 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23721 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23722 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23723 the next command.
23724
23725 @smallexample
23726 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23727 @end smallexample
23728
23729 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23730 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23731 would be directed to @file{log}.
23732
23733 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23734 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23735 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23736 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23737 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23738 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23739 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23740 conditionally, etc.
23741
23742 @table @code
23743 @kindex if
23744 @kindex else
23745 @item if
23746 @itemx else
23747 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23748 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23749 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23750 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23751 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23752 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23753 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23754
23755 @kindex while
23756 @item while
23757 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23758 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23759 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23760 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23761 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23762 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23763
23764 @kindex loop_break
23765 @item loop_break
23766 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23767 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23768 line.
23769
23770 @kindex loop_continue
23771 @item loop_continue
23772 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23773 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23774 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23775 the controlling expression.
23776
23777 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23778 @item end
23779 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23780 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23781 @end table
23782
23783
23784 @node Output
23785 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23786
23787 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23788 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23789 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23790 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23791 want.
23792
23793 @table @code
23794 @kindex echo
23795 @item echo @var{text}
23796 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23797 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23798 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23799 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23800 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23801 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23802 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23803 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23804 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23805 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23806 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23807
23808 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23809 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23810
23811 @smallexample
23812 echo This is some text\n\
23813 which is continued\n\
23814 onto several lines.\n
23815 @end smallexample
23816
23817 produces the same output as
23818
23819 @smallexample
23820 echo This is some text\n
23821 echo which is continued\n
23822 echo onto several lines.\n
23823 @end smallexample
23824
23825 @kindex output
23826 @item output @var{expression}
23827 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23828 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23829 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23830 on expressions.
23831
23832 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23833 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23834 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23835 Formats}, for more information.
23836
23837 @kindex printf
23838 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23839 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23840 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23841 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23842 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23843 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23844 executing the code below:
23845
23846 @smallexample
23847 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23848 @end smallexample
23849
23850 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23851 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23852 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23853 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23854 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23855 printed.
23856
23857 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23858
23859 @smallexample
23860 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23861 @end smallexample
23862
23863 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23864 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23865 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23866
23867 @itemize @bullet
23868 @item
23869 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23870
23871 @item
23872 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23873 width.
23874
23875 @item
23876 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23877 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23878
23879 @item
23880 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23881 supported.
23882
23883 @item
23884 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23885
23886 @item
23887 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23888 @end itemize
23889
23890 @noindent
23891 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23892 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23893 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23894 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23895
23896 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23897 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23898 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23899 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23900 supported.
23901
23902 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23903 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23904 together with a floating point specifier.
23905 letters:
23906
23907 @itemize @bullet
23908 @item
23909 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23910
23911 @item
23912 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23913
23914 @item
23915 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23916 @end itemize
23917
23918 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23919 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23920 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23921
23922 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23923 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23924
23925 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23926 @smallexample
23927 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23928 @end smallexample
23929
23930 @kindex eval
23931 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23932 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23933 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23934
23935 @end table
23936
23937 @node Auto-loading sequences
23938 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23939 @cindex native script auto-loading
23940
23941 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23942 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23943 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23944 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23945
23946 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23947 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23948
23949 @table @code
23950 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23951 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23952 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23953 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23954
23955 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23956 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23957 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23958 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23959 disabled.
23960
23961 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23962 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23963 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23964 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23965 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23966 auto-loaded.
23967 @end table
23968
23969 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23970 matching names are printed.
23971
23972 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23973 @include python.texi
23974
23975 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23976 @include guile.texi
23977
23978 @node Auto-loading extensions
23979 @section Auto-loading extensions
23980 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23981
23982 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23983 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23984 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23985 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23986 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23987
23988 @menu
23989 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23990 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23991 * Which flavor to choose?::
23992 @end menu
23993
23994 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23995 debugging commands and features.
23996
23997 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23998 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23999 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24000 for more information.
24001 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24002 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24003
24004 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24005 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24006
24007 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24008 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24009 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24010 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24011 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24012
24013 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24014 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24015 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24016 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24017
24018 @table @code
24019 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24020 GDB's own command language
24021 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24022 Python
24023 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24024 Guile
24025 @end table
24026
24027 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24028 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24029 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24030 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24031 script in the specified extension language.
24032
24033 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24034 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24035
24036 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24037 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24038
24039 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24040 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24041 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24042 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24043 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24044 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24045
24046 @table @code
24047 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24048 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24049 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24050 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24051 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24052 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24053
24054 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24055 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24056
24057 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24058 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24059 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24060 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24061
24062 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24063 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24064 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24065 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24066 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24067 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24068 platform.
24069
24070 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24071 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24072 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24073
24074 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24075 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24076 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24077 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24078
24079 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24080 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24081 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24082 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24083 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24084 @end table
24085
24086 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24087 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24088 @var{objfile} is opened.
24089 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24090 is evaluated more than once.
24091
24092 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24093 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24094 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24095
24096 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24097 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24098 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24099 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24100 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24101 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24102 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24103
24104 The following entries are supported:
24105
24106 @table @code
24107 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24108 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24109 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24110 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24111 @end table
24112
24113 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24114
24115 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24116 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24117 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24118 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24119 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24120
24121 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24122 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24123
24124 @example
24125 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24126 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24127 asm("\
24128 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24129 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24130 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24131 .popsection \n\
24132 ");
24133 @end example
24134
24135 @noindent
24136 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24137 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24138
24139 @example
24140 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24141 @end example
24142
24143 The script name may include directories if desired.
24144
24145 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24146 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24147
24148 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24149 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24150 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24151 will remove duplicates.
24152
24153 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24154
24155 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24156 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24157 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24158 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24159 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24160 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24161 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24162 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24163 on its name.
24164
24165 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24166 testsuite.
24167
24168 @example
24169 #include "symcat.h"
24170 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24171 asm(
24172 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24173 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24174 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24175 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24176 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24177 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24178 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24179 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24180 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24181 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24182 ".byte 0\n"
24183 ".popsection\n"
24184 );
24185 @end example
24186
24187 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24188 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24189 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24190 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24191
24192 @node Which flavor to choose?
24193 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24194
24195 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24196 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24197
24198 @noindent
24199 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24200
24201 @itemize @bullet
24202 @item
24203 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24204
24205 @item
24206 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24207
24208 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24209 in the source search path.
24210 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24211 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24212
24213 @item
24214 Doesn't require source code additions.
24215 @end itemize
24216
24217 @noindent
24218 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24219
24220 @itemize @bullet
24221 @item
24222 Works with static linking.
24223
24224 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24225 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24226 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24227 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24228 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24229
24230 @item
24231 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24232
24233 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24234 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24235
24236 @item
24237 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24238
24239 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24240 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24241 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24242 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24243 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24244 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24245 @end itemize
24246
24247 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24248 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24249
24250 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24251 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24252 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24253
24254 @subsection Python comes first
24255
24256 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24257 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24258 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24259 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24260 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24261 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24262 pretty-printed form of a value).
24263 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24264 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24265 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24266
24267 @node Aliases
24268 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24269 @cindex aliases for commands
24270
24271 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24272 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24273 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24274 that involves less typing.
24275
24276 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24277 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24278 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24279
24280 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24281 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24282 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24283
24284 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24285
24286 @table @code
24287
24288 @kindex alias
24289 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24290
24291 @end table
24292
24293 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24294 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24295 underscores.
24296
24297 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24298 that is being aliased.
24299
24300 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24301 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24302 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24303
24304 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24305 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24306
24307 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24308 of a command so that there is less to type.
24309 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24310 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24311 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24312 The following will accomplish this.
24313
24314 @smallexample
24315 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24316 @end smallexample
24317
24318 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24319 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24320 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24321 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24322
24323 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24324 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24325 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24326 of a command.
24327
24328 @smallexample
24329 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24330 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24331 (gdb) set p elms 20
24332 (gdb) show p elms
24333 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24334 @end smallexample
24335
24336 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24337 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24338 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24339
24340 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24341 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24342
24343 @smallexample
24344 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24345 @end smallexample
24346
24347 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24348 alias for a more complex command.
24349 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24350
24351 @smallexample
24352 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24353 (gdb) spe 20
24354 @end smallexample
24355
24356 @node Interpreters
24357 @chapter Command Interpreters
24358 @cindex command interpreters
24359
24360 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24361 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24362 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24363
24364 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24365 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24366 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24367 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24368
24369 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24370 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24371 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24372 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24373
24374 @table @code
24375 @item console
24376 @cindex console interpreter
24377 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24378 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24379 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24380
24381 @item mi
24382 @cindex mi interpreter
24383 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24384 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24385 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24386 Interface}.
24387
24388 @item mi2
24389 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24390 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24391
24392 @item mi1
24393 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24394 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24395
24396 @end table
24397
24398 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24399 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24400 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24401 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24402 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24403 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24404 the IDE inoperable!
24405
24406 @kindex interpreter-exec
24407 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24408 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24409 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24410 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24411
24412 @smallexample
24413 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24414 @end smallexample
24415
24416 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24417 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24418
24419 @node TUI
24420 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24421 @cindex TUI
24422 @cindex Text User Interface
24423
24424 @menu
24425 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24426 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24427 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24428 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24429 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24430 @end menu
24431
24432 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24433 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24434 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24435 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24436 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24437 is available.
24438
24439 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24440 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24441 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24442 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24443 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24444
24445 @node TUI Overview
24446 @section TUI Overview
24447
24448 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24449
24450 @table @emph
24451 @item command
24452 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24453 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24454 managed using readline.
24455
24456 @item source
24457 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24458 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24459
24460 @item assembly
24461 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24462
24463 @item register
24464 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24465 when their values change.
24466 @end table
24467
24468 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24469 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24470 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24471 indicates the breakpoint type:
24472
24473 @table @code
24474 @item B
24475 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24476
24477 @item b
24478 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24479
24480 @item H
24481 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24482
24483 @item h
24484 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24485 @end table
24486
24487 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24488
24489 @table @code
24490 @item +
24491 Breakpoint is enabled.
24492
24493 @item -
24494 Breakpoint is disabled.
24495 @end table
24496
24497 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24498 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24499 changes.
24500
24501 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24502 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24503 layouts:
24504
24505 @itemize @bullet
24506 @item
24507 source only,
24508
24509 @item
24510 assembly only,
24511
24512 @item
24513 source and assembly,
24514
24515 @item
24516 source and registers, or
24517
24518 @item
24519 assembly and registers.
24520 @end itemize
24521
24522 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24523
24524 @table @emph
24525 @item target
24526 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24527 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24528
24529 @item process
24530 Gives the current process or thread number.
24531 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24532
24533 @item function
24534 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24535 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24536 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24537 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24538
24539 @item line
24540 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24541 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24542
24543 @item pc
24544 Indicates the current program counter address.
24545 @end table
24546
24547 @node TUI Keys
24548 @section TUI Key Bindings
24549 @cindex TUI key bindings
24550
24551 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24552 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24553 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24554 @end ifset
24555 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24556 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24557 @end ifclear
24558 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24559 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24560
24561 @table @kbd
24562 @kindex C-x C-a
24563 @item C-x C-a
24564 @kindex C-x a
24565 @itemx C-x a
24566 @kindex C-x A
24567 @itemx C-x A
24568 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24569 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24570 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24571 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24572 The screen is then refreshed.
24573
24574 @kindex C-x 1
24575 @item C-x 1
24576 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24577 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24578 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24579
24580 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24581
24582 @kindex C-x 2
24583 @item C-x 2
24584 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24585 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24586 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24587 previous layout and the new one.
24588
24589 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24590
24591 @kindex C-x o
24592 @item C-x o
24593 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24594 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24595 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24596
24597 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24598
24599 @kindex C-x s
24600 @item C-x s
24601 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24602 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24603 @end table
24604
24605 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24606
24607 @table @asis
24608 @kindex PgUp
24609 @item @key{PgUp}
24610 Scroll the active window one page up.
24611
24612 @kindex PgDn
24613 @item @key{PgDn}
24614 Scroll the active window one page down.
24615
24616 @kindex Up
24617 @item @key{Up}
24618 Scroll the active window one line up.
24619
24620 @kindex Down
24621 @item @key{Down}
24622 Scroll the active window one line down.
24623
24624 @kindex Left
24625 @item @key{Left}
24626 Scroll the active window one column left.
24627
24628 @kindex Right
24629 @item @key{Right}
24630 Scroll the active window one column right.
24631
24632 @kindex C-L
24633 @item @kbd{C-L}
24634 Refresh the screen.
24635 @end table
24636
24637 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24638 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24639 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24640 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24641 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24642
24643 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24644 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24645 @cindex TUI single key mode
24646
24647 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24648 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24649 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24650
24651 @table @kbd
24652 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24653 @item c
24654 continue
24655
24656 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24657 @item d
24658 down
24659
24660 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24661 @item f
24662 finish
24663
24664 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24665 @item n
24666 next
24667
24668 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24669 @item q
24670 exit the SingleKey mode.
24671
24672 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24673 @item r
24674 run
24675
24676 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24677 @item s
24678 step
24679
24680 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24681 @item u
24682 up
24683
24684 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24685 @item v
24686 info locals
24687
24688 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24689 @item w
24690 where
24691 @end table
24692
24693 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24694 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24695 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24696 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24697 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24698 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24699
24700
24701 @node TUI Commands
24702 @section TUI-specific Commands
24703 @cindex TUI commands
24704
24705 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24706 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24707 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24708 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24709
24710 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24711 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24712 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24713 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24714 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24715
24716 @table @code
24717 @item info win
24718 @kindex info win
24719 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24720
24721 @item layout next
24722 @kindex layout
24723 Display the next layout.
24724
24725 @item layout prev
24726 Display the previous layout.
24727
24728 @item layout src
24729 Display the source window only.
24730
24731 @item layout asm
24732 Display the assembly window only.
24733
24734 @item layout split
24735 Display the source and assembly window.
24736
24737 @item layout regs
24738 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24739
24740 @item focus next
24741 @kindex focus
24742 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24743
24744 @item focus prev
24745 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24746
24747 @item focus src
24748 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24749
24750 @item focus asm
24751 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24752
24753 @item focus regs
24754 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24755
24756 @item focus cmd
24757 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24758
24759 @item refresh
24760 @kindex refresh
24761 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24762
24763 @item tui reg float
24764 @kindex tui reg
24765 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24766
24767 @item tui reg general
24768 Show the general registers in the register window.
24769
24770 @item tui reg next
24771 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24772 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24773 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24774 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24775
24776 @item tui reg system
24777 Show the system registers in the register window.
24778
24779 @item update
24780 @kindex update
24781 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24782
24783 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24784 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24785 @kindex winheight
24786 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24787 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24788 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24789 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24790 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24791
24792 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24793 @kindex tabset
24794 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24795 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24796 assembly windows.
24797 @end table
24798
24799 @node TUI Configuration
24800 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24801 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24802
24803 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24804
24805 @table @code
24806 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24807 @kindex set tui border-kind
24808 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24809 The possible values are the following:
24810 @table @code
24811 @item space
24812 Use a space character to draw the border.
24813
24814 @item ascii
24815 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24816
24817 @item acs
24818 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24819 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24820 @end table
24821
24822 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24823 @kindex set tui border-mode
24824 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24825 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24826 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24827 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24828 @table @code
24829 @item normal
24830 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24831
24832 @item standout
24833 Use standout mode.
24834
24835 @item reverse
24836 Use reverse video mode.
24837
24838 @item half
24839 Use half bright mode.
24840
24841 @item half-standout
24842 Use half bright and standout mode.
24843
24844 @item bold
24845 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24846
24847 @item bold-standout
24848 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24849 @end table
24850 @end table
24851
24852 @node Emacs
24853 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24854
24855 @cindex Emacs
24856 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24857 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24858 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24859 @value{GDBN}.
24860
24861 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24862 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24863 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24864 created Emacs buffer.
24865 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24866
24867 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24868 things:
24869
24870 @itemize @bullet
24871 @item
24872 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24873 the GUD buffer.
24874
24875 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24876 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24877
24878 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24879 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24880 in this way.
24881
24882 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24883 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24884 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24885 stop.
24886
24887 @item
24888 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24889
24890 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24891 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24892 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24893 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24894 and the source.
24895
24896 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24897 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24898 @end itemize
24899
24900 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24901 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24902 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24903 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24904
24905 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24906 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24907 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24908 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24909 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24910 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24911 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24912 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24913 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24914
24915 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24916 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24917 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24918 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24919
24920 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24921 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24922 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24923 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24924 one you want.
24925
24926 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24927 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24928
24929 @table @kbd
24930 @item C-h m
24931 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24932
24933 @item C-c C-s
24934 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24935 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24936
24937 @item C-c C-n
24938 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24939 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24940 to show the current file and location.
24941
24942 @item C-c C-i
24943 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24944 display window accordingly.
24945
24946 @item C-c C-f
24947 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24948 @code{finish} command.
24949
24950 @item C-c C-r
24951 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24952 command.
24953
24954 @item C-c <
24955 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24956 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24957 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24958
24959 @item C-c >
24960 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24961 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24962 @end table
24963
24964 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24965 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24966
24967 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24968 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24969 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24970 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24971 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24972 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24973 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24974
24975 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24976 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24977 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24978 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24979 frame.
24980
24981 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24982 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24983 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24984 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24985 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24986 to correspond properly with the code.
24987
24988 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24989 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24990 Emacs Manual}).
24991
24992 @node GDB/MI
24993 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24994
24995 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24996
24997 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24998 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24999 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25000 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25001 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25002 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25003
25004 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25005 in the form of a reference manual.
25006
25007 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25008 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25009 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25010
25011 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25012
25013 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25014 This chapter uses the following notation:
25015
25016 @itemize @bullet
25017 @item
25018 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25019
25020 @item
25021 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25022 it may or may not be given.
25023
25024 @item
25025 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25026 may repeat zero or more times.
25027
25028 @item
25029 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25030 may repeat one or more times.
25031
25032 @item
25033 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25034 @end itemize
25035
25036 @ignore
25037 @heading Dependencies
25038 @end ignore
25039
25040 @menu
25041 * GDB/MI General Design::
25042 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25043 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25044 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25045 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25046 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25047 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25048 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25049 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25050 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25051 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25052 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25053 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25054 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25055 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25056 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25057 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25058 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25059 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25060 @ignore
25061 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25062 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25063 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25064 @end ignore
25065 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25066 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25067 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25068 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25069 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25070 @end menu
25071
25072 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25073 @node GDB/MI General Design
25074 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25075 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25076
25077 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25078 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25079 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25080 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25081 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25082 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25083 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25084 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25085 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25086 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25087
25088 The important examples of notifications are:
25089 @itemize @bullet
25090
25091 @item
25092 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25093 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25094 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25095 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25096 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25097 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25098 command itself was successfully executed.
25099
25100 @item
25101 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25102 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25103 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25104 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25105 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25106 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25107
25108 @item
25109 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25110 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25111 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25112 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25113 orthogonal frontend design.
25114
25115 @end itemize
25116
25117 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25118 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25119 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25120 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25121 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25122 the user interface.
25123
25124
25125 @menu
25126 * Context management::
25127 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25128 * Thread groups::
25129 @end menu
25130
25131 @node Context management
25132 @subsection Context management
25133
25134 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25135
25136 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25137 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25138 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25139 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25140 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25141 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25142 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25143 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25144 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25145
25146 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25147 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25148 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25149 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25150 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25151 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25152 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25153 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25154 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25155 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25156 for thread and frame to operate on.
25157
25158 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25159 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25160 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25161 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25162 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25163 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25164 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25165 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25166 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25167 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25168
25169 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25170 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25171 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25172 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25173 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25174 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25175 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25176 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25177 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25178 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25179 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25180 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25181 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25182 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25183 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25184 @samp{--frame} options.
25185
25186 @subsubsection Language
25187
25188 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25189 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25190 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25191 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25192 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25193 For instance:
25194
25195 @smallexample
25196 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25197 ^done,value="4"
25198 (gdb)
25199 @end smallexample
25200
25201 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25202 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25203 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25204
25205 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25206 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25207
25208 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25209 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25210 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25211 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25212 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25213 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25214 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25215 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25216 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25217
25218 @table @code
25219 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25220 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25221 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25222
25223 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25224 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25225 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25226
25227 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25228 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25229 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25230 MI commands even while the target is running.
25231
25232 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25233 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25234 @end table
25235
25236 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25237 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25238 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25239 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25240 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25241 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25242
25243 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25244 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25245 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25246 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25247 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25248 are running.
25249
25250 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25251 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25252 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25253 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25254 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25255 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25256 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25257 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25258 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25259 @samp{--thread} option).
25260
25261 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25262 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25263 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25264 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25265
25266 @node Thread groups
25267 @subsection Thread groups
25268 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25269 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25270 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25271 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25272 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25273
25274 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25275 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25276 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25277 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25278 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25279 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25280 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25281 into processes.
25282
25283 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25284 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25285 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25286 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25287 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25288 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25289 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25290 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25291 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25292 the members of specific thread group.
25293
25294 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25295 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25296 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25297 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25298 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25299 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25300 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25301 after attaching to that thread group.
25302
25303 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25304 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25305 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25306 such thread groups.
25307
25308 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25309 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25310 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25311
25312 @menu
25313 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25314 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25315 @end menu
25316
25317 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25318 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25319
25320 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25321 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25322 @table @code
25323 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25324 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25325
25326 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25327 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25328 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25329
25330 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25331 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25332 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25333
25334 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25335 "any sequence of digits"
25336
25337 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25338 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25339
25340 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25341 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25342
25343 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25344 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25345
25346 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25347 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25348 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25349
25350 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25351 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25352
25353 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25354 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25355 @end table
25356
25357 @noindent
25358 Notes:
25359
25360 @itemize @bullet
25361 @item
25362 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25363 output is described below.
25364
25365 @item
25366 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25367 finishes.
25368
25369 @item
25370 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25371 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25372 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25373 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25374 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25375 @end itemize
25376
25377 Pragmatics:
25378
25379 @itemize @bullet
25380 @item
25381 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25382
25383 @item
25384 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25385 @end itemize
25386
25387 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25388 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25389
25390 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25391 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25392 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25393 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25394 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25395 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25396
25397 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25398 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25399 @var{token}.
25400
25401 @table @code
25402 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25403 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25404
25405 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25406 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25407
25408 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25409 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25410
25411 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25412 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25413
25414 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25415 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25416
25417 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25418 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25419
25420 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25421 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25422
25423 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25424 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25425
25426 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25427 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25428
25429 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25430 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25431 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25432
25433 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25434 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25435
25436 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25437 @code{ @var{string} }
25438
25439 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25440 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25441
25442 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25443 @code{@var{c-string}}
25444
25445 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25446 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25447
25448 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25449 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25450 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25451
25452 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25453 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25454
25455 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25456 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25457
25458 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25459 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25460
25461 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25462 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25463
25464 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25465 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25466
25467 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25468 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25469 @end table
25470
25471 @noindent
25472 Notes:
25473
25474 @itemize @bullet
25475 @item
25476 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25477
25478 @item
25479 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25480 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25481 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25482 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25483 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25484 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25485 prior command.
25486
25487 @item
25488 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25489 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25490 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25491 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25492
25493 @item
25494 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25495 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25496 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25497 @samp{*}.
25498
25499 @item
25500 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25501 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25502 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25503 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25504
25505 @item
25506 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25507 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25508 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25509 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25510
25511 @item
25512 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25513 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25514 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25515
25516 @item
25517 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25518 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25519 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25520 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25521
25522 @item
25523 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25524 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25525 @var{values}.
25526
25527
25528 @end itemize
25529
25530 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25531 details about the various output records.
25532
25533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25534 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25535 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25536
25537 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25538 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25539
25540 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25541 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25542 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25543 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25544 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25545 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25546
25547 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25548 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25549 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25550
25551 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25552 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25553 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25554 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25555
25556 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25557 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25558
25559 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25560 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25561 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25562 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25563 might change.
25564
25565 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25566 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25567 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25568 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25569
25570 @itemize @bullet
25571 @item
25572 New MI commands may be added.
25573
25574 @item
25575 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25576
25577 @item
25578 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25579 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25580
25581 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25582 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25583
25584 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25585 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25586 @end itemize
25587
25588 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25589 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25590 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25591 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25592 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25593
25594 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25595 @c version?
25596
25597 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25598 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25599 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25600 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25601 @cindex mailing lists
25602
25603 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25604 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25605 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25606
25607 @menu
25608 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25609 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25610 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25611 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25612 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25613 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25614 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25615 @end menu
25616
25617 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25618 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25619
25620 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25621 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25622 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25623 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25624
25625 @table @code
25626 @findex ^done
25627 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25628 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25629 values.
25630
25631 @item "^running"
25632 @findex ^running
25633 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25634 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25635 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25636 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25637 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25638 which threads are resumed.
25639
25640 @item "^connected"
25641 @findex ^connected
25642 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25643
25644 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25645 @findex ^error
25646 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25647 the corresponding error message.
25648
25649 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25650 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25651 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25652
25653 @table @samp
25654 @item "undefined-command"
25655 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25656 @end table
25657
25658 @item "^exit"
25659 @findex ^exit
25660 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25661
25662 @end table
25663
25664 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25665 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25666
25667 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25668 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25669 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25670 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25671 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25672
25673 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25674 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25675 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25676 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25677 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25678
25679 @table @code
25680 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25681 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25682 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25683
25684 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25685 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25686 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25687 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25688
25689 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25690 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25691 internals.
25692 @end table
25693
25694 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25695 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25696
25697 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25698 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25699 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25700 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25701 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25702 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25703
25704 The following is the list of possible async records:
25705
25706 @table @code
25707
25708 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25709 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25710 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25711 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25712 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25713 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25714 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25715 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25716 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25717 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25718
25719 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25720 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25721 following values:
25722
25723 @table @code
25724 @item breakpoint-hit
25725 A breakpoint was reached.
25726 @item watchpoint-trigger
25727 A watchpoint was triggered.
25728 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25729 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25730 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25731 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25732 @item function-finished
25733 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25734 @item location-reached
25735 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25736 @item watchpoint-scope
25737 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25738 @item end-stepping-range
25739 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25740 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25741 @item exited-signalled
25742 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25743 @item exited
25744 The inferior exited.
25745 @item exited-normally
25746 The inferior exited normally.
25747 @item signal-received
25748 A signal was received by the inferior.
25749 @item solib-event
25750 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25751 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25752 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25753 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25754 @item fork
25755 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25756 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25757 @item vfork
25758 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25759 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25760 @item syscall-entry
25761 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25762 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25763 @item syscall-entry
25764 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25765 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25766 @item exec
25767 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25768 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25769 @end table
25770
25771 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25772 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25773 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25774 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25775 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25776 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25777 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25778 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25779 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25780 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25781 if such information is not available.
25782
25783 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25784 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25785 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25786 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25787 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25788 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25789 cannot be used in any way.
25790
25791 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25792 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25793 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25794 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25795 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25796 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25797
25798 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25799 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25800 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25801 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25802 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25803 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25804
25805 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25806 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25807 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25808 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25809 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25810
25811 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25812 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25813 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25814 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25815 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25816 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25817 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25818
25819 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25820 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25821 that thread.
25822
25823 @item =library-loaded,...
25824 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25825 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25826 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25827 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25828 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25829 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25830 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25831 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25832 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25833 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25834 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25835 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25836 thread groups.
25837
25838 @item =library-unloaded,...
25839 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25840 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25841 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25842 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25843 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25844 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25845 thread groups.
25846
25847 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25848 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25849 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25850 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25851 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25852
25853 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25854 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25855 initial value @var{initial}.
25856
25857 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25858 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25859 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25860 trace state variables are deleted.
25861
25862 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25863 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25864 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25865 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25866 value of trace state variable is known.
25867
25868 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25869 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25870 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25871 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25872 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25873 user.
25874
25875 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25876 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25877 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25878
25879 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25880 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25881
25882 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25883 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25884 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25885 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25886 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25887
25888 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25889 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25890 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25891 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25892 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25893 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25894
25895 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25896 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25897 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25898 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25899 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25900 executable code.
25901 @end table
25902
25903 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25904 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25905
25906 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25907 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25908 following fields:
25909
25910 @table @code
25911 @item number
25912 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25913 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25914 @samp{1.2}.
25915
25916 @item type
25917 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25918 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25919
25920 @item catch-type
25921 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25922 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25923
25924 @item disp
25925 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25926 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25927 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25928
25929 @item enabled
25930 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25931 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25932 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25933
25934 @item addr
25935 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25936 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25937 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25938 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25939 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25940
25941 @item func
25942 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25943 If not known, this field is not present.
25944
25945 @item filename
25946 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25947 If not known, this field is not present.
25948
25949 @item fullname
25950 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25951 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25952
25953 @item line
25954 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25955 If not known, this field is not present.
25956
25957 @item at
25958 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25959 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25960 by a symbol name.
25961
25962 @item pending
25963 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25964 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25965
25966 @item evaluated-by
25967 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25968 @samp{target}.
25969
25970 @item thread
25971 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25972 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25973
25974 @item task
25975 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25976 field will hold the task identifier.
25977
25978 @item cond
25979 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25980
25981 @item ignore
25982 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25983
25984 @item enable
25985 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25986
25987 @item traceframe-usage
25988 FIXME.
25989
25990 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25991 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25992
25993 @item mask
25994 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25995
25996 @item pass
25997 A tracepoint's pass count.
25998
25999 @item original-location
26000 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26001 This field is optional.
26002
26003 @item times
26004 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26005
26006 @item installed
26007 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26008 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26009 is not.
26010
26011 @item what
26012 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26013
26014 @end table
26015
26016 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26017 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26018
26019 @smallexample
26020 -> -break-insert main
26021 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26022 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26023 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26024 times="0"@}
26025 <- (gdb)
26026 @end smallexample
26027
26028 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26029 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26030
26031 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26032 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26033 fields:
26034
26035 @table @code
26036 @item level
26037 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26038 zero. This field is always present.
26039
26040 @item func
26041 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26042 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26043
26044 @item addr
26045 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26046
26047 @item file
26048 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26049 address. This field may be absent.
26050
26051 @item line
26052 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26053 may be absent.
26054
26055 @item from
26056 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26057 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26058
26059 @end table
26060
26061 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26062 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26063
26064 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26065 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26066
26067 @table @code
26068 @item id
26069 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26070 always present.
26071
26072 @item target-id
26073 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26074
26075 @item details
26076 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26077 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26078 frontend. This field is optional.
26079
26080 @item state
26081 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26082 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26083
26084 @item core
26085 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26086 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26087 @end table
26088
26089 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26090 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26091
26092 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26093 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26094 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26095 the @code{exception-name} field.
26096
26097 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26098 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26099 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26100 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26101
26102 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26103 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26104 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26105 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26106
26107 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26108 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26109
26110 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26111
26112 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26113 information of the breakpoint.
26114
26115 @smallexample
26116 -> -break-insert main
26117 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26118 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26119 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26120 times="0"@}
26121 <- (gdb)
26122 @end smallexample
26123
26124 @subheading Program Execution
26125
26126 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26127 reason that execution stopped.
26128
26129 @smallexample
26130 -> -exec-run
26131 <- ^running
26132 <- (gdb)
26133 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26134 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26135 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26136 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26137 <- (gdb)
26138 -> -exec-continue
26139 <- ^running
26140 <- (gdb)
26141 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26142 <- (gdb)
26143 @end smallexample
26144
26145 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26146
26147 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26148
26149 @smallexample
26150 -> (gdb)
26151 <- -gdb-exit
26152 <- ^exit
26153 @end smallexample
26154
26155 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26156 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26157 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26158 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26159 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26160 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26161
26162 @subheading A Bad Command
26163
26164 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26165
26166 @smallexample
26167 -> -rubbish
26168 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26169 <- (gdb)
26170 @end smallexample
26171
26172
26173 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26174 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26175 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26176
26177 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26178 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26179
26180 @subheading Motivation
26181
26182 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26183
26184 @subheading Introduction
26185
26186 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26187
26188 @subheading Commands
26189
26190 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26191
26192 @subsubheading Synopsis
26193
26194 @smallexample
26195 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26196 @end smallexample
26197
26198 @subsubheading Result
26199
26200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26201
26202 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26203
26204 @subsubheading Example
26205
26206 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26207 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26208
26209
26210 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26211 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26212 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26213
26214 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26215 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26216 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26217 breakpoints.
26218
26219 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26220 @findex -break-after
26221
26222 @subsubheading Synopsis
26223
26224 @smallexample
26225 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26226 @end smallexample
26227
26228 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26229 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26230 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26231 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26232
26233 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26234
26235 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26236
26237 @subsubheading Example
26238
26239 @smallexample
26240 (gdb)
26241 -break-insert main
26242 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26243 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26244 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26245 times="0"@}
26246 (gdb)
26247 -break-after 1 3
26248 ~
26249 ^done
26250 (gdb)
26251 -break-list
26252 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26253 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26254 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26255 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26256 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26257 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26258 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26259 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26260 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26261 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26262 (gdb)
26263 @end smallexample
26264
26265 @ignore
26266 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26267 @findex -break-catch
26268 @end ignore
26269
26270 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26271 @findex -break-commands
26272
26273 @subsubheading Synopsis
26274
26275 @smallexample
26276 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26277 @end smallexample
26278
26279 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26280 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26281 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26282 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26283 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26284 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26285
26286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26287
26288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26289
26290 @subsubheading Example
26291
26292 @smallexample
26293 (gdb)
26294 -break-insert main
26295 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26296 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26297 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26298 times="0"@}
26299 (gdb)
26300 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26301 ^done
26302 (gdb)
26303 @end smallexample
26304
26305 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26306 @findex -break-condition
26307
26308 @subsubheading Synopsis
26309
26310 @smallexample
26311 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26312 @end smallexample
26313
26314 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26315 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26316 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26317 command below).
26318
26319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26320
26321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26322
26323 @subsubheading Example
26324
26325 @smallexample
26326 (gdb)
26327 -break-condition 1 1
26328 ^done
26329 (gdb)
26330 -break-list
26331 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26332 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26333 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26334 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26335 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26336 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26337 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26338 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26339 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26340 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26341 (gdb)
26342 @end smallexample
26343
26344 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26345 @findex -break-delete
26346
26347 @subsubheading Synopsis
26348
26349 @smallexample
26350 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26351 @end smallexample
26352
26353 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26354 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26355
26356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26357
26358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26359
26360 @subsubheading Example
26361
26362 @smallexample
26363 (gdb)
26364 -break-delete 1
26365 ^done
26366 (gdb)
26367 -break-list
26368 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26369 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26370 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26371 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26372 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26373 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26374 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26375 body=[]@}
26376 (gdb)
26377 @end smallexample
26378
26379 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26380 @findex -break-disable
26381
26382 @subsubheading Synopsis
26383
26384 @smallexample
26385 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26386 @end smallexample
26387
26388 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26389 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26390
26391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26392
26393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26394
26395 @subsubheading Example
26396
26397 @smallexample
26398 (gdb)
26399 -break-disable 2
26400 ^done
26401 (gdb)
26402 -break-list
26403 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26404 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26405 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26406 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26407 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26408 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26409 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26410 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26411 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26412 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26413 (gdb)
26414 @end smallexample
26415
26416 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26417 @findex -break-enable
26418
26419 @subsubheading Synopsis
26420
26421 @smallexample
26422 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26423 @end smallexample
26424
26425 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26426
26427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26428
26429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26430
26431 @subsubheading Example
26432
26433 @smallexample
26434 (gdb)
26435 -break-enable 2
26436 ^done
26437 (gdb)
26438 -break-list
26439 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26440 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26441 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26442 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26443 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26444 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26445 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26446 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26447 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26448 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26449 (gdb)
26450 @end smallexample
26451
26452 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26453 @findex -break-info
26454
26455 @subsubheading Synopsis
26456
26457 @smallexample
26458 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26459 @end smallexample
26460
26461 @c REDUNDANT???
26462 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26463
26464 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26465 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26466 table.
26467
26468 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26469
26470 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26471
26472 @subsubheading Example
26473 N.A.
26474
26475 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26476 @findex -break-insert
26477
26478 @subsubheading Synopsis
26479
26480 @smallexample
26481 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26482 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26483 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26484 @end smallexample
26485
26486 @noindent
26487 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26488
26489 @itemize @bullet
26490 @item function
26491 @c @item +offset
26492 @c @item -offset
26493 @c @item linenum
26494 @item filename:linenum
26495 @item filename:function
26496 @item *address
26497 @end itemize
26498
26499 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26500
26501 @table @samp
26502 @item -t
26503 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26504 @item -h
26505 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26506 @item -f
26507 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26508 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26509 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26510 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26511 cannot be parsed.
26512 @item -d
26513 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26514 @item -a
26515 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26516 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26517 @item -c @var{condition}
26518 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26519 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26520 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26521 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26522 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26523 @end table
26524
26525 @subsubheading Result
26526
26527 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26528 resulting breakpoint.
26529
26530 Note: this format is open to change.
26531 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26532
26533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26534
26535 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26536 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26537
26538 @subsubheading Example
26539
26540 @smallexample
26541 (gdb)
26542 -break-insert main
26543 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26544 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26545 times="0"@}
26546 (gdb)
26547 -break-insert -t foo
26548 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26549 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26550 times="0"@}
26551 (gdb)
26552 -break-list
26553 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26554 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26555 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26556 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26557 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26558 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26559 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26560 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26561 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26562 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26563 times="0"@},
26564 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26565 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26566 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26567 times="0"@}]@}
26568 (gdb)
26569 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26570 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26571 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26572 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26573 @c times="0"@}
26574 @c (gdb)
26575 @end smallexample
26576
26577 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26578 @findex -dprintf-insert
26579
26580 @subsubheading Synopsis
26581
26582 @smallexample
26583 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26584 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26585 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26586 [ @var{argument} ]
26587 @end smallexample
26588
26589 @noindent
26590 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26591
26592 @itemize @bullet
26593 @item @var{function}
26594 @c @item +offset
26595 @c @item -offset
26596 @c @item @var{linenum}
26597 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26598 @item @var{filename}:function
26599 @item *@var{address}
26600 @end itemize
26601
26602 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26603
26604 @table @samp
26605 @item -t
26606 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26607 @item -f
26608 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26609 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26610 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26611 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26612 cannot be parsed.
26613 @item -d
26614 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26615 @item -c @var{condition}
26616 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26617 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26618 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26619 to @var{ignore-count}.
26620 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26621 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26622 @end table
26623
26624 @subsubheading Result
26625
26626 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26627 resulting breakpoint.
26628
26629 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26630
26631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26632
26633 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26634
26635 @subsubheading Example
26636
26637 @smallexample
26638 (gdb)
26639 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26640 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26641 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26642 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26643 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26644 original-location="foo"@}
26645 (gdb)
26646 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26647 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26648 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26649 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26650 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26651 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26652 (gdb)
26653 @end smallexample
26654
26655 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26656 @findex -break-list
26657
26658 @subsubheading Synopsis
26659
26660 @smallexample
26661 -break-list
26662 @end smallexample
26663
26664 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26665
26666 @table @samp
26667 @item Number
26668 number of the breakpoint
26669 @item Type
26670 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26671 @item Disposition
26672 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26673 or @samp{nokeep}
26674 @item Enabled
26675 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26676 @item Address
26677 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26678 @item What
26679 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26680 name, line number
26681 @item Thread-groups
26682 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26683 @item Times
26684 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26685 @end table
26686
26687 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26688 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26689
26690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26691
26692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26693
26694 @subsubheading Example
26695
26696 @smallexample
26697 (gdb)
26698 -break-list
26699 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26700 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26701 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26702 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26703 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26704 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26705 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26706 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26707 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26708 times="0"@},
26709 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26710 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26711 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26712 (gdb)
26713 @end smallexample
26714
26715 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26716
26717 @smallexample
26718 (gdb)
26719 -break-list
26720 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26721 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26722 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26723 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26724 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26725 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26726 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26727 body=[]@}
26728 (gdb)
26729 @end smallexample
26730
26731 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26732 @findex -break-passcount
26733
26734 @subsubheading Synopsis
26735
26736 @smallexample
26737 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26738 @end smallexample
26739
26740 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26741 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26742 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26743 command @samp{passcount}.
26744
26745 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26746 @findex -break-watch
26747
26748 @subsubheading Synopsis
26749
26750 @smallexample
26751 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26752 @end smallexample
26753
26754 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26755 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26756 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26757 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26758 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26759 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26760 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26761 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26762
26763 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26764 breakpoints inserted.
26765
26766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26767
26768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26769 @samp{rwatch}.
26770
26771 @subsubheading Example
26772
26773 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26774
26775 @smallexample
26776 (gdb)
26777 -break-watch x
26778 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26779 (gdb)
26780 -exec-continue
26781 ^running
26782 (gdb)
26783 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26784 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26785 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26786 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26787 (gdb)
26788 @end smallexample
26789
26790 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26791 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26792 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26793
26794 @smallexample
26795 (gdb)
26796 -break-watch C
26797 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26798 (gdb)
26799 -exec-continue
26800 ^running
26801 (gdb)
26802 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26803 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26804 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26805 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26806 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26807 (gdb)
26808 -exec-continue
26809 ^running
26810 (gdb)
26811 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26812 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26813 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26814 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26815 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26816 (gdb)
26817 @end smallexample
26818
26819 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26820 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26821 deleted.
26822
26823 @smallexample
26824 (gdb)
26825 -break-watch C
26826 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26827 (gdb)
26828 -break-list
26829 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26830 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26831 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26832 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26833 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26834 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26835 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26836 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26837 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26838 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26839 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26840 times="1"@},
26841 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26842 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26843 (gdb)
26844 -exec-continue
26845 ^running
26846 (gdb)
26847 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26848 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26849 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26850 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26851 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26852 (gdb)
26853 -break-list
26854 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26855 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26856 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26857 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26858 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26859 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26860 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26861 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26862 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26863 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26864 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26865 times="1"@},
26866 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26867 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26868 (gdb)
26869 -exec-continue
26870 ^running
26871 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26872 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26873 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26874 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26875 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26876 (gdb)
26877 -break-list
26878 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26879 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26880 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26881 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26882 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26883 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26884 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26885 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26886 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26887 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26888 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26889 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26890 (gdb)
26891 @end smallexample
26892
26893
26894 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26895 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26896 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26897
26898 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26899 catchpoints.
26900
26901 @menu
26902 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26903 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26904 @end menu
26905
26906 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26907 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26908
26909 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26910 @findex -catch-load
26911
26912 @subsubheading Synopsis
26913
26914 @smallexample
26915 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26916 @end smallexample
26917
26918 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26919 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26920 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26921 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26922 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26923
26924
26925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26926
26927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26928
26929 @subsubheading Example
26930
26931 @smallexample
26932 -catch-load -t foo.so
26933 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26934 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26935 (gdb)
26936 @end smallexample
26937
26938
26939 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26940 @findex -catch-unload
26941
26942 @subsubheading Synopsis
26943
26944 @smallexample
26945 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26946 @end smallexample
26947
26948 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26949 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26950 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26951 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26952 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26953
26954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26955
26956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26957
26958 @subsubheading Example
26959
26960 @smallexample
26961 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26962 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26963 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26964 (gdb)
26965 @end smallexample
26966
26967 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26968 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26969
26970 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26971 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26972
26973 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26974 @findex -catch-assert
26975
26976 @subsubheading Synopsis
26977
26978 @smallexample
26979 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26980 @end smallexample
26981
26982 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26983
26984 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26985
26986 @table @samp
26987 @item -c @var{condition}
26988 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26989 @item -d
26990 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26991 @item -t
26992 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26993 @end table
26994
26995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26996
26997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26998
26999 @subsubheading Example
27000
27001 @smallexample
27002 -catch-assert
27003 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27004 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27005 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27006 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27007 (gdb)
27008 @end smallexample
27009
27010 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27011 @findex -catch-exception
27012
27013 @subsubheading Synopsis
27014
27015 @smallexample
27016 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27017 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27018 @end smallexample
27019
27020 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27021 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27022 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27023 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27024 catchpoints.
27025
27026 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27027
27028 @table @samp
27029 @item -c @var{condition}
27030 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27031 @item -d
27032 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27033 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27034 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27035 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27036 @item -t
27037 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27038 @item -u
27039 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27040 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27041 @end table
27042
27043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27044
27045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27046 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27047
27048 @subsubheading Example
27049
27050 @smallexample
27051 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27052 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27053 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27054 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27055 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27056 (gdb)
27057 @end smallexample
27058
27059 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27060 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27061 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27062
27063 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27064 @findex -exec-arguments
27065
27066
27067 @subsubheading Synopsis
27068
27069 @smallexample
27070 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27071 @end smallexample
27072
27073 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27074 @samp{-exec-run}.
27075
27076 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27077
27078 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27079
27080 @subsubheading Example
27081
27082 @smallexample
27083 (gdb)
27084 -exec-arguments -v word
27085 ^done
27086 (gdb)
27087 @end smallexample
27088
27089
27090 @ignore
27091 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27092 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27093
27094 @subsubheading Synopsis
27095
27096 @smallexample
27097 -exec-show-arguments
27098 @end smallexample
27099
27100 Print the arguments of the program.
27101
27102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27103
27104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27105
27106 @subsubheading Example
27107 N.A.
27108 @end ignore
27109
27110
27111 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27112 @findex -environment-cd
27113
27114 @subsubheading Synopsis
27115
27116 @smallexample
27117 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27118 @end smallexample
27119
27120 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27121
27122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27123
27124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27125
27126 @subsubheading Example
27127
27128 @smallexample
27129 (gdb)
27130 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27131 ^done
27132 (gdb)
27133 @end smallexample
27134
27135
27136 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27137 @findex -environment-directory
27138
27139 @subsubheading Synopsis
27140
27141 @smallexample
27142 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27143 @end smallexample
27144
27145 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27146 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27147 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27148 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27149 occurs as normal.
27150 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27151 multiple directories in a single command
27152 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27153 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27154 If blanks are needed as
27155 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27156 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27157 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27158 character must not be used
27159 in any directory name.
27160 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27161
27162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27163
27164 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27165
27166 @subsubheading Example
27167
27168 @smallexample
27169 (gdb)
27170 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27171 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27172 (gdb)
27173 -environment-directory ""
27174 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27175 (gdb)
27176 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27177 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27178 (gdb)
27179 -environment-directory -r
27180 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27181 (gdb)
27182 @end smallexample
27183
27184
27185 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27186 @findex -environment-path
27187
27188 @subsubheading Synopsis
27189
27190 @smallexample
27191 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27192 @end smallexample
27193
27194 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27195 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27196 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27197 supplied in addition to the
27198 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27199 occurs as normal.
27200 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27201 multiple directories in a single command
27202 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27203 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27204 If blanks are needed as
27205 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27206 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27207 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27208 character must not be used
27209 in any directory name.
27210 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27211
27212
27213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27214
27215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27216
27217 @subsubheading Example
27218
27219 @smallexample
27220 (gdb)
27221 -environment-path
27222 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27223 (gdb)
27224 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27225 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27226 (gdb)
27227 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27228 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27229 (gdb)
27230 @end smallexample
27231
27232
27233 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27234 @findex -environment-pwd
27235
27236 @subsubheading Synopsis
27237
27238 @smallexample
27239 -environment-pwd
27240 @end smallexample
27241
27242 Show the current working directory.
27243
27244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27245
27246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27247
27248 @subsubheading Example
27249
27250 @smallexample
27251 (gdb)
27252 -environment-pwd
27253 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27254 (gdb)
27255 @end smallexample
27256
27257 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27258 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27259 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27260
27261
27262 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27263 @findex -thread-info
27264
27265 @subsubheading Synopsis
27266
27267 @smallexample
27268 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27269 @end smallexample
27270
27271 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27272 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27273 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27274 also reports the current thread.
27275
27276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27277
27278 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27279 about all threads.
27280
27281 @subsubheading Result
27282
27283 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27284 defined for a given thread:
27285
27286 @table @samp
27287 @item current
27288 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27289
27290 @item id
27291 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27292
27293 @item target-id
27294 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27295
27296 @item details
27297 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27298 field is optional.
27299
27300 @item name
27301 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27302 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27303 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27304 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27305 field is omitted.
27306
27307 @item frame
27308 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27309
27310 @item state
27311 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27312 values:
27313
27314 @table @code
27315 @item stopped
27316 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27317 threads.
27318
27319 @item running
27320 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27321 threads.
27322
27323 @end table
27324
27325 @item core
27326 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27327 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27328
27329 @end table
27330
27331 @subsubheading Example
27332
27333 @smallexample
27334 -thread-info
27335 ^done,threads=[
27336 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27337 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27338 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27339 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27340 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27341 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27342 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27343 state="running"@}],
27344 current-thread-id="1"
27345 (gdb)
27346 @end smallexample
27347
27348 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27349 @findex -thread-list-ids
27350
27351 @subsubheading Synopsis
27352
27353 @smallexample
27354 -thread-list-ids
27355 @end smallexample
27356
27357 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27358 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27359
27360 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27361 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27362
27363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27364
27365 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27366
27367 @subsubheading Example
27368
27369 @smallexample
27370 (gdb)
27371 -thread-list-ids
27372 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27373 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27374 (gdb)
27375 @end smallexample
27376
27377
27378 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27379 @findex -thread-select
27380
27381 @subsubheading Synopsis
27382
27383 @smallexample
27384 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27385 @end smallexample
27386
27387 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27388 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27389
27390 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27391 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27392
27393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27394
27395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27396
27397 @subsubheading Example
27398
27399 @smallexample
27400 (gdb)
27401 -exec-next
27402 ^running
27403 (gdb)
27404 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27405 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27406 (gdb)
27407 -thread-list-ids
27408 ^done,
27409 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27410 number-of-threads="3"
27411 (gdb)
27412 -thread-select 3
27413 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27414 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27415 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27416 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27417 (gdb)
27418 @end smallexample
27419
27420 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27421 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27422 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27423
27424 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27425 @findex -ada-task-info
27426
27427 @subsubheading Synopsis
27428
27429 @smallexample
27430 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27431 @end smallexample
27432
27433 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27434 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27435
27436 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27437
27438 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27439 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27440
27441 @subsubheading Result
27442
27443 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27444 defined for each Ada task:
27445
27446 @table @samp
27447 @item current
27448 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27449
27450 @item id
27451 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27452
27453 @item task-id
27454 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27455
27456 @item thread-id
27457 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27458
27459 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27460 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27461 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27462
27463 @item parent-id
27464 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27465 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27466
27467 @item priority
27468 The base priority of the task.
27469
27470 @item state
27471 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27472 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27473
27474 @item name
27475 The name of the task.
27476
27477 @end table
27478
27479 @subsubheading Example
27480
27481 @smallexample
27482 -ada-task-info
27483 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27484 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27485 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27486 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27487 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27488 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27489 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27490 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27491 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27492 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27493 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27494 (gdb)
27495 @end smallexample
27496
27497 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27498 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27499 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27500
27501 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27502 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27503 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27504 other cases.
27505
27506 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27507 @findex -exec-continue
27508
27509 @subsubheading Synopsis
27510
27511 @smallexample
27512 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27513 @end smallexample
27514
27515 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27516 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27517 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27518 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27519 @itemize @bullet
27520 @item
27521 breakpoints or watchpoints
27522 @item
27523 signals or exceptions
27524 @item
27525 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27526 @item
27527 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27528 @end itemize
27529 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27530 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27531 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27532 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27533 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27534 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27535
27536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27537
27538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27539
27540 @subsubheading Example
27541
27542 @smallexample
27543 -exec-continue
27544 ^running
27545 (gdb)
27546 @@Hello world
27547 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27548 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27549 line="13"@}
27550 (gdb)
27551 @end smallexample
27552
27553
27554 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27555 @findex -exec-finish
27556
27557 @subsubheading Synopsis
27558
27559 @smallexample
27560 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27561 @end smallexample
27562
27563 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27564 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27565 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27566 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27567 function was called.
27568
27569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27570
27571 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27572
27573 @subsubheading Example
27574
27575 Function returning @code{void}.
27576
27577 @smallexample
27578 -exec-finish
27579 ^running
27580 (gdb)
27581 @@hello from foo
27582 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27583 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27584 (gdb)
27585 @end smallexample
27586
27587 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27588 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27589 value itself.
27590
27591 @smallexample
27592 -exec-finish
27593 ^running
27594 (gdb)
27595 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27596 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27597 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27598 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27599 (gdb)
27600 @end smallexample
27601
27602
27603 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27604 @findex -exec-interrupt
27605
27606 @subsubheading Synopsis
27607
27608 @smallexample
27609 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27610 @end smallexample
27611
27612 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27613 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27614 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27615 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27616 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27617
27618 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27619 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27620 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27621 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27622
27623 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27624 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27625 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27626 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27627
27628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27629
27630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27631
27632 @subsubheading Example
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 (gdb)
27636 111-exec-continue
27637 111^running
27638
27639 (gdb)
27640 222-exec-interrupt
27641 222^done
27642 (gdb)
27643 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27644 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27645 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27646 (gdb)
27647
27648 (gdb)
27649 -exec-interrupt
27650 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27651 (gdb)
27652 @end smallexample
27653
27654 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27655 @findex -exec-jump
27656
27657 @subsubheading Synopsis
27658
27659 @smallexample
27660 -exec-jump @var{location}
27661 @end smallexample
27662
27663 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27664 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27665 different forms of @var{location}.
27666
27667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27668
27669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27670
27671 @subsubheading Example
27672
27673 @smallexample
27674 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27675 *running,thread-id="all"
27676 ^running
27677 @end smallexample
27678
27679
27680 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27681 @findex -exec-next
27682
27683 @subsubheading Synopsis
27684
27685 @smallexample
27686 -exec-next [--reverse]
27687 @end smallexample
27688
27689 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27690 of the next source line is reached.
27691
27692 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27693 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27694 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27695 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27696 source line where the function was called.
27697
27698
27699 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27700
27701 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27702
27703 @subsubheading Example
27704
27705 @smallexample
27706 -exec-next
27707 ^running
27708 (gdb)
27709 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27710 (gdb)
27711 @end smallexample
27712
27713
27714 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27715 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27716
27717 @subsubheading Synopsis
27718
27719 @smallexample
27720 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27721 @end smallexample
27722
27723 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27724 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27725 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27726 printed as well.
27727
27728 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27729 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27730 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27731 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27732 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27733
27734 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27735
27736 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27737
27738 @subsubheading Example
27739
27740 @smallexample
27741 (gdb)
27742 -exec-next-instruction
27743 ^running
27744
27745 (gdb)
27746 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27747 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27748 (gdb)
27749 @end smallexample
27750
27751
27752 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27753 @findex -exec-return
27754
27755 @subsubheading Synopsis
27756
27757 @smallexample
27758 -exec-return
27759 @end smallexample
27760
27761 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27762 Displays the new current frame.
27763
27764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27765
27766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27767
27768 @subsubheading Example
27769
27770 @smallexample
27771 (gdb)
27772 200-break-insert callee4
27773 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27774 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27775 (gdb)
27776 000-exec-run
27777 000^running
27778 (gdb)
27779 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27780 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27781 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27782 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27783 (gdb)
27784 205-break-delete
27785 205^done
27786 (gdb)
27787 111-exec-return
27788 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27789 args=[@{name="strarg",
27790 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27791 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27792 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27793 (gdb)
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796
27797 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27798 @findex -exec-run
27799
27800 @subsubheading Synopsis
27801
27802 @smallexample
27803 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27804 @end smallexample
27805
27806 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27807 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27808 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27809 the program has exited exceptionally.
27810
27811 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27812 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27813 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27814 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27815 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27816
27817 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27818 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27819 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27820 (@pxref{Starting}).
27821
27822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27823
27824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27825
27826 @subsubheading Examples
27827
27828 @smallexample
27829 (gdb)
27830 -break-insert main
27831 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27832 (gdb)
27833 -exec-run
27834 ^running
27835 (gdb)
27836 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27837 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27838 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27839 (gdb)
27840 @end smallexample
27841
27842 @noindent
27843 Program exited normally:
27844
27845 @smallexample
27846 (gdb)
27847 -exec-run
27848 ^running
27849 (gdb)
27850 x = 55
27851 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27852 (gdb)
27853 @end smallexample
27854
27855 @noindent
27856 Program exited exceptionally:
27857
27858 @smallexample
27859 (gdb)
27860 -exec-run
27861 ^running
27862 (gdb)
27863 x = 55
27864 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27865 (gdb)
27866 @end smallexample
27867
27868 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27869 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27870
27871 @smallexample
27872 (gdb)
27873 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27874 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27875 @end smallexample
27876
27877
27878 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27879
27880
27881 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27882 @findex -exec-step
27883
27884 @subsubheading Synopsis
27885
27886 @smallexample
27887 -exec-step [--reverse]
27888 @end smallexample
27889
27890 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27891 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27892 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27893 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27894 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27895 previously executed source line.
27896
27897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27898
27899 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27900
27901 @subsubheading Example
27902
27903 Stepping into a function:
27904
27905 @smallexample
27906 -exec-step
27907 ^running
27908 (gdb)
27909 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27910 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27911 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27912 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27913 (gdb)
27914 @end smallexample
27915
27916 Regular stepping:
27917
27918 @smallexample
27919 -exec-step
27920 ^running
27921 (gdb)
27922 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27923 (gdb)
27924 @end smallexample
27925
27926
27927 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27928 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27929
27930 @subsubheading Synopsis
27931
27932 @smallexample
27933 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27934 @end smallexample
27935
27936 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27937 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27938 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27939 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27940 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27941 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27942 as well.
27943
27944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27945
27946 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27947
27948 @subsubheading Example
27949
27950 @smallexample
27951 (gdb)
27952 -exec-step-instruction
27953 ^running
27954
27955 (gdb)
27956 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27957 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27958 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27959 (gdb)
27960 -exec-step-instruction
27961 ^running
27962
27963 (gdb)
27964 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27965 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27966 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27967 (gdb)
27968 @end smallexample
27969
27970
27971 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27972 @findex -exec-until
27973
27974 @subsubheading Synopsis
27975
27976 @smallexample
27977 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27978 @end smallexample
27979
27980 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27981 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27982 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27983 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27984
27985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27986
27987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27988
27989 @subsubheading Example
27990
27991 @smallexample
27992 (gdb)
27993 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27994 ^running
27995 (gdb)
27996 x = 55
27997 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27998 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27999 (gdb)
28000 @end smallexample
28001
28002 @ignore
28003 @subheading -file-clear
28004 Is this going away????
28005 @end ignore
28006
28007 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28008 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28009 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28010
28011 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28012 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28013
28014 @smallexample
28015 -enable-frame-filters
28016 @end smallexample
28017
28018 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28019 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28020 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28021 request that this functionality be enabled.
28022
28023 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28024
28025 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28026 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28027
28028 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28029 @findex -stack-info-frame
28030
28031 @subsubheading Synopsis
28032
28033 @smallexample
28034 -stack-info-frame
28035 @end smallexample
28036
28037 Get info on the selected frame.
28038
28039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28040
28041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28042 (without arguments).
28043
28044 @subsubheading Example
28045
28046 @smallexample
28047 (gdb)
28048 -stack-info-frame
28049 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28050 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28051 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28052 (gdb)
28053 @end smallexample
28054
28055 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28056 @findex -stack-info-depth
28057
28058 @subsubheading Synopsis
28059
28060 @smallexample
28061 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28062 @end smallexample
28063
28064 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28065 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28066
28067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28068
28069 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28070
28071 @subsubheading Example
28072
28073 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28074
28075 @smallexample
28076 (gdb)
28077 -stack-info-depth
28078 ^done,depth="12"
28079 (gdb)
28080 -stack-info-depth 4
28081 ^done,depth="4"
28082 (gdb)
28083 -stack-info-depth 12
28084 ^done,depth="12"
28085 (gdb)
28086 -stack-info-depth 11
28087 ^done,depth="11"
28088 (gdb)
28089 -stack-info-depth 13
28090 ^done,depth="12"
28091 (gdb)
28092 @end smallexample
28093
28094 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28095 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28096 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28097
28098 @subsubheading Synopsis
28099
28100 @smallexample
28101 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28102 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28103 @end smallexample
28104
28105 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28106 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28107 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28108 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28109 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28110 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28111 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28112 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28113
28114 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28115 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28116 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28117 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28118 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28119 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28120
28121 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28122 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28123 are still displayed, however.
28124
28125 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28126 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28127
28128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28129
28130 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28131 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28132 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28133
28134 @subsubheading Example
28135
28136 @smallexample
28137 (gdb)
28138 -stack-list-frames
28139 ^done,
28140 stack=[
28141 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28142 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28143 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28144 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28145 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28146 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28147 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28148 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28149 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28150 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28151 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28152 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28153 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28154 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28155 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28156 (gdb)
28157 -stack-list-arguments 0
28158 ^done,
28159 stack-args=[
28160 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28161 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28162 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28163 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28164 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28165 (gdb)
28166 -stack-list-arguments 1
28167 ^done,
28168 stack-args=[
28169 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28170 frame=@{level="1",
28171 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28172 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28173 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28174 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28175 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28176 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28177 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28178 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28179 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28180 (gdb)
28181 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28182 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28183 (gdb)
28184 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28185 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28186 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28187 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28188 (gdb)
28189 @end smallexample
28190
28191 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28192
28193
28194 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28195 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28196 @findex -stack-list-frames
28197
28198 @subsubheading Synopsis
28199
28200 @smallexample
28201 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28202 @end smallexample
28203
28204 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28205 following info:
28206
28207 @table @samp
28208 @item @var{level}
28209 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28210 @item @var{addr}
28211 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28212 @item @var{func}
28213 Function name.
28214 @item @var{file}
28215 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28216 @item @var{fullname}
28217 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28218 @item @var{line}
28219 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28220 @item @var{from}
28221 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28222 if the frame's function is not known.
28223 @end table
28224
28225 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28226 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28227 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28228 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28229 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28230 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28231 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28232 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28233 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28234
28235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28236
28237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28238
28239 @subsubheading Example
28240
28241 Full stack backtrace:
28242
28243 @smallexample
28244 (gdb)
28245 -stack-list-frames
28246 ^done,stack=
28247 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28248 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28249 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28250 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28251 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28252 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28253 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28254 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28255 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28256 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28257 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28258 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28259 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28260 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28261 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28262 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28263 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28264 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28265 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28266 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28267 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28268 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28269 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28270 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28271 (gdb)
28272 @end smallexample
28273
28274 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28275
28276 @smallexample
28277 (gdb)
28278 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28279 ^done,stack=
28280 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28281 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28282 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28283 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28284 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28285 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28286 (gdb)
28287 @end smallexample
28288
28289 Show a single frame:
28290
28291 @smallexample
28292 (gdb)
28293 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28294 ^done,stack=
28295 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28297 (gdb)
28298 @end smallexample
28299
28300
28301 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28302 @findex -stack-list-locals
28303 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28304
28305 @subsubheading Synopsis
28306
28307 @smallexample
28308 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28309 @end smallexample
28310
28311 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28312 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28313 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28314 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28315 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28316 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28317 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28318 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28319 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28320 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28321
28322 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28323 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28324 variables are still displayed, however.
28325
28326 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28327 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28328
28329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28330
28331 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28332
28333 @subsubheading Example
28334
28335 @smallexample
28336 (gdb)
28337 -stack-list-locals 0
28338 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28339 (gdb)
28340 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28341 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28342 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28343 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28344 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28345 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28346 (gdb)
28347 @end smallexample
28348
28349 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28350 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28351 @findex -stack-list-variables
28352
28353 @subsubheading Synopsis
28354
28355 @smallexample
28356 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28357 @end smallexample
28358
28359 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28360 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28361 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28362 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28363 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28364 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28365 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28366
28367 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28368 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28369 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28370
28371 @subsubheading Example
28372
28373 @smallexample
28374 (gdb)
28375 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28376 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28377 (gdb)
28378 @end smallexample
28379
28380
28381 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28382 @findex -stack-select-frame
28383
28384 @subsubheading Synopsis
28385
28386 @smallexample
28387 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28388 @end smallexample
28389
28390 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28391 the stack.
28392
28393 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28394 option to every command.
28395
28396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28397
28398 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28399 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28400
28401 @subsubheading Example
28402
28403 @smallexample
28404 (gdb)
28405 -stack-select-frame 2
28406 ^done
28407 (gdb)
28408 @end smallexample
28409
28410 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28411 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28412 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28413
28414 @ignore
28415
28416 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28417
28418 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28419 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28420 used by @code{Insight}.
28421
28422 The two main reasons for that are:
28423
28424 @enumerate 1
28425 @item
28426 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28427
28428 @item
28429 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28430 now).
28431 @end enumerate
28432
28433 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28434 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28435 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28436 hints about their use.
28437
28438 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28439 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28440 least, the following operations:
28441
28442 @itemize @bullet
28443 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28444 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28445 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28446 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28447 @end itemize
28448
28449 @end ignore
28450
28451 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28452
28453 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28454
28455 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28456 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28457 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28458 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28459 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28460 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28461 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28462 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28463 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28464 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28465 object, or to change display format.
28466
28467 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28468 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28469 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28470 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28471 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28472 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28473 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28474 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28475 child will be created.
28476
28477 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28478 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28479 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28480 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28481 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28482
28483 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28484 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28485 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28486 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28487 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28488 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28489 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28490 variables that frontend has created.
28491
28492 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28493 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28494 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28495 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28496 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28497 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28498 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28499 implicitly updated.
28500
28501 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28502 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28503 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28504 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28505 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28506 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28507 frame. Consider this example:
28508
28509 @smallexample
28510 void do_work(...)
28511 @{
28512 struct work_state state;
28513
28514 if (...)
28515 do_work(...);
28516 @}
28517 @end smallexample
28518
28519 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28520 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28521 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28522 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28523 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28524
28525 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28526 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28527 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28528 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28529 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28530 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28531
28532 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28533 access this functionality:
28534
28535 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28536 @item @strong{Operation}
28537 @tab @strong{Description}
28538
28539 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28540 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28541 @item @code{-var-create}
28542 @tab create a variable object
28543 @item @code{-var-delete}
28544 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28545 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28546 @tab set the display format of this variable
28547 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28548 @tab show the display format of this variable
28549 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28550 @tab tells how many children this object has
28551 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28552 @tab return a list of the object's children
28553 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28554 @tab show the type of this variable object
28555 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28556 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28557 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28558 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28559 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28560 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28561 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28562 @tab get the value of this variable
28563 @item @code{-var-assign}
28564 @tab set the value of this variable
28565 @item @code{-var-update}
28566 @tab update the variable and its children
28567 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28568 @tab set frozeness attribute
28569 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28570 @tab set range of children to display on update
28571 @end multitable
28572
28573 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28574 how it can be used.
28575
28576 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28577
28578 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28579 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28580
28581 @smallexample
28582 -enable-pretty-printing
28583 @end smallexample
28584
28585 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28586 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28587 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28588 request that this functionality be enabled.
28589
28590 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28591
28592 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28593 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28594
28595 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28596 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28597
28598 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28599 @findex -var-create
28600
28601 @subsubheading Synopsis
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28605 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28606 @end smallexample
28607
28608 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28609 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28610 register.
28611
28612 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28613 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28614 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28615 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28616 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28617
28618 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28619 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28620 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28621 object must be created.
28622
28623 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28624 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28625
28626 @itemize @bullet
28627 @item
28628 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28629
28630 @item
28631 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28632
28633 @item
28634 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28635 @end itemize
28636
28637 @cindex dynamic varobj
28638 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28639 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28640 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28641 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28642 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28643 compatibility for existing clients.
28644
28645 @subsubheading Result
28646
28647 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28648 are:
28649
28650 @table @samp
28651 @item name
28652 The name of the varobj.
28653
28654 @item numchild
28655 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28656 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28657 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28658
28659 @item value
28660 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28661 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28662 will not be interesting.
28663
28664 @item type
28665 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28666 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28667 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28668 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28669 @emph{declared} one.
28670
28671 @item thread-id
28672 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28673 thread's identifier.
28674
28675 @item has_more
28676 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28677 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28678
28679 @item dynamic
28680 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28681 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28682 then this attribute will not be present.
28683
28684 @item displayhint
28685 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28686 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28687 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28688 @end table
28689
28690 Typical output will look like this:
28691
28692 @smallexample
28693 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28694 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28695 @end smallexample
28696
28697
28698 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28699 @findex -var-delete
28700
28701 @subsubheading Synopsis
28702
28703 @smallexample
28704 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28705 @end smallexample
28706
28707 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28708 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28709
28710 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28711
28712
28713 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28714 @findex -var-set-format
28715
28716 @subsubheading Synopsis
28717
28718 @smallexample
28719 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28720 @end smallexample
28721
28722 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28723 @var{format-spec}.
28724
28725 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28726 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28727
28728 @smallexample
28729 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28730 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28731 @end smallexample
28732
28733 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28734 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28735 for pointers, etc.).
28736
28737 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28738 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28739
28740 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28741 @findex -var-show-format
28742
28743 @subsubheading Synopsis
28744
28745 @smallexample
28746 -var-show-format @var{name}
28747 @end smallexample
28748
28749 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28750
28751 @smallexample
28752 @var{format} @expansion{}
28753 @var{format-spec}
28754 @end smallexample
28755
28756
28757 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28758 @findex -var-info-num-children
28759
28760 @subsubheading Synopsis
28761
28762 @smallexample
28763 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28764 @end smallexample
28765
28766 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28767
28768 @smallexample
28769 numchild=@var{n}
28770 @end smallexample
28771
28772 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28773 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28774 be available.
28775
28776
28777 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28778 @findex -var-list-children
28779
28780 @subsubheading Synopsis
28781
28782 @smallexample
28783 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28784 @end smallexample
28785 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28786
28787 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28788 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28789 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28790 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28791 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28792 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28793 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28794 and unions.
28795
28796 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28797 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28798 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28799 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28800 reported.
28801
28802 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28803 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28804 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28805 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28806 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28807 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28808 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28809 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28810 the visible items.
28811
28812 For each child the following results are returned:
28813
28814 @table @var
28815
28816 @item name
28817 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28818
28819 @item exp
28820 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28821 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28822
28823 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28824 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28825
28826 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28827 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28828 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28829 type and value are not present.
28830
28831 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28832 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28833 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28834
28835 @item numchild
28836 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28837 0.
28838
28839 @item type
28840 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28841 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28842 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28843 @emph{declared} one.
28844
28845 @item value
28846 If values were requested, this is the value.
28847
28848 @item thread-id
28849 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28850 Otherwise this result is not present.
28851
28852 @item frozen
28853 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28854
28855 @item displayhint
28856 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28857 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28858 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28859
28860 @item dynamic
28861 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28862 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28863 then this attribute will not be present.
28864
28865 @end table
28866
28867 The result may have its own attributes:
28868
28869 @table @samp
28870 @item displayhint
28871 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28872 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28873 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28874
28875 @item has_more
28876 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28877 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28878 @end table
28879
28880 @subsubheading Example
28881
28882 @smallexample
28883 (gdb)
28884 -var-list-children n
28885 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28886 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28887 (gdb)
28888 -var-list-children --all-values n
28889 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28890 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28891 @end smallexample
28892
28893
28894 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28895 @findex -var-info-type
28896
28897 @subsubheading Synopsis
28898
28899 @smallexample
28900 -var-info-type @var{name}
28901 @end smallexample
28902
28903 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28904 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28905 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28906
28907 @smallexample
28908 type=@var{typename}
28909 @end smallexample
28910
28911
28912 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28913 @findex -var-info-expression
28914
28915 @subsubheading Synopsis
28916
28917 @smallexample
28918 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28919 @end smallexample
28920
28921 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28922 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28923 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28924
28925 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28926 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28927
28928 @smallexample
28929 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28930 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28931 @end smallexample
28932
28933 @noindent
28934 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28935 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28936
28937 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28938 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28939 is of limited use.
28940
28941 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28942 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28943
28944 @subsubheading Synopsis
28945
28946 @smallexample
28947 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28948 @end smallexample
28949
28950 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28951 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28952 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28953 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28954 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28955 watchpoint from a variable object.
28956
28957 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28958 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28959
28960 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28961 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28962 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28963 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28964 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28965 @smallexample
28966 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28967 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28968 @end smallexample
28969
28970 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28971 @findex -var-show-attributes
28972
28973 @subsubheading Synopsis
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28977 @end smallexample
28978
28979 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28980
28981 @smallexample
28982 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28983 @end smallexample
28984
28985 @noindent
28986 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28987
28988 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28989 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28990
28991 @subsubheading Synopsis
28992
28993 @smallexample
28994 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28995 @end smallexample
28996
28997 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28998 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28999 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29000 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29001 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29002 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29003 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29004
29005 @smallexample
29006 value=@var{value}
29007 @end smallexample
29008
29009 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29010 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29011
29012 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29013 @findex -var-assign
29014
29015 @subsubheading Synopsis
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29019 @end smallexample
29020
29021 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29022 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29023 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29024 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29025
29026 @subsubheading Example
29027
29028 @smallexample
29029 (gdb)
29030 -var-assign var1 3
29031 ^done,value="3"
29032 (gdb)
29033 -var-update *
29034 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29035 (gdb)
29036 @end smallexample
29037
29038 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29039 @findex -var-update
29040
29041 @subsubheading Synopsis
29042
29043 @smallexample
29044 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29045 @end smallexample
29046
29047 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29048 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29049 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29050 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29051 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29052 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29053 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29054 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29055 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29056 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29057 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29058 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29059 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29060
29061 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29062 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29063 diagnostic.
29064
29065 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29066 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29067
29068 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29069 @samp{changelist}.
29070
29071 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29072
29073 @table @samp
29074 @item name
29075 The name of the varobj.
29076
29077 @item value
29078 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29079 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29080
29081 @item in_scope
29082 @anchor{-var-update}
29083 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29084
29085 @table @code
29086 @item "true"
29087 The variable object's current value is valid.
29088
29089 @item "false"
29090 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29091 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29092 scope.
29093
29094 @item "invalid"
29095 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29096 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29097 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29098 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29099 objects.
29100 @end table
29101
29102 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29103 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29104
29105 @item type_changed
29106 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29107 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29108 be @samp{false}.
29109
29110 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29111 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29112 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29113 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29114 unset.
29115
29116 @item new_type
29117 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29118 hold the new type.
29119
29120 @item new_num_children
29121 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29122 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29123
29124 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29125 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29126 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29127 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29128 children which may be available.
29129
29130 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29131 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29132 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29133 only happen at the end of the update range).
29134
29135 @item displayhint
29136 The display hint, if any.
29137
29138 @item has_more
29139 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29140 available outside the varobj's update range.
29141
29142 @item dynamic
29143 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29144 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29145 then this attribute will not be present.
29146
29147 @item new_children
29148 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29149 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29150 be listed in this attribute.
29151 @end table
29152
29153 @subsubheading Example
29154
29155 @smallexample
29156 (gdb)
29157 -var-assign var1 3
29158 ^done,value="3"
29159 (gdb)
29160 -var-update --all-values var1
29161 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29162 type_changed="false"@}]
29163 (gdb)
29164 @end smallexample
29165
29166 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29167 @findex -var-set-frozen
29168 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29169
29170 @subsubheading Synopsis
29171
29172 @smallexample
29173 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29174 @end smallexample
29175
29176 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29177 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29178 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29179 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29180 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29181 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29182 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29183 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29184 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29185 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29186 @code{-var-update} does.
29187
29188 @subsubheading Example
29189
29190 @smallexample
29191 (gdb)
29192 -var-set-frozen V 1
29193 ^done
29194 (gdb)
29195 @end smallexample
29196
29197 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29198 @findex -var-set-update-range
29199 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29200
29201 @subsubheading Synopsis
29202
29203 @smallexample
29204 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29205 @end smallexample
29206
29207 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29208 @code{-var-update}.
29209
29210 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29211 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29212 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29213 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29214
29215 @subsubheading Example
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29220 ^done
29221 @end smallexample
29222
29223 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29224 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29225 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29226
29227 @subsubheading Synopsis
29228
29229 @smallexample
29230 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29231 @end smallexample
29232
29233 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29234
29235 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29236 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29237
29238 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29239 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29240 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29241 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29242 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29243 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29244 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29245
29246 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29247 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29248 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29249 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29250
29251 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29252 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29253 can be used to check this.
29254
29255 @subsubheading Example
29256
29257 Resetting the visualizer:
29258
29259 @smallexample
29260 (gdb)
29261 -var-set-visualizer V None
29262 ^done
29263 @end smallexample
29264
29265 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29266
29267 @smallexample
29268 (gdb)
29269 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29270 ^done
29271 @end smallexample
29272
29273 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29274 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29279 ^done
29280 @end smallexample
29281
29282 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29283 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29284 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29285
29286 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29287 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29288 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29289 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29290
29291 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29292 @c @subheading -data-assign
29293 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29294 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29295 @c set variable
29296 @c @subsubheading Example
29297 @c N.A.
29298
29299 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29300 @findex -data-disassemble
29301
29302 @subsubheading Synopsis
29303
29304 @smallexample
29305 -data-disassemble
29306 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29307 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29308 -- @var{mode}
29309 @end smallexample
29310
29311 @noindent
29312 Where:
29313
29314 @table @samp
29315 @item @var{start-addr}
29316 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29317 @item @var{end-addr}
29318 is the end address
29319 @item @var{filename}
29320 is the name of the file to disassemble
29321 @item @var{linenum}
29322 is the line number to disassemble around
29323 @item @var{lines}
29324 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29325 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29326 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29327 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29328 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29329 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29330 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29331 are displayed.
29332 @item @var{mode}
29333 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29334 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29335 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29336 @end table
29337
29338 @subsubheading Result
29339
29340 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29341 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29342 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29343
29344 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29345 following fields:
29346
29347 @table @code
29348 @item address
29349 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29350
29351 @item func-name
29352 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29353
29354 @item offset
29355 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29356
29357 @item inst
29358 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29359
29360 @item opcodes
29361 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29362 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29363
29364 @end table
29365
29366 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29367 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29368
29369 @table @code
29370 @item line
29371 The line number within @samp{file}.
29372
29373 @item file
29374 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29375 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29376 used.
29377
29378 @item fullname
29379 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29380 using the source file search path
29381 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29382 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29383
29384 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29385 present in the debug information.
29386
29387 @item line_asm_insn
29388 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29389 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29390 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29391 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29392 @samp{opcodes}.
29393
29394 @end table
29395
29396 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29397 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29398 adjust its format.
29399
29400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29401
29402 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29403
29404 @subsubheading Example
29405
29406 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29407
29408 @smallexample
29409 (gdb)
29410 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29411 ^done,
29412 asm_insns=[
29413 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29414 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29415 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29416 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29417 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29418 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29419 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29420 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29421 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29422 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29423 (gdb)
29424 @end smallexample
29425
29426 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29427 @code{main}.
29428
29429 @smallexample
29430 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29431 ^done,asm_insns=[
29432 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29433 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29434 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29435 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29436 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29437 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29438 [@dots{}]
29439 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29440 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29441 (gdb)
29442 @end smallexample
29443
29444 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29445
29446 @smallexample
29447 (gdb)
29448 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29449 ^done,asm_insns=[
29450 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29451 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29452 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29453 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29454 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29455 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29456 (gdb)
29457 @end smallexample
29458
29459 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29460
29461 @smallexample
29462 (gdb)
29463 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29464 ^done,asm_insns=[
29465 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29466 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29467 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29468 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29469 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29470 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29471 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29472 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29473 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29474 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29475 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29476 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29477 (gdb)
29478 @end smallexample
29479
29480
29481 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29482 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29483
29484 @subsubheading Synopsis
29485
29486 @smallexample
29487 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29488 @end smallexample
29489
29490 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29491 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29492 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29493
29494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29495
29496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29497 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29498 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29499
29500 @subsubheading Example
29501
29502 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29503 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29504 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29505 output.
29506
29507 @smallexample
29508 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29509 211^done,value="1"
29510 (gdb)
29511 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29512 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29513 (gdb)
29514 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29515 411^done,value="4"
29516 (gdb)
29517 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29518 511^done,value="4"
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29524 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29525
29526 @subsubheading Synopsis
29527
29528 @smallexample
29529 -data-list-changed-registers
29530 @end smallexample
29531
29532 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29533
29534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29535
29536 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29537 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29538
29539 @subsubheading Example
29540
29541 On a PPC MBX board:
29542
29543 @smallexample
29544 (gdb)
29545 -exec-continue
29546 ^running
29547
29548 (gdb)
29549 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29550 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29551 line="5"@}
29552 (gdb)
29553 -data-list-changed-registers
29554 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29555 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29556 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29557 (gdb)
29558 @end smallexample
29559
29560
29561 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29562 @findex -data-list-register-names
29563
29564 @subsubheading Synopsis
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29568 @end smallexample
29569
29570 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29571 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29572 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29573 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29574 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29575 include empty register names.
29576
29577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29578
29579 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29580 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29581 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29582
29583 @subsubheading Example
29584
29585 For the PPC MBX board:
29586 @smallexample
29587 (gdb)
29588 -data-list-register-names
29589 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29590 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29591 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29592 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29593 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29594 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29595 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29596 (gdb)
29597 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29598 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29599 (gdb)
29600 @end smallexample
29601
29602 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29603 @findex -data-list-register-values
29604
29605 @subsubheading Synopsis
29606
29607 @smallexample
29608 -data-list-register-values
29609 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29610 @end smallexample
29611
29612 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29613 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29614 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29615 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29616 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29617 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29618
29619 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29620
29621 @table @code
29622 @item x
29623 Hexadecimal
29624 @item o
29625 Octal
29626 @item t
29627 Binary
29628 @item d
29629 Decimal
29630 @item r
29631 Raw
29632 @item N
29633 Natural
29634 @end table
29635
29636 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29637
29638 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29639 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29640
29641 @subsubheading Example
29642
29643 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29644 don't appear in the actual output):
29645
29646 @smallexample
29647 (gdb)
29648 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29649 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29650 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29651 (gdb)
29652 -data-list-register-values x
29653 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29654 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29655 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29656 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29657 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29658 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29659 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29660 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29661 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29662 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29663 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29664 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29665 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29666 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29667 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29668 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29669 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29670 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29671 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29672 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29673 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29674 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29675 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29676 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29677 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29678 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29679 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29680 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29681 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29682 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29683 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29684 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29685 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29686 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29687 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29688 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29689 (gdb)
29690 @end smallexample
29691
29692
29693 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29694 @findex -data-read-memory
29695
29696 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29697
29698 @subsubheading Synopsis
29699
29700 @smallexample
29701 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29702 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29703 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29704 @end smallexample
29705
29706 @noindent
29707 where:
29708
29709 @table @samp
29710 @item @var{address}
29711 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29712 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29713 quoted using the C convention.
29714
29715 @item @var{word-format}
29716 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29717 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29718 ,Output Formats}).
29719
29720 @item @var{word-size}
29721 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29722
29723 @item @var{nr-rows}
29724 The number of rows in the output table.
29725
29726 @item @var{nr-cols}
29727 The number of columns in the output table.
29728
29729 @item @var{aschar}
29730 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29731 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29732 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29733 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29734
29735 @item @var{byte-offset}
29736 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29737 @end table
29738
29739 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29740 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29741 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29742 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29743 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29744 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29745 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29746 @samp{addr}.
29747
29748 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29749 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29750 @samp{prev-page}.
29751
29752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29753
29754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29755 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29756
29757 @subsubheading Example
29758
29759 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29760 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29761 word. Display each word in hex.
29762
29763 @smallexample
29764 (gdb)
29765 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29766 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29767 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29768 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29769 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29770 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29771 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29772 (gdb)
29773 @end smallexample
29774
29775 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29776 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29777
29778 @smallexample
29779 (gdb)
29780 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29781 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29782 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29783 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29784 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29785 (gdb)
29786 @end smallexample
29787
29788 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29789 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29790 used as the non-printable character.
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 (gdb)
29794 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29795 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29796 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29797 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29798 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29799 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29800 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29801 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29802 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29803 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29804 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29805 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29806 (gdb)
29807 @end smallexample
29808
29809 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29810 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29811
29812 @subsubheading Synopsis
29813
29814 @smallexample
29815 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29816 @var{address} @var{count}
29817 @end smallexample
29818
29819 @noindent
29820 where:
29821
29822 @table @samp
29823 @item @var{address}
29824 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29825 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29826 quoted using the C convention.
29827
29828 @item @var{count}
29829 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29830
29831 @item @var{byte-offset}
29832 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29833 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29834 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29835 perform address arithmetics itself.
29836
29837 @end table
29838
29839 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29840 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29841 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29842 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29843 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29844 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29845
29846 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29847 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29848 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29849 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29850 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29851 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29852 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29853 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29854
29855 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29856 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29857 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29858 and has the following fields:
29859
29860 @table @code
29861 @item begin
29862 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29863
29864 @item end
29865 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29866
29867 @item offset
29868 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29869 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29870
29871 @item contents
29872 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29873
29874 @end table
29875
29876
29877
29878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29879
29880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29881
29882 @subsubheading Example
29883
29884 @smallexample
29885 (gdb)
29886 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29887 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29888 end="0xbffff15e",
29889 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29890 (gdb)
29891 @end smallexample
29892
29893
29894 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29895 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29896
29897 @subsubheading Synopsis
29898
29899 @smallexample
29900 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29901 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29902 @end smallexample
29903
29904 @noindent
29905 where:
29906
29907 @table @samp
29908 @item @var{address}
29909 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29910 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29911 quoted using the C convention.
29912
29913 @item @var{contents}
29914 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29915
29916 @item @var{count}
29917 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29918 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29919 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29920
29921 @end table
29922
29923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29924
29925 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29926
29927 @subsubheading Example
29928
29929 @smallexample
29930 (gdb)
29931 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29932 ^done
29933 (gdb)
29934 @end smallexample
29935
29936 @smallexample
29937 (gdb)
29938 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29939 ^done
29940 (gdb)
29941 @end smallexample
29942
29943 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29944 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29945 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29946
29947 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29948 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29949
29950 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29951 @findex -trace-find
29952
29953 @subsubheading Synopsis
29954
29955 @smallexample
29956 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29957 @end smallexample
29958
29959 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29960 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29961 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29962
29963 @table @samp
29964
29965 @item none
29966 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29967
29968 @item frame-number
29969 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29970 that index.
29971
29972 @item tracepoint-number
29973 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29974 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29975
29976 @item pc
29977 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29978 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29979 address.
29980
29981 @item pc-inside-range
29982 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29983 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29984 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29985
29986 @item pc-outside-range
29987 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29988 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29989 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29990
29991 @item line
29992 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29993 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29994 the specified location.
29995
29996 @end table
29997
29998 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29999 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30000
30001 @table @samp
30002 @item found
30003 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30004 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30005
30006 @item traceframe
30007 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30008 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30009
30010 @item tracepoint
30011 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30012 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30013
30014 @item frame
30015 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30016 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30017 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30018
30019 @end table
30020
30021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30022
30023 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30024
30025 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30026 @findex -trace-define-variable
30027
30028 @subsubheading Synopsis
30029
30030 @smallexample
30031 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30032 @end smallexample
30033
30034 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30035 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30036 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30037 with the @samp{$} character.
30038
30039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30040
30041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30042
30043 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30044 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30045
30046 @subsubheading Synopsis
30047
30048 @smallexample
30049 -trace-frame-collected
30050 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30051 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30052 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30053 [--memory-contents]
30054 @end smallexample
30055
30056 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30057 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30058 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30059 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30060 See the output description table below for more details.
30061
30062 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30063 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30064 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30065 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30066 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30067
30068 For instance, if the actions were
30069 @smallexample
30070 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30071 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30072 @end smallexample
30073
30074 @noindent
30075 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30076 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30077 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30078 objects would be computed expressions.
30079
30080 An example output would be:
30081
30082 @smallexample
30083 (gdb)
30084 -trace-frame-collected
30085 ^done,
30086 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30087 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30088 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30089 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30090 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30091 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30092 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30093 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30094 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30095 ...
30096 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30097 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30098 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30099 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30100 (gdb)
30101 @end smallexample
30102
30103 Where:
30104
30105 @table @code
30106 @item explicit-variables
30107 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30108 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30109 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30110 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30111 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30112 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30113 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30114 arrays, structures and unions.
30115
30116 @item computed-expressions
30117 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30118 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30119 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30120 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30121
30122 @item registers
30123 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30124 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30125 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30126 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30127 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30128
30129 @item tvars
30130 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30131 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30132 current value are returned.
30133
30134 @item memory
30135 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30136 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30137 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30138
30139 @table @code
30140 @item address
30141 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30142
30143 @item length
30144 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30145
30146 @item contents
30147 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30148 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30149
30150 @end table
30151
30152 @end table
30153
30154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30155
30156 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30157
30158 @subsubheading Example
30159
30160 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30161 @findex -trace-list-variables
30162
30163 @subsubheading Synopsis
30164
30165 @smallexample
30166 -trace-list-variables
30167 @end smallexample
30168
30169 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30170 table has the following fields:
30171
30172 @table @samp
30173 @item name
30174 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30175
30176 @item initial
30177 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30178 field is always present.
30179
30180 @item current
30181 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30182 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30183 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30184 presently running.
30185
30186 @end table
30187
30188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30189
30190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30191
30192 @subsubheading Example
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 (gdb)
30196 -trace-list-variables
30197 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30198 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30199 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30200 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30201 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30202 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30203 (gdb)
30204 @end smallexample
30205
30206 @subheading -trace-save
30207 @findex -trace-save
30208
30209 @subsubheading Synopsis
30210
30211 @smallexample
30212 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30213 @end smallexample
30214
30215 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30216 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30217 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30218 to perform the save.
30219
30220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30221
30222 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30223
30224
30225 @subheading -trace-start
30226 @findex -trace-start
30227
30228 @subsubheading Synopsis
30229
30230 @smallexample
30231 -trace-start
30232 @end smallexample
30233
30234 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30235 have any fields.
30236
30237 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30238
30239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30240
30241 @subheading -trace-status
30242 @findex -trace-status
30243
30244 @subsubheading Synopsis
30245
30246 @smallexample
30247 -trace-status
30248 @end smallexample
30249
30250 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30251 the following fields:
30252
30253 @table @samp
30254
30255 @item supported
30256 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30257 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30258 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30259 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30260 started. This field is always present.
30261
30262 @item running
30263 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30264 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30265 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30266
30267 @item stop-reason
30268 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30269 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30270 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30271 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30272 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30273 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30274 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30275 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30276 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30277
30278 @item stopping-tracepoint
30279 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30280 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30281 @samp{passcount}.
30282
30283 @item frames
30284 @itemx frames-created
30285 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30286 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30287 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30288 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30289
30290 @item buffer-size
30291 @itemx buffer-free
30292 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30293 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30294
30295 @item circular
30296 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30297 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30298 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30299 and may fill up.
30300
30301 @item disconnected
30302 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30303 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30304 that the trace run will stop.
30305
30306 @item trace-file
30307 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30308 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30309
30310 @end table
30311
30312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30313
30314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30315
30316 @subheading -trace-stop
30317 @findex -trace-stop
30318
30319 @subsubheading Synopsis
30320
30321 @smallexample
30322 -trace-stop
30323 @end smallexample
30324
30325 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30326 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30327 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30328
30329 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30330
30331 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30332
30333
30334 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30335 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30336 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30337
30338
30339 @ignore
30340 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30341 @findex -symbol-info-address
30342
30343 @subsubheading Synopsis
30344
30345 @smallexample
30346 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30347 @end smallexample
30348
30349 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30350
30351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30352
30353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30354
30355 @subsubheading Example
30356 N.A.
30357
30358
30359 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30360 @findex -symbol-info-file
30361
30362 @subsubheading Synopsis
30363
30364 @smallexample
30365 -symbol-info-file
30366 @end smallexample
30367
30368 Show the file for the symbol.
30369
30370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30371
30372 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30373 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30374
30375 @subsubheading Example
30376 N.A.
30377
30378
30379 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30380 @findex -symbol-info-function
30381
30382 @subsubheading Synopsis
30383
30384 @smallexample
30385 -symbol-info-function
30386 @end smallexample
30387
30388 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30389
30390 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30391
30392 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30393
30394 @subsubheading Example
30395 N.A.
30396
30397
30398 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30399 @findex -symbol-info-line
30400
30401 @subsubheading Synopsis
30402
30403 @smallexample
30404 -symbol-info-line
30405 @end smallexample
30406
30407 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30408
30409 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30410
30411 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30412 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30413
30414 @subsubheading Example
30415 N.A.
30416
30417
30418 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30419 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30420
30421 @subsubheading Synopsis
30422
30423 @smallexample
30424 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30425 @end smallexample
30426
30427 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30428
30429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30430
30431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30432
30433 @subsubheading Example
30434 N.A.
30435
30436
30437 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30438 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30439
30440 @subsubheading Synopsis
30441
30442 @smallexample
30443 -symbol-list-functions
30444 @end smallexample
30445
30446 List the functions in the executable.
30447
30448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30449
30450 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30451 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30452
30453 @subsubheading Example
30454 N.A.
30455 @end ignore
30456
30457
30458 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30459 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30460
30461 @subsubheading Synopsis
30462
30463 @smallexample
30464 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30465 @end smallexample
30466
30467 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30468 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30469 ascending PC order.
30470
30471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30472
30473 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30474
30475 @subsubheading Example
30476 @smallexample
30477 (gdb)
30478 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30479 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30480 (gdb)
30481 @end smallexample
30482
30483
30484 @ignore
30485 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30486 @findex -symbol-list-types
30487
30488 @subsubheading Synopsis
30489
30490 @smallexample
30491 -symbol-list-types
30492 @end smallexample
30493
30494 List all the type names.
30495
30496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30497
30498 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30499 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30500
30501 @subsubheading Example
30502 N.A.
30503
30504
30505 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30506 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30507
30508 @subsubheading Synopsis
30509
30510 @smallexample
30511 -symbol-list-variables
30512 @end smallexample
30513
30514 List all the global and static variable names.
30515
30516 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30517
30518 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30519
30520 @subsubheading Example
30521 N.A.
30522
30523
30524 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30525 @findex -symbol-locate
30526
30527 @subsubheading Synopsis
30528
30529 @smallexample
30530 -symbol-locate
30531 @end smallexample
30532
30533 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30534
30535 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30536
30537 @subsubheading Example
30538 N.A.
30539
30540
30541 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30542 @findex -symbol-type
30543
30544 @subsubheading Synopsis
30545
30546 @smallexample
30547 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30548 @end smallexample
30549
30550 Show type of @var{variable}.
30551
30552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30553
30554 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30555 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30556
30557 @subsubheading Example
30558 N.A.
30559 @end ignore
30560
30561
30562 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30563 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30564 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30565
30566 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30567 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30568
30569 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30570 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30571
30572 @subsubheading Synopsis
30573
30574 @smallexample
30575 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30576 @end smallexample
30577
30578 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30579 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30580 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30581 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30582 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30583 notification.
30584
30585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30586
30587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30588
30589 @subsubheading Example
30590
30591 @smallexample
30592 (gdb)
30593 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30594 ^done
30595 (gdb)
30596 @end smallexample
30597
30598
30599 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30600 @findex -file-exec-file
30601
30602 @subsubheading Synopsis
30603
30604 @smallexample
30605 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30606 @end smallexample
30607
30608 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30609 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30610 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30611 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30612 notification.
30613
30614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30615
30616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30617
30618 @subsubheading Example
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 (gdb)
30622 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30623 ^done
30624 (gdb)
30625 @end smallexample
30626
30627
30628 @ignore
30629 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30630 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30631
30632 @subsubheading Synopsis
30633
30634 @smallexample
30635 -file-list-exec-sections
30636 @end smallexample
30637
30638 List the sections of the current executable file.
30639
30640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30641
30642 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30643 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30644 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30645
30646 @subsubheading Example
30647 N.A.
30648 @end ignore
30649
30650
30651 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30652 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30653
30654 @subsubheading Synopsis
30655
30656 @smallexample
30657 -file-list-exec-source-file
30658 @end smallexample
30659
30660 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30661 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30662 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30663 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30664
30665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30666
30667 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30668
30669 @subsubheading Example
30670
30671 @smallexample
30672 (gdb)
30673 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30674 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30675 (gdb)
30676 @end smallexample
30677
30678
30679 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30680 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30681
30682 @subsubheading Synopsis
30683
30684 @smallexample
30685 -file-list-exec-source-files
30686 @end smallexample
30687
30688 List the source files for the current executable.
30689
30690 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30691 name) of a source file.
30692
30693 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30694
30695 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30696 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30697
30698 @subsubheading Example
30699 @smallexample
30700 (gdb)
30701 -file-list-exec-source-files
30702 ^done,files=[
30703 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30704 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30705 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30706 (gdb)
30707 @end smallexample
30708
30709 @ignore
30710 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30711 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30712
30713 @subsubheading Synopsis
30714
30715 @smallexample
30716 -file-list-shared-libraries
30717 @end smallexample
30718
30719 List the shared libraries in the program.
30720
30721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30722
30723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30724
30725 @subsubheading Example
30726 N.A.
30727
30728
30729 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30730 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30731
30732 @subsubheading Synopsis
30733
30734 @smallexample
30735 -file-list-symbol-files
30736 @end smallexample
30737
30738 List symbol files.
30739
30740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30741
30742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30743
30744 @subsubheading Example
30745 N.A.
30746 @end ignore
30747
30748
30749 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30750 @findex -file-symbol-file
30751
30752 @subsubheading Synopsis
30753
30754 @smallexample
30755 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30756 @end smallexample
30757
30758 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30759 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30760 produced, except for a completion notification.
30761
30762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30763
30764 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30765
30766 @subsubheading Example
30767
30768 @smallexample
30769 (gdb)
30770 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30771 ^done
30772 (gdb)
30773 @end smallexample
30774
30775 @ignore
30776 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30777 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30778 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30779
30780 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30781
30782 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30783
30784 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30785
30786 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30787
30788 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30789
30790 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30791
30792 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30793
30794 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30795
30796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30797 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30799
30800 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30801
30802 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30803
30804 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30805
30806 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30807 @end ignore
30808
30809
30810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30811 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30813
30814
30815 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30816 @findex -target-attach
30817
30818 @subsubheading Synopsis
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30822 @end smallexample
30823
30824 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30825 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30826 group, the id previously returned by
30827 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30828
30829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30830
30831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30832
30833 @subsubheading Example
30834 @smallexample
30835 (gdb)
30836 -target-attach 34
30837 =thread-created,id="1"
30838 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30839 ^done
30840 (gdb)
30841 @end smallexample
30842
30843 @ignore
30844 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30845 @findex -target-compare-sections
30846
30847 @subsubheading Synopsis
30848
30849 @smallexample
30850 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30851 @end smallexample
30852
30853 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30854 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30855
30856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30857
30858 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30859
30860 @subsubheading Example
30861 N.A.
30862 @end ignore
30863
30864
30865 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30866 @findex -target-detach
30867
30868 @subsubheading Synopsis
30869
30870 @smallexample
30871 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30872 @end smallexample
30873
30874 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30875 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30876 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30877
30878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30879
30880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30881
30882 @subsubheading Example
30883
30884 @smallexample
30885 (gdb)
30886 -target-detach
30887 ^done
30888 (gdb)
30889 @end smallexample
30890
30891
30892 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30893 @findex -target-disconnect
30894
30895 @subsubheading Synopsis
30896
30897 @smallexample
30898 -target-disconnect
30899 @end smallexample
30900
30901 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30902 generally not resumed.
30903
30904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30905
30906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30907
30908 @subsubheading Example
30909
30910 @smallexample
30911 (gdb)
30912 -target-disconnect
30913 ^done
30914 (gdb)
30915 @end smallexample
30916
30917
30918 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30919 @findex -target-download
30920
30921 @subsubheading Synopsis
30922
30923 @smallexample
30924 -target-download
30925 @end smallexample
30926
30927 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30928 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30929
30930 @table @samp
30931 @item section
30932 The name of the section.
30933 @item section-sent
30934 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30935 @item section-size
30936 The size of the section.
30937 @item total-sent
30938 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30939 @item total-size
30940 The size of the overall executable to download.
30941 @end table
30942
30943 @noindent
30944 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30945 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30946
30947 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30948 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30949
30950 @table @samp
30951 @item section
30952 The name of the section.
30953 @item section-size
30954 The size of the section.
30955 @item total-size
30956 The size of the overall executable to download.
30957 @end table
30958
30959 @noindent
30960 At the end, a summary is printed.
30961
30962 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30963
30964 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30965
30966 @subsubheading Example
30967
30968 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30969 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30970
30971 @smallexample
30972 (gdb)
30973 -target-download
30974 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30975 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30976 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30977 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30978 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30979 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30980 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30981 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30982 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30983 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30984 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30985 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30986 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30987 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30988 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30989 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30990 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30991 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30992 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30993 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30994 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30995 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30996 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30997 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30998 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30999 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31000 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31001 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31002 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31003 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31004 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31005 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31006 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31007 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31008 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31009 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31010 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31011 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31012 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31013 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31014 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31015 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31016 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31017 write-rate="429"
31018 (gdb)
31019 @end smallexample
31020
31021
31022 @ignore
31023 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31024 @findex -target-exec-status
31025
31026 @subsubheading Synopsis
31027
31028 @smallexample
31029 -target-exec-status
31030 @end smallexample
31031
31032 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31033 not, for instance).
31034
31035 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31036
31037 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31038
31039 @subsubheading Example
31040 N.A.
31041
31042
31043 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31044 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31045
31046 @subsubheading Synopsis
31047
31048 @smallexample
31049 -target-list-available-targets
31050 @end smallexample
31051
31052 List the possible targets to connect to.
31053
31054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31055
31056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31057
31058 @subsubheading Example
31059 N.A.
31060
31061
31062 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31063 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31064
31065 @subsubheading Synopsis
31066
31067 @smallexample
31068 -target-list-current-targets
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071 Describe the current target.
31072
31073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31074
31075 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31076 other things).
31077
31078 @subsubheading Example
31079 N.A.
31080
31081
31082 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31083 @findex -target-list-parameters
31084
31085 @subsubheading Synopsis
31086
31087 @smallexample
31088 -target-list-parameters
31089 @end smallexample
31090
31091 @c ????
31092 @end ignore
31093
31094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31095
31096 No equivalent.
31097
31098 @subsubheading Example
31099 N.A.
31100
31101
31102 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31103 @findex -target-select
31104
31105 @subsubheading Synopsis
31106
31107 @smallexample
31108 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31109 @end smallexample
31110
31111 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31112
31113 @table @samp
31114 @item @var{type}
31115 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31116 @item @var{parameters}
31117 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31118 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31119 @end table
31120
31121 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31122 which the target program is, in the following form:
31123
31124 @smallexample
31125 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31126 args=[@var{arg list}]
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31130
31131 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31132
31133 @subsubheading Example
31134
31135 @smallexample
31136 (gdb)
31137 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31138 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31139 (gdb)
31140 @end smallexample
31141
31142 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31143 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31144 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31145
31146
31147 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31148 @findex -target-file-put
31149
31150 @subsubheading Synopsis
31151
31152 @smallexample
31153 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31154 @end smallexample
31155
31156 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31157 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31158
31159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31160
31161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31162
31163 @subsubheading Example
31164
31165 @smallexample
31166 (gdb)
31167 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31168 ^done
31169 (gdb)
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172
31173 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31174 @findex -target-file-get
31175
31176 @subsubheading Synopsis
31177
31178 @smallexample
31179 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31183 on the host system.
31184
31185 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31186
31187 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31188
31189 @subsubheading Example
31190
31191 @smallexample
31192 (gdb)
31193 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31194 ^done
31195 (gdb)
31196 @end smallexample
31197
31198
31199 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31200 @findex -target-file-delete
31201
31202 @subsubheading Synopsis
31203
31204 @smallexample
31205 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31206 @end smallexample
31207
31208 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31209
31210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31211
31212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31213
31214 @subsubheading Example
31215
31216 @smallexample
31217 (gdb)
31218 -target-file-delete remotefile
31219 ^done
31220 (gdb)
31221 @end smallexample
31222
31223
31224 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31225 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31226 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31227
31228 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31229 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31230
31231 @subsubheading Synopsis
31232
31233 @smallexample
31234 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31235 @end smallexample
31236
31237 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31238 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31239 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31240
31241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31242
31243 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31244
31245 @subsubheading Result
31246
31247 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31248 defined for each exception:
31249
31250 @table @samp
31251 @item name
31252 The name of the exception.
31253
31254 @item address
31255 The address of the exception.
31256
31257 @end table
31258
31259 @subsubheading Example
31260
31261 @smallexample
31262 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31263 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31264 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31265 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31266 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31267 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31268 @end smallexample
31269
31270 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31271
31272 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31273 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31274 Catchpoint Commands}.
31275
31276
31277 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31278 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31279 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31280
31281 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31282 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31283 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31284 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31285
31286 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31287 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31288 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31289
31290 @subsubheading Synopsis
31291
31292 @smallexample
31293 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31294 @end smallexample
31295
31296 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31297
31298 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31299 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31300 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31301 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31302 dash.
31303
31304 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31305
31306 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31307
31308 @subsubheading Result
31309
31310 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31311
31312 @table @samp
31313 @item exists
31314 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31315 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31316
31317 @end table
31318
31319 @subsubheading Example
31320
31321 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31322
31323 @smallexample
31324 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31325 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31326 @end smallexample
31327
31328 @noindent
31329 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31330 to the debugger:
31331
31332 @smallexample
31333 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31334 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31335 @end smallexample
31336
31337 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31338 @findex -list-features
31339 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31340
31341 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31342 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31343 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31344 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31345 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31346 startup.
31347
31348 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31349 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31350 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31351 is given below.
31352
31353 Example output:
31354
31355 @smallexample
31356 (gdb) -list-features
31357 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31358 @end smallexample
31359
31360 The current list of features is:
31361
31362 @ftable @samp
31363 @item frozen-varobjs
31364 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31365 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31366 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31367 @item pending-breakpoints
31368 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31369 command.
31370 @item python
31371 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31372 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31373 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31374 @item thread-info
31375 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31376 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31377 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31378 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31379 @item breakpoint-notifications
31380 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31381 CLI will be announced via async records.
31382 @item ada-task-info
31383 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31384 @item language-option
31385 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31386 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31387 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31388 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31389 @item undefined-command-error-code
31390 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31391 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31392 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31393 @item exec-run-start-option
31394 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31395 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31396 @end ftable
31397
31398 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31399 @findex -list-target-features
31400
31401 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31402 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31403 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31404 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31405 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31406 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31407 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31408 Example output:
31409
31410 @smallexample
31411 (gdb) -list-target-features
31412 ^done,result=["async"]
31413 @end smallexample
31414
31415 The current list of features is:
31416
31417 @table @samp
31418 @item async
31419 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31420 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31421 while the target is running.
31422
31423 @item reverse
31424 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31425 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31426
31427 @end table
31428
31429 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31430 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31431 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31432
31433 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31434
31435 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31436 @findex -gdb-exit
31437
31438 @subsubheading Synopsis
31439
31440 @smallexample
31441 -gdb-exit
31442 @end smallexample
31443
31444 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31445
31446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31447
31448 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31449
31450 @subsubheading Example
31451
31452 @smallexample
31453 (gdb)
31454 -gdb-exit
31455 ^exit
31456 @end smallexample
31457
31458
31459 @ignore
31460 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31461 @findex -exec-abort
31462
31463 @subsubheading Synopsis
31464
31465 @smallexample
31466 -exec-abort
31467 @end smallexample
31468
31469 Kill the inferior running program.
31470
31471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31472
31473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31474
31475 @subsubheading Example
31476 N.A.
31477 @end ignore
31478
31479
31480 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31481 @findex -gdb-set
31482
31483 @subsubheading Synopsis
31484
31485 @smallexample
31486 -gdb-set
31487 @end smallexample
31488
31489 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31490 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31491
31492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31493
31494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31495
31496 @subsubheading Example
31497
31498 @smallexample
31499 (gdb)
31500 -gdb-set $foo=3
31501 ^done
31502 (gdb)
31503 @end smallexample
31504
31505
31506 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31507 @findex -gdb-show
31508
31509 @subsubheading Synopsis
31510
31511 @smallexample
31512 -gdb-show
31513 @end smallexample
31514
31515 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31516
31517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31518
31519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31520
31521 @subsubheading Example
31522
31523 @smallexample
31524 (gdb)
31525 -gdb-show annotate
31526 ^done,value="0"
31527 (gdb)
31528 @end smallexample
31529
31530 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31531
31532
31533 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31534 @findex -gdb-version
31535
31536 @subsubheading Synopsis
31537
31538 @smallexample
31539 -gdb-version
31540 @end smallexample
31541
31542 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31543
31544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31545
31546 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31547 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31548
31549 @subsubheading Example
31550
31551 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31552 @c box in TeX.
31553 @smallexample
31554 (gdb)
31555 -gdb-version
31556 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31557 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31558 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31559 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31560 ~ certain conditions.
31561 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31562 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31563 ~ details.
31564 ~This GDB was configured as
31565 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31566 ^done
31567 (gdb)
31568 @end smallexample
31569
31570 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31571 @findex -list-thread-groups
31572
31573 @subheading Synopsis
31574
31575 @smallexample
31576 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31577 @end smallexample
31578
31579 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31580 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31581 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31582 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31583 top-level thread groups.
31584
31585 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31586 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31587 available on the target.
31588
31589 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31590 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31591 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31592 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31593 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31594 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31595 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31596 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31597
31598 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31599 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31600 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31601 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31602 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31603 @samp{threads} field.
31604
31605 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31606 the following caveats:
31607
31608 @itemize @bullet
31609 @item
31610 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31611 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31612 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31613
31614 @item
31615 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31616 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31617 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31618 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31619 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31620 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31621
31622 @end itemize
31623
31624 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31625 have the following fields:
31626
31627 @table @code
31628 @item id
31629 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31630 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31631 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31632
31633 @item type
31634 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31635 valid type.
31636
31637 @item pid
31638 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31639 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31640
31641 @item exit-code
31642 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31643 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31644 only if the process is not running.
31645
31646 @item num_children
31647 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31648 absent for an available thread group.
31649
31650 @item threads
31651 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31652 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31653 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31654
31655 @item cores
31656 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31657 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31658 such information is not available.
31659
31660 @item executable
31661 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31662 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31663 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31664
31665 @end table
31666
31667 @subheading Example
31668
31669 @smallexample
31670 @value{GDBP}
31671 -list-thread-groups
31672 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31673 -list-thread-groups 17
31674 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31675 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31676 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31677 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31678 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31679 -list-thread-groups --available
31680 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31681 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31682 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31683 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31684 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31685 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31686 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31687 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31688 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31689 @end smallexample
31690
31691 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31692 @findex -info-os
31693
31694 @subsubheading Synopsis
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31701 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31702 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31703 of data of that type.
31704
31705 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31706 system.
31707
31708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31709
31710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31711
31712 @subsubheading Example
31713
31714 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31715 like this:
31716
31717 @smallexample
31718 @value{GDBP}
31719 -info-os
31720 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31721 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31722 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31723 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31724 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31725 col2="Processes"@},
31726 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31727 col2="Process groups"@},
31728 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31729 col2="Threads"@},
31730 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31731 col2="File descriptors"@},
31732 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31733 col2="Sockets"@},
31734 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31735 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31736 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31737 col2="Semaphores"@},
31738 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31739 col2="Message queues"@},
31740 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31741 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31742 @value{GDBP}
31743 -info-os processes
31744 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31745 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31746 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31747 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31748 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31749 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31750 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31751 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31752 ...
31753 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31754 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31755 (gdb)
31756 @end smallexample
31757
31758 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31759 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31760 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31761 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31762 @code{info os} omits it.)
31763
31764 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31765 @findex -add-inferior
31766
31767 @subheading Synopsis
31768
31769 @smallexample
31770 -add-inferior
31771 @end smallexample
31772
31773 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31774 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31775 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31776 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31777 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31778 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31779
31780 @subheading Example
31781
31782 @smallexample
31783 @value{GDBP}
31784 -add-inferior
31785 ^done,inferior="i3"
31786 @end smallexample
31787
31788 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31789 @findex -interpreter-exec
31790
31791 @subheading Synopsis
31792
31793 @smallexample
31794 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31795 @end smallexample
31796 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31797
31798 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31799
31800 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31801
31802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31803
31804 @subheading Example
31805
31806 @smallexample
31807 (gdb)
31808 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31809 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31810 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31811 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31812 ^done
31813 (gdb)
31814 @end smallexample
31815
31816 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31817 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31818
31819 @subheading Synopsis
31820
31821 @smallexample
31822 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31823 @end smallexample
31824
31825 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31826
31827 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31828
31829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31830
31831 @subheading Example
31832
31833 @smallexample
31834 (gdb)
31835 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31836 ^done
31837 (gdb)
31838 @end smallexample
31839
31840 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31841 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31842
31843 @subheading Synopsis
31844
31845 @smallexample
31846 -inferior-tty-show
31847 @end smallexample
31848
31849 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31850
31851 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31852
31853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31854
31855 @subheading Example
31856
31857 @smallexample
31858 (gdb)
31859 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31860 ^done
31861 (gdb)
31862 -inferior-tty-show
31863 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31864 (gdb)
31865 @end smallexample
31866
31867 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31868 @findex -enable-timings
31869
31870 @subheading Synopsis
31871
31872 @smallexample
31873 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31874 @end smallexample
31875
31876 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31877 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31878 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31879 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31880
31881 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31882
31883 No equivalent.
31884
31885 @subheading Example
31886
31887 @smallexample
31888 (gdb)
31889 -enable-timings
31890 ^done
31891 (gdb)
31892 -break-insert main
31893 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31894 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31895 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31896 times="0"@},
31897 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31898 (gdb)
31899 -enable-timings no
31900 ^done
31901 (gdb)
31902 -exec-run
31903 ^running
31904 (gdb)
31905 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31906 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31907 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31908 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31909 (gdb)
31910 @end smallexample
31911
31912 @node Annotations
31913 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31914
31915 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31916 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31917 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31918 relatively high level.
31919
31920 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31921 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31922
31923 @ignore
31924 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31925 @end ignore
31926
31927 @menu
31928 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31929 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31930 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31931 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31932 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31933 * Annotations for Running::
31934 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31935 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31936 @end menu
31937
31938 @node Annotations Overview
31939 @section What is an Annotation?
31940 @cindex annotations
31941
31942 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31943 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31944 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31945 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31946 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31947 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31948 cannot contain newline characters.
31949
31950 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31951 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31952 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31953 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31954 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31955 means those three characters as output.
31956
31957 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31958 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31959 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31960 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31961 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31962 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31963 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31964 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31965 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31966
31967 @table @code
31968 @kindex set annotate
31969 @item set annotate @var{level}
31970 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31971 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31972
31973 @item show annotate
31974 @kindex show annotate
31975 Show the current annotation level.
31976 @end table
31977
31978 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31979
31980 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31981
31982 @smallexample
31983 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31984 GNU gdb 6.0
31985 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31986 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31987 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31988 under certain conditions.
31989 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31990 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31991 for details.
31992 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31993
31994 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31995 (@value{GDBP})
31996 ^Z^Zprompt
31997 @kbd{quit}
31998
31999 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32000 $
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32004 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32005 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32006 output from @value{GDBN}.
32007
32008 @node Server Prefix
32009 @section The Server Prefix
32010 @cindex server prefix
32011
32012 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32013 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32014 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32015 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32016 a transparent manner.
32017
32018 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32019 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32020 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32021 @code{print} command.
32022
32023 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32024 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32025
32026 @node Prompting
32027 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32028
32029 @cindex annotations for prompts
32030 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32031 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32032 over, etc.
32033
32034 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32035 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32036 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32037 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32038 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32039 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32040 features the following annotations:
32041
32042 @smallexample
32043 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32044 ^Z^Zprompt
32045 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32046 @end smallexample
32047
32048 The input types are
32049
32050 @table @code
32051 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32052 @findex prompt annotation
32053 @findex post-prompt annotation
32054 @item prompt
32055 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32056
32057 @findex pre-commands annotation
32058 @findex commands annotation
32059 @findex post-commands annotation
32060 @item commands
32061 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32062 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32063
32064 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32065 @findex overload-choice annotation
32066 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32067 @item overload-choice
32068 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32069
32070 @findex pre-query annotation
32071 @findex query annotation
32072 @findex post-query annotation
32073 @item query
32074 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32075
32076 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32077 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32078 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32079 @item prompt-for-continue
32080 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32081 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32082 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32083 presence of annotations.
32084 @end table
32085
32086 @node Errors
32087 @section Errors
32088 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32089
32090 @findex quit annotation
32091 @smallexample
32092 ^Z^Zquit
32093 @end smallexample
32094
32095 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32096
32097 @findex error annotation
32098 @smallexample
32099 ^Z^Zerror
32100 @end smallexample
32101
32102 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32103
32104 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32105 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32106 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32107 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32108 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32109 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32110 to the top level.
32111
32112 @findex error-begin annotation
32113 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32114
32115 @smallexample
32116 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32117 @end smallexample
32118
32119 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32120 message.
32121
32122 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32123 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32124 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32125
32126 @node Invalidation
32127 @section Invalidation Notices
32128
32129 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32130 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32131 changed.
32132
32133 @table @code
32134 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32135 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32136
32137 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32138 have changed.
32139
32140 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32141 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32142
32143 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32144 deleted a breakpoint.
32145 @end table
32146
32147 @node Annotations for Running
32148 @section Running the Program
32149 @cindex annotations for running programs
32150
32151 @findex starting annotation
32152 @findex stopping annotation
32153 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32154 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32155
32156 @smallexample
32157 ^Z^Zstarting
32158 @end smallexample
32159
32160 is output. When the program stops,
32161
32162 @smallexample
32163 ^Z^Zstopped
32164 @end smallexample
32165
32166 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32167 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32168
32169 @table @code
32170 @findex exited annotation
32171 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32172 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32173 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32174
32175 @findex signalled annotation
32176 @findex signal-name annotation
32177 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32178 @findex signal-string annotation
32179 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32180 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32181 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32182 annotation continues:
32183
32184 @smallexample
32185 @var{intro-text}
32186 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32187 @var{name}
32188 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32189 @var{middle-text}
32190 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32191 @var{string}
32192 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32193 @var{end-text}
32194 @end smallexample
32195
32196 @noindent
32197 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32198 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32199 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32200 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32201 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32202
32203 @findex signal annotation
32204 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32205 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32206 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32207 terminated with it.
32208
32209 @findex breakpoint annotation
32210 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32211 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32212
32213 @findex watchpoint annotation
32214 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32215 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32216 @end table
32217
32218 @node Source Annotations
32219 @section Displaying Source
32220 @cindex annotations for source display
32221
32222 @findex source annotation
32223 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32224
32225 @smallexample
32226 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32227 @end smallexample
32228
32229 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32230 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32231 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32232 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32233 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32234 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32235 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32236 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32237 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32238 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32239 depend on the language).
32240
32241 @node JIT Interface
32242 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32243 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32244 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32245
32246 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32247 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32248 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32249 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32250
32251 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32252 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32253 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32254 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32255 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32256 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32257
32258 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32259 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32260 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32261 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32262 LLVM JIT.
32263
32264 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32265 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32266 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32267 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32268 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32269 out about additional code.
32270
32271 @menu
32272 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32273 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32274 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32275 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32276 @end menu
32277
32278 @node Declarations
32279 @section JIT Declarations
32280
32281 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32282 implement the interface:
32283
32284 @smallexample
32285 typedef enum
32286 @{
32287 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32288 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32289 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32290 @} jit_actions_t;
32291
32292 struct jit_code_entry
32293 @{
32294 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32295 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32296 const char *symfile_addr;
32297 uint64_t symfile_size;
32298 @};
32299
32300 struct jit_descriptor
32301 @{
32302 uint32_t version;
32303 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32304 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32305 uint32_t action_flag;
32306 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32307 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32308 @};
32309
32310 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32311 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32312
32313 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32314 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32315 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32316 @end smallexample
32317
32318 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32319 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32320 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32321
32322 @node Registering Code
32323 @section Registering Code
32324
32325 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32326
32327 @itemize @bullet
32328 @item
32329 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32330 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32331
32332 @item
32333 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32334 file.
32335
32336 @item
32337 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32338
32339 @item
32340 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32341
32342 @item
32343 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32344 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32345 @end itemize
32346
32347 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32348 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32349 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32350 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32351
32352 @node Unregistering Code
32353 @section Unregistering Code
32354
32355 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32356
32357 @itemize @bullet
32358 @item
32359 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32360
32361 @item
32362 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32363
32364 @item
32365 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32366 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32367 @end itemize
32368
32369 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32370 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32371
32372 @node Custom Debug Info
32373 @section Custom Debug Info
32374 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32375 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32376
32377 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32378 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32379 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32380 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32381 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32382 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32383 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32384 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32385 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32386
32387 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32388 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32389 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32390 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32391 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32392 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32393 compiler.
32394
32395 @menu
32396 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32397 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32398 @end menu
32399
32400 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32401 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32402 @kindex jit-reader-load
32403 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32404
32405 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32406 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32407
32408 @table @code
32409 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32410 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32411 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32412 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32413 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32414 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32415 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32416
32417 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32418 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32419 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32420 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32421 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32422
32423 @item jit-reader-unload
32424 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32425
32426 @end table
32427
32428 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32429 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32430 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32431
32432 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32433 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32434
32435 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32436 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32437 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32438 the system include directory.
32439
32440 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32441 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32442 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32443
32444 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32445 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32446
32447 @findex gdb_init_reader
32448 @smallexample
32449 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32450 @end smallexample
32451
32452 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32453
32454 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32455 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32456 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32457 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32458 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32459 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32460
32461 @smallexample
32462 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32463 @{
32464 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32465 int reader_version;
32466
32467 /* For use by the reader. */
32468 void *priv_data;
32469
32470 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32471 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32472 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32473 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32474 @};
32475 @end smallexample
32476
32477 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32478 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32479
32480 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32481 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32482 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32483 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32484 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32485 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32486 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32487 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32488 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32489 target's address space.
32490
32491 @node In-Process Agent
32492 @chapter In-Process Agent
32493 @cindex debugging agent
32494 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32495 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32496 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32497 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32498 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32499 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32500 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32501 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32502 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32503 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32504 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32505 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32506 behavior without interrupting it.
32507
32508 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32509 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32510 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32511 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32512 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32513 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32514 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32515 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32516 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32517
32518 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32519 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32520 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32521 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32522
32523 @anchor{Control Agent}
32524 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32525 debugging with the following commands:
32526
32527 @table @code
32528 @kindex set agent on
32529 @item set agent on
32530 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32531 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32532 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32533 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32534 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32535 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32536
32537 @kindex set agent off
32538 @item set agent off
32539 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32540 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32541
32542 @kindex show agent
32543 @item show agent
32544 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32545 the in-process agent.
32546 @end table
32547
32548 @menu
32549 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32550 @end menu
32551
32552 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32553 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32554 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32555
32556 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32557 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32558 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32559 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32560 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32561 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32562 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32563 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32564 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32565
32566 @menu
32567 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32568 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32569 @end menu
32570
32571 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32572 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32573 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32574
32575 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32576 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32577
32578 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32579 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32580 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32581 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32582
32583 @enumerate
32584 @item
32585 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32586 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32587 @item
32588 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32589 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32590 the other one.
32591 @end enumerate
32592
32593 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32594
32595 @enumerate
32596 @item
32597 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32598 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32599 @anchor{agent expression object}
32600 @item
32601 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32602 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32603 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32604 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32605 @item
32606 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32607 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32608
32609 @end enumerate
32610
32611 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32612 object:
32613
32614 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32615 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32616 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32617 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32618 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32619 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32620 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32621 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32622 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32623 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32624 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32625 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32626 memory address for collecting.
32627 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32628 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32629 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32630 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32631 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32632 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32633 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32634 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32635 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32636 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32637 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32638 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32639 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32640 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32641 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32642 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32643 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32644 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32645 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32646 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32647 @ref{agent expression object}
32648 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32649 @ref{agent expression object}
32650 @item actions @tab variable
32651 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32652 @end multitable
32653
32654 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32655 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32656 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32657
32658 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32659 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32660
32661 @table @samp
32662
32663 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32664 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32665 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32666 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32667 in IPA finally.
32668
32669 Replies:
32670 @table @samp
32671 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32672 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32673 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32674 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32675 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32676 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32677 @item E @var{NN}
32678 for an error
32679
32680 @end table
32681
32682 @item close
32683 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32684 is about to kill inferiors.
32685
32686 @item qTfSTM
32687 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32688 @item qTsSTM
32689 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32690 @item qTSTMat
32691 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32692 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32693 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32694
32695 Replies:
32696 @table @samp
32697 @item E @var{NN}
32698 for an error
32699 @end table
32700 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32701 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32702 @end table
32703
32704 @node GDB Bugs
32705 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32706 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32707 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32708
32709 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32710
32711 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32712 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32713 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32714 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32715
32716 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32717 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32718
32719 @menu
32720 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32721 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32722 @end menu
32723
32724 @node Bug Criteria
32725 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32726 @cindex bug criteria
32727
32728 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32729
32730 @itemize @bullet
32731 @cindex fatal signal
32732 @cindex debugger crash
32733 @cindex crash of debugger
32734 @item
32735 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32736 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32737
32738 @cindex error on valid input
32739 @item
32740 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32741 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32742 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32743
32744 @cindex invalid input
32745 @item
32746 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32747 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32748 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32749 for traditional practice''.
32750
32751 @item
32752 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32753 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32754 @end itemize
32755
32756 @node Bug Reporting
32757 @section How to Report Bugs
32758 @cindex bug reports
32759 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32760
32761 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32762 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32763 contact that organization first.
32764
32765 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32766 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32767 distribution.
32768 @c should add a web page ref...
32769
32770 @ifset BUGURL
32771 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32772 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32773 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32774 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32775 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32776 be used.
32777
32778 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32779 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32780 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32781 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32782
32783 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32784 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32785 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32786 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32787 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32788 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32789 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32790 bug reports to the mailing list.
32791 @end ifset
32792 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32793 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32794 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32795 @end ifclear
32796 @end ifset
32797
32798 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32799 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32800 fact or leave it out, state it!
32801
32802 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32803 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32804 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32805 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32806 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32807 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32808 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32809 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32810 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32811
32812 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32813 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32814 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32815 self-contained.
32816
32817 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32818 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32819 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32820 bugs properly.
32821
32822 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32823
32824 @itemize @bullet
32825 @item
32826 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32827 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32828 version}.
32829
32830 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32831 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32832
32833 @item
32834 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32835 version number.
32836
32837 @item
32838 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32839 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32840 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32841 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32842
32843 @item
32844 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32845 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32846
32847 @item
32848 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32849 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32850 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32851 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32852 those compilers.
32853
32854 @item
32855 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32856 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32857 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32858 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32859
32860 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32861 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32862
32863 @item
32864 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32865 reproduce the bug.
32866
32867 @item
32868 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32869 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32870
32871 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32872 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32873 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32874 a chance to make a mistake.
32875
32876 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32877 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32878 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32879 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32880 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32881 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32882 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32883 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32884
32885 @pindex script
32886 @cindex recording a session script
32887 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32888 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32889 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32890 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32891
32892 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32893 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32894
32895 @item
32896 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32897 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32898 it by context, not by line number.
32899
32900 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32901 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32902
32903 @end itemize
32904
32905 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32906
32907 @itemize @bullet
32908 @item
32909 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32910
32911 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32912 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32913 changes will not affect it.
32914
32915 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32916 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32917 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32918 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32919
32920 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32921 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32922 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32923 less time, and so on.
32924
32925 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32926 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32927
32928 @item
32929 A patch for the bug.
32930
32931 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32932 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32933 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32934 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32935
32936 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32937 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32938 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32939 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32940
32941 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32942 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32943 help us to understand.
32944
32945 @item
32946 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32947
32948 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32949 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32950 @end itemize
32951
32952 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32953 @c and consists of the two following files:
32954 @c rluser.texi
32955 @c hsuser.texi
32956 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32957 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32958 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32959 @include rluser.texi
32960 @include hsuser.texi
32961 @end ifclear
32962
32963 @node In Memoriam
32964 @appendix In Memoriam
32965
32966 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32967 contributors:
32968
32969 @table @code
32970 @item Fred Fish
32971 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32972 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32973 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32974
32975 @item Michael Snyder
32976 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32977 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32978 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32979 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32980 @end table
32981
32982 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32983 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32984
32985 @node Formatting Documentation
32986 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32987
32988 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32989 @cindex reference card
32990 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32991 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32992 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32993 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32994 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32995 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32996
32997 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32998 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32999
33000 @smallexample
33001 make refcard.dvi
33002 @end smallexample
33003
33004 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33005 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33006 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33007 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33008 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33009
33010 @cindex documentation
33011
33012 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33013 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33014 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33015 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33016 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33017 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33018
33019 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33020 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33021 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33022 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33023 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33024 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33025 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33026 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33027
33028 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33029 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33030 @code{makeinfo}.
33031
33032 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33033 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33034 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33035
33036 @smallexample
33037 cd gdb
33038 make gdb.info
33039 @end smallexample
33040
33041 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33042 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33043 Texinfo definitions file.
33044
33045 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33046 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33047 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33048 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33049 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33050 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33051 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33052
33053 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33054 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33055 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33056 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33057 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33058 directory.
33059
33060 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33061 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33062 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33063 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33064
33065 @smallexample
33066 make gdb.dvi
33067 @end smallexample
33068
33069 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33070
33071 @node Installing GDB
33072 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33073 @cindex installation
33074
33075 @menu
33076 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33077 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33078 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33079 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33080 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33081 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33082 @end menu
33083
33084 @node Requirements
33085 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33086 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33087
33088 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33089 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33090
33091 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33092 @table @asis
33093 @item ISO C90 compiler
33094 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33095 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33096
33097 @end table
33098
33099 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33100 @table @asis
33101 @item Expat
33102 @anchor{Expat}
33103 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33104 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33105 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33106 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33107 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33108 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33109
33110 Expat is used for:
33111
33112 @itemize @bullet
33113 @item
33114 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33115 @item
33116 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33117 @item
33118 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33119 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33120 @item
33121 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33122 @item
33123 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33124 @item
33125 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33126 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33127 @end itemize
33128
33129 @item zlib
33130 @cindex compressed debug sections
33131 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33132 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33133 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33134 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33135 information in such binaries.
33136
33137 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33138 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33139 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33140
33141 @item iconv
33142 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33143 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33144 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33145 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33146
33147 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33148 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33149 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33150 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33151
33152 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33153 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33154 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33155
33156 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33157 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33158 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33159 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33160 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33161 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33162 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33163 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33164 @end table
33165
33166 @node Running Configure
33167 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33168 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33169 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33170 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33171 build the @code{gdb} program.
33172 @iftex
33173 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33174 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33175 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33176 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33177 @end iftex
33178
33179 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33180 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33181 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33182
33183 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33184 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33185
33186 @table @code
33187 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33188 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33189
33190 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33191 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33192
33193 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33194 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33195
33196 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33197 @sc{gnu} include files
33198
33199 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33200 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33201
33202 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33203 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33204
33205 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33206 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33207
33208 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33209 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33210
33211 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33212 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33213 @end table
33214
33215 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33216 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33217 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33218
33219 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33220 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33221 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33222 argument.
33223
33224 For example:
33225
33226 @smallexample
33227 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33228 ./configure @var{host}
33229 make
33230 @end smallexample
33231
33232 @noindent
33233 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33234 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33235 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33236 correct value by examining your system.)
33237
33238 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33239 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33240 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33241 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33242
33243 @need 750
33244 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33245 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33246 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33247
33248 @smallexample
33249 sh configure @var{host}
33250 @end smallexample
33251
33252 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33253 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33254 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33255 @file{configure}
33256 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33257 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33258
33259 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33260 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33261 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33262 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33263 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33264 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33265 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33266 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33267 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33268
33269 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33270 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33271 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33272 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33273 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33274
33275 @node Separate Objdir
33276 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33277
33278 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33279 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33280 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33281 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33282 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33283 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33284 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33285 program specified there.
33286
33287 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33288 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33289 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33290 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33291 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33292 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33293
33294 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33295 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33296
33297 @smallexample
33298 @group
33299 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33300 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33301 cd ../gdb-sun4
33302 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33303 make
33304 @end group
33305 @end smallexample
33306
33307 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33308 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33309 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33310 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33311 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33312 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33313
33314 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33315 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33316 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33317 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33318 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33319
33320 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33321 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33322 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33323 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33324 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33325 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33326
33327 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33328 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33329 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33330
33331 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33332 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33333 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33334 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33335 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33336
33337 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33338 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33339 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33340 with each other.
33341
33342 @node Config Names
33343 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33344
33345 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33346 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33347 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33348 of information in the following pattern:
33349
33350 @smallexample
33351 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33352 @end smallexample
33353
33354 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33355 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33356 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33357
33358 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33359 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33360 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33361 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33362 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33363 abbreviations---for example:
33364
33365 @smallexample
33366 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33367 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33368 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33369 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33370 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33371 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33372 % sh config.sub sun4
33373 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33374 % sh config.sub sun3
33375 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33376 % sh config.sub i986v
33377 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33378 @end smallexample
33379
33380 @noindent
33381 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33382 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33383
33384 @node Configure Options
33385 @section @file{configure} Options
33386
33387 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33388 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33389 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33390 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33391
33392 @smallexample
33393 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33394 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33395 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33396 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33397 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33398 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33399 @var{host}
33400 @end smallexample
33401
33402 @noindent
33403 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33404 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33405 @samp{--}.
33406
33407 @table @code
33408 @item --help
33409 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33410
33411 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33412 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33413 @file{@var{dir}}.
33414
33415 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33416 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33417 @file{@var{dir}}.
33418
33419 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33420 @need 2000
33421 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33422 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33423 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33424 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33425 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33426 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33427 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33428 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33429 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33430 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33431 @var{dirname}.
33432
33433 @item --norecursion
33434 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33435 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33436
33437 @item --target=@var{target}
33438 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33439 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33440 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33441
33442 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33443
33444 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33445 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33446
33447 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33448 @end table
33449
33450 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33451 needed for special purposes only.
33452
33453 @node System-wide configuration
33454 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33455 @cindex system-wide init file
33456
33457 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33458 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33459 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33460
33461 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33462
33463 @table @code
33464 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33465 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33466 @var{file}.
33467 @end table
33468
33469 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33470 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33471
33472 @itemize @bullet
33473 @item
33474 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33475 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33476 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33477 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33478 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33479 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33480
33481 @item
33482 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33483 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33484 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33485 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33486 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33487 @end itemize
33488
33489 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33490 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33491 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33492 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33493 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33494 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33495 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33496 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33497 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33498 reread.
33499
33500 @menu
33501 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33502 @end menu
33503
33504 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33505 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33506 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33507
33508 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33509 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33510 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33511 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33512 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33513 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33514
33515 The following scripts are currently available:
33516 @itemize @bullet
33517
33518 @item @file{elinos.py}
33519 @pindex elinos.py
33520 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33521 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33522 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33523 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33524 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33525 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33526
33527 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33528 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33529 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33530 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33531 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33532 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33533
33534 @end itemize
33535
33536 @node Maintenance Commands
33537 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33538 @cindex maintenance commands
33539 @cindex internal commands
33540
33541 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33542 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33543 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33544 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33545 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33546
33547 @table @code
33548 @kindex maint agent
33549 @kindex maint agent-eval
33550 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33551 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33552 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33553 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33554 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33555 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33556 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33557 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33558 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33559 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33560 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33561 addition and return the sum.
33562 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33563 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33564
33565 @kindex maint agent-printf
33566 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33567 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33568 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33569 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33570 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33571
33572 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33573 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33574 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33575 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33576 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33577 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33578 is shown:
33579
33580 @table @code
33581 @item breakpoint
33582 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33583
33584 @item watchpoint
33585 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33586
33587 @item longjmp
33588 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33589 @code{longjmp} calls.
33590
33591 @item longjmp resume
33592 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33593
33594 @item until
33595 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33596
33597 @item finish
33598 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33599
33600 @item shlib events
33601 Shared library events.
33602
33603 @end table
33604
33605 @kindex maint info bfds
33606 @item maint info bfds
33607 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33608 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33609
33610 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33611 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33612 @cindex displaced stepping support
33613 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33614 @item set displaced-stepping
33615 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33616 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33617 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33618 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33619 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33620 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33621
33622 @table @code
33623 @item set displaced-stepping on
33624 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33625 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33626
33627 @item set displaced-stepping off
33628 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33629 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33630
33631 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33632 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33633 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33634 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33635 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33636 @end table
33637
33638 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33639 @item maint check-psymtabs
33640 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33641 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33642
33643 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33644 @item maint check-symtabs
33645 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33646
33647 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33648 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33649 Expand symbol tables.
33650 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33651 names matching @var{regexp}.
33652
33653 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33654 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33655 @cindex demangler crashes
33656 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33657 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33658 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33659 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33660 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33661 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33662 option to terminate the current session.
33663
33664 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33665 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33666 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33667
33668 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33669 @item maint cplus namespace
33670 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33671
33672 @kindex maint deprecate
33673 @kindex maint undeprecate
33674 @cindex deprecated commands
33675 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33676 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33677 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33678 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33679 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33680 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33681 the replacement as part of the warning.
33682
33683 @kindex maint dump-me
33684 @item maint dump-me
33685 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33686 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33687 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33688 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33689
33690 @kindex maint internal-error
33691 @kindex maint internal-warning
33692 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33693 @cindex demangler crashes
33694 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33695 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33696 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33697
33698 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33699 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33700 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33701 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33702 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33703 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33704 @value{GDBN} session.
33705
33706 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33707 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33708
33709 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33710
33711 @smallexample
33712 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33713 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33714 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33715 debugging may prove unreliable.
33716 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33717 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33718 (@value{GDBP})
33719 @end smallexample
33720
33721 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33722 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33723 @cindex demangler crashes
33724
33725 @kindex maint set internal-error
33726 @kindex maint show internal-error
33727 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33728 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33729 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33730 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33731 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33732 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33733 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33734 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33735 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33736 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33737 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33738 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33739 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33740 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33741 described in the table below.
33742
33743 @table @samp
33744 @item quit
33745 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33746 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33747
33748 @item corefile
33749 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33750 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33751 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33752 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33753 disabled.
33754 @end table
33755
33756 @kindex maint packet
33757 @item maint packet @var{text}
33758 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33759 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33760 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33761 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33762 checksum.
33763
33764 @kindex maint print architecture
33765 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33766 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33767 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33768
33769 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33770 @item maint print c-tdesc
33771 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33772 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33773 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33774
33775 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33776 @item maint print dummy-frames
33777 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33778
33779 @smallexample
33780 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33781 @dots{}
33782 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33783 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33784 58 return (a + b);
33785 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33786 @dots{}
33787 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33788 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33789 (@value{GDBP})
33790 @end smallexample
33791
33792 Takes an optional file parameter.
33793
33794 @kindex maint print registers
33795 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33796 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33797 @kindex maint print register-groups
33798 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33799 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33800 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33801 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33802 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33803 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33804 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33805
33806 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33807 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33808 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33809 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33810 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33811 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33812 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33813 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33814
33815 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33816 write the information.
33817
33818 @kindex maint print reggroups
33819 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33820 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33821 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33822 information.
33823
33824 The register groups info looks like this:
33825
33826 @smallexample
33827 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33828 Group Type
33829 general user
33830 float user
33831 all user
33832 vector user
33833 system user
33834 save internal
33835 restore internal
33836 @end smallexample
33837
33838 @kindex flushregs
33839 @item flushregs
33840 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33841
33842 @kindex maint print objfiles
33843 @cindex info for known object files
33844 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33845 Print a dump of all known object files.
33846 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33847 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33848 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33849
33850 @kindex maint print user-registers
33851 @cindex user registers
33852 @item maint print user-registers
33853 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
33854 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
33855 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
33856 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
33857 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
33858 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
33859 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
33860
33861 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33862 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33863 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33864 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33865 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33866 matching @var{regexp}.
33867 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33868 and the full path if known.
33869 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33870
33871 @kindex maint print statistics
33872 @cindex bcache statistics
33873 @item maint print statistics
33874 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33875 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33876 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33877 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33878 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33879 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33880 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33881 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33882 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33883 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33884 lengths.
33885
33886 @kindex maint print target-stack
33887 @cindex target stack description
33888 @item maint print target-stack
33889 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33890 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33891 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33892 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33893 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33894 address.
33895
33896 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33897 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33898
33899 @kindex maint print type
33900 @cindex type chain of a data type
33901 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33902 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33903 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33904 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33905 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33906 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33907
33908 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33909 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33910 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33911 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33912 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33913 information.
33914
33915 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33916 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33917 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33918 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33919 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33920 always see the disassembly form.
33921
33922 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33923
33924 @smallexample
33925 (gdb) info addr argc
33926 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33927 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33928 @end smallexample
33929
33930 For more information on these expressions, see
33931 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33932
33933 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33934 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33935 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33936 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33937 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33938
33939 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33940 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33941 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33942 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33943 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33944 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33945 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33946 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33947 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33948
33949 @kindex maint set profile
33950 @kindex maint show profile
33951 @cindex profiling GDB
33952 @item maint set profile
33953 @itemx maint show profile
33954 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33955
33956 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33957 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33958 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33959 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33960 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33961 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33962 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33963
33964 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33965 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33966
33967 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33968 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33969 @cindex hardware debug registers
33970 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33971 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33972 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33973 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33974 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33975 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33976 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33977
33978 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33979 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33980 @item maint set show-all-tib
33981 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33982 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33983 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33984 command.
33985
33986 @kindex maint set target-async
33987 @kindex maint show target-async
33988 @item maint set target-async
33989 @itemx maint show target-async
33990 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33991 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33992 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33993 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33994
33995 @kindex maint set per-command
33996 @kindex maint show per-command
33997 @item maint set per-command
33998 @itemx maint show per-command
33999 @cindex resources used by commands
34000
34001 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34002 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34003
34004 @table @code
34005 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34006 @itemx maint show per-command space
34007 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34008 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34009 took, following the command's own output.
34010 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34011 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34012
34013 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34014 @itemx maint show per-command time
34015 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34016 for each command.
34017 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34018 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34019 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34020 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34021 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34022 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34023 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34024 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34025 spent by the program been debugged.
34026 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34027 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34028
34029 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34030 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34031 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34032 for each command.
34033 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34034
34035 @enumerate a
34036 @item
34037 number of symbol tables
34038 @item
34039 number of primary symbol tables
34040 @item
34041 number of blocks in the blockvector
34042 @end enumerate
34043 @end table
34044
34045 @kindex maint space
34046 @cindex memory used by commands
34047 @item maint space @var{value}
34048 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34049 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34050
34051 @kindex maint time
34052 @cindex time of command execution
34053 @item maint time @var{value}
34054 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34055 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34056
34057 @kindex maint translate-address
34058 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34059 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34060 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34061 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34062 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34063 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34064 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34065
34066 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34067 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34068 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34069
34070 @end table
34071
34072 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34073 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34074
34075 @table @code
34076 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34077 @kindex set watchdog
34078 @cindex watchdog timer
34079 @cindex timeout for commands
34080 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34081 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34082 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34083
34084 @item show watchdog
34085 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34086 @end table
34087
34088 @node Remote Protocol
34089 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34090
34091 @menu
34092 * Overview::
34093 * Packets::
34094 * Stop Reply Packets::
34095 * General Query Packets::
34096 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34097 * Tracepoint Packets::
34098 * Host I/O Packets::
34099 * Interrupts::
34100 * Notification Packets::
34101 * Remote Non-Stop::
34102 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34103 * Examples::
34104 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34105 * Library List Format::
34106 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34107 * Memory Map Format::
34108 * Thread List Format::
34109 * Traceframe Info Format::
34110 * Branch Trace Format::
34111 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34112 @end menu
34113
34114 @node Overview
34115 @section Overview
34116
34117 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34118 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34119 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34120 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34121
34122 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34123 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34124
34125 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34126 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34127 @cindex remote serial protocol
34128 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34129 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34130 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34131 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34132 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34133
34134 @smallexample
34135 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34136 @end smallexample
34137 @noindent
34138
34139 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34140 @noindent
34141 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34142 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34143 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34144
34145 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34146 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34147
34148 @smallexample
34149 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34150 @end smallexample
34151
34152 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34153 @noindent
34154 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34155 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34156 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34157
34158 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34159 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34160 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34161 retransmission):
34162
34163 @smallexample
34164 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34165 <- @code{+}
34166 @end smallexample
34167 @noindent
34168
34169 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34170 once a connection is established.
34171 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34172
34173 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34174 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34175 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34176 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34177 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34178 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34179 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34180
34181 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34182 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34183 exceptions).
34184
34185 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34186 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34187 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34188 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34189
34190 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34191 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34192 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34193
34194 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34195 @anchor{Binary Data}
34196 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34197 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34198 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34199 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34200 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34201 binary data.
34202
34203 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34204 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34205 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34206 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34207 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34208 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34209 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34210 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34211 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34212 (described next).
34213
34214 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34215 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34216 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34217 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34218 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34219 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34220 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34221 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34222 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34223 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34224 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34225 3}} more times.
34226
34227 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34228 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34229 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34230 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34231 @samp{0*"00}.
34232
34233 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34234 error number. That number is not well defined.
34235
34236 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34237 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34238 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34239 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34240 on that response.
34241
34242 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34243 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34244 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34245 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34246 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34247 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34248
34249 @node Packets
34250 @section Packets
34251
34252 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34253 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34254 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34255 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34256
34257 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34258 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34259 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34260 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34261 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34262 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34263 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34264 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34265 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34266 @var{baz}.
34267
34268 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34269 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34270 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34271 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34272 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34273 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34274 pick any thread.
34275
34276 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34277 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34278 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34279 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34280 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34281 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34282 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34283 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34284 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34285 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34286 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34287 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34288 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34289
34290 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34291 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34292 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34293 more information.
34294
34295 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34296 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34297
34298 Here are the packet descriptions.
34299
34300 @table @samp
34301
34302 @item !
34303 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34304 @anchor{extended mode}
34305 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34306 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34307 debugged.
34308
34309 Reply:
34310 @table @samp
34311 @item OK
34312 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34313 @end table
34314
34315 @item ?
34316 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34317 @anchor{? packet}
34318 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34319 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34320 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34321
34322 Reply:
34323 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34324
34325 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34326 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34327 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34328 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34329 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34330
34331 Reply:
34332 @table @samp
34333 @item OK
34334 The arguments were set.
34335 @item E @var{NN}
34336 An error occurred.
34337 @end table
34338
34339 @item b @var{baud}
34340 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34341 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34342 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34343
34344 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34345 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34346 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34347
34348 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34349 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34350 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34351 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34352 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34353
34354 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34355 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34356 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34357 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34358
34359 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34360 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34361
34362 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34363 @anchor{bc}
34364 @item bc
34365 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34366 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34367
34368 Reply:
34369 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34370
34371 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34372 @anchor{bs}
34373 @item bs
34374 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34375 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34376
34377 Reply:
34378 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34379
34380 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34381 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34382 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34383 is omitted, resume at current address.
34384
34385 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34386 packet}.
34387
34388 Reply:
34389 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34390
34391 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34392 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34393 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34394 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34395
34396 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34397 packet}.
34398
34399 Reply:
34400 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34401
34402 @item d
34403 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34404 Toggle debug flag.
34405
34406 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34407 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34408
34409 @item D
34410 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34411 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34412 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34413 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34414 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34415
34416 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34417 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34418 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34419 big-endian hex string.
34420
34421 Reply:
34422 @table @samp
34423 @item OK
34424 for success
34425 @item E @var{NN}
34426 for an error
34427 @end table
34428
34429 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34430 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34431 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34432 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34433 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34434
34435 @item g
34436 @anchor{read registers packet}
34437 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34438 Read general registers.
34439
34440 Reply:
34441 @table @samp
34442 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34443 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34444 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34445 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34446 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34447 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34448 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34449
34450 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34451 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34452 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34453 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34454 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34455 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34456 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34457 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34458
34459 @smallexample
34460 -> @code{g}
34461 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34462 @end smallexample
34463
34464 @item E @var{NN}
34465 for an error.
34466 @end table
34467
34468 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34469 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34470 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34471 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34472
34473 Reply:
34474 @table @samp
34475 @item OK
34476 for success
34477 @item E @var{NN}
34478 for an error
34479 @end table
34480
34481 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34482 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34483 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34484 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34485 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34486 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34487 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34488 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34489 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34490
34491 Reply:
34492 @table @samp
34493 @item OK
34494 for success
34495 @item E @var{NN}
34496 for an error
34497 @end table
34498
34499 @c FIXME: JTC:
34500 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34501 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34502 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34503 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34504 @c described. For example:
34505 @c
34506 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34507 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34508 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34509 @c
34510 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34511 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34512 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34513
34514 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34515 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34516 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34517 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34518 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34519 step starting at that address.
34520
34521 @item I
34522 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34523 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34524 step packet}.
34525
34526 @item k
34527 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34528 Kill request.
34529
34530 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34531
34532 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34533 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34534
34535 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34536
34537 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34538 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34539 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34540
34541 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34542 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34543 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34544
34545 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34546 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34547 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34548 (@pxref{? packet}).
34549
34550 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34551 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34552 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34553 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34554
34555 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34556 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34557 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34558 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34559 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34560 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34561 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34562 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34563
34564 Reply:
34565 @table @samp
34566 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34567 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34568 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34569 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34570 @item E @var{NN}
34571 @var{NN} is errno
34572 @end table
34573
34574 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34575 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34576 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34577 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34578 hexadecimal number.
34579
34580 Reply:
34581 @table @samp
34582 @item OK
34583 for success
34584 @item E @var{NN}
34585 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34586 written).
34587 @end table
34588
34589 @item p @var{n}
34590 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34591 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34592 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34593 register value is encoded.
34594
34595 Reply:
34596 @table @samp
34597 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34598 the register's value
34599 @item E @var{NN}
34600 for an error
34601 @item @w{}
34602 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34603 @end table
34604
34605 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34606 @anchor{write register packet}
34607 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34608 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34609 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34610 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34611
34612 Reply:
34613 @table @samp
34614 @item OK
34615 for success
34616 @item E @var{NN}
34617 for an error
34618 @end table
34619
34620 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34621 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34622 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34623 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34624 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34625 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34626
34627 @item r
34628 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34629 Reset the entire system.
34630
34631 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34632
34633 @item R @var{XX}
34634 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34635 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34636 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34637
34638 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34639
34640 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34641 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34642 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34643 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34644
34645 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34646 packet}.
34647
34648 Reply:
34649 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34650
34651 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34652 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34653 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34654 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34655 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34656
34657 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34658 packet}.
34659
34660 Reply:
34661 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34662
34663 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34664 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34665 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34666 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34667 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34668
34669 @item T @var{thread-id}
34670 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34671 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34672
34673 Reply:
34674 @table @samp
34675 @item OK
34676 thread is still alive
34677 @item E @var{NN}
34678 thread is dead
34679 @end table
34680
34681 @item v
34682 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34683 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34684
34685 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34686 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34687 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34688 The process ID is a
34689 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34690 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34691 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34692
34693 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34694 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34695 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34696 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34697 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34698 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34699 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34700 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34701
34702 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34703
34704 Reply:
34705 @table @samp
34706 @item E @var{nn}
34707 for an error
34708 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34709 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34710 @item OK
34711 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34712 @end table
34713
34714 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34715 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34716 @anchor{vCont packet}
34717 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34718 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34719 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34720 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34721 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34722 Specifying multiple
34723 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34724 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34725
34726 Currently supported actions are:
34727
34728 @table @samp
34729 @item c
34730 Continue.
34731 @item C @var{sig}
34732 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34733 @item s
34734 Step.
34735 @item S @var{sig}
34736 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34737 @item t
34738 Stop.
34739 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34740 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34741 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34742 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34743 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34744 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34745
34746 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34747 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34748 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34749 jumps to @var{start}).
34750
34751 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34752 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34753 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34754
34755 @end table
34756
34757 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34758 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34759 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34760
34761 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34762 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34763 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34764 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34765 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34766 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34767 as an implementation detail.
34768
34769 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34770 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34771 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34772 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34773 @var{thread-id}.
34774
34775 Reply:
34776 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34777
34778 @item vCont?
34779 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34780 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34781
34782 Reply:
34783 @table @samp
34784 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34785 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34786 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34787 @item @w{}
34788 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34789 @end table
34790
34791 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34792 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34793 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34794 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34795
34796 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34797 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34798 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34799 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34800 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34801 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34802 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34803 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34804 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34805 packet is received.
34806
34807 Reply:
34808 @table @samp
34809 @item OK
34810 for success
34811 @item E @var{NN}
34812 for an error
34813 @end table
34814
34815 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34816 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34817 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34818 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34819 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34820 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34821 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34822 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34823 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34824 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34825 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34826 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34827
34828
34829 Reply:
34830 @table @samp
34831 @item OK
34832 for success
34833 @item E.memtype
34834 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34835 @item E @var{NN}
34836 for an error
34837 @end table
34838
34839 @item vFlashDone
34840 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34841 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34842 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34843 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34844 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34845 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34846 request is completed.
34847
34848 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34849 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34850 @anchor{vKill packet}
34851 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34852 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34853 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34854 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34855
34856 Reply:
34857 @table @samp
34858 @item E @var{nn}
34859 for an error
34860 @item OK
34861 for success
34862 @end table
34863
34864 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34865 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34866 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34867 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34868 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34869 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34870 state.
34871
34872 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34873
34874 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34875
34876 Reply:
34877 @table @samp
34878 @item E @var{nn}
34879 for an error
34880 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34881 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34882 @end table
34883
34884 @item vStopped
34885 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34886 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34887
34888 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34889 @anchor{X packet}
34890 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34891 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34892 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34893 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34894
34895 Reply:
34896 @table @samp
34897 @item OK
34898 for success
34899 @item E @var{NN}
34900 for an error
34901 @end table
34902
34903 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34904 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34905 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34906 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34907 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34908 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34909 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34910
34911 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34912 separately.
34913
34914 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34915 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34916 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34917 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34918 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34919 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34920
34921 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34922 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34923 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34924 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34925 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34926 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34927
34928 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34929 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34930 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34931 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34932 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34933 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34934 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34935 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34936 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34937 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34938
34939 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34940 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34941
34942 @table @samp
34943
34944 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34945 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34946 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34947
34948 @end table
34949
34950 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34951 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34952 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34953 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34954 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34955 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34956 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34957
34958 @table @samp
34959
34960 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34961 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34962 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34963
34964 @end table
34965
34966 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34967
34968 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34969 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34970 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34971 target, is not defined.}
34972
34973 Reply:
34974 @table @samp
34975 @item OK
34976 success
34977 @item @w{}
34978 not supported
34979 @item E @var{NN}
34980 for an error
34981 @end table
34982
34983 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34984 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34985 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34986 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34987 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34988 address @var{addr}.
34989
34990 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34991 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34992 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34993
34994 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34995 movement.}
34996
34997 Reply:
34998 @table @samp
34999 @item OK
35000 success
35001 @item @w{}
35002 not supported
35003 @item E @var{NN}
35004 for an error
35005 @end table
35006
35007 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35008 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35009 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35010 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35011 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35012 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35013
35014 Reply:
35015 @table @samp
35016 @item OK
35017 success
35018 @item @w{}
35019 not supported
35020 @item E @var{NN}
35021 for an error
35022 @end table
35023
35024 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35025 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35026 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35027 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35028 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35029 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35030
35031 Reply:
35032 @table @samp
35033 @item OK
35034 success
35035 @item @w{}
35036 not supported
35037 @item E @var{NN}
35038 for an error
35039 @end table
35040
35041 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35042 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35043 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35044 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35045 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35046 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35047
35048 Reply:
35049 @table @samp
35050 @item OK
35051 success
35052 @item @w{}
35053 not supported
35054 @item E @var{NN}
35055 for an error
35056 @end table
35057
35058 @end table
35059
35060 @node Stop Reply Packets
35061 @section Stop Reply Packets
35062 @cindex stop reply packets
35063
35064 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35065 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35066 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35067 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35068 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35069 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35070 @value{GDBN} source code.
35071
35072 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35073 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35074 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35075 components.
35076
35077 @table @samp
35078
35079 @item S @var{AA}
35080 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35081 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35082 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35083
35084 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35085 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35086 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35087 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35088 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35089 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35090 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35091 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35092
35093 @itemize @bullet
35094 @item
35095 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35096 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35097 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35098 two-digit hex number.
35099
35100 @item
35101 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35102 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35103
35104 @item
35105 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35106 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35107
35108 @item
35109 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35110 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35111 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35112 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35113
35114 @item
35115 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35116 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35117 future.
35118 @end itemize
35119
35120 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35121
35122 @table @samp
35123 @item watch
35124 @itemx rwatch
35125 @itemx awatch
35126 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35127 hex.
35128
35129 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35130 @item library
35131 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35132 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35133 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35134
35135 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35136 @item replaylog
35137 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35138 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35139 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35140 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35141 for more information.
35142 @end table
35143
35144 @item W @var{AA}
35145 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35146 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35147 applicable to certain targets.
35148
35149 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35150 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35151 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35152 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35153
35154 @item X @var{AA}
35155 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35156 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35157
35158 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35159 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35160 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35161 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35162
35163 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35164 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35165 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35166 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35167 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35168
35169 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35170 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35171 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35172 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35173 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35174 system calls.
35175
35176 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35177 this very system call.
35178
35179 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35180 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35181 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35182 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35183 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35184 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35185
35186 @end table
35187
35188 @node General Query Packets
35189 @section General Query Packets
35190 @cindex remote query requests
35191
35192 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35193 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35194 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35195 sending information to and from the stub.
35196
35197 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35198 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35199 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35200 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35201 conventions:
35202
35203 @itemize @bullet
35204 @item
35205 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35206 @item
35207 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35208 letter.
35209 @item
35210 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35211 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35212 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35213 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35214 @end itemize
35215
35216 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35217 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35218 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35219 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35220 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35221 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35222 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35223 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35224 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35225 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35226 packet.}.
35227
35228 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35229 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35230 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35231 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35232 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35233
35234 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35235
35236 @table @samp
35237
35238 @item QAgent:1
35239 @itemx QAgent:0
35240 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35241 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35242
35243 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35244 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35245 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35246 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35247 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35248 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35249 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35250 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35251 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35252 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35253 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35254
35255 @item qC
35256 @cindex current thread, remote request
35257 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35258 Return the current thread ID.
35259
35260 Reply:
35261 @table @samp
35262 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35263 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35264 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35265 @item @r{(anything else)}
35266 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35267 @end table
35268
35269 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35270 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35271 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35272 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35273 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35274 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35275 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35276 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35277
35278 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35279 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35280 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35281 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35282 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35283 detect trailing zeros.
35284
35285 Reply:
35286 @table @samp
35287 @item E @var{NN}
35288 An error (such as memory fault)
35289 @item C @var{crc32}
35290 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35291 @end table
35292
35293 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35294 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35295 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35296 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35297 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35298 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35299 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35300 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35301 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35302 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35303 randomization.
35304
35305 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35306
35307 Reply:
35308 @table @samp
35309 @item OK
35310 The request succeeded.
35311
35312 @item E @var{nn}
35313 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35314
35315 @item @w{}
35316 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35317 by the stub.
35318 @end table
35319
35320 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35321 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35322 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35323 address space randomization.
35324
35325 @item qfThreadInfo
35326 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35327 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35328 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35329 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35330 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35331 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35332 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35333 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35334 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35335 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35336
35337 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35338
35339 Reply:
35340 @table @samp
35341 @item m @var{thread-id}
35342 A single thread ID
35343 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35344 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35345 @item l
35346 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35347 @end table
35348
35349 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35350 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35351 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35352 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35353 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35354 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35355 fields.
35356
35357 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35358 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35359 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35360 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35361 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35362
35363 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35364 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35365 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35366 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35367 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35368
35369 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35370 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35371
35372 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35373 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35374 information associated with the variable.)
35375
35376 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35377 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35378 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35379 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35380 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35381 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35382
35383 Reply:
35384 @table @samp
35385 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35386 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35387 local storage requested.
35388
35389 @item E @var{nn}
35390 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35391
35392 @item @w{}
35393 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35394 @end table
35395
35396 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35397 @cindex get thread information block address
35398 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35399 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35400
35401 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35402
35403 Reply:
35404 @table @samp
35405 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35406 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35407 thread information block.
35408
35409 @item E @var{nn}
35410 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35411 address could not be retrieved.
35412
35413 @item @w{}
35414 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35415 @end table
35416
35417 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35418 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35419 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35420 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35421 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35422 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35423 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35424
35425 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35426
35427 Reply:
35428 @table @samp
35429 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35430 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35431 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35432 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35433 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35434 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35435 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35436 @end table
35437
35438 @item qOffsets
35439 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35440 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35441 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35442 image.
35443
35444 Reply:
35445 @table @samp
35446 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35447 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35448 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35449 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35450 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35451 segments by the supplied offsets.
35452
35453 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35454 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35455 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35456
35457 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35458 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35459 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35460 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35461 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35462 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35463 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35464 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35465 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35466 @end table
35467
35468 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35469 @cindex thread information, remote request
35470 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35471 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35472 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35473 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35474
35475 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35476 (see below).
35477
35478 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35479
35480 @item QNonStop:1
35481 @itemx QNonStop:0
35482 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35483 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35484 @anchor{QNonStop}
35485 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35486 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35487
35488 Reply:
35489 @table @samp
35490 @item OK
35491 The request succeeded.
35492
35493 @item E @var{nn}
35494 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35495
35496 @item @w{}
35497 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35498 the stub.
35499 @end table
35500
35501 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35502 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35503 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35504 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35505
35506 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35507 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35508 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35509 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35510 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35511 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35512 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35513 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35514 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35515 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35516 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35517 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35518 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35519
35520 Reply:
35521 @table @samp
35522 @item OK
35523 The request succeeded.
35524
35525 @item E @var{nn}
35526 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35527
35528 @item @w{}
35529 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35530 the stub.
35531 @end table
35532
35533 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35534 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35535 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35536 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35537
35538 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35539 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35540 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35541 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35542 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35543 Others should be silently discarded.
35544
35545 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35546 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35547 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35548 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35549 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35550 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35551 signals.
35552
35553 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35554 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35555
35556 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35557 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35558 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35559 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35560 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35561
35562 Reply:
35563 @table @samp
35564 @item OK
35565 The request succeeded.
35566
35567 @item E @var{nn}
35568 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35569
35570 @item @w{}
35571 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35572 by the stub.
35573 @end table
35574
35575 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35576 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35577 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35578 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35579
35580 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35581 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35582 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35583 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35584 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35585 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35586 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35587 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35588 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35589
35590 Reply:
35591 @table @samp
35592 @item OK
35593 A command response with no output.
35594 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35595 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35596 @item E @var{NN}
35597 Indicate a badly formed request.
35598 @item @w{}
35599 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35600 @end table
35601
35602 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35603 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35604 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35605 packets.)
35606
35607 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35608 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35609 @ifnotinfo
35610 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35611 @end ifnotinfo
35612 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35613 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35614 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35615 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35616 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35617
35618 Reply:
35619 @table @samp
35620 @item 0
35621 The pattern was not found.
35622 @item 1,address
35623 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35624 @item E @var{NN}
35625 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35626 @item @w{}
35627 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35628 @end table
35629
35630 @item QStartNoAckMode
35631 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35632 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35633 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35634 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35635
35636 Reply:
35637 @table @samp
35638 @item OK
35639 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35640 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35641 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35642 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35643 @item @w{}
35644 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35645 @end table
35646
35647 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35648 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35649 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35650 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35651 @anchor{qSupported}
35652 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35653 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35654 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35655 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35656 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35657 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35658 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35659 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35660 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35661 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35662 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35663 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35664 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35665 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35666
35667 Reply:
35668 @table @samp
35669 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35670 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35671 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35672 possible forms).
35673 @item @w{}
35674 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35675 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35676 @end table
35677
35678 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35679 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35680 are:
35681
35682 @table @samp
35683 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35684 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35685 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35686 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35687 @item @var{name}+
35688 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35689 need an associated value.
35690 @item @var{name}-
35691 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35692 @item @var{name}?
35693 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35694 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35695 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35696 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35697 @end table
35698
35699 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35700 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35701 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35702 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35703 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35704
35705 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35706 are defined:
35707
35708 @table @samp
35709 @item multiprocess
35710 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35711 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35712 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35713 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35714 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35715
35716 @item xmlRegisters
35717 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35718 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35719 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35720 description.
35721
35722 @item qRelocInsn
35723 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35724 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35725 instruction reply packet}).
35726 @end table
35727
35728 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35729 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35730 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35731 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35732 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35733 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35734 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35735 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35736 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35737 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35738 all the features it supports.
35739
35740 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35741 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35742
35743 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35744 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35745 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35746 form response.
35747
35748 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35749 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35750 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35751 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35752
35753 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35754 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35755 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35756 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35757 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35758
35759 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35760
35761 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35762 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35763 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35764 @item Feature Name
35765 @tab Value Required
35766 @tab Default
35767 @tab Probe Allowed
35768
35769 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35770 @tab Yes
35771 @tab @samp{-}
35772 @tab No
35773
35774 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35775 @tab No
35776 @tab @samp{-}
35777 @tab Yes
35778
35779 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35780 @tab No
35781 @tab @samp{-}
35782 @tab Yes
35783
35784 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
35785 @tab No
35786 @tab @samp{-}
35787 @tab Yes
35788
35789 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35790 @tab No
35791 @tab @samp{-}
35792 @tab Yes
35793
35794 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35795 @tab No
35796 @tab @samp{-}
35797 @tab Yes
35798
35799 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35800 @tab No
35801 @tab @samp{-}
35802 @tab Yes
35803
35804 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35805 @tab No
35806 @tab @samp{-}
35807 @tab No
35808
35809 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35810 @tab No
35811 @tab @samp{-}
35812 @tab Yes
35813
35814 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35815 @tab No
35816 @tab @samp{-}
35817 @tab Yes
35818
35819 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35820 @tab No
35821 @tab @samp{-}
35822 @tab Yes
35823
35824 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35825 @tab No
35826 @tab @samp{-}
35827 @tab Yes
35828
35829 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35830 @tab No
35831 @tab @samp{-}
35832 @tab Yes
35833
35834 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35835 @tab No
35836 @tab @samp{-}
35837 @tab Yes
35838
35839 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35840 @tab No
35841 @tab @samp{-}
35842 @tab Yes
35843
35844 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35845 @tab No
35846 @tab @samp{-}
35847 @tab Yes
35848
35849 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35850 @tab No
35851 @tab @samp{-}
35852 @tab Yes
35853
35854 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35855 @tab No
35856 @tab @samp{-}
35857 @tab Yes
35858
35859 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35860 @tab Yes
35861 @tab @samp{-}
35862 @tab Yes
35863
35864 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35865 @tab Yes
35866 @tab @samp{-}
35867 @tab Yes
35868
35869 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
35870 @tab Yes
35871 @tab @samp{-}
35872 @tab Yes
35873
35874 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35875 @tab No
35876 @tab @samp{-}
35877 @tab Yes
35878
35879 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35880 @tab No
35881 @tab @samp{-}
35882 @tab Yes
35883
35884 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35885 @tab No
35886 @tab @samp{-}
35887 @tab Yes
35888
35889 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35890 @tab No
35891 @tab @samp{-}
35892 @tab No
35893
35894 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35895 @tab No
35896 @tab @samp{-}
35897 @tab No
35898
35899 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35900 @tab No
35901 @tab @samp{-}
35902 @tab No
35903
35904 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35905 @tab No
35906 @tab @samp{-}
35907 @tab No
35908
35909 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35910 @tab No
35911 @tab @samp{-}
35912 @tab No
35913
35914 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35915 @tab No
35916 @tab @samp{-}
35917 @tab No
35918
35919 @item @samp{QAgent}
35920 @tab No
35921 @tab @samp{-}
35922 @tab No
35923
35924 @item @samp{QAllow}
35925 @tab No
35926 @tab @samp{-}
35927 @tab No
35928
35929 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35930 @tab No
35931 @tab @samp{-}
35932 @tab No
35933
35934 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35935 @tab No
35936 @tab @samp{-}
35937 @tab No
35938
35939 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35940 @tab No
35941 @tab @samp{-}
35942 @tab No
35943
35944 @item @samp{tracenz}
35945 @tab No
35946 @tab @samp{-}
35947 @tab No
35948
35949 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35950 @tab No
35951 @tab @samp{-}
35952 @tab No
35953
35954 @end multitable
35955
35956 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35957
35958 @table @samp
35959 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35960 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35961 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35962 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35963 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35964 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35965 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35966 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35967 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35968 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35969
35970 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35971 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35972 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35973
35974 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35975 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35976 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35977
35978 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
35979 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
35980 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
35981
35982 @item qXfer:features:read
35983 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35984 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35985
35986 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35987 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35988 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35989
35990 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35991 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35992 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35993
35994 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35995 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35996 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35997 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35998
35999 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36000 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36001 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36002
36003 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36004 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36005 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36006
36007 @item qXfer:spu:read
36008 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36009 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36010
36011 @item qXfer:spu:write
36012 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36013 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36014
36015 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36016 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36017 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36018
36019 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36020 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36021 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36022
36023 @item qXfer:threads:read
36024 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36025 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36026
36027 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36028 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36029 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36030
36031 @item qXfer:uib:read
36032 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36033 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36034
36035 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36036 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36037 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36038
36039 @item QNonStop
36040 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36041 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36042
36043 @item QPassSignals
36044 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36045 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36046
36047 @item QStartNoAckMode
36048 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36049 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36050
36051 @item multiprocess
36052 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36053 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36054 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36055 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36056 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36057 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36058 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36059 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36060 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36061 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36062 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36063
36064 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36065 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36066 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36067
36068 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36069 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36070 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36071 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36072
36073 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36074 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36075 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36076
36077 @item ReverseContinue
36078 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36079 (@pxref{bc}).
36080
36081 @item ReverseStep
36082 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36083 (@pxref{bs}).
36084
36085 @item TracepointSource
36086 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36087 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36088
36089 @item QAgent
36090 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36091
36092 @item QAllow
36093 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36094
36095 @item QDisableRandomization
36096 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36097
36098 @item StaticTracepoint
36099 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36100 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36101
36102 @item InstallInTrace
36103 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36104 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36105
36106 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36107 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36108 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36109 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36110
36111 @item QTBuffer:size
36112 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36113 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36114
36115 @item tracenz
36116 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36117 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36118 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36119
36120 @item BreakpointCommands
36121 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36122 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36123 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36124
36125 @item Qbtrace:off
36126 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36127
36128 @item Qbtrace:bts
36129 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36130
36131 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36132 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36133
36134 @end table
36135
36136 @item qSymbol::
36137 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36138 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36139 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36140 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36141
36142 Reply:
36143 @table @samp
36144 @item OK
36145 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36146 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36147 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36148 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36149 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36150 below.
36151 @end table
36152
36153 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36154 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36155
36156 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36157 target has previously requested.
36158
36159 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36160 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36161 will be empty.
36162
36163 Reply:
36164 @table @samp
36165 @item OK
36166 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36167 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36168 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36169 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36170 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36171 @end table
36172
36173 @item qTBuffer
36174 @itemx QTBuffer
36175 @itemx QTDisconnected
36176 @itemx QTDP
36177 @itemx QTDPsrc
36178 @itemx QTDV
36179 @itemx qTfP
36180 @itemx qTfV
36181 @itemx QTFrame
36182 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36183
36184 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36185
36186 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36187 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36188 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36189 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36190 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36191 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36192 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36193 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36194 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36195 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36196 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36197
36198 Reply:
36199 @table @samp
36200 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36201 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36202 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36203 the thread's attributes.
36204 @end table
36205
36206 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36207 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36208 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36209 packets.)
36210
36211 @item QTNotes
36212 @itemx qTP
36213 @itemx QTSave
36214 @itemx qTsP
36215 @itemx qTsV
36216 @itemx QTStart
36217 @itemx QTStop
36218 @itemx QTEnable
36219 @itemx QTDisable
36220 @itemx QTinit
36221 @itemx QTro
36222 @itemx qTStatus
36223 @itemx qTV
36224 @itemx qTfSTM
36225 @itemx qTsSTM
36226 @itemx qTSTMat
36227 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36228
36229 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36230 @cindex read special object, remote request
36231 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36232 @anchor{qXfer read}
36233 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36234 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36235 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36236 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36237 additional details about what data to access.
36238
36239 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36240 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36241 formats, listed below.
36242
36243 @table @samp
36244 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36245 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36246 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36247 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36248
36249 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36250 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36251
36252 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36253 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36254
36255 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36256 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36257 packet may have one of the following values:
36258
36259 @table @code
36260 @item all
36261 Returns all available branch trace.
36262
36263 @item new
36264 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36265 the last read request.
36266
36267 @item delta
36268 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36269 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36270 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36271 used to stitch traces together.
36272
36273 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36274 @end table
36275
36276 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36277 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36278
36279 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36280 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36281
36282 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36283 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36284
36285 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36286 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36287
36288 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36289 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36290 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36291 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36292 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36293
36294 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36295 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36296
36297 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36298 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36299 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36300 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36301 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36302
36303 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36304 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36305 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36306
36307 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36308 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36309
36310 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36311 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36312 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36313 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36314 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36315 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36316 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36317 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36318
36319 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36320 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36321
36322 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36323 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36324
36325 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36326 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36327 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36328 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36329
36330 @table @code
36331 @item start=@var{address}
36332 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36333 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36334 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36335 chosen as the starting point.
36336
36337 @item prev=@var{address}
36338 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36339 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36340 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36341 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36342 exists prior to the starting point.
36343
36344 @end table
36345
36346 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36347 ignored.
36348
36349 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36350 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36351 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36352 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36353 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36354
36355 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36356 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36357
36358 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36359 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36360
36361 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36362 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36363 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36364 Action Lists}.
36365
36366 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36367 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36368 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36369
36370 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36371 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36372 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36373 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36374 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36375
36376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36378 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36379
36380 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36381 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36382 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36383 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36384 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36385 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36386 in that context to be accessed.
36387
36388 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36389 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36390 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36391
36392 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36393 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36394 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36395 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36396 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36397
36398 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36399 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36400
36401 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36402 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36403
36404 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36405 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36406 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36407
36408 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36409 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36410
36411 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36412 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36413
36414 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36415 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36416
36417 This packet is not probed by default.
36418
36419 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36420 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36421 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36422 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36423 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36424
36425 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36426 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36427
36428 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36429 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36430 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36431 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36432
36433 @end table
36434
36435 Reply:
36436 @table @samp
36437 @item m @var{data}
36438 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36439 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36440 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36441 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36442 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36443 request.
36444
36445 @item l @var{data}
36446 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36447 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36448 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36449
36450 @item l
36451 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36452 There is no more data to be read.
36453
36454 @item E00
36455 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36456
36457 @item E @var{nn}
36458 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36459 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36460
36461 @item @w{}
36462 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36463 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36464 @end table
36465
36466 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36467 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36468 @anchor{qXfer write}
36469 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36470 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36471 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36472 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36473 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36474 to access.
36475
36476 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36477 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36478 formats, listed below.
36479
36480 @table @samp
36481 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36482 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36483 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36484 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36485 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36486
36487 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36488 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36489 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36490
36491 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36492 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36493 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36494 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36495 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36496 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36497 in that context to be accessed.
36498
36499 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36500 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36501 @end table
36502
36503 Reply:
36504 @table @samp
36505 @item @var{nn}
36506 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36507 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36508
36509 @item E00
36510 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36511
36512 @item E @var{nn}
36513 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36514 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36515
36516 @item @w{}
36517 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36518 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36519 @end table
36520
36521 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36522 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36523 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36524 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36525 must respond with an empty packet.
36526
36527 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36528 @cindex query attached, remote request
36529 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36530 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36531 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36532 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36533 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36534 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36535 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36536
36537 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36538 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36539 the @code{quit} command.
36540
36541 Reply:
36542 @table @samp
36543 @item 1
36544 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36545 @item 0
36546 The remote server created a new process.
36547 @item E @var{NN}
36548 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36549 @end table
36550
36551 @item Qbtrace:bts
36552 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36553
36554 Reply:
36555 @table @samp
36556 @item OK
36557 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36558 @item E.errtext
36559 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36560 @end table
36561
36562 @item Qbtrace:off
36563 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36564
36565 Reply:
36566 @table @samp
36567 @item OK
36568 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36569 @item E.errtext
36570 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36571 @end table
36572
36573 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
36574 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
36575 btrace recording method in bts format.
36576
36577 Reply:
36578 @table @samp
36579 @item OK
36580 The ring buffer size has been set.
36581 @item E.errtext
36582 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36583 @end table
36584
36585 @end table
36586
36587 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36588 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36589
36590 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36591 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36592 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36593
36594 @menu
36595 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36596 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36597 @end menu
36598
36599 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36600 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36601
36602 @menu
36603 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36604 @end menu
36605
36606 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36607 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36608 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36609
36610 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36611
36612 @table @r
36613
36614 @item 2
36615 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36616
36617 @item 3
36618 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36619
36620 @item 4
36621 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36622
36623 @end table
36624
36625 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36626 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36627
36628 @menu
36629 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36630 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36631 @end menu
36632
36633 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36634 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36635 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36636
36637 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36638 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36639 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36640 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36641 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36642 most-significant -- least-significant.
36643
36644 @table @r
36645
36646 @item MIPS32
36647 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36648 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36649 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36650
36651 @item MIPS64
36652 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36653 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36654 as @code{MIPS32}.
36655
36656 @end table
36657
36658 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36659 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36660 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36661
36662 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36663
36664 @table @r
36665
36666 @item 2
36667 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36668
36669 @item 3
36670 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36671
36672 @item 4
36673 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36674
36675 @item 5
36676 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36677
36678 @end table
36679
36680 @node Tracepoint Packets
36681 @section Tracepoint Packets
36682 @cindex tracepoint packets
36683 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36684
36685 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36686 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36687
36688 @table @samp
36689
36690 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36691 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36692 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36693 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36694 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36695 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36696 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36697 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36698 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36699 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36700 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36701 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36702 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36703 actions.
36704
36705 Replies:
36706 @table @samp
36707 @item OK
36708 The packet was understood and carried out.
36709 @item qRelocInsn
36710 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36711 @item @w{}
36712 The packet was not recognized.
36713 @end table
36714
36715 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36716 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36717 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36718 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36719 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36720 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36721 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36722
36723 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36724 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36725 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36726 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36727 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36728 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36729 tracepoint actions.
36730
36731 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36732 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36733 following forms:
36734
36735 @table @samp
36736
36737 @item R @var{mask}
36738 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36739 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36740 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36741 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36742 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36743
36744 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36745 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36746 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36747 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36748 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36749 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36750 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36751
36752 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36753 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36754 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36755 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36756 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36757 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36758 packet).
36759
36760 @end table
36761
36762 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36763 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36764 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36765 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36766 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36767 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36768 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36769 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36770
36771 Replies:
36772 @table @samp
36773 @item OK
36774 The packet was understood and carried out.
36775 @item qRelocInsn
36776 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36777 @item @w{}
36778 The packet was not recognized.
36779 @end table
36780
36781 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36782 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36783 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36784 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36785 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36786 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36787 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36788 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36789
36790 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36791 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36792 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36793 fit in a single packet.
36794 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36795 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36796
36797 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36798 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36799 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36800 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36801
36802 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36803 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36804 query packets.
36805
36806 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36807 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36808 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36809 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36810 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36811 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36812 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36813 be found.
36814
36815 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
36816 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36817 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36818 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36819 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36820 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36821 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36822 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36823 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
36824 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
36825 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
36826 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
36827 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
36828 variable.
36829
36830 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36831 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36832 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36833 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36834 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36835
36836 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36837 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36838 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36839 one of the following forms:
36840
36841 @table @samp
36842 @item F @var{f}
36843 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36844 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36845 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36846
36847 @item T @var{t}
36848 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36849 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36850
36851 @end table
36852
36853 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36854 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36855 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36856 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36857
36858 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36859 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36860 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36861 is a hexadecimal number.
36862
36863 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36864 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36865 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36866 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36867 numbers.
36868
36869 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36870 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36871 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36872
36873 @item qTMinFTPILen
36874 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36875 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36876 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36877 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36878 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36879 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36880 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36881 arrange for that.
36882
36883 Replies:
36884
36885 @table @samp
36886 @item 0
36887 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36888 @item @var{length}
36889 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36890 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36891 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36892 regardless of size.
36893 @item E
36894 An error has occurred.
36895 @item @w{}
36896 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36897 @end table
36898
36899 @item QTStart
36900 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36901 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36902 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36903 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36904 instruction reply packet}).
36905
36906 @item QTStop
36907 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36908 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36909
36910 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36911 @anchor{QTEnable}
36912 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36913 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36914 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36915 of data from it will resume.
36916
36917 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36918 @anchor{QTDisable}
36919 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36920 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36921 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36922 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36923
36924 @item QTinit
36925 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36926 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36927
36928 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36929 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36930 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36931 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36932 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36933
36934 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36935 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36936 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36937 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36938
36939 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36940 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36941 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36942 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36943 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36944 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36945
36946 @item qTStatus
36947 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36948 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36949
36950 The reply has the form:
36951
36952 @table @samp
36953
36954 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36955 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36956 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36957 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36958
36959 @end table
36960
36961 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36962 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36963
36964 @table @samp
36965
36966 @item tnotrun:0
36967 No trace has been run yet.
36968
36969 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36970 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36971 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36972 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36973 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36974
36975 @item tfull:0
36976 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36977
36978 @item tdisconnected:0
36979 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36980
36981 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36982 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36983
36984 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36985 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36986 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36987 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36988 is hex encoded.
36989
36990 @item tunknown:0
36991 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36992
36993 @end table
36994
36995 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36996 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36997 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36998 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36999 trace.
37000
37001 @table @samp
37002
37003 @item tframes:@var{n}
37004 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37005
37006 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37007 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37008 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37009
37010 @item tsize:@var{n}
37011 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37012
37013 @item tfree:@var{n}
37014 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37015
37016 @item circular:@var{n}
37017 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37018 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37019 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37020 and may fill up.
37021
37022 @item disconn:@var{n}
37023 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37024 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37025 that the trace run will stop.
37026
37027 @end table
37028
37029 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37030 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37031 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37032 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37033 address @var{addr}.
37034
37035 Replies:
37036 @table @samp
37037 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37038 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37039 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37040 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37041 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37042
37043 @end table
37044
37045 @item qTV:@var{var}
37046 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37047 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37048 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37049
37050 Replies:
37051 @table @samp
37052 @item V@var{value}
37053 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37054 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37055 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37056 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37057 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37058 program is running.
37059
37060 @item U
37061 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37062 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37063 was not collected.
37064 @end table
37065
37066 @item qTfP
37067 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37068 @itemx qTsP
37069 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37070 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37071 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37072 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37073 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37074 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37075
37076 @item qTfV
37077 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37078 @itemx qTsV
37079 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37080 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37081 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37082 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37083 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37084 trace state variables.
37085
37086 @item qTfSTM
37087 @itemx qTsSTM
37088 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37089 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37090 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37091 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37092 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37093 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37094 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37095 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37096
37097 Reply:
37098 @table @samp
37099 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37100 A single marker
37101 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37102 a comma-separated list of markers
37103 @item l
37104 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37105 @item E @var{nn}
37106 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37107 @item @w{}
37108 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37109 stub.
37110 @end table
37111
37112 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37113 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37114
37115 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37116 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37117 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37118 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37119 @dfn{last}).
37120
37121 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37122 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37123 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37124 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37125 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37126 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37127 tracepoint markers.
37128
37129 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37130 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37131 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37132 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37133 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37134 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37135
37136 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37137 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37138 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37139 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37140 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37141 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37142 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37143 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37144 available.
37145
37146 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37147 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37148 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37149
37150 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37151 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37152 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37153 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37154 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37155 use whatever size it prefers.
37156
37157 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37158 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37159 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37160 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37161 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37162
37163 @end table
37164
37165 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37166 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37167 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37168 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37169 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37170 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37171 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37172 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37173 it had executed in the original location.
37174
37175 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37176 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37177 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37178 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37179 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37180 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37181 format of the request is:
37182
37183 @table @samp
37184 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37185
37186 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37187 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37188 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37189 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37190 memory starting at @var{to}.
37191 @end table
37192
37193 Replies:
37194 @table @samp
37195 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37196 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37197 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37198 @item E @var{NN}
37199 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37200 relocating the instruction.
37201 @end table
37202
37203 @node Host I/O Packets
37204 @section Host I/O Packets
37205 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37206 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37207
37208 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37209 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37210 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37211 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37212 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37213 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37214 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37215 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37216 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37217 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37218
37219 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37220 its arguments. They have this format:
37221
37222 @table @samp
37223
37224 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37225 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37226 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37227 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37228 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37229 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37230 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37231 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37232 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37233
37234 @end table
37235
37236 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37237
37238 @table @samp
37239
37240 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37241 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37242 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37243 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37244 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37245 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37246 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37247 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37248 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37249 @var{attachment}.
37250
37251 @item @w{}
37252 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37253
37254 @end table
37255
37256 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37257
37258 @table @samp
37259 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37260 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37261 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37262 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37263 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37264 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37265 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37266
37267 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37268 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37269 -1 if an error occurs.
37270
37271 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37272 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37273 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37274 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37275 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37276 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37277 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37278 @var{count} was zero.
37279
37280 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37281 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37282 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37283 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37284 some characters were escaped.
37285
37286 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37287 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37288 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37289 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37290 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37291 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37292 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37293 error occurred.
37294
37295 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37296 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37297 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37298
37299 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37300 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37301 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37302
37303 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37304 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37305 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37306 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37307 some characters were escaped.
37308
37309 @end table
37310
37311 @node Interrupts
37312 @section Interrupts
37313 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37314
37315 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37316 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37317 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37318 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37319
37320 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37321 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37322 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37323 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37324 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37325
37326 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37327 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37328 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37329 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37330 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37331 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37332 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37333 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37334
37335 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37336 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37337 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37338
37339 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37340 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37341 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37342 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37343 currently-executing threads and processes.
37344 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37345 running program, it should send one of the stop
37346 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37347 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37348 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37349 Interrupts received while the
37350 program is stopped are discarded.
37351
37352 @node Notification Packets
37353 @section Notification Packets
37354 @cindex notification packets
37355 @cindex packets, notification
37356
37357 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37358 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37359 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37360 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37361 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37362 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37363 is not a problem.
37364
37365 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37366 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37367 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37368 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37369 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37370 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37371 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37372
37373 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37374 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37375
37376 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37377 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37378 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37379 not they understand it.
37380
37381 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37382 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37383 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37384 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37385 recipients.
37386
37387 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37388 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37389 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37390 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37391 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37392
37393 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37394 @table @samp
37395 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37396 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37397 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37398 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37399 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37400 @item @var{ack}
37401 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37402 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37403 @end table
37404
37405 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37406 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37407
37408 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37409 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37410 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37411 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37412 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37413 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37414 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37415 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37416 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37417 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37418
37419 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37420 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37421 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37422 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37423 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37424 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37425
37426 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37427 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37428 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37429 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37430 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37431
37432 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37433 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37434 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37435 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37436 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37437 normally.
37438
37439 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37440 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37441 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37442 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37443 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37444 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37445 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37446 the process shall be repeated.
37447
37448 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37449 following example:
37450 @smallexample
37451 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37452 @code{...}
37453 -> @code{vStopped}
37454 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37455 -> @code{vStopped}
37456 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37457 -> @code{vStopped}
37458 <- @code{OK}
37459 @end smallexample
37460
37461 The following notifications are defined:
37462 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37463
37464 @item Notification
37465 @tab Ack
37466 @tab Event
37467 @tab Description
37468
37469 @item Stop
37470 @tab vStopped
37471 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37472 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37473 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37474 @value{GDBN}.
37475 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37476
37477 @end multitable
37478
37479 @node Remote Non-Stop
37480 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37481
37482 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37483 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37484 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37485 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37486
37487 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37488 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37489 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37490 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37491 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37492 probe the target state after a mode change.
37493
37494 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37495 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37496 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37497 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37498 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37499 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37500 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37501 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37502 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37503 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37504 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37505
37506 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37507 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37508 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37509 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37510 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37511 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37512 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37513 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37514 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37515 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37516 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37517 @samp{OK}.
37518
37519 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37520 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37521
37522 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37523 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37524 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37525 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37526 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37527 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37528 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37529
37530 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37531 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37532 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37533 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37534 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37535
37536 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37537 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37538 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37539 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37540
37541 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37542 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37543 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37544 @pxref{qSupported}.
37545 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37546 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37547 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37548 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37549 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37550 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37551 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37552
37553 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37554 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37555 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37556 connection.
37557 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37558 new connection is established,
37559 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37560 for the current connection, once disabled.
37561
37562 @node Examples
37563 @section Examples
37564
37565 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37566 does not get any direct output:
37567
37568 @smallexample
37569 -> @code{R00}
37570 <- @code{+}
37571 @emph{target restarts}
37572 -> @code{?}
37573 <- @code{+}
37574 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37575 -> @code{+}
37576 @end smallexample
37577
37578 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37579
37580 @smallexample
37581 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37582 <- @code{+}
37583 -> @code{s}
37584 <- @code{+}
37585 @emph{time passes}
37586 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37587 -> @code{+}
37588 -> @code{g}
37589 <- @code{+}
37590 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37591 -> @code{+}
37592 @end smallexample
37593
37594 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37595 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37596 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37597
37598 @menu
37599 * File-I/O Overview::
37600 * Protocol Basics::
37601 * The F Request Packet::
37602 * The F Reply Packet::
37603 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37604 * Console I/O::
37605 * List of Supported Calls::
37606 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37607 * Constants::
37608 * File-I/O Examples::
37609 @end menu
37610
37611 @node File-I/O Overview
37612 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37613 @cindex file-i/o overview
37614
37615 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37616 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37617 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37618 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37619 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37620 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37621
37622 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37623 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37624 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37625 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37626 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37627
37628 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37629 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37630 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37631 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37632 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37633 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37634 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37635
37636 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37637 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37638 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37639 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37640 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37641
37642 @smallexample
37643 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37644 <- target requests 'system call X'
37645 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37646 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37647 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37648 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37649 @end smallexample
37650
37651 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37652 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37653 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37654 system are not supported by this protocol.
37655
37656 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37657
37658 @node Protocol Basics
37659 @subsection Protocol Basics
37660 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37661
37662 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37663 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37664 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37665 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37666 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37667 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37668 to call the appropriate host system call:
37669
37670 @itemize @bullet
37671 @item
37672 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37673
37674 @item
37675 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37676 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37677 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37678 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37679
37680 @end itemize
37681
37682 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37683
37684 @itemize @bullet
37685 @item
37686 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37687 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37688 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37689 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37690 packet.
37691
37692 @item
37693 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37694 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37695
37696 @item
37697 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37698
37699 @item
37700 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37701
37702 @item
37703 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37704 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37705 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37706 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37707 packet.
37708
37709 @end itemize
37710
37711 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37712 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37713
37714 @itemize @bullet
37715 @item
37716 Return value.
37717
37718 @item
37719 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37720
37721 @item
37722 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37723
37724 @end itemize
37725
37726 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37727 the latest continue or step action.
37728
37729 @node The F Request Packet
37730 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37731 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37732 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37733
37734 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37735
37736 @table @samp
37737 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37738
37739 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37740 This is just the name of the function.
37741
37742 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37743 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37744 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37745 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37746 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37747 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37748 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37749
37750 @end table
37751
37752
37753
37754 @node The F Reply Packet
37755 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37756 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37757 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37758
37759 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37760
37761 @table @samp
37762
37763 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37764
37765 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37766
37767 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37768 representation.
37769 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37770
37771 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37772 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37773 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37774
37775 @smallexample
37776 F0,0,C
37777 @end smallexample
37778
37779 @noindent
37780 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37781
37782 @smallexample
37783 F-1,4,C
37784 @end smallexample
37785
37786 @noindent
37787 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37788
37789 @end table
37790
37791
37792 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37793 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37794 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37795
37796 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37797 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37798 the target should behave as if it had
37799 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37800 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37801 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37802 packet.
37803
37804 It's important for the target to know in which
37805 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37806
37807 @itemize @bullet
37808 @item
37809 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37810
37811 @item
37812 The system call on the host has been finished.
37813
37814 @end itemize
37815
37816 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37817 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37818 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37819 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37820 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37821 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37822
37823 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37824 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37825 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37826 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37827 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37828 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37829 or the full action has been completed.
37830
37831 @node Console I/O
37832 @subsection Console I/O
37833 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37834
37835 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37836 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37837 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37838 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37839 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37840 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37841 conditions is met:
37842
37843 @itemize @bullet
37844 @item
37845 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37846 @code{read}
37847 system call is treated as finished.
37848
37849 @item
37850 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37851 newline.
37852
37853 @item
37854 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37855 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37856
37857 @end itemize
37858
37859 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37860 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37861 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37862 is stopped at the user's request.
37863
37864
37865 @node List of Supported Calls
37866 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37867 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37868
37869 @menu
37870 * open::
37871 * close::
37872 * read::
37873 * write::
37874 * lseek::
37875 * rename::
37876 * unlink::
37877 * stat/fstat::
37878 * gettimeofday::
37879 * isatty::
37880 * system::
37881 @end menu
37882
37883 @node open
37884 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37885 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37886
37887 @table @asis
37888 @item Synopsis:
37889 @smallexample
37890 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37891 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37892 @end smallexample
37893
37894 @item Request:
37895 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37896
37897 @noindent
37898 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37899
37900 @table @code
37901 @item O_CREAT
37902 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37903 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37904 are concerned.
37905
37906 @item O_EXCL
37907 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37908 an error and open() fails.
37909
37910 @item O_TRUNC
37911 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37912 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37913 truncated to zero length.
37914
37915 @item O_APPEND
37916 The file is opened in append mode.
37917
37918 @item O_RDONLY
37919 The file is opened for reading only.
37920
37921 @item O_WRONLY
37922 The file is opened for writing only.
37923
37924 @item O_RDWR
37925 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37926 @end table
37927
37928 @noindent
37929 Other bits are silently ignored.
37930
37931
37932 @noindent
37933 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37934
37935 @table @code
37936 @item S_IRUSR
37937 User has read permission.
37938
37939 @item S_IWUSR
37940 User has write permission.
37941
37942 @item S_IRGRP
37943 Group has read permission.
37944
37945 @item S_IWGRP
37946 Group has write permission.
37947
37948 @item S_IROTH
37949 Others have read permission.
37950
37951 @item S_IWOTH
37952 Others have write permission.
37953 @end table
37954
37955 @noindent
37956 Other bits are silently ignored.
37957
37958
37959 @item Return value:
37960 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37961 occurred.
37962
37963 @item Errors:
37964
37965 @table @code
37966 @item EEXIST
37967 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37968
37969 @item EISDIR
37970 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37971
37972 @item EACCES
37973 The requested access is not allowed.
37974
37975 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37976 @var{pathname} was too long.
37977
37978 @item ENOENT
37979 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37980
37981 @item ENODEV
37982 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37983
37984 @item EROFS
37985 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37986 write access was requested.
37987
37988 @item EFAULT
37989 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37990
37991 @item ENOSPC
37992 No space on device to create the file.
37993
37994 @item EMFILE
37995 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37996
37997 @item ENFILE
37998 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37999 has been reached.
38000
38001 @item EINTR
38002 The call was interrupted by the user.
38003 @end table
38004
38005 @end table
38006
38007 @node close
38008 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38009 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38010
38011 @table @asis
38012 @item Synopsis:
38013 @smallexample
38014 int close(int fd);
38015 @end smallexample
38016
38017 @item Request:
38018 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38019
38020 @item Return value:
38021 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38022
38023 @item Errors:
38024
38025 @table @code
38026 @item EBADF
38027 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38028
38029 @item EINTR
38030 The call was interrupted by the user.
38031 @end table
38032
38033 @end table
38034
38035 @node read
38036 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38037 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38038
38039 @table @asis
38040 @item Synopsis:
38041 @smallexample
38042 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38043 @end smallexample
38044
38045 @item Request:
38046 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38047
38048 @item Return value:
38049 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38050 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38051 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38052
38053 @item Errors:
38054
38055 @table @code
38056 @item EBADF
38057 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38058 reading.
38059
38060 @item EFAULT
38061 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38062
38063 @item EINTR
38064 The call was interrupted by the user.
38065 @end table
38066
38067 @end table
38068
38069 @node write
38070 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38071 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38072
38073 @table @asis
38074 @item Synopsis:
38075 @smallexample
38076 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38077 @end smallexample
38078
38079 @item Request:
38080 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38081
38082 @item Return value:
38083 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38084 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38085 is returned.
38086
38087 @item Errors:
38088
38089 @table @code
38090 @item EBADF
38091 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38092 writing.
38093
38094 @item EFAULT
38095 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38096
38097 @item EFBIG
38098 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38099 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38100
38101 @item ENOSPC
38102 No space on device to write the data.
38103
38104 @item EINTR
38105 The call was interrupted by the user.
38106 @end table
38107
38108 @end table
38109
38110 @node lseek
38111 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38112 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38113
38114 @table @asis
38115 @item Synopsis:
38116 @smallexample
38117 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38118 @end smallexample
38119
38120 @item Request:
38121 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38122
38123 @var{flag} is one of:
38124
38125 @table @code
38126 @item SEEK_SET
38127 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38128
38129 @item SEEK_CUR
38130 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38131 bytes.
38132
38133 @item SEEK_END
38134 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38135 bytes.
38136 @end table
38137
38138 @item Return value:
38139 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38140 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38141 value of -1 is returned.
38142
38143 @item Errors:
38144
38145 @table @code
38146 @item EBADF
38147 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38148
38149 @item ESPIPE
38150 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38151
38152 @item EINVAL
38153 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38154
38155 @item EINTR
38156 The call was interrupted by the user.
38157 @end table
38158
38159 @end table
38160
38161 @node rename
38162 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38163 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38164
38165 @table @asis
38166 @item Synopsis:
38167 @smallexample
38168 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38169 @end smallexample
38170
38171 @item Request:
38172 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38173
38174 @item Return value:
38175 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38176
38177 @item Errors:
38178
38179 @table @code
38180 @item EISDIR
38181 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38182 directory.
38183
38184 @item EEXIST
38185 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38186
38187 @item EBUSY
38188 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38189 process.
38190
38191 @item EINVAL
38192 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38193 of itself.
38194
38195 @item ENOTDIR
38196 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38197 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38198 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38199
38200 @item EFAULT
38201 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38202
38203 @item EACCES
38204 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38205
38206 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38207
38208 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38209
38210 @item ENOENT
38211 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38212
38213 @item EROFS
38214 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38215
38216 @item ENOSPC
38217 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38218 directory entry.
38219
38220 @item EINTR
38221 The call was interrupted by the user.
38222 @end table
38223
38224 @end table
38225
38226 @node unlink
38227 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38228 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38229
38230 @table @asis
38231 @item Synopsis:
38232 @smallexample
38233 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38234 @end smallexample
38235
38236 @item Request:
38237 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38238
38239 @item Return value:
38240 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38241
38242 @item Errors:
38243
38244 @table @code
38245 @item EACCES
38246 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38247
38248 @item EPERM
38249 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38250
38251 @item EBUSY
38252 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38253 being used by another process.
38254
38255 @item EFAULT
38256 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38257
38258 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38259 @var{pathname} was too long.
38260
38261 @item ENOENT
38262 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38263
38264 @item ENOTDIR
38265 A component of the path is not a directory.
38266
38267 @item EROFS
38268 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38269
38270 @item EINTR
38271 The call was interrupted by the user.
38272 @end table
38273
38274 @end table
38275
38276 @node stat/fstat
38277 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38278 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38279 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38280
38281 @table @asis
38282 @item Synopsis:
38283 @smallexample
38284 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38285 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38286 @end smallexample
38287
38288 @item Request:
38289 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38290 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38291
38292 @item Return value:
38293 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38294
38295 @item Errors:
38296
38297 @table @code
38298 @item EBADF
38299 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38300
38301 @item ENOENT
38302 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38303 path is an empty string.
38304
38305 @item ENOTDIR
38306 A component of the path is not a directory.
38307
38308 @item EFAULT
38309 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38310
38311 @item EACCES
38312 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38313
38314 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38315 @var{pathname} was too long.
38316
38317 @item EINTR
38318 The call was interrupted by the user.
38319 @end table
38320
38321 @end table
38322
38323 @node gettimeofday
38324 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38325 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38326
38327 @table @asis
38328 @item Synopsis:
38329 @smallexample
38330 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38331 @end smallexample
38332
38333 @item Request:
38334 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38335
38336 @item Return value:
38337 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38338
38339 @item Errors:
38340
38341 @table @code
38342 @item EINVAL
38343 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38344
38345 @item EFAULT
38346 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38347 @end table
38348
38349 @end table
38350
38351 @node isatty
38352 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38353 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38354
38355 @table @asis
38356 @item Synopsis:
38357 @smallexample
38358 int isatty(int fd);
38359 @end smallexample
38360
38361 @item Request:
38362 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38363
38364 @item Return value:
38365 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38366
38367 @item Errors:
38368
38369 @table @code
38370 @item EINTR
38371 The call was interrupted by the user.
38372 @end table
38373
38374 @end table
38375
38376 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38377 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38378 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38379 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38380 needed.
38381
38382
38383 @node system
38384 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38385 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38386
38387 @table @asis
38388 @item Synopsis:
38389 @smallexample
38390 int system(const char *command);
38391 @end smallexample
38392
38393 @item Request:
38394 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38395
38396 @item Return value:
38397 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38398 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38399 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38400 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38401 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38402 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38403 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38404
38405 @item Errors:
38406
38407 @table @code
38408 @item EINTR
38409 The call was interrupted by the user.
38410 @end table
38411
38412 @end table
38413
38414 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38415 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38416 the host is simplified before it's returned
38417 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38418 is discarded, and the return value consists
38419 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38420
38421 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38422 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38423 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38424
38425 @table @code
38426 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38427 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38428 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38429 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38430
38431 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38432 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38433 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38434 protocol.
38435 @end table
38436
38437 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38438 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38439 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38440
38441 @menu
38442 * Integral Datatypes::
38443 * Pointer Values::
38444 * Memory Transfer::
38445 * struct stat::
38446 * struct timeval::
38447 @end menu
38448
38449 @node Integral Datatypes
38450 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38451 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38452
38453 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38454 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38455 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38456
38457 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38458 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38459
38460 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38461
38462 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38463 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38464
38465 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38466
38467 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38468 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38469 byte order.
38470
38471 @node Pointer Values
38472 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38473 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38474
38475 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38476 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38477 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38478 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38479
38480 @smallexample
38481 @code{1aaf/12}
38482 @end smallexample
38483
38484 @noindent
38485 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38486 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38487 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38488 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38489
38490 @smallexample
38491 @code{123456/d}
38492 @end smallexample
38493
38494 @node Memory Transfer
38495 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38496 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38497
38498 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38499 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38500 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38501 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38502 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38503 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38504 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38505
38506
38507 @node struct stat
38508 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38509 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38510
38511 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38512 is defined as follows:
38513
38514 @smallexample
38515 struct stat @{
38516 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38517 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38518 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38519 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38520 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38521 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38522 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38523 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38524 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38525 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38526 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38527 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38528 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38529 @};
38530 @end smallexample
38531
38532 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38533 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38534 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38535
38536 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38537 range of values.
38538
38539 @table @code
38540
38541 @item st_dev
38542 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38543
38544 @item st_ino
38545 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38546
38547 @item st_mode
38548 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38549 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38550
38551 @item st_uid
38552 @itemx st_gid
38553 @itemx st_rdev
38554 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38555
38556 @item st_atime
38557 @itemx st_mtime
38558 @itemx st_ctime
38559 These values have a host and file system dependent
38560 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38561 support exact timing values.
38562 @end table
38563
38564 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38565 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38566 continuing.
38567
38568 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38569 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38570 get truncated on the target.
38571
38572 @node struct timeval
38573 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38574 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38575
38576 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38577 is defined as follows:
38578
38579 @smallexample
38580 struct timeval @{
38581 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38582 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38583 @};
38584 @end smallexample
38585
38586 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38587 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38588 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38589
38590 @node Constants
38591 @subsection Constants
38592 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38593
38594 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38595 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38596 values before and after the call as needed.
38597
38598 @menu
38599 * Open Flags::
38600 * mode_t Values::
38601 * Errno Values::
38602 * Lseek Flags::
38603 * Limits::
38604 @end menu
38605
38606 @node Open Flags
38607 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38608 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38609
38610 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38611
38612 @smallexample
38613 O_RDONLY 0x0
38614 O_WRONLY 0x1
38615 O_RDWR 0x2
38616 O_APPEND 0x8
38617 O_CREAT 0x200
38618 O_TRUNC 0x400
38619 O_EXCL 0x800
38620 @end smallexample
38621
38622 @node mode_t Values
38623 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38624 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38625
38626 All values are given in octal representation.
38627
38628 @smallexample
38629 S_IFREG 0100000
38630 S_IFDIR 040000
38631 S_IRUSR 0400
38632 S_IWUSR 0200
38633 S_IXUSR 0100
38634 S_IRGRP 040
38635 S_IWGRP 020
38636 S_IXGRP 010
38637 S_IROTH 04
38638 S_IWOTH 02
38639 S_IXOTH 01
38640 @end smallexample
38641
38642 @node Errno Values
38643 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38644 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38645
38646 All values are given in decimal representation.
38647
38648 @smallexample
38649 EPERM 1
38650 ENOENT 2
38651 EINTR 4
38652 EBADF 9
38653 EACCES 13
38654 EFAULT 14
38655 EBUSY 16
38656 EEXIST 17
38657 ENODEV 19
38658 ENOTDIR 20
38659 EISDIR 21
38660 EINVAL 22
38661 ENFILE 23
38662 EMFILE 24
38663 EFBIG 27
38664 ENOSPC 28
38665 ESPIPE 29
38666 EROFS 30
38667 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38668 EUNKNOWN 9999
38669 @end smallexample
38670
38671 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38672 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38673
38674 @node Lseek Flags
38675 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38676 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38677
38678 @smallexample
38679 SEEK_SET 0
38680 SEEK_CUR 1
38681 SEEK_END 2
38682 @end smallexample
38683
38684 @node Limits
38685 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38686 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38687
38688 All values are given in decimal representation.
38689
38690 @smallexample
38691 INT_MIN -2147483648
38692 INT_MAX 2147483647
38693 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38694 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38695 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38696 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38697 @end smallexample
38698
38699 @node File-I/O Examples
38700 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38701 @cindex file-i/o examples
38702
38703 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38704 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38705
38706 @smallexample
38707 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38708 @emph{request memory read from target}
38709 -> @code{m1234,6}
38710 <- XXXXXX
38711 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38712 -> @code{F6}
38713 @end smallexample
38714
38715 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38716 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38717
38718 @smallexample
38719 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38720 @emph{request memory write to target}
38721 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38722 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38723 -> @code{F6}
38724 @end smallexample
38725
38726 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38727 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38728
38729 @smallexample
38730 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38731 -> @code{F-1,9}
38732 @end smallexample
38733
38734 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38735 host is called:
38736
38737 @smallexample
38738 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38739 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38740 <- @code{T02}
38741 @end smallexample
38742
38743 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38744 host is called:
38745
38746 @smallexample
38747 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38748 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38749 <- @code{T02}
38750 @end smallexample
38751
38752 @node Library List Format
38753 @section Library List Format
38754 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38755
38756 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38757 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38758 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38759 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38760 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38761 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38762 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38763 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38764 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38765 are loaded.
38766
38767 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38768 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38769 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38770 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38771
38772 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38773 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38774 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38775 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38776 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38777 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38778
38779 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38780 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38781
38782 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38783 offset, looks like this:
38784
38785 @smallexample
38786 <library-list>
38787 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38788 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38789 </library>
38790 </library-list>
38791 @end smallexample
38792
38793 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38794 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38795
38796 @smallexample
38797 <library-list>
38798 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38799 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38800 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38801 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38802 </library>
38803 </library-list>
38804 @end smallexample
38805
38806 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38807
38808 @smallexample
38809 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38810 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38811 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38812 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38813 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38814 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38815 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38816 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38817 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38818 @end smallexample
38819
38820 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38821 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38822 section for each library.
38823
38824 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38825 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38826 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38827
38828 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38829 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38830 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38831 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38832
38833 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38834 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38835 target, the following parameters are reported:
38836
38837 @itemize @minus
38838 @item
38839 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38840 @code{struct link_map}.
38841 @item
38842 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38843 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38844 @item
38845 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38846 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38847 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38848 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38849 @item
38850 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38851 @end itemize
38852
38853 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38854 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38855 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38856
38857 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38858 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38859
38860 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38861 looks like this:
38862
38863 @smallexample
38864 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38865 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38866 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38867 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38868 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38869 </library-list-svr>
38870 @end smallexample
38871
38872 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38873
38874 @smallexample
38875 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38876 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38877 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38878 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38879 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38880 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38881 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38882 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38883 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38884 @end smallexample
38885
38886 @node Memory Map Format
38887 @section Memory Map Format
38888 @cindex memory map format
38889
38890 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38891 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38892 memory map.
38893
38894 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38895 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38896 lists memory regions.
38897
38898 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38899 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38900
38901 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38902
38903 @smallexample
38904 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38905 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38906 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38907 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38908 <memory-map>
38909 region...
38910 </memory-map>
38911 @end smallexample
38912
38913 Each region can be either:
38914
38915 @itemize
38916
38917 @item
38918 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38919 bytes from there:
38920
38921 @smallexample
38922 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38923 @end smallexample
38924
38925
38926 @item
38927 A region of read-only memory:
38928
38929 @smallexample
38930 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38931 @end smallexample
38932
38933
38934 @item
38935 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38936 bytes in length:
38937
38938 @smallexample
38939 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38940 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38941 </memory>
38942 @end smallexample
38943
38944 @end itemize
38945
38946 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38947 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38948 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38949
38950 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38951
38952 @smallexample
38953 <!-- ................................................... -->
38954 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38955 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38956 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38957 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38958 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38959 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38960 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38961 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38962 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38963 and its type, or device. -->
38964 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38965 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38966 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38967 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38968 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38969 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38970 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38971 @end smallexample
38972
38973 @node Thread List Format
38974 @section Thread List Format
38975 @cindex thread list format
38976
38977 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38978 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38979 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38980 the following structure:
38981
38982 @smallexample
38983 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38984 <threads>
38985 <thread id="id" core="0">
38986 ... description ...
38987 </thread>
38988 </threads>
38989 @end smallexample
38990
38991 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38992 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38993 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38994 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38995 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38996
38997 @node Traceframe Info Format
38998 @section Traceframe Info Format
38999 @cindex traceframe info format
39000
39001 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39002 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39003 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39004 collected in a traceframe.
39005
39006 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39007 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39008
39009 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39010 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39011
39012 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39013
39014 @smallexample
39015 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39016 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39017 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39018 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39019 <traceframe-info>
39020 block...
39021 </traceframe-info>
39022 @end smallexample
39023
39024 Each traceframe block can be either:
39025
39026 @itemize
39027
39028 @item
39029 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39030 @var{length} bytes from there:
39031
39032 @smallexample
39033 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39034 @end smallexample
39035
39036 @item
39037 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39038 collected:
39039
39040 @smallexample
39041 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39042 @end smallexample
39043
39044 @end itemize
39045
39046 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39047
39048 @smallexample
39049 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39050 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39051
39052 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39053 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39054 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39055 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39056 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39057 @end smallexample
39058
39059 @node Branch Trace Format
39060 @section Branch Trace Format
39061 @cindex branch trace format
39062
39063 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39064 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39065 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39066 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39067
39068 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39069 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39070
39071 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39072 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39073
39074 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39075
39076 @smallexample
39077 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39078 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39079 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39080 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39081 <btrace>
39082 block...
39083 </btrace>
39084 @end smallexample
39085
39086 @itemize
39087
39088 @item
39089 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39090 and ending at @var{end}:
39091
39092 @smallexample
39093 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39094 @end smallexample
39095
39096 @end itemize
39097
39098 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39099
39100 @smallexample
39101 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39102 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39103
39104 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39105 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39106 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39107 @end smallexample
39108
39109 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39110 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39111 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39112
39113 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39114 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39115 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39116
39117 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39118 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39119
39120 @table @code
39121 @item bts
39122 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39123 @table @code
39124 @item size
39125 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39126 @end table
39127 @end table
39128
39129 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39130 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39131
39132 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39133
39134 @smallexample
39135 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39136 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39137
39138 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39139 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39140 @end smallexample
39141
39142 @include agentexpr.texi
39143
39144 @node Target Descriptions
39145 @appendix Target Descriptions
39146 @cindex target descriptions
39147
39148 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39149 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39150 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39151 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39152 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39153 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39154 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39155
39156 @itemize @bullet
39157 @item
39158 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39159 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39160 @item
39161 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39162 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39163 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39164 @item
39165 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39166 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39167 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39168 @end itemize
39169
39170 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39171 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39172 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39173 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39174 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39175
39176 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39177 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39178
39179 @menu
39180 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39181 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39182 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39183 descriptions.
39184 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39185 @end menu
39186
39187 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39188 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39189
39190 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39191 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39192 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39193 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39194 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39195 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39196 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39197 Format}.
39198
39199 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39200 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39201 specify a file are:
39202
39203 @table @code
39204 @cindex set tdesc filename
39205 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39206 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39207
39208 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39209 @item unset tdesc filename
39210 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39211 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39212
39213 @cindex show tdesc filename
39214 @item show tdesc filename
39215 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39216 @end table
39217
39218
39219 @node Target Description Format
39220 @section Target Description Format
39221 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39222
39223 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39224 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39225 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39226 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39227 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39228 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39229 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39230
39231 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39232 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39233 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39234 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39235 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39236
39237 Here is a simple target description:
39238
39239 @smallexample
39240 <target version="1.0">
39241 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39242 </target>
39243 @end smallexample
39244
39245 @noindent
39246 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39247 the x86-64 architecture.
39248
39249 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39250 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39251 are explained further below.
39252
39253 @smallexample
39254 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39255 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39256 <target version="1.0">
39257 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39258 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39259 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39260 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39261 </target>
39262 @end smallexample
39263
39264 @noindent
39265 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39266 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39267 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39268 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39269 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39270 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39271 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39272 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39273 the version mismatch.
39274
39275 @subsection Inclusion
39276 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39277 @cindex XInclude
39278 @ifnotinfo
39279 @cindex <xi:include>
39280 @end ifnotinfo
39281
39282 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39283 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39284 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39285 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39286 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39287
39288 @smallexample
39289 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39290 @end smallexample
39291
39292 @noindent
39293 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39294 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39295 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39296 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39297 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39298 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39299 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39300 original description.
39301
39302 @subsection Architecture
39303 @cindex <architecture>
39304
39305 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39306
39307 @smallexample
39308 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39309 @end smallexample
39310
39311 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39312 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39313
39314 @subsection OS ABI
39315 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39316
39317 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39318 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39319
39320 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39321
39322 @smallexample
39323 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39324 @end smallexample
39325
39326 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39327 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39328
39329 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39330 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39331
39332 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39333 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39334
39335 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39336
39337 @smallexample
39338 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39339 @end smallexample
39340
39341 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39342 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39343
39344 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39345 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39346 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39347 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39348 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39349 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39350 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39351
39352 @smallexample
39353 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39354 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39355 @end smallexample
39356
39357 @subsection Features
39358 @cindex <feature>
39359
39360 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39361 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39362 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39363 has this form:
39364
39365 @smallexample
39366 <feature name="@var{name}">
39367 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39368 @var{reg}@dots{}
39369 </feature>
39370 @end smallexample
39371
39372 @noindent
39373 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39374 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39375 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39376 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39377
39378 @subsection Types
39379
39380 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39381 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39382 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39383 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39384 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39385
39386 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39387 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39388 Types must be defined before they are used.
39389
39390 @cindex <vector>
39391 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39392 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39393 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39394 @var{count}:
39395
39396 @smallexample
39397 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39398 @end smallexample
39399
39400 @cindex <union>
39401 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39402 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39403 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39404 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39405
39406 @smallexample
39407 <union id="@var{id}">
39408 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39409 @dots{}
39410 </union>
39411 @end smallexample
39412
39413 @cindex <struct>
39414 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39415 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39416 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39417 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39418 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39419 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39420 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39421 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39422
39423 @smallexample
39424 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39425 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39426 @dots{}
39427 </struct>
39428 @end smallexample
39429
39430 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39431 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39432
39433 @smallexample
39434 <struct id="@var{id}">
39435 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39436 @dots{}
39437 </struct>
39438 @end smallexample
39439
39440 @cindex <flags>
39441 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39442 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39443 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39444 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39445 are supported.
39446
39447 @smallexample
39448 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39449 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39450 @dots{}
39451 </flags>
39452 @end smallexample
39453
39454 @subsection Registers
39455 @cindex <reg>
39456
39457 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39458
39459 @smallexample
39460 <reg name="@var{name}"
39461 bitsize="@var{size}"
39462 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39463 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39464 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39465 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39466 @end smallexample
39467
39468 @noindent
39469 The components are as follows:
39470
39471 @table @var
39472
39473 @item name
39474 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39475
39476 @item bitsize
39477 The register's size, in bits.
39478
39479 @item regnum
39480 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39481 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39482 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39483 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39484 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39485 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39486 in order of increasing register number.
39487
39488 @item save-restore
39489 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39490 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39491 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39492 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39493 ABI.
39494
39495 @item type
39496 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39497 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39498 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39499 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39500 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39501 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39502
39503 @item group
39504 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39505 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39506 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39507 in @code{info registers}.
39508
39509 @end table
39510
39511 @node Predefined Target Types
39512 @section Predefined Target Types
39513 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39514
39515 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39516 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39517 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39518 types. The currently supported types are:
39519
39520 @table @code
39521
39522 @item int8
39523 @itemx int16
39524 @itemx int32
39525 @itemx int64
39526 @itemx int128
39527 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39528
39529 @item uint8
39530 @itemx uint16
39531 @itemx uint32
39532 @itemx uint64
39533 @itemx uint128
39534 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39535
39536 @item code_ptr
39537 @itemx data_ptr
39538 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39539 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39540 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39541 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39542 may be marked as data pointers.
39543
39544 @item ieee_single
39545 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39546
39547 @item ieee_double
39548 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39549
39550 @item arm_fpa_ext
39551 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39552
39553 @item i387_ext
39554 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39555
39556 @item i386_eflags
39557 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39558
39559 @item i386_mxcsr
39560 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39561
39562 @end table
39563
39564 @node Standard Target Features
39565 @section Standard Target Features
39566 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39567
39568 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39569 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39570 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39571 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39572 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39573 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39574 can recognize them.
39575
39576 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39577 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39578 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39579 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39580 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39581 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39582 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39583 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39584
39585 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39586 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39587 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39588
39589 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39590 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39591 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39592 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39593
39594 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39595 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39596 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39597
39598 @menu
39599 * AArch64 Features::
39600 * ARM Features::
39601 * i386 Features::
39602 * MicroBlaze Features::
39603 * MIPS Features::
39604 * M68K Features::
39605 * Nios II Features::
39606 * PowerPC Features::
39607 * S/390 and System z Features::
39608 * TIC6x Features::
39609 @end menu
39610
39611
39612 @node AArch64 Features
39613 @subsection AArch64 Features
39614 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39615
39616 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39617 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39618 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39619
39620 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39621 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39622 and @samp{fpcr}.
39623
39624 @node ARM Features
39625 @subsection ARM Features
39626 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39627
39628 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39629 ARM targets.
39630 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39631 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39632
39633 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39634 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39635 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39636 and @samp{xpsr}.
39637
39638 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39639 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39640
39641 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39642 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39643 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39644 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39645
39646 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39647 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39648 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39649 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39650 halves of the double-precision registers.
39651
39652 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39653 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39654 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39655 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39656 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39657 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39658
39659 @node i386 Features
39660 @subsection i386 Features
39661 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39662
39663 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39664 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39665
39666 @itemize @minus
39667 @item
39668 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39669 @item
39670 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39671 @item
39672 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39673 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39674 @item
39675 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39676 @item
39677 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39678 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39679 @end itemize
39680
39681 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39682
39683 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39684 describe registers:
39685
39686 @itemize @minus
39687 @item
39688 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39689 @item
39690 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39691 @item
39692 @samp{mxcsr}
39693 @end itemize
39694
39695 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39696 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39697 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39698
39699 @itemize @minus
39700 @item
39701 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39702 @item
39703 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39704 @end itemize
39705
39706 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39707 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39708
39709 @itemize @minus
39710 @item
39711 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39712 @item
39713 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39714 @end itemize
39715
39716 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39717 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39718
39719 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39720 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39721 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39722
39723 @itemize @minus
39724 @item
39725 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39726 @end itemize
39727
39728 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39729
39730 @itemize @minus
39731 @item
39732 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39733 @end itemize
39734
39735 It should
39736 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39737
39738 @itemize @minus
39739 @item
39740 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39741 @item
39742 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39743 @end itemize
39744
39745 It should
39746 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39747
39748 @itemize @minus
39749 @item
39750 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39751 @end itemize
39752
39753 @node MicroBlaze Features
39754 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39755 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39756
39757 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39758 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39759 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39760 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39761 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39762
39763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39764 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39765
39766 @node MIPS Features
39767 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39768 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39769
39770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39771 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39772 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39773 on the target.
39774
39775 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39776 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39777 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39778
39779 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39780 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39781 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39782 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39783
39784 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39785 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39786 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39787 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39788
39789 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39790 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39791 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39792
39793 @node M68K Features
39794 @subsection M68K Features
39795 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39796
39797 @table @code
39798 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39799 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39800 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39801 One of those features must be always present.
39802 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39803 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39804 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39805 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39806
39807 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39808 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39809 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39810 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39811 @end table
39812
39813 @node Nios II Features
39814 @subsection Nios II Features
39815 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39816
39817 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39818 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39819 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39820 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39821 @samp{mpuacc}).
39822
39823 @node PowerPC Features
39824 @subsection PowerPC Features
39825 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39826
39827 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39828 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39829 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39830 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39831
39832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39833 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39834
39835 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39836 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39837 and @samp{vrsave}.
39838
39839 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39840 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39841 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39842 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39843 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39844 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39845
39846 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39847 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39848 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39849 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39850 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39851 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39852 user.
39853
39854 @node S/390 and System z Features
39855 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39856 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39857 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39858
39859 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39860 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39861 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39862 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39863 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39864 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39865 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39866 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39867 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39868
39869 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39870 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39871 @samp{fpc}.
39872
39873 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39874 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39875
39876 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39877 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39878 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39879 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39880 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39881 32-bit wide.
39882
39883 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39884 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39885 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39886
39887 @node TIC6x Features
39888 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39889 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39890 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39891 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39892 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39893 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39894
39895 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39896 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39897 through @samp{B31}.
39898
39899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39900 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39901
39902 @node Operating System Information
39903 @appendix Operating System Information
39904 @cindex operating system information
39905
39906 @menu
39907 * Process list::
39908 @end menu
39909
39910 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39911 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39912 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39913 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39914 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39915 on a different aspect of target.
39916
39917 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39918 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39919 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39920 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39921
39922 @node Process list
39923 @appendixsection Process list
39924 @cindex operating system information, process list
39925
39926 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39927 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39928 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39929 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39930
39931 An example document is:
39932
39933 @smallexample
39934 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39935 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39936 <osdata type="processes">
39937 <item>
39938 <column name="pid">1</column>
39939 <column name="user">root</column>
39940 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39941 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39942 </item>
39943 </osdata>
39944 @end smallexample
39945
39946 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39947 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39948 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39949 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39950 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39951 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39952 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39953
39954 @node Trace File Format
39955 @appendix Trace File Format
39956 @cindex trace file format
39957
39958 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39959 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39960
39961 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39962 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39963 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39964 in the future.
39965
39966 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39967 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39968 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39969 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39970 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39971 of this section.
39972
39973 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39974
39975 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39976 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39977 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39978 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39979 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39980 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39981 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39982 endianness.
39983
39984 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39985
39986 @table @code
39987 @item R @var{bytes}
39988 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39989 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39990 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39991 hexadecimal encoding.
39992
39993 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39994 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39995 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39996 @var{length} bytes.
39997
39998 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39999 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40000 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40001
40002 @end table
40003
40004 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40005 of blocks.
40006
40007 @node Index Section Format
40008 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40009 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40010 @cindex index section format
40011
40012 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40013 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40014 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40015 description.
40016
40017 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40018 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40019 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40020 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40021 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40022 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40023
40024 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40025
40026 @enumerate
40027 @item
40028 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40029 unless otherwise noted:
40030
40031 @enumerate
40032 @item
40033 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40034 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40035 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40036 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40037 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40038 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40039 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40040
40041 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40042 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40043 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40044 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40045
40046 @item
40047 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40048
40049 @item
40050 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40051 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40052 to the next offset.
40053
40054 @item
40055 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40056
40057 @item
40058 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40059
40060 @item
40061 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40062 @end enumerate
40063
40064 @item
40065 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40066 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40067 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40068 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40069 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40070 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40071 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40072 CU indices.
40073
40074 @item
40075 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40076 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40077 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40078 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40079
40080 @item
40081 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40082 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40083
40084 @enumerate
40085 @item
40086 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40087
40088 @item
40089 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40090 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40091
40092 @item
40093 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40094 @end enumerate
40095
40096 @item
40097 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40098 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40099
40100 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40101 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40102 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40103 constant pool.
40104
40105 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40106 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40107 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40108
40109 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40110 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40111 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40112 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40113 index version:
40114
40115 @table @asis
40116 @item Version 4
40117 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40118
40119 @item Versions 5 to 7
40120 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40121 @end table
40122
40123 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40124
40125 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40126 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40127 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40128 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40129 collision.
40130
40131 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40132 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40133 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40134 the code.
40135
40136 @item
40137 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40138 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40139 strings.
40140
40141 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40142 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40143 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40144 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40145 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40146 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40147
40148 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40149 @end enumerate
40150
40151 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40152 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40153 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40154
40155 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40156 (bit 0 = LSB):
40157
40158 @table @asis
40159
40160 @item Bits 0-23
40161 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40162 @item Bits 24-27
40163 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40164 @item Bits 28-30
40165 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40166
40167 @table @asis
40168 @item 0
40169 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40170 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40171 with previous versions of the index.
40172 @item 1
40173 The symbol is a type.
40174 @item 2
40175 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40176 @item 3
40177 The symbol is a function.
40178 @item 4
40179 Any other kind of symbol.
40180 @item 5,6,7
40181 These values are reserved.
40182 @end table
40183
40184 @item Bit 31
40185 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40186
40187 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40188 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40189 @value{GDBN} sources.
40190
40191 @end table
40192
40193 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40194 global/static attributes in the index.
40195
40196 @smallexample
40197 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40198 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40199 switch (die->tag)
40200 @{
40201 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40202 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40203 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40204 kind = TYPE;
40205 is_static = 1;
40206 break;
40207 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40208 kind = VARIABLE;
40209 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40210 break;
40211 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40212 kind = FUNCTION;
40213 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40214 break;
40215 case DW_TAG_constant:
40216 kind = VARIABLE;
40217 is_static = ! is_external;
40218 break;
40219 case DW_TAG_variable:
40220 kind = VARIABLE;
40221 is_static = ! is_external;
40222 break;
40223 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40224 kind = TYPE;
40225 is_static = 0;
40226 break;
40227 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40228 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40229 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40230 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40231 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40232 kind = TYPE;
40233 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40234 break;
40235 default:
40236 assert (0);
40237 @}
40238 @end smallexample
40239
40240 @node Man Pages
40241 @appendix Manual pages
40242 @cindex Man pages
40243
40244 @menu
40245 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40246 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40247 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40248 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40249 @end menu
40250
40251 @node gdb man
40252 @heading gdb man
40253
40254 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40255
40256 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40257 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40258 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40259 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40260 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40261 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40262 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40263 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40264 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40265 @c man end
40266
40267 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40268 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40269 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40270 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40271
40272 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40273 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40274
40275 @itemize @bullet
40276 @item
40277 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40278
40279 @item
40280 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40281
40282 @item
40283 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40284
40285 @item
40286 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40287 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40288 @end itemize
40289
40290 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40291 Modula-2.
40292
40293 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40294 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40295 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40296 by using the command @code{help}.
40297
40298 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40299 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40300 executable program as the argument:
40301
40302 @smallexample
40303 gdb program
40304 @end smallexample
40305
40306 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40307
40308 @smallexample
40309 gdb program core
40310 @end smallexample
40311
40312 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40313 to debug a running process:
40314
40315 @smallexample
40316 gdb program 1234
40317 gdb -p 1234
40318 @end smallexample
40319
40320 @noindent
40321 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40322 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40323 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40324
40325 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40326
40327 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40328 @table @env
40329 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40330 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40331
40332 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40333 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40334
40335 @item bt
40336 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40337
40338 @item print @var{expr}
40339 Display the value of an expression.
40340
40341 @item c
40342 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40343
40344 @item next
40345 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40346 function calls in the line.
40347
40348 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40349 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40350
40351 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40352 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40353
40354 @item step
40355 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40356 function calls in the line.
40357
40358 @item help [@var{name}]
40359 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40360 about using @value{GDBN}.
40361
40362 @item quit
40363 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40364 @end table
40365
40366 @ifset man
40367 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40368 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40369 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40370 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40371 @end ifset
40372 @c man end
40373
40374 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40375 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40376 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40377 encountered with no
40378 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40379 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40380 Many options have
40381 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40382 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40383 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40384 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40385 more usual convention.)
40386
40387 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40388 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40389 option is used.
40390
40391 @table @env
40392 @item -help
40393 @itemx -h
40394 List all options, with brief explanations.
40395
40396 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40397 @itemx -s @var{file}
40398 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40399
40400 @item -write
40401 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40402
40403 @item -exec=@var{file}
40404 @itemx -e @var{file}
40405 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40406 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40407 dump.
40408
40409 @item -se=@var{file}
40410 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40411 file.
40412
40413 @item -core=@var{file}
40414 @itemx -c @var{file}
40415 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40416
40417 @item -command=@var{file}
40418 @itemx -x @var{file}
40419 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40420
40421 @item -ex @var{command}
40422 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40423
40424 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40425 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40426 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40427
40428 @item -nh
40429 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40430
40431 @item -nx
40432 @itemx -n
40433 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40434
40435 @item -quiet
40436 @itemx -q
40437 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40438 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40439
40440 @item -batch
40441 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40442 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40443 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40444 commands in the command files.
40445
40446 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40447 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40448 more useful, the message
40449
40450 @smallexample
40451 Program exited normally.
40452 @end smallexample
40453
40454 @noindent
40455 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40456 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40457
40458 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40459 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40460 instead of the current directory.
40461
40462 @item -fullname
40463 @itemx -f
40464 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40465 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40466 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40467 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40468 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40469 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40470 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40471 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40472
40473 @item -b @var{bps}
40474 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40475 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40476
40477 @item -tty=@var{device}
40478 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40479 @end table
40480 @c man end
40481
40482 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40483 @ifset man
40484 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40485 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40486 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40487
40488 @smallexample
40489 info gdb
40490 @end smallexample
40491
40492 @noindent
40493 should give you access to the complete manual.
40494
40495 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40496 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40497 @end ifset
40498 @c man end
40499
40500 @node gdbserver man
40501 @heading gdbserver man
40502
40503 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40504 @format
40505 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40506 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40507
40508 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40509
40510 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40511 @c man end
40512 @end format
40513
40514 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40515 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40516 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40517
40518 @ifclear man
40519 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40520 @end ifclear
40521 @ifset man
40522 Usage (server (target) side):
40523 @end ifset
40524
40525 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40526 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40527 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40528 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40529
40530 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40531 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40532 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40533
40534 @smallexample
40535 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40536 @end smallexample
40537
40538 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40539
40540 @smallexample
40541 @ifset man
40542 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40543 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40544 @end ifset
40545 @ifclear man
40546 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40547 @end ifclear
40548 @end smallexample
40549
40550 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40551 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40552 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40553
40554 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40555
40556 @smallexample
40557 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40558 @end smallexample
40559
40560 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40561 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40562 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40563 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40564 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40565 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40566 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40567 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40568 print an error message and exit.
40569
40570 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40571 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40572
40573 @smallexample
40574 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40575 @end smallexample
40576
40577 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40578 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40579
40580 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40581 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40582 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40583 the program you want to debug.
40584
40585 @smallexample
40586 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40587 @end smallexample
40588
40589 @ifclear man
40590 @subheading Usage (host side)
40591 @end ifclear
40592 @ifset man
40593 Usage (host side):
40594 @end ifset
40595
40596 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40597 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40598 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40599 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40600 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40601 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40602 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40603 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40604 descriptor. For example:
40605
40606 @smallexample
40607 @ifset man
40608 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40609 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40610 @end ifset
40611 @ifclear man
40612 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40613 @end ifclear
40614 @end smallexample
40615
40616 @noindent
40617 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40618
40619 @smallexample
40620 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40621 @end smallexample
40622
40623 @noindent
40624 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40625 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40626 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40627 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40628 `Connection refused'.
40629
40630 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40631 described in
40632 @ifset man
40633 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40634 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40635 @end ifset
40636 @ifclear man
40637 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40638 @end ifclear
40639 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40640
40641 @smallexample
40642 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40643 @end smallexample
40644
40645 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40646 case.
40647 @c man end
40648
40649 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40650 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40651
40652 @itemize @bullet
40653
40654 @item
40655 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40656
40657 @smallexample
40658 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40659 @end smallexample
40660
40661 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40662 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40663 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40664 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40665 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40666 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40667 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40668
40669 @item
40670 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40671 program:
40672
40673 @smallexample
40674 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40675 @end smallexample
40676
40677 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40678 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40679 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40680 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40681
40682 @item
40683 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40684
40685 @smallexample
40686 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40687 @end smallexample
40688
40689 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40690 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40691 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40692 debug several processes in the same session.
40693 @end itemize
40694
40695 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40696
40697 @table @env
40698
40699 @item --help
40700 List all options, with brief explanations.
40701
40702 @item --version
40703 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40704
40705 @item --attach
40706 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40707
40708 @smallexample
40709 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40710 @end smallexample
40711
40712 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40713 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40714
40715 @item --multi
40716 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40717 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40718 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40719 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40720
40721 @smallexample
40722 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40723 @end smallexample
40724
40725 @item --debug
40726 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40727 process.
40728 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40729 the developers.
40730
40731 @item --remote-debug
40732 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40733 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40734 the developers.
40735
40736 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40737 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40738 of debugging output.
40739 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40740
40741 @item --wrapper
40742 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40743 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40744 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40745 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40746
40747 @item --once
40748 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40749 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40750 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40751 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40752
40753 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40754
40755 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40756 @c QDisableRandomization.
40757
40758 @end table
40759 @c man end
40760
40761 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40762 @ifset man
40763 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40764 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40765 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40766
40767 @smallexample
40768 info gdb
40769 @end smallexample
40770
40771 should give you access to the complete manual.
40772
40773 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40774 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40775 @end ifset
40776 @c man end
40777
40778 @node gcore man
40779 @heading gcore
40780
40781 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40782
40783 @format
40784 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40785 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40786 @c man end
40787 @end format
40788
40789 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40790 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40791 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40792 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40793 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40794 running without any change.
40795 @c man end
40796
40797 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40798 @table @env
40799 @item -o @var{filename}
40800 The optional argument
40801 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40802 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40803 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40804 @end table
40805 @c man end
40806
40807 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40808 @ifset man
40809 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40810 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40811 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40812
40813 @smallexample
40814 info gdb
40815 @end smallexample
40816
40817 @noindent
40818 should give you access to the complete manual.
40819
40820 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40821 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40822 @end ifset
40823 @c man end
40824
40825 @node gdbinit man
40826 @heading gdbinit
40827
40828 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40829
40830 @format
40831 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40832 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40833 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40834 @end ifset
40835
40836 ~/.gdbinit
40837
40838 ./.gdbinit
40839 @c man end
40840 @end format
40841
40842 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40843 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40844 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40845 described in
40846 @ifset man
40847 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40848 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40849 @end ifset
40850 @ifclear man
40851 @ref{Sequences}.
40852 @end ifclear
40853
40854 Please read more in
40855 @ifset man
40856 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40857 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40858 @end ifset
40859 @ifclear man
40860 @ref{Startup}.
40861 @end ifclear
40862
40863 @table @env
40864 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40865 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40866 @end ifset
40867 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40868 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40869 @end ifclear
40870 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40871 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40872 See more in
40873 @ifset man
40874 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40875 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40876 @end ifset
40877 @ifclear man
40878 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40879 @end ifclear
40880
40881 @item ~/.gdbinit
40882 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40883 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40884
40885 @item ./.gdbinit
40886 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40887 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40888 See more in
40889 @ifset man
40890 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40891 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40892 @end ifset
40893 @ifclear man
40894 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40895 @end ifclear
40896 @end table
40897 @c man end
40898
40899 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40900 @ifset man
40901 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40902
40903 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40904 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40905 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40906
40907 @smallexample
40908 info gdb
40909 @end smallexample
40910
40911 should give you access to the complete manual.
40912
40913 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40914 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40915 @end ifset
40916 @c man end
40917
40918 @include gpl.texi
40919
40920 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40921 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40922 @include fdl.texi
40923
40924 @node Concept Index
40925 @unnumbered Concept Index
40926
40927 @printindex cp
40928
40929 @node Command and Variable Index
40930 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40931
40932 @printindex fn
40933
40934 @tex
40935 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40936 % meantime:
40937 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40938 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40939 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40940 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40941 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40942 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40943 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40944 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40945 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40946 \page\colophon
40947 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40948 @end tex
40949
40950 @bye
This page took 0.901529 seconds and 3 git commands to generate.